18000010-HD-11994:90a678e2d15f84fbe93cb13dca896c57Tender No. : 18000010-HD-11994 Tender Published On...
Transcript of 18000010-HD-11994:90a678e2d15f84fbe93cb13dca896c57Tender No. : 18000010-HD-11994 Tender Published On...
18000010-HD-11994:90a678e2d15f84fbe93cb13dca896c57
Delivery Terms - Free to Destination location unless specified otherwise. Validity of offer - 120 days from the initial or extended Due Date for submission
of Tender whichever is later unless specified otherwise. Liquidated Damages/Price Reduction clause accepted unless specified otherwise.
In case bidder does not deviate from the standard offer validity in on line deviation form, bid’s offer validity shall be considered as mentioned above.
In case a Revised priced bid is initiated for this tender, at a later date (eg Technical evaluation stage etc), it shall be incumbent upon the bidder to submit
revised bids for the specified items/entire tender. In the absence of revised bids rom the bidder within specified time period, the original bid submitted by
the bidder shall not be considered for evaluation.
HPCL reserves the right to reveal the contents of the bid documents submitted by the vendor during the witness bid opening process as per prevailing
policy of the corporation.
Please quote all the taxes, if applicable, only in percentage terms and not in Per unit(Amount) basis. The Per unit option is provided only to quote for
extras like Loading charges, packing charges, TPI charges etc. In case, it is found that you have quoted taxes in amount basis, your bid may be liable for
rejection.
Tender No. : 18000010-HD-11994 Tender Published On : 21-Jun-2018 11:15
Basic Information Of TenderTitle Solar Car Parking Shed-VREEP
Description Supply and Installation of Car Parking sheds at IPS1, IPS2 and IPS3 Locations
Tender Type Public
Tender Scope Domestic
Bid Type Two Bid
Evaluation Criteria Overall L1 for all items
Tender Due Date & Time 12-Jul-2018 15:00
Reverse Auction Applicable Yes
Pre Bid Conference Start Date & Time
Pre Bid Conference End Date & Time
Queries Start Date & Time 21-Jun-2018 16:00
Quries End Date & Time 28-Jun-2018 15:00
Un Priced Bid Open Date & Time 12-Jul-2018 15:30
Purchase Deptt. PUR DEPT-MANGALORE BANGALORE LPG PL PROJ
Fax No. 22608555
Office Address Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited ,No. 332,Darus Salam Building(2nd Floor) ,Queens Road, ,Bangalore ,560052 , ,KA , ,
TF/EMD Drop Box Address D P Srivatsva,Manager Purchase,HPCL, 2nd floor no. 332, Darus Salam building, queens road,Banglore-560052
Tender Description WorleyParsons on behalf of Ms Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (HPCL)invites bids through e-tendering onPublic Domestic Competitive Bidding basisfor Supply and installation of Car Parking sheds for IPS1, IPS2 andIPS3Locations for VVSPL Capacity Augmentation Project, HPCL under single stagetwo envelopes system asdetailed given in tender. Bids submitted online shallonly be considered for processing.Digitally signed and sealed(encrypted) e-tender (on line bid only to be submitted at site https:etender.hpcl.co.in are invited under two bid systemTender No. 18000010-HD-11994, Tender submission due date: Upto 12.07.2018 (15:00 Hrs.)Online Unpriced Bidopening : From 15:30 Hours on 12.07.2018.The tender details including EMD, etc. can also be viewed at HPCLwebsite www.hindustanpetroleum.com under tender section: link-Tenders and Contracts.ALL REVISIONS,CLARIFICATIONS,CORRIGENDA,ADDENDA,TIME AND DUE DATE EXTENSIONSETC., TO THE TENDER WILLBE HOSTED ON WEBSITE www.hindustanpetroleum.com along with website mentioned above. BIDDERSSHOULDREGULARLY VISIT THIS WEBSITES TO KEEP THEMSELVES UPDATED
Notice Inviting Tender This Public Tender is floated for Supply and installation of Car Parking sheds for IPS1, IPS2 and IPS3 Locations forVVSPL Project.
Currency Type Tender Fee EMD
INR 0.0 42000.0
Business Rules and Terms & Conditions of Reverse Auction
Page 1 of 7
HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LIMITED
Reverse Auction – Terms & Conditions and Procedure HPCL proposes to conduct Reverse auction for the items or schedules or on overall basis as specified in the tender. Please go through the Terms & Conditions and Procedure given below and submit your acceptance to the same by signing and uploading this document along with unpriced bid. Terms & Conditions
1. HPCL reserves the right to carryout ‘Online Reverse Auction’ with techno-commercially accepted bidders for determining the lowest bidder for the requirements mentioned in this tender enquiry. Reverse auction shall be conducted only when there are at least two or more “Techno-commercially” accepted vendors at Technical evaluation stage.
2. Online reverse auction shall be conducted by HPCL on a specified date and time. The
vendors shall be participating in the reverse auction from their own offices / place of their choice. Internet connectivity shall have to be ensured by the bidders themselves. HPCL shall not be held responsible for local issues, such as loss of connectivity, Internet discontinuity, and discrepancy in browser which may result in non-display of latest bid in client PC.
3. In extreme case of Server outage, network outage or failure of Internet connectivity, (or any
other unforeseen conditions) from HPCL’s end, fax/ E-Mail communication shall have to be made immediately, to concerned purchase officer of HPCL. No such request shall be entertained beyond one hour of the RA closing time. To provide equal opportunity, HPCL may decide to extend the Reverse auction at their discretion, but not as the right of the bidder. The vendors participating in Reverse Auction process shall be kept on standby for 1 Hour after RA closing time.
4. HPCL shall investigate the above matter and decision for extension of Reverse Auction shall be
based on the merit of the issues pointed out and verified by HPCL and same shall be final and binding on the vendor.
5. HPCL shall complete the investigation within two working days of receiving complaint from
any of the vendor.
6. In case of decision to extend Reverse Auction, intimation mail may go out to all vendors within a day of investigation closure. Vendors shall generally be given intimation, a day in advance before extended Reverse Auction is commenced. The Reverse Auction shall
Business Rules and Terms & Conditions of Reverse Auction
Page 2 of 7
HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LIMITED
commence from the last saved decrement value and shall be open for period of original duration from commencement.
7. Bidders have to confirm their willingness to participate in ‘Online Reverse Auction’ during their bid submission by ensuring compliance to the Terms & Conditions and Procedure specified herewith. Please note that non acceptance to participate in the Reverse Auction process will lead to rejection of the bid without any further evaluation.
8. HPCL will pre-decide the commercial loading, if any, on the basis of the taxes & duties
quoted by the bidder, and loading on account of commercial deviations, if any. The loading factors shall be displayed in the portal prior to the date scheduled for Reverse Auction Event.
9. Bidders are requested to understand the impact of loading factors applied on their bids at
the earliest, on getting intimation regarding same. In case of any objection to the applied loading factor same shall be brought to the notice of Purchase officer immediately. No further communication on this ground will be entertained after publishing of Reverse auction.
10. As part of Reverse Auction process, the Start Bid price(Benchmark) shall be specified by
HPCL on Reverse Auction Portal, which shall be the lowest of the price bids, as submitted by the bidders on the e-procurement portal i.e. ‘Bids opened for RA event’ and HPCL’s in-house estimate. Please note that such priced bid opening shall be system driven and therefore bidder’s identity vis-à-vis quoted price shall be confidential.
11. In case of overall evaluation tenders or schedule wise evaluation tender, the Reverse
auction shall be conducted on the bottom line, net delivered cost.
12. In case of tenders, which are evaluated on Schedule wise or Overall L1 basis, the individual item rates will get reduced on pro-rated basis as the decrements are effected during reverse auction event.
13. During the Reverse auction event, the taxes which are quoted in percentage basis will get
reduced proportionately as the RA progresses. However, Extras like Loading charges/packing charges/TPI which are quoted in per unit basis (amount terms) remains constant as the decrements are effected.
14. Vendors shall ensure to quote the statutory taxes only in percentage basis and not in
amount terms. In case of non-compliance to this clause, bids shall be liable for rejection.
Business Rules and Terms & Conditions of Reverse Auction
Page 3 of 7
HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LIMITED
15. System shall allow to conduct Reverse Auction on multi-currency tender/bidding. The exchange rate for converting the INR value to originally quoted currency (USD, EUR, GBP, JPY only) shall be the one which was prevailing on the date of unpriced bid opening in line with tender condition. In such cases the basic reverse Auction shall be carried out in INR currency only. However bidders having submitted bids in any of the four currencies – USD, EUR, GBP, JPY shall be able to view the basic rates ( in original currency basis conversion on the date of unpriced bid opening ) corresponding to contemplated decrement in the “show” screen. (Vendors may first check impact of decrement on item rates in original currency before submission of decrement during RA).
16. Reverse auction shall be held for a period of 60 minutes and shall be automatically extended by a further period of 5 minutes in case of receipt of any bid during the last 5 minutes of the auction period. This process shall continue until no bids are received in the last 5 minutes of the auction. Hence it may be noted that the reverse auction may continue beyond a period of 60 minutes. Thereafter reverse auction shall get automatically closed. This shall be an automated process.
17. Order may be placed on the lowest bidder, emerging out of the reverse auction process and
HPCL’s decision on award of contract shall be final and binding on all the bidders.
18. HPCL reserves the right to further rationalize the prices with lowest bidder for reducing the price at any time before ordering.
19. HPCL reserves the right to cancel the reverse auction after event is scheduled but before
actual event taking place or after the reverse auction has completed in case of failure or any other reason. The reasons for cancellation shall be conveyed to all vendors.
20. In cases where tender is required to be cancelled after opening of priced bid and
identification of L1 vendor and wherein Reverse Auction was also part of tender, reasons for cancellation shall be conveyed to the L1 vendor.
21. During Reverse Auction Process, if no bids are received within the scheduled/rescheduled
date & specified time of the reverse auction, HPCL at its discretion can scrap the reverse auction and proceed with the opening of the Electronic priced bids submitted by the bidders. In such case HPCL shall display the bidder’s identity and original rates.
22. The bid on the Reverse Auction Portal will be taken as an offer to sell. Bids once made,
cannot be cancelled / withdrawn and the bidder shall be bound to sell the material/services at the final bid price, and as per the specifications mentioned in the tender. Should the bidder back out and not make the supplies as per the rates quoted or in case the material
Business Rules and Terms & Conditions of Reverse Auction
Page 4 of 7
HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LIMITED
supplied/services is not as per specifications mentioned in the tender, HPCL shall take appropriate action as per the terms & conditions mentioned in the tender.
23. At the end of the Reverse Auction, HPCL will decide the successful bidder, basis the
evaluation criteria specified in the tender. HPCL’s decision on award of Contract shall be final and binding on all the Bidders.
24. HPCL shall not have any liability to bidders for any interruption or delay in access to the
reverse auction portal irrespective of the cause.
25. The participation of vendors in the tendering process shall be construed as acceptance to the terms & conditions and procedure for the reverse auction. This compliance also shall be deemed as participation in Reverse auction.
26. In case a bidder agrees for reverse auction in the un-priced bid but withdraws acceptance
any time after tender due date & time, the EMD of such bidder may be forfeited along with rejection of offer at the sole discretion of HPCL.
27. Once Auction is started, no communication from vendor shall be entertained unless it is of
the nature of any serious issue in the Reverse Auction portal.
28. The yellow color back ground on RA page of the portal indicates that the due date and time of respective Reverse Auction is over. RA shall be concluded after standby period is over and auto generated mail is received by vendor.
29. The Bidder shall not involve himself or any of his representatives in Price manipulation of
any kind directly or indirectly by communicating with other suppliers / bidders.
30. The Bidder shall not divulge either his Bids or any other exclusive details of HPCL to any other party.
31. HPCL’s decision on award of Contract shall be final and binding on all the Bidders.
32. HPCL can decide to extend, reschedule or cancel any Auction. If any changes are made by
HPCL after the first posting and the Bidder continues to access the site after the changes, it shall be presumed that the bidder has accepted the changes.
33. HPCL will not be held responsible for consequential damages, including but not limited to
systems problems, inability to use the system, loss of electronic information etc.
Business Rules and Terms & Conditions of Reverse Auction
Page 5 of 7
HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LIMITED
Reverse Auction Procedure 1. In case HPCL decides to conduct Reverse Auction, the qualified bidders would be
communicated on the same thru E-mails about the date and time of the Reverse Auction event. The Reverse auction event shall be conducted in the HPCL e-tender portal under link “Reverse auction”.
2. Reverse Auction shall be available to Bidder only after two factor authentication. Initially
vendor will login to the site etender.hpcl.co.in with his Login Id and password. Thereafter they shall click on the “Reverse auction” link in the portal to view/participate in ongoing/upcoming reverse auctions.
3. Brief procedure to participate in RA:
I. Bidders may click on “Reverse Auction”, followed by click on 'password' and
Download the encrypted password. II. Save the downloaded password and open Signing Utility, Select action as
"Decrypt Reverse Auction Password". III. Browse the downloaded file. Select appropriate certificate and click on
Decrypt Password. Copy the password and paste in "Password" field and click on Reverse Auction.
4. HPCL will display Start Bid price i.e., Bench Mark price (which shall be the lowest of the
price bids submitted by the bidders on the e-procurement portal i.e. ‘Bids opened for RA event’ and HPCL’s in-house estimate), which shall be visible to all the vendors at the start of the Reverse Auction.
5. Identity of bidders never gets disclosed to anyone, during reverse auction process 6. HPCL shall specify the minimum amount/percentage by which the bidders can reduce
their bids at a time on the Reverse Auction Portal. This amount is referred as the ‘bid decrement factor’ and shall be specified by HPCL.
7. Bidders shall start bidding from this Bench Mark Price. The bidder can bid lower than the prevailing Lowest Bid at any time during the event by one decrement or multiples of the Bid decrement.
8. In case the “SUBMIT QUOTE” button is not enabled after a few seconds of clicking,
vendors are urged to Re-Login to the page for viewing the latest leading bid and submit fresh quotes. The process takes less than a few seconds.
Business Rules and Terms & Conditions of Reverse Auction
Page 6 of 7
HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LIMITED
9. The bidder shall be able to view the following values on his screen along with the other necessary fields in the Reverse Auction:
Item-wise Leading Bid in the Auction (Delivered Cost)
Bid Placed by bidder (Delivered Cost)
Bid value contemplated by bidder before submission(Delivered Cost)
33.9.1. Bidder can reduce his bid repeatedly during the auction period
10. Bidders shall be provided information on item wise pro-rated reduction in the rates, for guidance.
11. The confirmed bid submitted by vendor during the RA process shall always reflect in the “Previous Bid” field only (red font). The field “Current bid” shall display the contemplated bid value and “Leading Bid” shall show the current lowest bid value as submitted by any of the vendors.
12. The Closing Price(s) offered by the bidders at the conclusion of the Reverse Auction shall be valid for a minimum period of 30 days or as mentioned in tender, from the date of conclusion of the Reverse Auction.
13. After the Reverse auction is over successfully and closed by purchase officer, vendor can witness the lowest rate submitted by other vendors in “Witness bid opening” link.
14. In case of Item-wise evaluation tenders, any or all items may undergo Reverse Auction
separately at the discretion of HPCL.
15. In case of Schedule-wise evaluation tenders, any or all schedules may undergo Reverse Auction separately at the discretion of HPCL.
16. In case of SOR type tenders, where vendor has quoted a single percentage plus or minus
against the offered rate, the decrement shall be applicable on the bench mark value on base of 100 (i.e. it could be 107 in case of plus 7% or 94 in case of minus 6 percent). This value shall be delivered cost i.e. inclusive of taxes and loading factor.
17. HPCL reserves right to conduct single reverse auction for multiple items with separate
decrement option.
18. Vendor shall have option to participate in multiple reverse auction if it is scheduled at the same time.
Business Rules and Terms & Conditions of Reverse Auction
Page 7 of 7
HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LIMITED
19. Successful vendor shall be required to submit the final prices digitally signed and
uploaded as token of acceptance without any new condition other than those already agreed to before start of auction.
20. Vendors may seek telephonic guidance before or during the Reverse auction process
from Helpdesk support at 022-4114666, between 8.00 AM to 8.00 PM on any working day, except Sundays and Public holiday.
Line Details Of TenderSrl.No.
Line Description Ship To Location UOM Quantity HSN Code HPCLGSTIN
Mandatory
Overall Manadatory: Yes
1 Solar Car parking shed IPS1 11994-VR EXPANSIONEVACUATION PROJ
Each 1 37AAACH1118B1ZB
Yes
DESCRIPTION => Supply and installation of Car Parking shed strcuture with integrated solar panels and rain water harvesting system as per scope of work attached with the tenderdocument at MB Patnam (IPS-1) Booster Station Location.
2 Solar Car parking shed IPS2 11994-VR EXPANSIONEVACUATION PROJ
Each 1 37AAACH1118B1ZB
Yes
DESCRIPTION => Supply and installation of Car Parking shed structure with integrated solar panels and rain water harvesting system as per scope of work attached with the tenderdocument at JK Gudem (IPS-2) Booster Station Location.
3 Solar Car parking shed IPS3 11994-VR EXPANSIONEVACUATION PROJ
Each 1 37AAACH1118B1ZB
Yes
DESCRIPTION => Supply and installation of Car Parking shed structure with integrated solar panels and rain water harvesting system as per scope of work attached with the tenderdocument at Bogaram (IPS-3) Booster Station Location.
Tender No. : 18000010-HD-11994 Tender Published On : 21-Jun-2018 11:15
Online Agreed Terms and ConditionsSl.No. Description HPCL File HPCL Value Supporting
Doc. Req'd
1 WE HEREBY ACKNOWLEDGE RECEIPT OF SUBJECT E - TENDER FOR OURUSE IN PREPARING THE BID.WE UNDERTAKE THAT THE CONTENTS OFTHE BIDDING DOCUMENT SHALL BE KEPT CONFIDENTIAL ANDFURTHER THAT THE DRAWINGS, SPECIFICATIONS AND DOCUMENTSSHALL NOT BE TRANSFERRED AND THAT THE SAID DOCUMENTS ARE TOBE USED ONLY FOR THE PURPOSE FOR WHICH THEY ARE INTENDED.
- No
2 COMPLIANCE TO BID REQUIREMENT. WE HEREBY AGREE TO EACH ANDEVERY WORD ORLINE FORMING PART OF THIS TENDER DOCUMENT ANDADDENDUM OR CORRIGENDUM TO THE BIDDING DOCUMENT. WE HAVEALSO CHECKED e TENDER MESSAGE BOARD AND QUERY REPLIESISSUED BY HPCL AND THE SAMEHAS BEEN CONSIDERED IN OUR OFFER.HOWEVER, IF THERE ARE ANYDEVIATIONS TECHNICAL OR COMMERCIAL in ONLINE DEVIATION SHEETOR GENERAL RAISED BY US AGAINST THIS TENDER, THE SAME SHALL BEMENTIONED UNDER DEVIATION ,IF APPLICABLE . WE ALSO DECLARE THATDEVIATIONS MENTIONED BY US ANYWHERE ELSE SHALL BE NULL ANDVOID. WE FURTHER CONFORM THAT THE PERSONSUBMITTING THIS BID ON LINE IS AUTHORIZRED TO SUBMIT THE BID. sayCONFIRM
- No
3 Please fill Party NAME hereby declare OR clarify that we have not been banned ordelisted OR blacklisted or put on holiday list by any government or quasiGovernment agencies or Public Sector Undertakings. NOTE If a bidder has beenbanned or delisted OR blacklisted or put on holiday list by any Government orquasi Government agencies or PSUs,this fact must be clearly stated with detailsand it may not necessarily be a cause for disqualifying him.If this declaration is notgiven along with the unpriced bid, the tender will be rejected as non - responsive.
- Mandatory
4 We Messers...........confirm that we are not under liquidation, court receivership orsimilar proceedings
- No
5 NAME OF THE COMPANY OR PARTY - No
6 POSTAL ADDRESS - No
7 NAME OF THE AUTHORISED CONTACT PERSON - No
8 Mobile No. and Email id of the Authorized Contact person - No
9 TELEPHONE NO. - No
10 FAX NO. OF THE BIDDER - No
11 WHETHER REGISTERED WITH NSIC . Say YES OR NO - No
12 WHETHER COPY OF NSIC CERTIFICATE ENCLOSED . Say YES OR NOPlease upload NSIC CERTIFICATE HERE, In case applicable
- Allowed
13 NSIC REGISTRATION CERTIFICATE IS VALID UPTO - Allowed
14 MONETARY LIMIT OF NSIC - No
15 WHETHER REGISTERED AS MICRO SMALL ENTERPRISE (MSE). Say YES ORNO
- No
16 If registered as MSE,upload MSE certificate - Allowed
17 If registered as MSE,Whether owner (having more than 50 percentage share),belongs to SC OR STcategory(Yes OR No),If yes ,Please upload supporting documents for same.
- Allowed
18 E -PAYMENT BANK DETAILS. PLEASE SUBMIT AND UPLOAD DETAILS ASPER BANK MANDATE FORMAT PROVIDED WITH THIS TENDER (ANNEXURE-T TO CHAPTER-9).
- Allowed
19 PLEASE UPLOAD YOUR PAN CARD ,IN CASE NOT REGISTERED WITH HPCLFOR E -PAYMENT.
- Allowed
20 ENTITY STATUS. INDICATE YOUR COMPANY ENTITY STATUS. CorporateEntity - Public Limited OR Private Limited OR Non Body Corporate-Individuals ORHindu Undivided Family OR Partnership Firms OR Association of Persons (AOP)and upload proof of entity status.
- Mandatory
21 Whether any of the Directors of Bidder is relative of any Director of Owner or theBidder is a firm inwhich any Director of Owner or his relative is a Partner or the Bidder is PrivateCompany in whichany Director of Owner is a member or Director. (SAY YES or NO)
- No
22 Confirm your offer is in complete compliance with the scope as specified in the biddocument.
- No
23 All correspondence must be in English Language Only. Please Confirm. - No
24 Applicable Income Tax will be deducted at source as per provisions of Income Taxact read with Income Tax Rules at Prevailing Rates. Please confirm.
- No
25 Bidders to confirm that Income tax deduction at source shall be done by HPCL onpayments to be made to successful bidder,at applicable rates. Bidder to confirmhis acceptance to the same.
- No
26 Confirm your acceptance to Payment Terms mentioned in Bidding Document. - No
27 Confirm you have been registered under GST. - Allowed
28 Write your GST Registration no. here and also enclose copy of GST registrationdocuments along with unpriced bid document.
- Allowed
29 Confirm your quoted price are in line with Bidding Document. - No
30 Please confirm submission of Original Power of Attorney and also upload thescanned copy of thesame here.
- Allowed
31 Confirm your Compliance to Reverse Auction Terms and Conditions and itsprocedure
- No
32 Bidders are requested to quote with applicable GST Only. - Allowed
33 UPLOADING ANY OTHER DOCUMENTS ASKED FOR IN TENDER DOCUMENT - Allowed
34 UPLOADING ANY OTHER DOCUMENTS ASKED FOR IN TENDER DOCUMENT - Allowed
35 UPLOADING ANY OTHER DOCUMENTS ASKED FOR IN TENDER DOCUMENT - Allowed
36 Arbitration Clause: Please confirm your acceptance to our Arbitration Clause,enclosed with this tender.
- No
37 The supplies made against this order shall be fully guaranteed against anymanufacturing defects OR poor workmanship OR inferior quality etc. for aminimum period of 12 months from the date of commissioning or 18 months fromthe date of supply whichever is earlier.
- No
38 Transit Insurance will be arranged by Owner, Hence Bidders are advised not toquote Transit insurance from Ex-works upto FOB Site.
- No
39 Cancellation OR Risk Purchase Clause:Please confirm your acceptance to ourPurchase Order Cancellation clause and the Risk Purchase Clause, enclosed withthis tender.
- No
Tender No. : 18000010-HD-11994 Tender Published On : 21-Jun-2018 11:15
Tips for bid submissionSl.No. Description HPCL File HPCL Value Supporting
Doc. Req'd
1 Tips for bid Submission TipsBidsubmission.PDF - No
Tips for successful bid submission in the HPCL e-Procurement platform
As you are aware, HPCL has rolled out an improved e-Procurement portal for floating of
tenders and receiving bids. The new application is simpler and more users friendly compared
to the previous system. Further it is designed to ensure security and confidentiality of your bids
till the tender opening and provide transparency after bid opening. However, it has
been observed in few instances that vendors tend to submit their bid only in
the last hour even when they are submitting bid on this platform for the first
time and for some reasons are not able to submit their bids within due time.
The following document is prepared based on such vendor experiences, so that you can
avoid such pitfalls and successfully submit bid in the new system:
1. Please note that in the current system you are NOT required to download the tender,
take a print of the same followed by physically signing on all pages of the tender. You
are also not required to scan the signed tender document and upload the same.
Simply generate the technical bid pdf / priced bid pdf, digitally sign, encrypt and
upload same for bid submission.
2. Please start the process of bid preparation well in advance and do not wait for the
last moment to get DC validated/prepare the technical bid and priced bid. In the
current system the process mimics the manual bidding procedure. You have to enter
all the necessary technical responses in the form provided (i.e., upload necessary pdf
documents like vendor declaration form and answer the questions).You also have to
enter the rates for various items followed by taxes and preferably save the work in
your local machine(Tab-“Work without attaching doc”). Please note that during this
process we are not capturing any data entered by you in the server.
3. You get to save work only if you work in the tab “Work without attaching docs”and
you only generate the bid documents in tab “Attach doc and generate envelope”.
You will not be able to generate the bid from tab“Work w/o attaching doc”. Only
after you submit the digitally signed document, the same is stored in the server in
encrypted format. The main points are:
a. You can go to the forms any number of times and generate any number of
Technical bid pdf and priced bid pdf before you finally submit the same –
(however system will allow only for uploading the latest generated
document).
b. You may generate both the documents, digitally sign and keep it ready, in
case you want to submit the same only on last day. However, it is
recommended, not to wait till the last day as traffic congestion, unforeseen
connectivity issue or other aspects may adversely affect your bid submission
chances.
c. If you have already submitted a bid and you do not want to submit a modified
bid, you also have the option to withdraw the submitted bid. You may select
tender from home screen and go to “Prepare tender”>>”Regret” for same.
4. Please note that the larger your bid size, the lesser are the chances of successful bid
submission in the system. This is not for the fact that server cannot receive big files, but
the fact that traffic congestion, connectivity speed, type of connection and other
aspects adversely affect the time taken for upload of large files. So it may happen
that the session times out before the entire upload is completed (The current session
out time is 30 minutes). The main points are:
a. Please keep the size of the bid document within 40-45 MB (max). To keep the
size of the bid document low, you must scan all the documents in low
resolution, preferably 150-200 dpi wherein the data should be legible. Further
please scan in grayscale and not color to reduce file size. For large drawings,
please scan the same in jpeg format and later covert same to pdf to reduce
size of pdf document.
b. Whenever there is a requirement to upload supporting documents like old PO
copies, or credential document, please focus on the main requirement. If the
PO copies are meant to arrive at value of jobs executed, you may scan only
the first page(where name of client is given) and last page of the PO(where
value of PO) is mentioned. This way you can avoid unnecessarily inflating the
size of bid document.
c. Pl ensure to upload all such supporting documents in your bid which can have
a financial implication while arriving at the net delivered cost as such
documents cannot be received at the technical evaluation stage.
5. In case of any doubt regarding the tender, you may raise queries to clarify the same
before due date. Please remember that for every tender, the query start date and
query end date is specified in the first page of the tender document. You cannot raise
any query after the query end date is over, so it makes sense to start the bid
preparation process early.
6. And finally, if you have any issue during the bid preparation process, pl get in touch
with e-procurement helpdesk at 022-42100111 and seek help. However, you must
seek help at least two to three days (min) in advance so that if there is really any
issue, we have time to remedy the same. You will realize that, helpdesk can do very
little if you are calling up helpdesk on the last day/last hour.
Supplementary section on saving work
As with any application, the e-procurement application also has multiple options to
generate the bid documents based on requirement of vendors. The two broad
classification to generate bid document, be it “Pre-qualification bid” or “Technical/Priced
bid” are as follows:
1. Low value tender having 20-50 items and limited uploads/questions- Most of the
tenders floated by locations are of this nature. Since the No of items where rate is
to be entered is very limited and there are not too many questions, vendors can
directly click on “Prepare tender”>> “Generate Technical/Priced bid” >> “Attach
document and generate envelope”, enter the item rates, upload documents etc
and directly click on “Generate technical bid”, followed by “Generate Priced
bid”. However, there is no option to save the work. So if the vendor wishes to
resubmit the bid with modified rates, they have to enter rates for all items again
and similarly enter all other responses again. While this method is very fast for
generation of bids, it requires full efforts in redoing same if need arises.
2. Moderate to high value tender having more than 50 items and other
uploads – Though the number of such tenders is lesser, these are more crucial in
nature for obvious reasons. For such tenders, the first method of generating bid
can be very risky as there is no option to save interim work. Further, the session
out time for application is 30 minutes, which means if you do not click on
“generate bid” button within 30 minutes of landing in the page the work can get
lost. The correct method is as follows:
a. Click on “Prepare tender” >> “Generate Technical/Priced bid” >> “Work
without attaching document”. Here you must enter the rates, enter
responses to question etc, except for uploading the documents. Once you
have made adequate entries and nearing 20 minutes, please click on the
tab “Save work on local computer”, show the path as “Desktop” or “My
document” etc and save your work”. An xml file containing your data will
get saved in your computer.
b. Now click on “Upload values from local computer” and show path of
saved document. The rates and responses will get filled up till the previous
work done and you can fill up rates of balance items from that point. Save
your work when you are approaching 20 minutes. You can do this as
many times required. The main advantage is that your work is always
saved and available for use.
c. Once you are through with all the rates and responses, you may click on
the tab “Generate Technical and Priced bid envelope”>> “Attach doc
and generate envelope”. Now click on the tab at the bottom of screen
“Update value from local computer”. You will see that all the item rates
and responses have got populated against appropriate section. Now you
may show path of documents to be uploaded if any.
d. Once you find that all rates are entered, responses are filled up and
documents are uploaded, you may click on “Generate technical bid
envelope” followed by “Generate Priced bid envelope”. You will get an
option to save document, which can be saved in “desktop” or My
documents”.
e. Please note that in case you want to modify some value in your bid
document simply click on “Update value from local computer” and show
path of xml file. The values will be filled up on screen and will be available
for editing. You may make necessary changes and then again “Generate
technical bid envelope” followed by “Generate Priced bid envelope”.
f. Please remember to upload only the latest generated xml file.
3. The final step requires you to check the pdf document for correctness. If found Ok,
it is required to be digitally signed. The digitally signed document is then required
to be encrypted by using the “Bid encryption utility”, hosted in “utility” tab. This
encrypted document shall be submitted by you.
4. Please ensure that you are uploading only the latest generated “Technical bid
envelope” and “Priced bid envelope”, after digitally signing and encrypting the
same.
5. It is recommended that you use the “Signing cum encryption utility” for signing
and encrypting the document in one step. Alternately you may install and use
“Jsignpdf”, which is license free signing utility only for signing.
6. It is also recommended that you check the hash of the document and match it
with the hash value given on the screen prior to uploading of bid document.
Please refer “Manual for checking hash before and after signing”.
Tender No. : 18000010-HD-11994 Tender Published On : 21-Jun-2018 11:15
Tender DocumenstSl.No. Description HPCL File HPCL Value Supporting
Doc. Req'd
1 Tender Final Tender Document.pdf - No
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 1 of 170
HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LIMITED
VIZAG-VIJAYAWADA-SECUNDERABAD (VVSPL) PIPELINE CAPACITY AUGMENTATION PROJECT
(TENDER NO – 18000010-HD-11994)
(WP Ref No.: 14495-00-PP-ITT-0047)
BIDDING DOCUMENT FOR SUPPLY AND INSTALLATION OF CAR PARKING SHEDS
FOR IPS1, IPS2 & IPS 3 LOCATIONS
Prepared by:
WorleyParsons India Pvt. Ltd, 5TH Floor, B wing, “I Think” Lodha Techno Campus Off Pokhran Road No. 2 Thane (West) 400607, Maharastra Telephone: +91 22 6781 8000 Facsimile: +91 22 6781 8080 www.worleyparsons.com
© Copyright 2018 WorleyParsons
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 2 of 170
TABLE OF CONTENTS
I Chapter 1 Notice Inviting Tender - Domestic Competitive Bidding
Invitation For Bids (IFB) / e-tender
II Chapter 2 Instructions to Bidders E-Tender Instructions
III Chapter 3 Special Conditions of Purchase (SCP)
IV Chapter 4 4a General Terms and Conditions for Work Contracts 4b General Terms and Conditions for Supply
V Chapter 5 A Terms and conditions for Erection, Testing and Commissioning
B Terms and conditions for Training C Terms & Conditions for Annual Maintenance Charges
VI Chapter 6 Bid Form and Price Schedule Formats
VII Chapter 7 Delivery Schedules
VIII Chapter 8 Agreed Terms & Conditions – Questionnaire
IX Chapter 9 Proformae / Annexures
A : Bid Security Form
B : Contract Performance Bank Guarantee
C : Letter of Authority for attending Pre-Bid Meeting and Subsequent Negotiations/Conferences
D : Declaration Form
E : Undertaking of Adequate Capacity
F : Bidder’s Queries
G : MSME/ NSIC Certificate Details
H : Certificate of Non-Involvement of Agent
I : Proforma for Details of Indian Agent
J : Composite BG - Mobilization Advance, Security Deposit/ Retention Money/Performance Guarantee
K : Bidder’s General Information
L : Annual Turnover Form M : Integrity Pact
N: Bank Guarantee Format Mobilization advance
P : Technical Check list
Q : Reference list
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 3 of 170
R : Compliance Statement
S : Grievance Redressal Mechanism
T : Advice from supplier/contractor for E-payment
U : Reverse Auction Clause
V: Detailed Addresses of sites
X : Bank Guarantee For Security Deposit
Y : Arbitration Clause
Z : P.F. Registration TDS / TAN / ESIC
AA : Plant and Equipment owned by Bidder
AB : Proposed Head Office and Site Organization
AC : List of Technical Staff
AD : Details of Measuring & Testing Equipment
AE: Commercial Questionnaire
AF: Check List for Submission of Bid
X Chapter 10 1. Contractor HSE Management Plan 2. Scope of Work– (SOW No. 14495-00-CI-SOW-0005)
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 4 of 170
Chapter – 1
- Notice For Public Domestic Invitation For Bids (IFB) - Invitation For Bids (IFB) / e-tender
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 5 of 170
DOMESTIC PUBLIC NOTICE INVITING TENDER
M/s. WorleyParsons India Pvt. Ltd. on behalf of Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (HPCL) invites electronic bids (e-tenders) under Single Stage two bid system for Supply and Installation of Car Parking Sheds For IPS1, IPS2 & IPS 3 Locations from eligible Bidders for Vizag Vijayawada Secunderabad Pipeline (VVSPL) Capacity Augmentation Project, as per details given in the Tender Document :-
TENDER NO : 18000010-HD-11994 JOB : SUPPLY AND INSTALLATION OF CAR PARKING SHEDS FOR IPS1, IPS2 & IPS 3 LOCATIONS
1.0
a) Bidding document on Website From 21/06/2018 to 12/07/2018 (15:00Hrs IST)
b) Last date of Receipt of bidder’s queries
28/06/2018 (15:00 Hrs. IST) Note: Please note all queries are to be uploaded at website : https://etender.hpcl.co.in
c) Pre-bid meeting date & place Not applicable.
d) Bid Due date and time of Online submission of bid
Up to 15:00 Hrs. (IST) on 12/07/2018
e) Online Opening Of Techno- Commercial Unpriced bid date and time
At 15:30 Hrs. (IST) on 12/07/2018
f) Earnest Money Deposit / Bid Security As per Clause No. 04
g) Tender Document Fee Not applicable
h) Online Price Bid Opening/Reverse Auction
Date & time shall be intimated to techno -commercially accepted bidders only at later stage before price bid opening/Reverse Auction.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 6 of 170
DETAILED NOTICE FOR INVITATION FOR BIDS
UNDER PUBLIC-DOMESTIC COMPETITIVE BIDDING FOR
SUPPLY AND INSTALLATION OF CAR PARKING SHEDS FOR IPS1, IPS2 & IPS 3 LOCATIONS FOR VIZAG-VIJAYAWADA-SECUNDERABAD (VVSPL)
PIPELINE CAPACITY AUGMENTATION PROJECT OF M/S HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LTD.
(BIDDING DOCUMENT NO: 18000010-HD-11994)
(WP REFERENCE NO: 14495-00-PP-ITT-0047)
M/s Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (hereinafter referred to as "HPCL") has appointed WorleyParsons India Pvt. Ltd. (hereinafter referred to as "WorleyParsons") as EPMC for the project. WorleyParsons on behalf of HPCL invites Bids through e-tendering on Domestic Competitive Bidding basis for Supply and Installation of Car Parking Sheds For IPS1, IPS2 & IPS 3 Locations for VVSPL Capacity Augmentation Project (VVSPL) under single stage two-bid system from competent suppliers meeting the Bidder Qualification Criteria (BQC) as detailed herein. Bids submitted online in e-tender portal of HPCL https://etender.hpcl.co.in shall only be considered for processing.
1.0 BRIEF PROJECT DETAILS:
HPCL is currently pursuing to expand Vizag refinery from the current name plate capacity of 8.3 MMPTA to 15 MMTPA with a yield of 11.85 MMTPA for MS, HSD & SKO. In-line with refinery expansion plan, HPCL is also planning to take up capacity augmentation of existing VVSPL (Vizag Vijayawada Secunderabad Pipeline) from 5.38 MMTPA to 7.9 MMTPA simultaneously.
Capacity augmentation is proposed by implementation of new pump stations at existing IPS-1 (Ch. 92.9 km), IPS-2 (Ch. 264.5 km), SV-17 Station and also by upgrading the existing booster pump facilities in Vizag, Rajahmundry, Vijayawada, Suryapet and in Secunderabad. It also covers formulating and integration of new facilities with existing Electrical, Instrumentation, PLC, SCADA, APPS including LDS, OWS system, piping arrangements.
2.0 SCOPE OF SUPPLY:
The scope of work includes (but not limited to) the Design, Engineering, Procurement of material / Components/bought out items, Supply, Manufacturing, Fabrication, Assembly, Painting, Inspection, Testing, Packing & Forwarding, Delivery and Installation, Commissioning for SUPPLY AND INSTALLATION OF CAR PARKING SHEDS FOR IPS1, IPS2 & IPS 3 LOCATIONS, complete with all the associated necessary accessories in compliance with attached Material Requisition for VVSPL Capacity Augmentation Project, (As per Scope of Supply & Works mentioned in e-tender)
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 7 of 170
3.0 BIDDER QUALIFICATION CRITERIA (BQC):
3.1 TECHNICAL CRITERIA 3.1.1 Bidder shall meet all the following criteria:
Bidder shall have proven track record of having successfully executed similar work comprising of Supply, installation, testing and commissioning of smart inverted canopies with Solar and Rainwater harvesting component works for covered areas during the last 7 years reckoned from 31/05/2018.
3.1.2 The Bidder, during the last seven years ending 31/05/2018, should have successfully completed *Similar Work Order(s) meeting either of the following criteria:-
Domestic Bidders
Sl. No.
Details
One Similar
(*) order executed &
completed of value not less
than
Or Two Similar (*)
order executed & completed each of value not less than
Or Three Similar (*) order executed &
completed each of value not less than
INR (IN LAKHS)
1 Supply & installation of Car Parking Sheds
17 11 8.5
*Definition of Similar Work: “The similar work mentioned above is works involving “Supply, installation, testing and commissioning of smart inverted canopies with Solar and Rainwater harvesting component works for covered areas”.
Note:
1. Bidder shall quote for all line items and the evaluation criteria will be overall lowest. 2. Bidder shall submit the dealership / manufacturer authorization certificate for supplied items in
case the bidder is an authorized dealer / representative of the manufacturer.
3. Bidder shall furnish necessary documentary evidence by uploading the documents in the e-portal of HPCL, such as notarized copies of purchase order/work order (clearly indicating scope of work), inspection release note, final invoice, and certified bills from client, completion certificates from client.
4. For the Bidders who are submitting Purchase orders against bid qualification criteria in a currency other that INR and USD, purchase order value/Financial statements etc. will be converted into Indian Rupees at the Bill selling rates as on date of issue of Purchase Order, as available in State Bank of India, Mumbai. In case, exchange rate is not available in State Bank of India (Mumbai), alternative sources viz. Economics Times shall be considered for all the currencies.
3.2 COMMERCIAL
3.2.1 FINANCIAL CRITERIA:
Bidder shall meet all the following criteria:
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 8 of 170
Bidder shall have achieved minimum average Annual Financial turnover as per audited financial results in the last 3 financial / calendar (2015, 2016, 2017) for companies having financial year ending in December or 2014 -2015, 2015 - 2016, 2016- 2017 for companies having financial year having other than December.
Sr. No.
Schedule Details
Average Annual financial turnover during the last 3 years, ending 31st March 2017, should
be at least Rs. (In Lakh)
1 Supply & Installation of Car Parking Sheds 6.5
3.2.2 NET WORTH: Net worth of the bidder for financial year ending 31st March 2017* should be positive. However it will not be applicable for PSUs approved by HPCL.
Note: (*): 1. In case Bidders’ financial statements are audited in calendar year, bidder’s Average Annual
financial turnover during the last 3 years, ending Dec- 2017 shall be checked against criteria stated at clause no. 3.2.1 above & Net worth ending Dec- 2017 against criteria stated at clause no. 3.2.2 above.
2. Bidder shall furnish necessary documentary evidence by uploading the documents in the e-
portal of HPCL, such as notarized copies of audited Annual Report/Balance Sheet for last
three years as mentioned above, Original Certificate from Chartered Account indicating
Turnover & Net worth.
3.3 GENERAL:
3.3.1 Bidder shall meet the technical as well as commercial qualification criteria as stated above. Support documents pertaining to bidders Qualification criteria have to be uploaded under Bid common forms Tilted “Bidders Qualification Criteria”. Two formats namely BQC –Technical & BQC-Financial are given in tender common forms under the same heads. These documents after duly filled, signed & stamped have to be uploaded under similar heads provided in Bid Common Forms. In absence of requisite documents, HPCL / WorleyParsons reserve the right to reject the Bid without making any reference to the Bidder.
3.3.2 The bid evaluation procedure is specified in bid document. 3.3.3 OTHER INFORMATION
1.0 Parties who are affiliates of one another can decide which affiliate will make a bid. Only one affiliate may submit a bid. Two or more affiliates are not permitted to make separate bids directly or indirectly. If two or more affiliates submit a bid, then any one or all of them are liable for disqualification. However up to 3 affiliates may make a joint bid as a Consortium and in which case the conditions applicable to a Consortium shall apply to them. "Affiliate" of a party shall mean any company or legal entity which:
a) Controls either directly or indirectly a party, or b) Which is controlled directly or indirectly by a Party; or c) Is directly or indirectly controlled by a company, legal entity or partnership which
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 9 of 170
directly or indirectly controls a party. "Control" means actual control or ownership of at least a 50% voting or other controlling interest that gives the power to direct, cause the direction of the management and material business of the controlled entity.
2.0 Bids may be submitted by:
a) A single person/entity (called sole bidder); b) A newly formed incorporated joint venture (JV) which has not completed 3 (three)
financial years from the date of commencement of business; c) A consortium (including an unincorporated JV) having a maximum of 3 (three)
members; d) An Indian arm of a foreign company.
3.0 Fulfillment of Eligibility criteria and certain additional conditions in respect of each of
the above four (4) types of bidders are stated below, respectively: a) The sole bidder (including and incorporated JV which has completed three (3)
financial years after date of commencement of business) shall fulfill each eligibility criteria.
b) In case the bidder is a newly formed and incorporated joint venture and which has not completed three (3) financial years from the date of commencement of business, then either the said JV shall fulfill each eligibility criteria or any one constituent member/promoter of such a JV shall fulfill each eligibility criteria. If the bid is received with the proposal that one constituent member/promoter fulfills each eligibility criteria, then this member/promoter shall be clearly identified and he/it shall assume all obligations under the contract and provide such comfort letter/guarantees as may be required by Owner. The guarantees shall over inter alia the commitment of the member/promoter to complete the entire work in all respects and in a timely fashion, being bound by all the obligations under the Contract, an undertaking to provide all necessary technical and financial support to the JV to ensure completion of the work, etc.
c) In case the bidder(s) is/are a consortium (including an unincorporated JV), then the following conditions shall apply:
1) Each member in consortium may only be a entity and not an individual person; 2) The bid shall specifically identify and describe each member of the consortium; 3) The consortium member descriptions shall indicate what type of legal entity the
member is and its jurisdiction of incorporation (or of establishment as a legal entity other than a corporation) and provide evidence by a copy of the articles of corporation (or equivalent documents);
4) One participant member of the consortium shall be identified as the “Prime member” and contracting entity for the consortium;
5) This prime member shall be solely responsible for all aspects of the Bid/proposal including the execution of all tasks and performance of all consortium obligations;
6) The prime member shall fulfill each eligibility criteria; 7) A commitment shall be given from each of the consortium members in the form of a
letter signed by a duly authorized officer clearly identifying the role of the member in the Bid and the member’s commitment to perform all relevant tasks and obligations in support of the Prime/lead member of the Consortium and a commitment not to withdraw from the consortium;
8) No change shall be permitted in the number, nature or share holding pattern of the consortium members after pre-qualification, without the prior written permission of the Owner (HPCL).
9) No change in project plans, timetables or pricing will be permitted as a consequence of any withdrawal or failure to perform by a consortium member;
10) No consortium member shall hold less than 25% stake in a consortium; 11) Entities which are affiliates of one another are allowed to bid either as a sole
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 10 of 170
bidder or as a consortium only; 12) Any person or entity can bid either singly or as a member of only one consortium.
d) In case the bidder is an Indian arm (subsidiary, authorized agent, branch office or
affiliate) of a foreign bidder, then the foreign bidder shall have to full fill each eligibility criteria. If such foreign company desires that the contract be entered into with the Indian arm, then a proper back to back continuing (parent company) guarantee shall be provided by the foreign company clearly stating that in case of any failure of any supply or performance of the equipment, machinery material or plant or completion of the work in all respects and as per the warranties/guarantees that may have been given, then the foreign company shall assume all obligations under the contract. Towards this purpose, it shall provide such comfort letter/guarantees as may be required by Owner. The guarantees shall cover inter alia the commitment of the foreign company to complete the entire work in all respects and in a timely fashion being bound by all the obligations under the contract, an undertaking to provide all necessary technical and financial support to the Indian arm or to render the same themselves so as to ensure completion of the contract when awarded, an undertaking not to withdraw from the contract till completion of the work etc.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 11 of 170
4.0 EARNEST MONEY DEPOSIT (EMD) / BID SECURITY: Bid Security / EMD shall be as mentioned below: -
Sr. No.
Schedule Details
EMD - Domestic Bidder
( in INR)
1 Supply & Installation of Car Parking Sheds 42,000.00
Note:
(a) The requirement of bid security shall be as defined in the ‘Note’ under clause 3.1 above.
(b) Public Sector Enterprises and Small scale industries (Registered with NSIC) are exempted
from submission of Bid Security. However to claim the exemption Public Sector Enterprises shall submit a declaration on their letter head and Small Scale Industries shall submit valid copy of NSIC Registration Certificate.
(c) In case of Consortium (including an unincorporated JV), the bid security shall be submitted by
the “Prime Member”. 4.1.1 The bid security/EMD is required to protect the Owner against the risk of Bidder’s conduct, which
would warrant the security’s forfeiture.
In e-tenders, a scanned copy of Bid Security/EMD or MSE Certificate seeking exemption shall also to be uploaded with the offer at e-portal https://etender.hpcl.co.in. EMD shall be accepted in the form of demand draft/ pay order, banker’s cheque (in favour of “ Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited ”, payable at Bangalore), issued by any Scheduled bank other than cooperative bank or in the form of Irrevocable Bank Guarantee issued by any Scheduled bank other than cooperative bank in case of Domestic Bidder.
In case EMD is submitted in the form of Bank Guarantee by Domestic Bidder, it should be made on non-judicial stamp paper of appropriate value (denomination) and should be valid for SIX (6) months from due date / extended due date of the tender (as per the proforma attached in the General Terms and Conditions in the format at Annexure-A of Chapter-9), however, demand draft / pay order/ Banker’s Cheque may be valid for three months for Domestic as well as foreign bidders. Cheque / FDR or EMD in any other form shall be treated as offer without EMD and shall not be acceptable. Bid Security received late due to any reasons shall be rejected.
4.1.2 EMD (original instrument: DD/Pay order/ Banker’s Cheque OR Bank Guarantee)/ EMD exemption document should be kept in separate envelope (super-scribed with tender number, job & due date) and should be deposited by tender due date and time, in the tender box provided in the office of :-
Shri. D P SRIVASTAVA
Manager - Purchase Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited
VVSPL Capacity Augmentation Project 2nd Floor, No.332, Darus Salam Building Queen's Road
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 12 of 170
Bangalore-560052 India. 4.1.3 In case the EMD (original instrument) is not deposited in the tender box (as mentioned above) by
tender due date and time, the offer of bidder shall be rejected. Owner / Consultant shall not be responsible for any postal delays or non-receipt of EMD by tender due date and time, reasons whatsoever.
4.1.4 Bidders are requested to advise their BANKS not to post Bank Guarantee/or any Other EMD/Bid
security document directly to HPCL, as the Bid Security/EMD is to be submitted as mentioned in para 4.1.2.
4.1.5 The EMD shall be held interest free and no bank charges shall be payable by Owner / Consultant
towards the EMD submitted by the bidders. 4.2 EMD FORFEITURE (In case EMD is applicable) AND FURTHER ACTION AS PER
CORPORATION’S (HPCL) POLICY:-
EMD submitted by the bidder for subject tender shall be forfeited in following cases:- (i) Withdrawal of bid in interval between the deadline for submission of bids and
the expiration of the period of bid validity specified by the bidder (To be read in conjunction with clause no. 12.3 of ITB).
(ii) Unsolicited post bid modification (To be read in conjunction with clause no. 15.8 of ITB). (iii) Price changes against technical/commercial clarification, if any, in line with
terms & conditions of enquiry documents are not allowed. (To be read in conjunction with clause no. 15.8 of ITB)
(iv) Conditional Price Bids. (v) Non –Withdrawal (by evaluated lowest bidder) of deviations mentioned elsewhere other
than on-line deviation sheet. (vi) Any new deviation stipulated after tender due date (To be read in conjunction with point
no. 12.4 of ITB) (vii) Unsolicited Post Bid Revision in Taxes & Duties. (viii) Violation of Integrity Pact (If Applicable).
DISCLAIMER:- Besides above, Owner/Consultant reserves the right to forfeit the EMD of bidder (In case
EMD is applicable) and take further action as per corporation’s (HPCL’s) policy in case bidder deviates from his submitted offer / adopt unfair practices.
4.3 REFUND OF BID SECURITY / EARNEST MONEY DEPOSIT
EMD should be refunded to other than lowest evaluated bidder(s), immediately upon completion of price evaluation, by means of A/c Payee cheques or e-payment. The successful Bidder’s bid security will be discharged upon the Bidder’s accepting the Contract/ Purchase Order, and furnishing the requisite bank guarantee / security Deposit in line with the tender terms and conditions.
5.0 DELIVERY PERIOD: Refer Chapter – 7 for completion period. 6.0 PRE-BID MEETING – IF APPLICABLE: 6.1 Pre-Bid Meeting shall be held as mentioned in Clause No.1.0 of NIT.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 13 of 170
6.2 All question/ queries should be referred to Owner/Consultant not later than 3 (three) days before Scheduled date of pre-bid meeting and HPCL/WorleyParsons reserves the right not to entertain any pre-bid query after cut-off date. Reply to Pre-Bid Queries shall be hosted on HPCL Tender website.
6.3 Bidders in their own interest are advised to take part in the pre-bid meeting by deputing their
competent personnel. This will help bidder not only to cut short of the evaluation time leading to requirement of shorter bid validity but also enable them to submit their best prices based on the clear techno-commercial scope.
7.0 GENERAL
7.1 Owner /Consultant reserve the right to carry out capacity & capability assessment of the bidder
using in –house information and past performance.
7.2 Owner/Consultant shall not be responsible for any costs or expenses incurred by Bidder in
connection with the preparation or delivery of Bids, site-visit and other expenses incurred during
bidding process, regardless of the outcome of the bidding process.
7.3 In case any bidder is found to be involved in cartel formation, his bid will not be considered for
evaluation / placement of order. Such bidder will also be debarred from bidding in future.
7.4 Canvassing in any form by the bidder or by any other agency on their behalf may lead to
disqualification of their bid.
7.5 Unsolicited clarifications to the offer and / or change in the prices during the validity period would
render the bid liable for rejection.
7.6 Bidder shall not be under liquidation, court receivership or similar proceeding.
7.7 Net Worth of bidder shall be calculated as per the formula below:
Net worth means paid up share capital, Share Application Money pending allotment* and
reserves# less accumulated losses and deferred expenditure to the extent not written off.
# Reserves to be considered for the purpose of net worth shall be all reserves created out of the profits and securities premium account but shall not include reserves created out of revaluation of assets, write back of depreciation and amalgamation.
*Share Application Money pending allotment will be considered only in respect of share to be allotted.
Accordingly, the definition of Net worth shall be as follows:
Paid up share capital XXXX Add: Share Application Money pending allotment XXXX Add: Reserves (As defined Above) XXXX Less: Accumulated Losses XX Less: Deferred Revenue Expenditure to the extent not written off
XX
Net worth XXXX
7.8 In case a bidder is having wholly owned subsidiaries but only a single consolidated annual report is
prepared and audited which includes the financial details of their wholly owned subsidiaries,
consolidated audited annual report shall be considered for establishing the financial criteria subject
to statutory auditor/ chartered accountant of the bidder certifying that separate annual report of
bidder (without the financial data of subsidiaries) is not prepared and audited.
Further, in case a bidder is a subsidiary company and separate annual report of the bidder is not
published, but only a consolidated annual report of the Parent Company is available, consolidated
audited annual report shall be considered for establishing the financial criteria subject to statutory
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 14 of 170
auditor/ chartered accountant of the bidder certifying that separate annual report of bidder is not
prepared and audited.
7.9 In the event of submission of any document / certificate/ Audited Annual Financial Results by the
bidder in a language other than English, the bidder shall get the same translated into English and
submit the same after getting the translation duly authenticated by local Chamber of Commerce of
Bidder's country.
7.10 Owner /Consultant will follow purchase preference policy as per prevailing guidelines of Govt. of
India.
7.11 Clarification if any, can be obtained (on working days, between 09:00 Hrs to 16:00 Hrs) through
Telephone nos: +91 22 66515701 Ext: 1170 and/or E-mail:
[email protected]; ( Project Manager)
However, It is Mandatory for Bidder to upload all pre-bid queries, if any, only at website
https://etender.hpcl.co.in. Only for those queries, Owner & Consultant would be able to reply
For any technical queries related to operation of the portal please send mail to
[email protected] OR please call us at 022-41146666. The helpdesk support is
available 6 days a week from 8AM to 8 PM (except public holidays).
Sr. Manager- Procurement & Contracts
WorleyParsons India Pvt. Limited
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 15 of 170
Chapter – 2
INSTRUCTION TO BIDDERS (ITB)
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 16 of 170
INDEX
SR. NO. DESCRIPTION
1.0 COST OF BIDDING
2.0 BID DOCUMENT
3.0 AMENDMENT OF BID DOCUMENT
4.0 LANGUAGE OF BID
5.0 BID PARTS
6.0 DOCUMENTS COMPRISING THE BIDS
7.0 BID FORM AND PRICE SCHEDULE
8.0 PREPARATION & SUBMISSION OF BIDS
9.0 BID DUE DATE & TIME
10.0 PERIOD OF VALIDITY OF BIDS
11.0 LATE BIDS
12.0 MODIFICATION & WITHDRAWAL OF BIDS
13.0 OPENING OF BIDS
14.0 BID PRICES & BIDDING CURRENCY
15.0 EVALUATION OF BIDS
16.0 REJECTION CRITERIA
17.0 COMPARISION OF BIDS
18.0 CONTACTING THE OWNER/ OWNER’S CONSULTANT
19.0 AWARD CRITERIA
20.0 OWNER’S RIGHT TO ACCEPT ANY BID AND TO REJECT ANY OR ALL BIDS
21.0 NOTIFICATION OF AWARD
22.0 ISSUE OF PURCHASE ORDER
23.0 REBATE
24.0 FRAUDULENT PRACTICES
25.0 REVERSE AUCTION 26.0 QUOTED PRICES - PRICE SHALL BE QUOTED CONSIDERING
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 17 of 170
CHAPTER-2
INSTRUCTIONS TO BIDDERS (ITB)
1.0 COST OF BIDDING
1.1 The Bidder shall bear all costs associated with the preparation and submission of the bid, and Owner/ Consultant will in no case, be responsible or liable for these costs, regardless of the conduct or outcome of the bidding process.
2.0 BID DOCUMENT
2.1 The bidder is expected to examine all instructions, forms, terms and specifications in the bid document. The Notice Inviting Tender ,Invitation for Bids (IFB) together with all its attachments thereto, shall be considered to be read, understood and accepted by the bidder, unless deviations are specifically stated seriatim by the bidder. Failure to furnish all information required by the bid document or submission of a bid not substantially responsive to the bid documents in every respect will be at bidder’s risk and may result in the rejection of his bid.
2.2 The bidder's scope of supplies as specified in the Material Requisition shall be in strict compliance with the scope detailed therein and in the bid document.
3.0 AMENDMENT OF BID DOCUMENT
3.1 At any time prior to the bid due date, the Owner may, for any reason, whether at its own initiative or in response to a clarification requested by a prospective Bidder, modify the Bid Document.
3.2 The amendment/corrigendum to tender shall be published at Owner's e-PORTAL
https://etender.hpcl.co.in and HPCL's website www.hindustanpetroleum.com. Bidders are advised to visit these websites regularly to keep themselves updated. In case bidder has submitted the online bid before corrigendum, such bidder shall be required to modify /edit the already submitted bid before tender submission due date/extended due date, whichever is later. In case of bidder submitted the bid without compliance /confirmation /acceptance to corrigendum, he shall not be allowed to revise the bid price /rates on account of compliance/acceptance /confirmation to corrigendum. Such bidder shall be given opportunity during evaluation to accept/confirm compliance to corrigendum without revision in rates and taxes, failing which the bid shall be rejected at the sole discretion of the Owner
3.3 In order to afford prospective Bidder, reasonable time in which to take the amendment into
account in preparing their bids, the Owner may, at its discretion, extend the bid due date.
4.0 LANGUAGE OF BID
4.1 The bid prepared by the Bidder and all correspondence/ drawings and documents relating to the bid exchanged by Bidder and the Owner/Consultant shall be written in ENGLISH language, provided that any printed literature furnished by the Bidder may be written in another language so long as accompanied by an ENGLISH translation, in which case, for the purpose of interpretation of the bid, the English translation shall govern.
4.2 In the event of submission of any document / certificate / Audited financial report by the bidder in a
language other than English, the bidder shall get the same translated into English and submit the same after getting the translation duly certified by local Chamber of Commerce of Bidder’s country.
5.0 BID PARTS
5.1 Bid shall be in two parts. Part-I shall be unpriced bid & Part-II shall be priced bid. Bidder shall
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 18 of 170
include Bid Security, Integrity pact duly signed & stamped, unpriced price Schedule duly filled as “quoted” in each cell of price Schedule etc. shall be submitted with Part-I. Duly filled Part-II with price figures shall be submitted in Part-II (in e-portal of HPCL).
6.0 DOCUMENTS COMPRISING THE BIDS
6.1 The bid prepared by the Bidder shall comprise the following components:
6.1.1 UNPRICED BID( PART-I):
a) Physical Documents:
� Bid Security - Original DD / BG.
� NSIC / MSE Registration certificate in lieu of EMD.
� Power of Attorney of bidder’s representative digitally signing the bid document
� Duly signed & stamped Integrity Pact.
Physical documents in seal envelope containing above documents shall be super scribed
with Tender no, Due date and name of the Job to be submitted at the following address on
or before Bid Due date and time :-
Shri D P Srivastava
Manager - Purchase Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited VVSPL Capacity Augmentation Project 2nd Floor, No.332, Darus Salam Building Queen's Road Bangalore- 560052. India. In e-tenders, a scanned copy of Bid Security/EMD or MSE Certificate seeking exemption shall also to be uploaded with the offer at e-portal https://etender.hpcl.co.in.
i. In case Bid Security / EMD is not received as per Clause 04 of NIT (Global Notice Inviting Tender) the offer of the bidder shall be rejected.
ii. In case of availing exemption, NSIC / MSE Certificate as per the requirement of Clause 04 of NIT (Global Notice Inviting Tender) shall be submitted, wherever applicable.
iii. Bidders are advised to instruct their banks not to post Bid Security directly to HPCL as the same has to be deposited as explained above.
b) Documentary evidence establishing Bidder's claim for meeting Bidder Qualification Criteria
as stipulated in the Bid Document. Owner/Consultant reserve the right to call the bidder
during evaluation along with originals for verification of the documents submitted by the
bidder in his bid. OWNER / CONSULTANT also reserve the right to get the documents
(purchase orders, completion certificates and other documents submitted by the bidder)
verified/ confirmed by the issuing authority of these documents.
c) Power of Attorney in favour of person (s) digitally signing the bid that such person (s) is/are
authorised to sign the bid on behalf of the bidder and any consequence resulting due to
such signing shall be binding on the bidder;
d) Tender document including Corrigendum, if any, and subsequent correspondences duly
stamped and signed on each page as a token of acceptance. Please note no hard copy of
documents shall be taken in case of e-tender except the documents stated in the note at
the end of this clause.
e) All form and format dully filled in.
f) Copies of Purchase Orders, Financial Statement (Audited Balance Sheet including, Profit
& Loss Account, Schedule and Independent Auditor Report) for last three preceding
financial years.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 19 of 170
g) Taxes & Duties Statement – shall be same as filled in Price Schedule & should not be
separately submitted by the bidder.
h) Agreed Terms & Conditions duly filled-in & online.
i) Integrity Pact
j) Any other information/details/documents/data required as per Bid Document.
k) NOTE: The documents sought under clause 6.1.1 a are to be received by OWNER by bid
submission date & time in hard copy. However, scanned copies of documents under
clause 6.1.1 a along with balance documents are to be uploaded at OWNER e-tender
website. 6.1.2 PRICED BID ( PART-II):
a) It shall consist of Price Bid only. It shall be uploaded on the e-portal https://etender.hpcl.co.in
b) Bidders are advised to ensure that the Price Bid is quoted and uploaded in the e-procurement system. Quoted price shall include Basic cost, packing charges, loading charges, Insurance, Freight and any other charges, if any.
c) Bidders have to ensure that Bid Price is not mentioned anywhere in the Techno Commercial bid, failing which the bid is liable to be rejected.
7.0 BID FORM & PRICE SCHEDULE FORMAT
7.1 The bidders shall complete the Bid Form and appropriate Price Schedule Format furnished in the Chapter 6 of Bid Document, indicating the required information.
8.0 PREPARATION & SUBMISSION OF BIDS
8.1 Bids shall be submitted at the address by the due date & time.
8.2 Documents mentioned in the Bid Document shall be submitted along with the bid by the Bidder.
8.3 Addenda/Corrigenda to the Bid Document, if issued, must be signed and submitted along with the bid.
8.4 Bidders are advised to submit bids based strictly on the terms & conditions and specifications contained in the Bid Document and not to stipulate any deviations.
8.5 A Bidder( i.e., the bidding entity) shall, on no account submit more than one bid either directly ( as a single bidder or as a member of consortium) or indirectly failing which all bids submitted by such bidder directly & indirectly , shall stand rejected and BID SECURITY shall be Forfeited.
9.0 BID DUE DATE AND TIME
9.1 Bid is required to be submitted through OWNER e-PORTAL https://etender.hpcl.co.in only, on or before the Bid submission date and time.
9.2 The Owner may, at its discretion, on giving reasonable notice by letter/fax/e-mail, or any written communication to all prospective Bidders who have been issued the bid documents, extend the bid due date, in which case all rights and obligations of the Owner and the Bidders, previously subject to the bid due date, shall thereafter be subject to the new bid due date as extended.
9.3 Request for extension of tender submission due date, if any, shall be considered at the sole discretion of Owner. However, Owner reserves the right not to entertain any request for extension received within two (2) days of tender submission due date/time.
10.0 PERIOD OF VALIDITY OF BIDS
10.1 Bids shall be kept valid for 120 days from the final bid due date. A bid valid for a shorter period
shall be considered as non-responsive and will be liable for rejection.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 20 of 170
10.2 The Bidder shall not be entitled during the said period of 120 days, without the consent in writing of the Owner to revoke or cancel its bid or to vary the bid given or any term thereof. In case of Bidder revoking or cancelling its bid without the consent of the Owner in writing, the Owner shall forfeit the Bid Security furnished by Bidder.
10.3 Notwithstanding above, the Owner may solicit the Bidder’s consent to an extension of the period
of bid validity. The request and the responses thereto shall be made in writing. The bid security
shall also be accordingly extended.
11.0 LATE BIDS
11.1 E-tendering portal shall close immediately after the deadline for submission of bid.
11.2 Bids must be submitted online in e-tendering portal of OWNER. Bids submitted through any other mode shall not be considered for opening / evaluation / award and shall be rejected.
12.0 MODIFICATION AND WITHDRAWAL OF BIDS
12.1 The Bidder may modify or withdraw his bid after the bid’s submission, provided that the modification/ withdrawal notice is received by the Owners/ Consultant prior to the bid due date & time, but, before the due date and time for submission of Bid following the electronic bid submission procedures.
12.2 No bid shall be modified subsequent to the due date & time or extension, if any, for submission of bids. Bidder(s) to note that unsolicited price changes (including changes in taxes, duties mentioned & their applicability) after submission of bid shall not be allowed. In case any bidder gives unsolicited revised prices/price implication, his bid shall be rejected and EMD/ Bid security submitted by the bidder shall be forfeited, however, any unilateral rebate shall be dealt as per Clause no. 23 of ITB.
12.3 No bid shall be allowed to be withdrawn in the interval between the deadline for submission of bids and the expiration of the period of bid validity specified by the Bidder. Withdrawal of a bid during this interval shall result in the forfeiture of Bidder’s EMD/Bid security and further action as per corporation (OWNER) policy.
12.4 No new deviation will be received/ accepted from bidder after bid due date & time. In case bidder submits new deviation, his bid will be rejected. At the sole discretion of the owner bidder may be given opportunity to withdraw the deviation and in case the same is not withdrawn by the bidder, the offer of the bidder shall be rejected.
13.0 OPENING OF BIDS
13.1 Unpriced bid shall be opened by OWNER/CONSULTANT on the date and time specified in Invitation for Bids (IFB) / e-tender. Date & time for opening of price bids shall be advised later to only techno-commercially accepted bidders.
13.2 In case of e-tender, the bids shall be opened online and bidders shall be able to view details by logging in at their remote location. Physical presence of bidders at WorleyParsons/HPCL‟s office is not required for witnessing bid opening.
14.0 BID PRICES & BIDDING CURRENCY
14.1 Bidder to submit their Prices in Indian Currency only. Payment shall be made in Indian Rupees Only.
14.2 Deleted.
15.0 EVALUATION OF BIDS
15.1 The Owner/Consultant will examine the bids to determine whether they are complete, whether any computational errors have been made, whether the documents have been properly digitally signed and whether the bids are generally in order.
15.2 The bids without requisite Bid Security and/or not in the prescribed proforma will not be
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 21 of 170
considered and bids of such Bidder(s) shall be rejected at the sole discretion of Owner/Consultant.
15.3 Qualification of Bidder: The experience details and financial, technical & production capabilities of the Bidder(s) shall be examined to determine whether the Bidder(s) meet the Qualification Criteria mentioned in the INVITATION FOR BIDS (IFB). Bids that do not meet the qualification criteria mentioned in IFB shall be rejected.
15.4 Bidder shall mandatorily quote for all the Schedules.
15.5 The price bids of techno-commercially accepted bidders shall only be opened.The evaluation criteria shall be Overall Lowest (L1) on the basis of Delivered Landed Cost at Site including all duties, taxes, freight etc. (i.e. lowest delivered cost for complete scope for each individual location). The price bids shall be opened in the following order.
15.6 Deleted
15.7 After tender submission due date & time/ extended due date & time (as the case may be) the bidders shall not make any subsequent price changes/Changes on taxes quoted, whether resulting or arising out of any technical / commercial clarifications sought/allowed on any deviations or exceptions mentioned in the bid unless discussed and agreed by Owner/Consultant in writing. In case a bidder submits the bid without confirmation/compliance/acceptance to corrigendum’s (issued before bid submission due date/extended due date), bidder shall not be allowed to change the bid price /rates on account of compliance /acceptance/confirmation to such corrigendum.
15.8 To assist in the examination, evaluation and comparison of unpriced bids, the Owner/Owner’s Consultant may, at its discretion, ask the Bidder clarifications on the bid. The request for such clarifications and the response thereto shall be in writing and shall be binding on the bidder.
15.9 Bidder(s) to note that Price changes against Technical/Commercial clarification, if any, in line with terms & conditions of enquiry documents are not allowed. In case, any bidder gives revised prices/price implications (including revision in taxes /duties & their applicability) against such clarification, it would amount to unsolicited post bid modification by the bidder and action shall be taken by the owner as per clause “MODIFICATION AND WITHDRAWAL OF BIDS” mentioned above. However, the Owner/Consultant reserves the right to seek cost implication/revised rates from all the vendors in case of a revision in technical specification/scope of job.
15.10 Prior to the evaluation and comparison of the bid, the Owner/ Owner’s Consultant will determine the substantial responsiveness of each bid to the bidding documents. For the purpose of this Article, a substantially responsive bid is one, which conforms to all the terms and conditions of the bidding document without material deviations or reservations. The Owner’s/Consultant’s determination of a bid’s responsiveness is to be based on the contents of the bid itself without recourse to the extrinsic evidence.
15.11 A bid determined as substantially non-responsive will be rejected by the Owner/Consultant and shall not subsequently be allowed by the Owner/Consultant to be made responsive by the Bidder by correction of the non-conformity.
15.12 Bidders are requested to accept tender terms/conditions in totality and should avoid deviations.
15.13 In case deviations to tender terms/conditions are unavoidable, the same should be mentioned in ONLINE DEVIATION SHEET. Deviations mentioned elsewhere shall not be considered by Owner/Consultant.
15.14 In Case, bidder is evaluated L1 bidder and has mentioned deviation to tender terms not in online deviation sheet, but elsewhere and is not withdrawing those deviations, Owner/Consultant shall reject his bid and forfeit the EMD/Bid security of the bidder in such cases.
15.15 No set off (including set off on account of taxes/duties) shall be considered in evaluation for deciding L1 bidder.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 22 of 170
15.16 In case any deviation sought by bidder is accepted by Owner, Owner reserves the right to suitably load the bidder for evaluation purpose only.
15.17 Evaluation shall be carried out based on price quoted by bidder including stated taxes & duties as on date of opening of unpriced bid. For import content also, if any, no exchange rate variation / Customs duty variation shall be considered during evaluation.
15.18 Bidder must quote the entire cell against each quoted line item. If no prices (free of cost) are envisaged for any of the entries, ‘0’ shall be mentioned. In this context “0’ mentioned against any item shall construe that the Bidder shall not charge any amount separately for that item from the Owner and shall execute the job as per the scope, terms and conditions of the tender. If bidder quotes any Statutory Taxes and duties at a rate different from the present/ statutory rate, then the taxes and duties as quoted by the bidder shall be considered for evaluation; however payment shall be made as per the taxes & duties quoted by the bidder or payable as per statutes, whichever is less.
15.19 Non acceptance of commercial terms and conditions may result in rejection of bidder offer, or suitable commercial loading e.g. for non-acceptance of PRS clause, loading @ as defined for PRS shall be imposed. Deviations on payment terms shall be loaded with interest rate of SBI's Prime lending rate (PLR) + 1% prevailing on tender submission due date/extended due date(whichever is later).
15.20 Owner/Consultant reserves the right, at the time of award of contract, to increase or decrease in quantity(ies)of goods for any/all items as specified in the bid document without any change in the unit prices (as well as lump sum prices, if any) and other terms and conditions. Bidder’s quoted prices shall be valid for such quantity variation.
15.21 Evaluation will be done inclusive of all taxes as under:
a) Registered Bidders: The tax liability will be borne by the bidder and the same shall be considered for the purpose of evaluating the bid.
b) Unregistered Bidders: The tax liability will be borne by HPCL under reverse charge and the same shall be loaded for the purpose of evaluating the bid.
c) Bidders under composition scheme: The rate is considered to be inclusive of all taxes and no separate tax shall be billed to HPCL and the bid shall be accordingly evaluated.
For this purpose Bidder should give status whether Registered, Unregistered or Composition Scheme.
In case of different rates of Goods and Service Tax (GST) quoted by the Bidders, Corporation reserves the right to query on the same and adopt the correct classification and GST rate. The decision of Corporation in this regard will be final and binding on the Bidder.
For imports (if applicable), all relevant costs/taxes (as mentioned elsewhere in the tender documents) will be included for the purpose of evaluation.
16.0 REJECTION CRITERIA
16.1 Owner/ Consultant expect Bidder’s compliance to requirement of Bidding Document without any deviation and submit substantially responsive bid.
16.2 Bids not compliance to requirement of Bidding Document shall be given once chance to withdraw their deviations/stipulations. Bids with the following deviation(s) to the bid conditions shall be considered as non-responsive and be rejected:
16.2.1 Bid Security
16.2.2 Tender Fee( if applicable)
16.2.3 Mention rates anywhere else in the tender other than online Price Bid
16.2.4 Security Deposit
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 23 of 170
16.2.5 Period of Validity of bids shorter than specified
16.2.6 Force Majeure
16.2.7 Defect Liability Period/Guarantee Period
16.2.8 Firm Prices
16.2.9 Workability Clause
16.2.10 Completion Period / Time Schedule
16.2.11 Liquidated Damages / Price Reduction Clause
16.2.12 Unsolicited Price change/implication (including revision in taxes / duties & their applicability) after bid submission due date / extended due date; however, any unilateral rebate shall be dealt as per clause no. 23 of ITB.
16.2.13 Integrity Pact
16.2.14 Non Submission of declaration of not banning / holiday listing/delisting from Government of India /ministries of Govt. of India / PSU
16.2.15 Non-conformance of scope of work /technical specifications
16.2.16 Performance Security (Contract Performance Bank Guarantee)
16.2.17 Guarantee/ Warranty Clause
16.3 Bids that do not meet the bidder qualification criteria as specified in the bid document shall be rejected.
16.4 A bid with incomplete scope of work and/or which does not meet the technical requirements as specified in the bid document shall be considered as non-responsive and rejected.
16.5 Price must be furnished in the Price Schedule format available online in e-tender portal of HPCL https://etender.hpcl.co.in and shall be strictly based on the terms specified under “Bid Prices” & “Taxes & Duties” specified in the bid document. Noncompliance of this requirement shall make the bid liable for rejection. Conditional bids will be liable for rejection.
16.6 Conditional bids will be liable for rejection.
16.7 Non acceptance of commercial terms and conditions may result in rejection of Bidder offer or with suitable commercial loading.
16.8 In case bidder is on the holiday list/Banned/Blacklisted/Delisted by any Government or quasi Government agency or PSU, his offer may be rejected at the sole discretion of Owner.
16.9 Notwithstanding the above , if a Bidder who is on Holiday/ Negative/Suspension / Banning list of OWNER/CONSULTANT on due date of submission of bid / during the process of evaluation of the bids, the offers of such bidders shall not be considered for bid opening/evaluation/award. Further, in case of a consortium, if any of the member(s) of consortium is on Holiday/ Negative /Suspension / Banning list of OWNER/CONSULTANT on due date of submission of bid / during the process of evaluation of the bids, the offers of such consortium shall not be considered for bid opening/evaluation/Award.
16.10 Owner reserves the right to reject offers not meeting its Technical requirements and / or commercial conditions.
16.11 WRONG INFORMATION
If the Bidder deliberately gives wrong information in his Bid to create circumstances for the acceptance of his Bid, Owner reserves the right to reject his BID without any reference to the Bidder
17.0 COMPARISON OF BIDS
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 24 of 170
17.1 The Owners / Consultant will evaluate and compare bids previously determined to be substantially responsive pursuant to the provisions of the bidding document.
17.2 The “Price Schedule” as quoted for Overall basis (as stated in IFB / Price Schedule) shall be taken up for evaluation Criteria defined in above Clause No .15 ( Evaluation of Bids).
17.3 Owner’s Consultant/Owner’s evaluation and comparison of prices of previously determined substantially responsive bids shall take following in account :-
17.3.1 FOR SCOPE OF SUPPLY Evaluated price shall be derived by taking the following into account :-
i) FOT Dispatch Point Price including loading on to trailers / Trucks.
ii) All taxes / duties as applicable on finished goods as quoted by Bidder would be as per the prevailing rates of GST for Supply of Material.
iii) Transportation of Material from manufacturer's work up to Project site inclusive of GST for Services, as quoted by the Bidder. Transit Insurance will be arranged & Borne by HCPL.
iv) Charges towards Installation/erection, pre-commissioning and commissioning as specified in Preamble of Price Schedule.
v) Loading on account of the technical parameters, as stipulated in SPC and Material Requisition, if any.
18.0 CONTACTING THE OWNER/ OWNER’S CONSULTANT
18.1 From the time of the bid opening to the time of the Contract award, if any bidder wishes to contact the OWNER for any matter relating to the bid it should do so in writing.
18.2 Any efforts by a Bidder to influence the Owner’s/ Owner’s Consultant during bid evaluation, bid comparison or contract award decisions may result in the rejection of the Bidder’s bid.
19.0 AWARD CRITERIA
19.1 Evaluation and comparison of bids shall be done to work out the ordering on Overall lowest delivered cost to Owner, utilizing maximum capacity taking following into consideration:
i. Evaluated Prices for all the Schedules.
ii. Price Preference to Indian Manufacturers.
iii. Purchase preference to Micro and Small Enterprise as per Public Procurement Policy of Govt. of India, 2012.
19.1.1 Evaluated Prices for all items.
Owner will award the job on Overall lowest delivered cost basis. However, if in the opinion of HPCL, the total price or certain item rates quoted by the lowest evaluated bidder are considered high, HPCL may invite such bidder for price negotiation. Lowest quoted bidder shall attend such negotiation meetings and if requested by HPCL, Bidder shall provide the analysis of rates/break-up of amount quoted by him for any or all items of Schedule of Rates/ Prices to demonstrate the reasonability. As a result of negotiation, bidder may offer rebate on his earlier quoted Price as per clause 23 of ITB.
19.1.2 Purchase preference to Micro and Small Enterprise as per Public Procurement Policy of Govt. of India,2012 shall be applicable as per Methodology as explained below:
19.1.2.1 Participating Micro and Small Enterprises quoting price within price brand of L1+15% shall also be allowed to supply a portion of requirement by bringing down their prices to L1 price in a situation where L1 price is from someone other than a micro and small enterprises and such micro and small enterprises shall be allowed to supply up to 20% of the total tendered value. In case of more than one such Micro and Small Enterprises, the supply shall be shared proportionately (to tendered quantity).Further, out of above 20%, 4% (20% of 20%) shall be from MSEs owned by SC/ST entrepreneurs. This quota is to be
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 25 of 170
transferred to other MSEs in case of non-availability of MSEs owned by SC/ST entrepreneurs.
19.1.2.2 The MSEs owned by SC/ ST entrepreneurs shall mean:
a. In case of Proprietary MSE, Proprietor(s) shall be SC/ ST.
b. In case of Partnership MSE, the SC/ST partners shall be holding at least 51% share in the unit.
c. In case of Private Limited Companies, at least 51% share is held by SC/ ST. If the MSE is owned by SC/ ST Entrepreneurs, the bidder shall furnish appropriate documentary evidence in this regard.
19.1.2.3 The quoted prices against various items shall remain valid in case of splitting of quantities of the items as above.
19.1.2.4 The owner reserves the right to allow Micro & Small enterprises as well as MSEs Owned by SC/ST entrepreneur, price preference as admissible under the prevailing procurement policy for MSEs.
The quantity against the item(s) of MR may be split to enable ordering of 20% quality against the item(s)of MR to MSEs, in line with price preference as admissible under the prevailing procurement policy for MSEs. Accordingly, the quoted prices against various items of MR shall remain valid in case of splitting of quantities of the items in view of the same. However, in case where quantity against a line item cannot be split (i.e. minimum 20% to MSEs) or items with single quantity or in group item, the complete line item/group shall be awarded on MSE bidder within the price range of L1 bidder’s evaluated price+15% subject to their matching L1 bidder’s price.
19.1.2.5 MSE bidder shall submit the following:
i. Documentary evidence that the bidder is a Micro or Small Enterprises registered with District Industries Centres or Khadi and Village Industries Commission or Khadi and Village Industries Board or Coir Board or national Small Industries Corporation or Directorate of Handicrafts and Handloom or any other body specified by Ministry of Micro, Small and Medium Enterprises.
ii. If the MSE is owned by SC/ST Entrepreneurs, the bidder shall furnish appropriate documentary evidence in this regard.
If the bidder does not provide the appropriate document or any evidence to substantiate the above, the NIT will be presumed that he does not qualify for any preference admissible in the Public Procurement Policy, 2012.
19.1.3 Price Preference to Indian Manufacturers:
Government have decided that the domestic manufacturers of capital goods supplied to fertilizer, power and petroleum projects under international competitive bidding would be accorded a price preference to offset Central Sales Tax to the extent of 4% or actuals, whichever is less, as well as Octroi at actuals. This dispensation would be subject to 30% of local content norm as stipulated for World Bank funded projects.
Local Content (LC) linked Purchase Preference Eligible (techno-commercially qualified) LC manufacturers / LC service providers may be granted a purchase preference of 10% at the lowest valid price bid.
Bidders to note that Local Content (LC) linked Purchase Preference shall not be available for goods/ services falling under MSME (Micro, Small and Medium Enterprises) or DMEP (Domestically Manufactured Electronic Products) as those Products / Services are already covered under the specific relevant policy.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 26 of 170
Bidders to declare their preference for seeking benefit under PPLC policy or MSME/DMEP policy.
19.2 Deleted
19.3 Workability Clause
Where the lowest bid is very low compared to the cost estimate and other higher bids, the Owner shall review the lowest offered bid for workability of rates and shall ascertain whether Bidder has properly quoted with reference to the scope. In such cases, Owner may require the lowest Bidder to produce detailed price analysis for any or all items to demonstrate the internal consistency of these prices. After evaluation of the price analysis, Owner may require that the amount of the performance security is increased to a level sufficient to protect the Owner against financial loss in the event of default of the successful Bidder under the order and same shall be provided by the bidder. Where based on workability assessment by authority (Owner/Consultant), the vendor's bid is found non-workable, the same will be rejected and EMD, if any, forfeited.
20.0 OWNER’S RIGHT TO ACCEPT ANY BID AND TO REJECT ANY OR ALL BIDS
20.1 Owner reserves the right to accept or reject any bid, and to annul the bidding process and reject all bids, at any time prior to award of contract, without thereby incurring any liability to the affected Bidder or Bidders or; any obligations to inform the affected Bidder or Bidders of the ground for the Owner’s action.
20.2 The submission of any bid connected with these documents and specifications shall constitute an agreement that the Bidder shall have no cause for action or claim, against the Owner for rejection of his bid. The Owner shall always be at liberty to reject or accept any bid or bids at his sole discretion and any such action will not be called into question and the Bidder shall have no claim in that regard against the Owner.
21.0 NOTIFICATION OF AWARD
21.1 Prior to the expiration of period of bid validity, the Owner will notify the successful Bidder in writing or by fax to be confirmed in writing, that his bid has been accepted. The Notification of Award will constitute the formation of the Contract.
21.2 Delivery Period shall be counted from the date of notification of award (Letter of Award).
22.0 ISSUE OF PURCHASE ORDER
22.1 After the successful Bidder/Bidders ( as per awards criterion) has been notified that his bid has been accepted, the Owner will send to such Bidder a detailed Purchase Order incorporating all the terms and conditions of the tender and deviation to tender terms if any ,permitted by Owner.
22.2 Within 15 days of receipt of the detailed Purchase Order, the Bidder shall sign and return it to the Owner, in token of acceptance of the Order. Failure on part of bidder in doing so may result in cancellation of Purchase order and further action by OWNER in line with tender terms including forfeiture of EMD/Bid security at the sole discretion of OWNER.
23.0 REBATE
23.1 If a bidder offers a rebate unilaterally after the closing date and time of the bid, it will not be taken into account for evaluating purposes, but if that bidder emerges as the lowest evaluated, the rebate offered will be taken into account and shall be binding on the bidder for award of work.
23.2 If a contractor submits his bid, qualifies and does not get the order because of his being not the lowest, he will be prohibited from working as a subcontractor for the contractor who is executing the order.
24.0 FRADULENT PRACTICES
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 27 of 170
24.1 The OWNER/CONSULTANT requires that Bidder/Vendor/ Contractor observe the highest standard of ethics during the award/execution of Contract. “Fraudulent Practice” means a misrepresentation of facts in order to influence the award of a Contract to the detriment of the OWNER/CONSULTANT and includes collusive practice among bidders ( prior to or after bid submission ) designed to establish bid prices at artificial non-competitive levels and to deprive the OWNER of the benefits of free and open competition.
24.2 The OWNER/CONSULTANT will reject a bid for award if it determines that the bidder recommended for award has engaged in fraudulent practices in competing for the Contract in question.
24.3 Bidder is required to furnish the complete and correct information/ documents required for evaluation of their bids, if the information/ documents forming basis of evaluation is found to be false/ forged, the same shall be considered adequate ground for rejection of bids.
24.4 In case, the information/ document furnished by the Bidder/vendor/Contractor forming basis of evaluation of his bid is found to be false/ forged after the award of the contract, OWNER shall have full right to terminate the contract and get the remaining job executed at the risk & cost of such Bidder/Vendor/ Contractor without any prejudice to other rights available to OWNER under the contract such as forfeiture of CPBG/Security Deposit, withholding of payment etc.
24.5 In case, this issue of submission of false document comes to the notice after execution of work, OWNER shall have full right to forfeit any amount due to the Bidder/Vendor/Contractor along with forfeiture of CPBG/Security Deposit furnished by the Bidder/Vendor/Contractor.
Further, such Bidder/Vendor/ Contractor shall be put on Blacklist /Holiday/ Negative List of OWNER debarring them from future business with OWNER and WORLEYPARSONS for a time period, as per the prevailing policy of OWNER and WORLEYPARSONS.
25.0 REVERSE AUCTION
25.1 Please note that HPCL reserves the right to carry out “ONLINE REVERSE AUCTION”, for determining the lowest bidder, for the requirements mentioned in this Tender Enquiry.
25.2 Bidders are requested to submit their “Un-Priced” & “Priced” bids online as per the “Instructions to Bidders” and other documents attached with the tender. The Un- Priced Bids of the participating bidders will be opened as per the date & time mentioned in the tender calendar. After Techno-Commercial evaluation, in case it is decided to finalize the tender through Online Reverse Auction process, the qualified bidders would be advised regarding the modalities for participating in the Reverse Auction. In the event of the tender being finalized through Reverse Auction process, the online “Priced” bids submitted by the bidders will not be opened.
25.3 Bidders are requested to confirm their willingness to participate in “Online Reverse Auction”, in the “Agreed Terms & Conditions”, where provision for the same has been provided. Please note that non-acceptance to participate in the Reverse Auction process may lead to rejection of your offer.
25.4 Bidders are requested to note that the decision to conduct Reverse Auction or not is entirely at the discretion of HPCL, and in case it is decided not to conduct the Reverse Auction, then the online “Priced Bids” submitted by the vendors shall be opened and lowest bidder shall be determined on the basis of these bids. Bidders are requested to take specific note of this provision and submit their online “Priced” bids accordingly. The terms & conditions of reverse auction is attached in bidding document.
26.0 QUOTED PRICES - PRICE SHALL BE QUOTED CONSIDERING THE FOLLOWING:
The bidder shall quote the prices for items in the Schedule of Rates after careful analysis of cost involved for the performance of complete work considering all parts of the bidding documents. In case, any activity though specifically not covered but is required to complete the work as per scope of work, scope of supply, specifications, standards, drawings, GTC, SCP or any other part of bidding document, the prices quoted shall deemed to be inclusive of cost incurred for such activity.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 28 of 170
E-TENDER INSTRUCTIONS
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 29 of 170
1.0 This is only an e-Tender Enquiry and not an order. HPCL reserves the right to cancel it at any
stage without assigning a reason.
2.0 Void
3.0 The tender should be submitted online at website https://etender.hpcl.co.in only, by the due date and time, as specified in the tender. Late / delayed tenders submitted on line after the due date and time, for whatsoever reasons will not be considered. The Server Date & Time as appearing on the HPCL website (https://etender.hpcl.co.in) shall only be considered for the cut-off date and time for receipt of tenders. Offers sent through post, telegram, fax, telex, e-mail, courier will not be considered.
4.0 All communication regarding the tender including queries, if any, and submission of offers shall be done online within the e-Procurement system at website https://etender.hpcl.co.in
5.0 Two Bid System Bidders are required to submit offer in Two parts, namely “Unpriced (Technical Bid)” & “Priced (Priced Bid)”. The Bidder may modify or withdraw his online bid after the bid’s submission on line but prior to the bid due date & time.
6.0 Void
7.0 Bidders shall be required to arrange all resources, including Digital Certificate and Internet Connections at their own cost, for participating in online tenders at HPCL e Procurement site https://etender.hpcl.co.in. For submitting on line response Digital Certificate / Signatures (Class II/ Class III) shall be mandatory. In case, you are logging in for the first time please ensure to upload your Digital certificate. The process for same is listed in the Help link after logging in.
8.0 PLEASE LOGIN WITH YOUR EIGHT DIGIT JDE (HPCL) VENDOR CODE AND CORRESPONDING BILL TRACKING SYSTEM (BTS) PASSWORD TO BID FOR THE TENDER (in case, you do not have EIGHT DIGIT JDE (HPCL) VENDOR CODE , Please contact E proc helpdesk at:022-42100111 on any day between 10.00 AM to 6.00 PM except on Sundays/Public holidays). Alternatively for public tenders vendor can create temporary login on his own. In case vendor login is not enabled with above help, vendor may contact at 011-22408444/405. In case of any difficulty in logging or in case you do not have the BTS password, please contact (E proc helpdesk at: 022-42100111 on any day between 10.00AM to 6.00PM except on Sundays /Public holidays.) Please refer to help link after logging in, in case you are new to e-Tender.
9.0 HPCL shall not be responsible for any delays reasons whatsoever in receiving as well as submitting offers, including connectivity issues. HPCL shall not be responsible for any postal or other delays in submitting EMD / tender cost wherever applicable.
10.0 HPCL will not be responsible for the cost incurred in preparation and submission of bids including the cost of digital certificate, regardless of the conduct of outcome of the biding process.
11.0 Void
12.0 Bidders are requested to quote unit rates (per unit quantity) in the on-line price bid only.
13.0 Please do not quote / mention rates anywhere else in the tender other than online price bid. In case bidders quote rates at any other place (other than online price bid), THE OFFER OF PARTY SHALL BE REJECTED.
14.0 Bidders should only quote unit basic rate in the online priced bid format. However, all taxes and duties as applicable for the tender shall be quoted in the tax section online by the bidders. In case bidders do not quote any tax component/charges or mention the same as “0”, in online Tax sheet/section, it will be considered that all the taxes/charges are included in rates quoted by the bidder and the same shall be binding to the bidder.
15.0 Request for extension of tender submission due date, if any, shall be considered at the sole
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 30 of 170
discretion of HPCL however, request for extension received within two (2) days for limited tenders / three (3) days for public tender of tender submission due date /time shall not be considered.
16.0 The HPCL may, at its discretion, on giving reasonable notice online to extend the bid due date, in which case all rights and obligations of the HPCL and the Bidders, previously subject to the bid due date, shall thereafter be subject to the new bid due date as extended.
17.0 Please note that queries related to scope of job, tender specifications, terms & conditions etc. should be submitted on–line only (by logging in at https://etender.hpcl.co.in) by the query end date / time specified in the online tender . The reply of queries sent by bidders/ messages issued by HPCL pertaining to tender shall be available on tender message board. HPCL, at its sole discretion, may not entertain the queries sent by post / fax/ e-mail or through any other mode of communication.
18.0 BID CLARIFICATIONS/AMENDMENTS BY HPCL: HPCL may issue clarifications / amendments in the form of online addendum / corrigendum and on Message Board at https://etender.hpcl.co.in during the bidding period and may also issue amendments subsequent to receiving the bids. Bidders shall consider the addendum/corrigendum/Messages on Message Board while quoting for the tender. Bidders shall examine the Bidding Document thoroughly and submit to HPCL / HPCL any apparent conflict, discrepancy or error. HPCL / HPCL shall issue appropriate clarifications or amendments, if required. Any failure by Bidder to comply with the aforesaid shall not excuse the Bidder from performing the Services in accordance with the contract if subsequently awarded.
19.0 Void
20.0 Void
21.0 In case any deviation sought by bidder is accepted by HPCL, HPCL reserves the right to suitably load the bidder for evaluation purpose only.
22.0 DEVIATIONS TO TENDER TERMS:
1.0 Bidders are requested to accept tender terms/conditions in totality and should avoid deviations. 2.0 In case deviations to tender terms/conditions are unavoidable, the same should be mentioned in
ONLINE DEVIATION SHEET. Deviations mentioned elsewhere shall not be considered by HPCL.
3.0 In case, bidder is evaluated L1 bidder and has mentioned deviation to tender terms not in online deviation sheet , but elsewhere and is not withdrawing those deviations, HPCL may forfeit the EMD (IF APPLICABLE) of the bidder in such cases.
4.0 No new deviation will be received/ accepted from bidder after bid due date. Incase bidder submits new deviation, his bid will be rejected. At the sole discretion of the HPCL bidder may be given opportunity to withdraw the deviation and in case the same is not withdrawn by the bidder, the offer of the bidder shall be rejected & EMD/ bid security (if applicable) submitted by the bidder shall be forfeited.
23.0 Void 24.0 Bidder submission file size limit is 40 MB. However, bidders must attempt to
submit bids only in non-peak hours as there could be chances of packet droppings in peak hour. Further, bidders must be educated on efficient scanning techniques at lower dpi so that more no of pages can be scanned by them within lesser file size limits. Lower file size would also mean, easier submission of bid documents by the vendor.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 31 of 170
Chapter 3 SPECIAL CONDITIONS OF PURCHASE
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 32 of 170
SPECIAL CONDITIONS OF PURCHASE (SCP)
INDEX
SR. NO. DESCRIPTION
1. GENERAL 2. DEFINITIONS / NOTES 3. SCOPE OF WORK 4. BID PRICES 5. TAXES, DUTIES AND LEVIES ON MATERIALS /SERVICES AND FOREIGN EXCHANGE
VARIATION BID SECURITY 6. TRAINING 7. ANNUAL MAINTENANCE CHARGES 8. BID SECURITY 9. CONTRACT PERFORMANCE BANK 10. PRICE REDUCTION FOR DELAY IN DELIVERY 11. INSURANCE 12. PAYMENT TERMS 13. TERMS & CONDITIONS FOR INSTALLATION, ERECTION TESTING & COMMISSIOING 14. LIMITATION OF LIABILITIES 15. LIABILITY CLAUSE 16. DEFECTS AFTER TAKING OVER OR TERMINATION OF WORK CONTRACT BY OWNER 17. TERMINATION OF CONTRACT 18. ARBITRATION
19. LOADING AND PENALTY CLAUSE 20. GRIEVANCE REDRESSAL 21. SUB-CONTRACTING 22. JURISDICTION
23. INTEGRITY PACT 24. UNLOADING 25. MAKE OF MATERIAL 26. ANNEXURE -1: LIST OF OUR APPROVED MAKES / SUB-VENDORS
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 33 of 170
1.0 GENERAL
1.1 Special Conditions of Purchase (SCP) shall be read in conjunction with the General Terms & Conditions for Supply (also referred as General Terms & Conditions hereinafter) , Schedule of Rates, specifications of work, drawings and any other document forming part of this Contract wherever the context so requires.
1.2 Notwithstanding the sub-division of the document into these separate Chapter and volumes, every part of each shall be deemed to be supplementary of every other part and shall be read with and into the Contract so far as it may be practicable to do so.
1.3 Where any portion of the General Terms & Conditions for is repugnant to or at variance with any provisions of the Special Purchase Conditions, then unless a different intention appears, the provision(s) of the Special Purchase Conditions shall be deemed to override the provision(s) of General Terms & Conditions for Supply/ General Terms & Conditions of Work Contract only to the extent that such repugnancies or variations in the Special Purchase Conditions are not possible of being reconciled with the provisions of General Terms & Conditions for Supply/ General Terms & Conditions of Work Contract.
1.4 Wherever it is stated in this Bidding Document that such and such a supply is to be affected or such and such a work is to be carried out, it shall be understood that the same shall be affected and/or carried out by the CONTRACTOR at his own cost, unless a different intention is specifically and expressly stated herein or otherwise explicit from the context. Contract Price shall be deemed to have included such cost.
1.5 The materials, design & workmanship shall satisfy the applicable relevant International / Indian Standards, the job specifications contained herein & codes referred to. Where the job specifications stipulate requirements in addition to those contained in the standard codes and specifications, these additional requirements shall also be satisfied. In the absence of any Standard / Specifications / Codes of practice for detailed specifications covering any part of the work covered in this bidding document, the instructions / directions of HPCL /Consultant will be binding upon the CONTRACTOR.
1.6 In case of contradiction between relevant International / Indian standards, Ge n er a l Terms & Conditions for Supply, Special Purchase Conditions, Specifications, Drawings and Price Schedule / Schedule of Rates, the following shall prevail in order of precedence.
a. Detailed Order along with Statement of Agreed Variations, if any, and its
enclosures.
b. Letter of Award (LOA)
c. Price Schedule / Schedule of Rates with Quantities.
d. Scope of Work
e. Technical Specifications
f. Drawings
g. Special Purchase Conditions (SPC) / Agreed Terms and Conditions(A.T.C.)
h. Instructions to Bidders (ITB) / Invitation for Bids (IFB)
i. General Terms & Conditions for Supply.
j. Relevant Indian / International Standards/ Specifications.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 34 of 170
2.0 DEFINITIONS / NOTES
i. The terms ‘Bidder’, ‘Contractor’, `Seller’, `Supplier’ or ‘Vendor’ stated anywhere in the Bid Document carry the same meaning.
ii. The terms `Client’, ‘Owner’, ‘Purchaser’ stated anywhere in the Bid Document refer to
Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (HPCL).
iii. The term `Consultant’ shall mean WorleyParsons India Pvt. Limited.
iv. The term ‘Contract’, ‘Order’ or ‘Purchase Order’ stated anywhere in the Bid Document carry the same meaning.
v. The term ‘MR means ‘Material Requisition’ containing technical requirements and scope of
work (technical), ‘GPC means General Purchase Conditions’ containing commercial terms & conditions, ‘PR means Purchase Requisition’ issued after award of contract incorporating agreed deviations in MR,’ Instructions to Bidders (ITB)’, ‘ATC means Agreed Terms & Conditions’ , ‘IFB means Invitation For Bids / e-tender’.
vi. In the event of any contradictions between these Instructions to Bidders/Special Conditions
of Purchase and other Chapters of Bid Document, the terms specified under this Chapter shall prevail.
vii. Deleted.
viii. Any reference to the Govt. Acts / Regulations etc. in the Bid Document is only indicative,
and it is entirely for the Bidder to ascertain the applicable Acts/Regulations.
ix. Deleted.
3.0 SCOPE OF WORK / SUPPLY
The scope of work covered in this Contract will be as described in Particular job specifications, Technical specifications, Standard Specifications, Schedule of Rates etc. The scope of supply covered in this Contract will be as described in Particular Job Specifications, Technical Specifications, Standard Specifications, Schedule of Rates etc. It is however, explicitly understood that scope described is not limiting, in so far as the responsibilities of the contractor are concerned and shall include, inter alia, carrying out any and all works and providing any and all facilities as are required to complete the works in all respect.
4.0 BID PRICES
4.1 Price must be furnished in the Price Schedule format available online in e-tender portal of HPCL. Quoted prices must be net of discount, if any. Conditional discounts, if offered by a bidder, shall not be considered for evaluation.
4.2 Quoted prices shall be inclusive of all testing and inspection requirements (including stage wise
and final inspection by Owner/ Owner’s Consultant for which no extra charges shall be paid) as specified in the bid document. However, Personal and incidental expenses of Owner’s / Owner’s Consultant’s inspectors and Third Party Inspection Agency (TPIA) is not in Bidder’s scope. TPIA Charges for final inspection will be borne by Consultant. However, In case the material is later not acceptable/ rejected due to various reasons attributable to Bidder, then in such event, TPIA Charges are deemed to be inclusive in quoted rates by bidder.
4.3 Bidder’s quoted prices shall be deemed to include entire scope of work and all obligations and
responsibilities to be carried out/ executed by the Bidder as per terms of bid document. The
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 35 of 170
quoted base price shall be inclusive of Mandatory Spares, Pre-Commissioning & Commissioning Spares, Special Tools & Tackles for Complete package as per MR.
4.4 It shall be the responsibility of the Bidder to duly enquire of their own and comply with all
applicable laws, rules, regulations, orders and formalities applicable to GST, Customs Duty, Countervailing Duty etc. on the manufacture, sale and/or supply of any material / services to Owner / Consultant. The Bidder shall keep the Owner / Consultant indemnified from and against any and all claims, demands, prosecutions, penalties, damages, demurrages and/or other levies whatsoever made or levied by any Court, Tribunal or the Customs or other Authorities with respect to any alleged breach, evasion or infraction of such duties, taxes, charges or levies or any breach or infraction of such laws, rules, regulations, orders or formalities concerning the same and from the consequence thereof.
4.5 Price quoted by the bidder, shall remain Firm & Fixed until complete execution of the Purchase Order and shall not be subject to any variation, except statutory variation in taxes, duties & levies pursuant to relevant provisions in Special Purchase Conditions. The Bidder’s quoted price shall also remain Firm and Fixed on account of Foreign Exchange (FE) Variation, unless otherwise any specific provision is indicated in IFB document.
4.6 The bidder shall quote the prices after careful analysis of cost involved for the performance of complete work considering all parts of the IFB documents. In case, any activity though specifically not covered but is required to complete the work as per scope of work, scope of supply, specifications, standards, drawings, GPC, SPC or any other part of IFB Document, the prices quoted shall deemed to be inclusive of cost incurred for such activity(ies).
4.7 Deleted. If bidder has considered Customs Duty for import contents other than the Merit Rate of Customs Duty in their offer, then statutory variation on the Customs Duty will be payable extra on the Merit Rate of Custom Duty or the rate of Custom Duty considered by the bidder, whichever is lower.
4.8 Bidder to note and consider the following for Road Permit/Way Bill Clause :-
a) Suppliers/Contractors shall arrange Road Permits/Waybills by themselves and comply with the statutory laws of the concerned state.
b) In case as per state laws the issuance of Road Permit/Waybill is to be arranged by the buyer, HPCL will arrange to issue Road Permit/Waybill. In case of imposition of any Tax the same shall be discharged by the buyer and the same will be adjusted against the payments due to vendors against their bills.
4.9 Bidders shall quote their prices in Indian Rupees only indicate the following in their offer:
4.9.1 FOT dispatch point price of item including packing & forwarding, (such price to include
fabrication /manufacturing of item, all costs as well as duties and taxes paid or payable on components and raw materials incorporated or to be incorporated in the goods, inspection, testing etc.) but excluding applicable taxes and duties on finished goods.
4.9.2 Prevailing GST which will be applicable on the finished goods.
4.9.3 Tansportation Charges (as per Price Schedule) upto respective project site inclusive of GST.
Transit Insurance and Road Permit to be arranged by Owner. In case, bidder does not quote for transportation charges, the bidder shall be required to absorb the same in their quoted price. Non- compliance shall result in rejection of the bid.
4.9.4 Site work Prices, if applicable as per MR for the scope of work mentioned in MR / IFB documents, shall be exclusive of Prevailing GST. All necessary taxes & duties and registration, if required, for carrying out the site activities shall be done by the bidder and cost towards the same shall be included in quoted site work prices.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 36 of 170
4.9.5 Lumpsum Installation charges are as per SOQ/MR, shall be exclusive of GST. In case a bidder does not quote for Installation & Commissioning charges, the bidder shall be required to absorb the same in their quoted price. Non-compliance shall result in rejection of the bid.
4.9.6 Deleted
4.9.7 Deleted 4.9.8 GST, payable extra on Services i.e. Installation/ Site Work, as applicable.
4.9.9 Deleted
4.10 Deleted
5.0 TAXES, DUTIES AND LEVIES ON MATERIALS /SERVICES AND FOREIGN EXCHANGE VARIATION :
5.1 Bidder’s quoted prices shall be inclusive of all taxes, duties, cess, levies etc; Paid or payable on the raw material/components incorporated or to be incorporated in the offered finished goods, packing and forwarding charges, but excluding applicable taxes and duties on finished goods.
5.2 Bidder shall furnish the present rate(s) of GST and payable on quoted finished goods. Owner may decide to place order without concessional form based on the availability of such Form.
5.3 The statutory variation in GST and introduction of new tax on finished goods, from bid due date till the contractual completion period shall be to Purchaser’s account against submission of the documentary evidence. However, any increase in the rate of these taxes and duties beyond the contractual delivery period shall be to Seller’s account. Any decrease in the rate of these taxes and duties shall be passed on to the Purchaser even after contractual delivery period.
5.4 It is for the Bidder to assess and ascertain the rate of applicable GST on quoted items. It is clearly understood that Owner will not have any additional liability towards payment of GST which is based on Bidder's wrong assessment / interpretation of applicability of such GST.
5.5 Deleted. 5.6 Deleted. 5.7 Income Tax / Corporate Tax:
5.7.1 Income Tax deductions shall be made from all payments made to the Contractor as per the rules
and regulations in force in accordance with the Income Tax Act prevailing from time to time. 5.7.2 Corporate Tax Liability if any shall be to Contractor's account.
5.7.3 As regards Income Tax, Surcharge on Income Tax or any other Corporate Tax payable by the
Bidder for reason of the contract awarded, and / or on their expatriate personal, the Owner shall not bear any Tax liability whatsoever, irrespective of the mode of construction of contract / order. The Bidder shall be liable and responsible for payment of such tax, if attracted under the provision of Indian Income Tax Act.
5.7.4 Bidder may note that if any tax is deductible at source as per Indian Income Tax Law, the same will be so deducted before releasing any payment to the Bidder and a TDS (Tax deducted at source) certificate will be furnished to the Bidder. Accordingly, Bidder shall have the responsibility to check and include such provision of taxes in the prices.
5.7.5 In case of delay in delivery due to reasons attributable to Bidder, any new or additional taxes or duties levied by Statutory authorities during this period shall be borne by the Bidder.
5.7.6 The contractor shall provide accurate particulars of PAN number as required, under Section 206AA of Income Tax Act 1961. In case of non-residents not having Permanent Account Number (PAN) the provisions of section 206AA shall not apply if the non-resident furnishes the following information/ documents:
a. Name, e-mail id, contact number; b. Address in the country of which the deductee is a resident
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 37 of 170
c. Tax Residency Certificate (TRC) from the Government of that country d. Tax identification number / unique number of the deductee in the country of his residence.
5.7.7 The contractors having their ‘tax residency status’ outside India shall provide Tax Residency Certificate (TRC), issued by Government of the Country or the specified territory where the Contractor is a Resident. Rule 21AB of the Income Tax Rules, 1962 has prescribed the contents of a TRC. This would enable the Owner to deduct tax at source by duly considering the ‘treaty relief’, if any, under Double Taxation Avoidance Agreement (DTAA) entered into between GOI and the respective country/specified.
5.8 In addition to the terms specified in Clause no. 23 of GTC :- 5.8.1 GST as applicable shall be reimbursed for the materials consigned to Corporation as per limits
indicated in the offer against documentary evidence to be furnished by the Supplier. Corporation shall pay only those taxes, duties and levies as indicated by Supplier at the time of bid submission/as agreed subsequently (prior to opening of priced bids). The tender shall be evaluated as per the taxes & duties quoted by the bidder, however payment shall be made as per the taxes & duties quoted by the bidder or payable as per statutes, whichever is less. Taxes / Duties and/or Levies not indicated by supplier in Bid, but payable, shall be to Supplier’s account. Owner shall make from Contractor's bills such tax deductions as are required as per rules and regulations in force from time to time.
5.8.2 DELETED 5.9 Statutory Variations in taxes, duties & levies 5.9.1 In the event of any Change in Tax Law (as defined below), which results in increased cost of
supply and services under the Contract through increased liability of Taxes, the seller shall be covered for any such increased cost by the Owner subject to the production of documentary proof to the satisfaction of the Owner to the extent which is attributable to such change or amendment as mentioned above within the Contractual Delivery Date. However, in case of delay in delivery beyond the contractual delivery date, for reasons attributable to seller, any increase in taxes shall be borne by seller. Any decrease in Taxes shall be passed on to the Owner.
5.9.2 Further variation in taxes and duties (both nature and quantum) shall be applicable only on the taxes and duties indicated in the Price Bid. The statutory increase in taxes (in case where quoted taxes are less than the taxes/ duties payable as per the statute) shall be payable only to the extent of taxes quoted by the vendor plus statutory increase in the taxes.
5.9.3 Any decrease in the rate of Customs duty shall be passed on to the Owner. 5.9.4 Since Goods and Services Tax (“GST”) is implemented, Bidders to provide GSTIN number,
HSN/SAC Code of the Material/Services being supplied and the applicable GST rates. 5.9.5 The Bidder accepts full and exclusive liability for the payment of any and all applicable taxes
(CGST, SGST, IGST, UTGST), levies and statutory payments payable under all or any of the prevailing Central/State statues.
5.9.6 The Bidder shall comply with all the provisions of the GST Act / Rules / requirements like providing of tax invoices, payment of taxes to the authorities within the due dates, filing of returns within the due dates etc. to enable HPCL to take Input Tax Credit. In case of imports, vendor shall provide import documents and invoice fulfilling the requirement of Customs Act and Rules. Vendor will be fully responsible for complying with the Customs provisions to enable HPCL to take Input Tax Credit. In case, HPCL is not able to take Input Tax Credit due to any noncompliance/default/negligence of the seller of goods / service provider, the same shall be recovered from the pending bills/dues (including security deposit, BG etc.) of Bidder. Bidder shall be responsible to indemnify the Corporation for any loss, direct or implied, accrued to the Corporation on account of supplier/service provider failure to discharge his statutory liabilities like paying taxes on time, filing appropriate returns within the prescribed time etc.
5.9.7 Every invoice of the vendor shall contain invoice number, date, GSTIN number and HSN/SAC code (Harmonized system of Nomenclature/service accounting code) for the items being supplied or services being provided along with tax rate.
5.9.8 The Vendor shall mention their registration status (Registered / Composition / Unregistered) on the bill/invoice. In case there is change in the Registration status of the vendor during the
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 38 of 170
execution of the contract the same should be advised immediately. Due to change in the Registration status from Composition to Registered vendor etc. Corporation will not be liable for any additional tax payments.
5.9.9 Corporation will be liable to pay only those taxes and levies as indicated by Bidder at the time of Price Bid submission/as agreed subsequently (prior to opening of priced bids).
5.9.10 Any tax, levies or any other form of statutory levies or cost as on closing date of the tender will be treated as included in Priced bid. Taxes, Duties, and Levies not indicated by Bidder in the unpriced Bid, but payable, shall be to Bidder’s account.
5.9.11 New taxes / change in tax rates / levies imposed by the Indian/State Governments through Gazette notification after the date of submission of last Price Bid but prior to Contractual Delivery Date, the Corporation shall reimburse/ adjust the increase/ decrease in taxes on satisfactory supporting documents being provided by the Bidder.
5.9.12 In case goods are not supplied/services not provided within the scheduled delivery period, then the increase in the statutory levies, if any, shall be on vendor’s account.
5.9.13 GST Act. anti-profiteering provisions mandates that any reduction in tax rates or benefits of input tax credits be passed on to the consumer by way of commensurate reduction in prices. Bidders to take note of the same and pass such benefits while quoting their price.
5.9.14 GSTIN Number States where the supplies/services are required are given in the price schedule. GSTIN details of HPCL for these states can be taken from our website www.hindustanpetroleum.com. Bidder is required to provide the GSTIN number of state from where supplies will be made to each of the HPCL delivery locations. In case any changes are warranted during the execution of the contract with regard to change in state where delivery is required or change in the supply location of Bidder, the same will be made with mutual consent.
5.9.15 Income tax will be deducted at source as per rules at prevailing rates, unless certificate, if any, for deduction at lesser rate or nil deduction is submitted by the Contractor from appropriate authority.
5.9.16 The Supplier shall provide accurate particulars of PAN number as required, to enable issuance of TDS (Tax Deduction at Source) certificate.
6.0 TRAINING:
Bidder shall arrange for training of M/s HPCL's engineers at site. The training shall cover the design, operation and maintenance of supplied Telecommunication System as per MR Bidder shall quote training fees in the Training price head in online price bid and this shall form
part of commercial evaluation
7.0 ANNUAL MAINTENANCE CHARGES (AMC):
7.1 Bidder shall quote for annual maintenance charges in online e-portal of HPCL, on Lumpsum basis per year for three consecutive years starting just after expiry of warranty for each item as specified in the Material Requisition and this shall form part of commercial evaluation, excluding the supply of spares and consumable and services required for total operation and maintenance of the system. The replacement/maintenance aspects of the total system shall be attended on call basis as per HPCL Instructions. Personal deployed shall be competent & must have experience on maintenance of similar systems. The spares, tools, tackles instruments required shall be arranged by Bidder. The Bidder shall ensure that all possible spares which may be required by the system will be available during the entire period of AMC i.e. 4 years. A list of recommended spares shall be submitted along with the unpriced Bid offer. Initially Bidder shall submit Bank Guarantee equivalent to the cost of maintenance contract to cover 4 Years AMC Period. However, HPCL may accept reducing BG value pertaining to consecutive years for AMC on completion of each year AMC. The travel, boarding & lodging of service engineer/technician
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 39 of 170
shall be borne by the bidder.
7.1 The order for AMC shall be placed separately by HPCL (may be after defect liability Period) and may not form part of the current order for Telecommunication & CCTV System.
7.2 Deleted
7.3 Terms and conditions for Annual Maintenance Charges are details in Chapter — 5 of this bid document.
The service under post warranty maintenance shall include:
7.3.1 Periodic maintenance 7.3.2 Trouble shooting 7.3.3 Preventive maintenance shall involve, complete checking, repair /replacement of defective
part/components and detailed reporting. Repairing & maintenance activity should be completed at the earliest.
7.3.4 Emergency maintenance in the event of any malfunction of the system, experienced service engineer shall be made available at site with-in one week on the receipt of such information from the owner & the system must be brought to the Normal within 24 hrs after reporting at site.
8.0 BID SECURITY
8.1 The Bidder shall furnish, as part of his bid, a bid security in original for the amount specified in the Invitation for bid (IFB).
8.2 The bid security is required to protect the Owner against the risk of Bidder’s conduct, which would warrant the security’s forfeiture.
8.3 Bid Security shall be in the form of an irrevocable Bank Guarantee (in the format provided by Owner) issued by any Indian Scheduled Bank (other than Co-operative Bank). Bid Security shall be issued in favour of “M/s Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited”, Bangalore.
8.4 Unsuccessful Bidder’s bid security will be discharged/returned as promptly as possible, immediately after price bid opening through cheque or e-payment.
8.5 The successful Bidder’s bid security will be discharged upon the Bidder’s accepting the Contract/ Purchase Order, and furnishing the Contract-cum-equipment performance bank guarantee.
8.6 The bid security may be forfeited:
a) If a Bidder withdraws his bid during the period of bid validity or
b) In the case of a successful Bidder, if the Bidder fails or refuses to: (vii) Accept the Purchase Order in accordance with agreed terms and conditions. ii) Furnish Contract performance bank guarantee as per bid document/ Purchase Order.
8.7 Bid Security should be in favour of Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (HPCL) and addressed to HPCL as per Cl. No. 4 of NIT. However, original Bid Security should be enclosed separately in a sealed cover and submitted along with the bid. Bid Security must indicate the Bid Document number and the item for which the Bidder is quoting. This is essential to have proper co-relation at a later date. The Bid Security shall be strictly in the form provided in the bid document For Bid Security/EMD, the details of beneficiary for issuance of bank guarantees are given below:- Beneficiary : Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Account No. : 11083987009.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 40 of 170
Bank Name : State Bank of India. Address : CAG branch, Ballard Estate, Mumbai 400001. Bank IFS Code : SBIN0009995 Swift Code : SBININBB162
8.8 Central Public Sector Undertaking of Govt. Of India are exempted from furnishing the bid security. Firms registered with NSIC are also exempted from furnishing bid security, provided they are registered for the tendered items and up to the monetary limit they intend to quote. Provided further that they submit a copy of the current and valid registration certificate for the quoted item and monetary value along with their bid(s). Owner reserves right to verify the registration certificate provided, with relevant authorities.
8.9 Bid security shall be Valid for Six (6) months from the Bid Due Date/ Extended Bid Due Date
9.0 CONTRACT PERFORMANCE BANK GUARANTEE [CPBG]
9.1 In partial modifications of the terms specified in Clause no. 31 of GTC , as a Performance security, the successful Bidder, to whom the work is awarded, shall be required to furnish within 15 days of notification of Letter of award (LOA) a Performance Bank Guarantee as per proforma attached herewith in tender in favour of the Owner.
9.2 The Bank Guarantee amount shall be equal to TEN PERCENT (10%) of the Total Order Value and it shall guarantee the faithful performance of the Order in accordance with the Terms and conditions specified in the documents and specifications.
9.3 CPBG shall be in the form of an irrevocable Bank Guarantee (in the format provided by Owner) issued by any Indian Scheduled Bank (other than Co-operative Bank). Bank Guarantee shall be issued in favour of “M/s Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited”.
9.4 The supplies made against this order shall be fully guaranteed against any manufacturing defects/poor workmanship/inferior quality etc. for a period of 12 months from the date of commissioning or 18 months from the date of supply whichever is earlier. During this period, you will arrange to repair/replace any defective parts free of cost or replace complete set if required. Guarantee Certificate should be submitted along with dispatch documents.
9.5 The Composite Bank Guarantee shall be valid upto a period of 3 months beyond the expiry of defect Liability period. The guarantee amount shall be payable without demur and demand to the Owner in the currency of the Contract.
9.6 Deleted.
9.7 The Total Order Value for this purpose shall be as under :
FOT dispatch value including Loading on to Trailers/ Trucks but excluding GST, transportation charges etc.,
9.8 In case, the Contract Performance Bank Guarantee stated above gets reduced/ deducted for reasons of non-fulfillment of any Contractual obligations up to the completion of guarantee period, the Bidder shall immediately take action to increase the value of Bank Guarantee to TEN PERCENT (10%) of the Contract price, to cover his guarantee/ warranty obligations.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 41 of 170
9.9 The Performance Guarantee will be returned to the Bidder without any interest at the end of the warranty / guarantee period subject to fulfillment of all contractual obligations by the Bidder.
10.0 PRICE REDUCTION FOR DELAY IN DELIVERY: 10.1 In partial modifications of the terms specified in the Clause No.18 of GTC Supply, In case of delay
in execution of the order beyond the date of delivery as stipulated in the order or any extension sanctioned, the Owner may at his option accept delayed delivery at prices reduced by a sum equivalent to ONE HALF OF ONE percent (½%) of the value of any goods not delivered for every week of delay or part thereof, limited to a maximum of 5% OF TOTAL ORDER VALUE.
Further, in case, of delay in delivery, the bidder shall calculate the applicable price reduction for delayed delivery and raise their invoices net of the same.
10.2 The Total Order Value for this purpose shall be as under:
FOT dispatch value including Loading on to Trailers/ Trucks but excluding GST, transportation charges etc.
10.3 Vendor has to respond within 15 days of notice given by owner for Installation / erection and commissioning and within 30 days for, failing which, LD shall be applicable on FOT value including Installation / Pre-commissioning / commissioning charges.
10.4 Deleted.
10.5 Contractor/Bidder should suggest HPCL for Recommended spares.
11.0 INSURANCE 11.1 HPCL will arrange Transit insurance till material reaches site.
12.0 PAYMENT TERMS
12.1 SUPPLY , INSTALLATION & COMMISSIONING:
12.1.1 60 % of invoice/bill value with applicable taxes shall be released within 15 days after completion of Supply part & from the date of receipt of certified bills at HPCL along with relevant documents against receipt of materials at site.
12.1.2 30% of total basic invoice value with applicable taxes will be released after completion of installation & commissioning of Car Parking Sheds at site.
12.1.3 Balance 10% of total basic value with applicable taxes will be released against submission of complete final documentation.
12.2 Deleted
12.2.1 Deleted.
12.2.2 All payments shall be released within 15 days of receipt of duly certified bill complete in all respects (as per tender by) HPCL except final bill (on case of partial delivery or running bills) which shall be paid within 30 days of receipt of certified at HPCL, complete in all respects as per tender.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 42 of 170
12.3 100% payment against claimed and certified bills shall be paid on submission of PBG as per Clause 9.0 of SCP.
12.4 Payment against invoice shall be made on receipt of equipment / materials at site against
submission of following documents along with your Bill / Invoice: i) Delivery Challan / Lorry Receipt ii) Manufacturer's Test Certificate if applicable iii) Third Party inspection / Clearance report if applicable iv) Manufacture's Guarantee Certificate, if applicable v) Performance Bank Guarantee for 10% Basic Order Value, if applicable vi) Any other document specified in the Purchase Order.
12.5 Payment shall be made in accordance with the following provisions:
The time for payment of invoices shall run only from the date of approval specified in the order or from the date of receipt of Vendor's correct invoices, whichever is later.
Wherever possible, payment shall be tendered to the contractor in electronic mode (e-payment) through any of the designated banks. The contractor will comply by furnishing full particulars of Bank account (mandate) to which the payments will be routed. Owner reserves the right to make payment in any alternate mode also.
12.6 Bills Submission:- VVSPL Project office / WorleyParsons RCM Office Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (Address as applicable)
12.7 INVOICING
Original + 2 copies to Manager (Finance), Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited Ltd, at the above address.
The bills will be reduced by the amount recoverable, if applicable, towards Price Reduction for delay in delivery.
13.0 TERMS & CONDITIONS FOR INSTALLATION/ERECTION TESTING & COMMISSIONING
Terms & conditions for Installation/erection testing & commissioning will be governed by the terms enclosed under Chapter– 5.
14.0 LIMITATION OF LIABILITIES: 14.1 The final payment by the Owner in pursuance of the contract terms shall not mean release of the
Contractor from all his liabilities under the contract. The Contractor will be liable and committed under this contract to fulfill all his liabilities and responsibilities, till such time the Owner releases Contract Performance Guarantee.
14.2 Notwithstanding anything contrary contained herein, the aggregate total liability of Seller, excluding his liability towards infringement of patent, trade mark or industrial design rights, breach of Confidentiality, Anti-Bribery, Corruption and Conflicts of Interest, under the contract or otherwise shall be limited to 100% of value of Purchase order. However, neither party shall be liable to the other party for any indirect and consequential damages, loss of profits or loss of production.
15.0 LIABILITY CLAUSE
It is expressly understood and agreed by and between Bidder and M/s Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited, (Indian Public Sector Undertaking) that M/s Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited is entering into this agreement solely on its own behalf and not on behalf of any other person or entity. In particular, it is expressly understood and agreed that the
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 43 of 170
Government of India is not a party to this agreement and has no liabilities, obligations or rights hereunder. It is expressly understood and agreed that M/s Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited is an independent legal entity with power and authority to enter into contracts solely on its own behalf under the applicable Laws of India and general principles of Contract Law. The Bidder expressly agrees, acknowledges and understands that M/s Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited. is not an agent, representative or delegate of the Government of India. It is further understood and agreed that the Government of India is not and shall not be liable for any acts, omissions, commissions, breaches or other wrongs arising out of the contract. Accordingly Bidder hereby expressly waives, releases and foregoes any and all actions or claims, including cross claims, impleader claims or counter claims against the Government of India arising out of this contract and covenants not to sue to Government of India as to any manner, claim, cause of action or thing whatsoever arising of or under this agreement.
16.0 DEFECTS AFTER TAKING OVER OR TERMINATION OF WORK CONTRACT BY OWNER :-
The Contractor shall remain responsible and liable to make good all losses or damages that may
occur/appear to the work carried out under this Contract within a period of 12 months from date of issue of the Completion Certificate and/or the date of Owner taking over the work, whichever is earlier. The Contractor shall issue a Composite Performance Bank Guarantee to the Owner in the sum of 10% of the work entrusted in the Contract, from any Scheduled bank (other than Co-operative Bank) acceptable to the Owner and if however, the Contractor fails to furnish such a Bank Guarantee the Owner shall have right to retain the Security Deposit and Retention Money to cover the 10% of the Guarantee amount under this clause and to return/refund the same after the expiry of the period of 12 months without any interest thereon.
17.0 TERMINATION OF CONTRACT:- 17.1 The owner may terminate the contract at any stage of the construction for reasons to be recorded
in the letter of termination. 17.2 The Owner inter alia may terminate the Contract for any or all of the following reasons that the
contractor
a. Has abandoned the work/Contract.
b. Has failed to commence the works, or has without any lawful excuse under these conditions suspended the work for 15 consecutive days.
c. Has failed to remove materials from the site or to pull down and replace the work within 15 days
after receiving from the Engineer written notice that the said materials or work were condemned and/or rejected by the Engineer under specified conditions.
d. Has neglected or failed to observe and perform all or any of the terms acts, matters or things
under this Contract to be observed and performed by the Contractor.
e. Has to the detriment of good workmanship or in defiance of the Engineer's instructions to the contrary sub-let any part of the Contract.
f. Has acted in any manner to the detrimental interest, reputation, dignity, name or prestige of the
Owner.
g. Has stopped attending to work without any prior notice and prior permission for a period of 15 days.
h. Has become untraceable.
i. Has without authority acted in violation of the terms and conditions of this contract and has
committed breach of terms of the contract in best judgement of the owner.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 44 of 170
j. Has been declared insolvent/bankrupt.
k. In the event of sudden death of the Contractor.
17.3 The owner on termination of such contract shall have the right to appropriate the Security Deposit,
Retention Money and invoke the Bank Guarantee furnished by the contractor and to appropriate the same towards the amounts due and payable by the contractor as per the conditions of Contract and return to the contractor excess money, if any, left over.
17.4 In case of Termination of the contract, Owner shall have the right to carry out the unexecuted portion of the work either by themselves or through any other contractor(s) at the risk and cost of the Contractor. In view of paucity of time, Owner shall have the right to place such unexecuted portion of the work on any nominated contractor(s). However, the overall liability of the Contractor shall be restricted to 100 % of the total contract value.
17.5 The contractor within or at the time fixed by the Owner shall depute his authorized representative for taking joint final measurements of the works executed thus far and submit the final bill for the work as per joint final measurement within 15 days of the date of joint final measurement. If the contractor fails to depute their representative for joint measurement, the owner shall take the measurement with their Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge or any other outside representatives. Such a measurement shall not be questioned by the Contractor and no dispute can be raised by the Contractor for purpose of Arbitration.
17.6 The Owner may enter upon and take possession of the works and all plant, tools, scaffoldings, sheds, machinery, power operated tools and steel, cement and other materials of the Contract at the site or around the site and use or employ the same for completion of the work or employ any other contractor or other person or persons to complete the works. The Contractor shall not in any way object or interrupt or do any act, matter or thing to prevent or hinder such actions, other Contractor or other persons employed for completing and finishing or using the materials and plant for the works. When the works shall be completed or as soon thereafter the Engineer shall give a notice in writing to the Contractor to remove surplus materials and plant, if any, and belonging to the Contractor except as provided elsewhere in the Contract and should the Contractor fail to do so within a period of 15 days after receipt thereof the Owner may sell the same by public auction and shall give credit to the contractor for the amount realised. The Owner shall thereafter ascertain and certify in writing under his hand what (if anything) shall be due or payable to or by the Owner for the value of the plant and materials so taken possession and the expense or loss which the Owner shall have been put to in procuring the works, to be so completed, and the amount if any, owing to the Contractor and the amount which shall be so certified shall thereupon be paid by the Owner to the Contractor or by the Contractor to the Owner, as the case may, and the Certificate of the Owner shall be final and conclusive between the parties.
17.7 When the contract is terminated by the Owner for all or any of the reasons mentioned above the Contractor shall not have any right to claim compensation on account of such termination.
18.0 ARBITRATION – Also Refer Annexure-Y of Chapter 9
18.1 All disputes and differences of whatsoever nature, whether existing or which shall at any time
arise between the parties hereto touching or concerning the agreement, meaning, operation or effect thereof or to the rights and liabilities of the parties or arising out of or in relation thereto whether during or after completion of the contract or whether before after determination, foreclosure, termination or breach of the agreement (other than those in respect of which the decision of any person is, by the contract, expressed to be final and binding) shall, after written notice by either party to the agreement to the other of them and to the Appointing Authority hereinafter mentioned, be referred for adjudication to the Sole Arbitrator to be appointed as hereinafter provided.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 45 of 170
18.2 The appointing authority shall either himself act as the Sole Arbitrator or nominate some officer/retired officer of Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (referred to as owner or HPCL) or a retired officer of any other Government Company in the Oil Sector of the rank of Ch. Manager & above or any retired officer of the Central Government not below the rank of a Director, to act as the Sole Arbitrator to adjudicate the disputes and differences between the parties. The contractor/vendor shall not be entitled to raise any objection to the appointment of such person as the Sole Arbitrator on the ground that the said person is/was an officer and/or shareholder of the owner, another Govt. Company or the Central Government or that he/she has to deal or had dealt with the matter to which the contract relates or that in the course of his/her duties, he/she has/had expressed views on all or any of the matters in dispute or difference.
18.3 In the event of the Arbitrator to whom the matter is referred to, does not accept the appointment,
or is unable or unwilling to act or resigns or vacates his office for any reasons whatsoever, the Appointing Authority aforesaid, shall nominate another person as aforesaid, to act as the Sole Arbitrator.
18.4 Such another person nominated as the Sole Arbitrator shall be entitled to proceed with the
arbitration from the stage at which it was left by his predecessor. It is expressly agreed between the parties that no person other than the Appointing Authority or a person nominated by the Appointing Authority as aforesaid, shall act as an Arbitrator. The failure on the part of the Appointing Authority to make an appointment on time shall only give rise to a right to a Contractor to get such an appointment made and not to have any other person appointed as the Sole Arbitrator.
18.5 The Award of the Sole Arbitrator shall be final and binding on the parties to the Agreement.
18.6 The work under the Contract shall, however, continue during the Arbitration proceedings and no
payment due or payable to the concerned party shall be withheld (except to the extent disputed) on account of initiation, commencement or pendency of such proceedings.
18.7 The Arbitrator may give a composite or separate Award(s) in respect of each dispute or difference
referred to him and may also make interim award(s) if necessary.
18.8 The fees of the Arbitrator and expenses of arbitration, if any, shall be borne equally by the parties
unless the Sole Arbitrator otherwise directs in his award with reasons. The lumpsum fees of the Arbitrator shall be Rs. 70,000/- per case for transportation contracts and Rs. 1,00,000/- for engineering contracts and if the sole Arbitrator completes the arbitration including his award within 5 months of accepting his appointment, he shall be paid Rs. 10,000/- additionally as bonus. Reasonable actual expenses for stenographer, etc. will be reimbursed. Fees shall be paid stagewise i.e. 25% on acceptance, 25% on completion of pleadings/documentation, 25% on completion of arguments and balance on receipt of award by the parties
18.9 Subject to the aforesaid, the provisions of the Arbitration and Conciliation Act, 1996 or any
statutory modification or re-enactment thereof and the rules made thereunder, shall apply to the Arbitration proceedings under this Clause.
18.10 The Contract shall be governed by and constructed according to the laws in force in India. The
parties hereby submit to the exclusive jurisdiction of the Courts situated at Mumbai for all purposes. The Arbitration shall be held at say Mumbai and conducted in English language.
18.11 The Appointing Authority is the Functional Director of Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 46 of 170
18.12 Public Sector v/s. Government Department or vice versa :
In case of contracts/agreement to be executed between Public Sector Enterprises / Government Departments, the following clause will be incorporated. "In the event of any dispute or difference between the parties hereto, such dispute or difference shall be resolved amicably by mutual consultation or through the good offices of empowered agencies of the Government. If such resolution is not possible, then, the unresolved dispute or difference shall be referred to arbitration of an arbitrator to be nominated by Secretary, Department of Legal Affairs ("Law Secretary"). The Arbitration & Conciliation Act, 1996) shall not be applicable to the Arbitration under this clause. The award of the arbitrator shall be binding upon the parties to the dispute, provided, however, that any party aggrieved by such award may appeal for setting aside or revision of the award to Law Secretary whose decision shall bind the parties finally and conclusively. The said appeal should be filed within the period specified in the award of the arbitrator." It is essential that, to avoid delay in nomination of arbitrator or initiation of arbitration proceeding, the Arbitration Clause or Agreement, as the case may be, is forwarded without fail at the time of making request for reference to the Law Secretary or Department of Legal Affairs.
18.13 Deleted 19.0 Deleted
20.0 GRIEVANCE REDRESSAL MECHANISM 20.1 There is a grievance redressal mechanism in HPCL for vendors participating in the tender, the
details of which are available on HPCL’s website www.hindustanpetroleum.com
21.0 SUB-CONTRACTING 21.1 Sub-contracting of any work is not permissible. If a contractor submits his bid, qualifies and does
not get the contract because of his being not the lowest, he will be prohibited from working as a subcontractor for the contractor who is executing the contract.
22.0 JURISDICTION 22.1 The courts at Mumbai (India) shall have exclusive jurisdiction over all Disputes arising under or in
connection with the CONTRACT.
23.0 INTEGRITY PACT 23.1 Integrity Pact: All tenders and contracts shall comply with the requirements of the Integrity Pact
(IP) if the value of such tenders or contracts exceed Rs.1 crore. Failure to sign the Integrity Pact shall lead to outright rejection of bid.
23.2 The successful tenderer shall execute Integrity Pact with Owner as per the enclosed Draft Integrity Pact Agreement. Hard copy of the same duly filled signed, stamped by authorized person and witnessed to be forwarded along with EMD in physical condition so as to be received at WORLEY PARSONS prior to bid due date and time.
24.0 UNLOADING i. Please note that unloading will be arranged by HPCL, unless specifically mentioned in
tender terms and conditions. ii. Bidders are requested to quote “0” in the field provided for unloading, unless specifically
mentioned in tender terms and conditions. iii. Kindly note that in case Unloading is in HPCL’s Scope and you are quoting for the same,
the same shall not be considered during evaluation and PO shall be placed accordingly.
25.0 MAKE OF MATERIAL
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 47 of 170
25.1 The materials required to be supplied by the Bidder under this Contract shall be procured only from Owner / Consultant approved vendors enlisted under Annexure-1 of this SCP (Chapter 3 of this tender).Where the makes of materials are not indicated in the IFB, Bidder shall furnish the details (Past track record / credentials) of proposed makes and shall obtain prior approval of Owner / Consultant. Bidder shall not procure any item from vendors not approved by Consultant/ Owner.
25.2 Bidder is also required to ensure that equipment qualification criteria, specified elsewhere in the bid document, are also simultaneously met.
25.3 Bidder shall make an independent assessment of capability of all the vendors for timely deliveries of material / equipment. Any delays in deliveries by vendor(s) shall not be a cause of Schedule and cost implication.
25.4 Non-acceptance of a particular proposed Makes /vendor due to any reasons whatsoever shall not be a cause of Schedule and cost implication to the Owner.
25.5 At any stage of the project, if it comes to the notice of Owner/ Consultant that Vendor has procured material / equipment, intentionally or unintentionally whatsoever, from an unapproved vendor and/or items not falling in approved range of vendor(s), the same shall be rejected forthwith and Vendor shall be liable to replace such material /plant / machinery without any Schedule and cost implication to the Owner.
25.6 It is understood that should the name of Vendor be changed due to change in their Company or Corporate shareholding, Owner may accept such Vendors under its new name with prior approval.
25.7 Any such approval shall however, not absolve the Vendor from any of his obligations under the contract; neither shall any such approval signify nominations or instruction to use such a vendor. All approved vendors are deemed to have been freely chosen by the VENDOR at his own risk.
26.0 Annexure - 1 of SCP - List of Approved Makes / Sub-Vendor’s - Not Applicable.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 48 of 170
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 49 of 170
Chapter – 4 a
GENERAL TERMS & CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 50 of 170
GENERAL TERMS & CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
1 PRELIMINARY
1.1 This is a Contract for execution of job as defined in tender document at the specified
location
1.2 The tenderer for the abovementioned item of work is the company/ proprietary
concern/ individual (as per details & address mentioned in the unpriced bid) and undersigned (digitally) is authorized to submit the bid on behalf of tenderer.
1.3 The terms and conditions mentioned hereunder are the terms and conditions of the
Contract for the execution of the work mentioned under item 1.1 above.
1.4 It is the clear understanding between Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited and the tenderer that in case the bid of tenderer is accepted by Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited and an intimation to that effect is so issued and also a Procurement Order is on the tenderer this document shall form part of the Contract between the parties and terms and conditions hereunder would govern the parties interest.
1.5 Interpretation of Contract Documents: All documents forming part of the Contract are to
be taken mutually explanatory. Should there be any discrepancy, inconsistency, error or omission in the contract, the decision of the Owner/Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge shall be the final and the contractor shall abide by the decision. The decision shall not be arbitrable. Works shown upon the drawings but not mentioned in the specification or described in the specifications without being shown on the drawings shall nevertheless be deemed to be included in the same manner as if they are shown in the drawings and described in the specifications.
1.6 Special conditions of Contract : The special conditions of contract, if any
provided and whenever and wherever referred to shall be read in conjunction with General Terms and Conditions of contract, specifications, drawings, and any other documents forming part of this contract wherever the context so requires. Notwithstanding the subdivision of the documents into separate sections, parts volumes, every section, part or volume shall be deemed to be supplementary or complementary to each other and shall be read in whole. In case of any misunderstanding arising the same shall be referred to decision of the Owner/ Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge and their decision shall be final and binding and the decision shall not be arbitrable.
It is the clear understanding that wherever it is mentioned that the Contractor shall do/perform a work and/or provide facilities for the performance of the work, the doing or the performance or the providing of the facilities is at the cost and expenses of the Contractor not liable to be paid or reimbursed by the Owner.
2. DEFINITIONS
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 51 of 170
In this contract unless otherwise specifically provided or defined and unless a contrary intention appears from the contract the following words and expressions are used in the following meanings;
2.1 The term "Agreement" wherever appearing in this document shall be read as
"Contract".
2.2 The "Authority" for the purpose of this Contract shall be the Chairman and
Managing Director or any other person so appointed or authorised.
2.3 The "Chairman and Managing Director" shall mean the Chairman and Managing Director of HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LIMITED or any person so appointed, nominated or designated and holding the office of Chairman & Managing Director.
2.4 The "Change Order" means an order given in writing by the Engineer-in-Charge or by Owner to effect additions to or deletion from or alterations into the Work.
2.5 The "Construction Equipment" means all appliances and equipment of whatsoever nature for the use in or for the execution, completion, operation or maintenance of the work except those intended to form part of the Permanent Work.
2.6 The "Contract" between the Owner and the Contractor shall mean and include all documents like enquiry, tender submitted by the contractor and the procurement order issued by the owner and other documents connected with the issue of the procurement order and orders, instruction, drawings, change orders, directions issued by the Owner/Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge for the execution, completion and commissioning of the works and the period of contract mentioned in the Contract including such periods of time extensions as may be granted by the owner at the request of the contractor and such period of time for which the work is continued by the contractor for purposes of completion of the work.
2.7 "The Contractor" means the person or the persons, firm or Company whose tender has been accepted by the Owner and includes the Contractor's legal heirs, representative, successor(s) and permitted assignees.
2.8 The "Drawings" shall include maps, plans and tracings or prints thereof with any modifications approved in writing by the Engineer-in-Charge and such other drawings as may, from time to time, be furnished or approved in writing by the Engineer-in-Charge.
2.9 The "Engineer-in-Charge or Site-in-Charge" shall mean the person appointed or designated as such by the Owner and shall include those who are expressly authorised by the owner to act for and on its behalf.
2.10 "The Owner" means the HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LIMITED incorporated in India having its Registered office at PETROLEUM HOUSE, 17, JAMSHEDJI TATA ROAD, BOMBAY - 400020 and Marketing office at the address mentioned for this purpose in the tender header or their successors or assignees.
2.11 The "Permanent Work" means and includes works which form a part of the work to be handed over to the Owner by the Contractor on completion of the contract.
2.12 The "Project Manager" shall mean the Project Manager of HINDUSTAN
PETROLEUM CORPORATION LIMITED, or any person so appointed, nominated or designated.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 52 of 170
2.13 The "Site" means the land on which the work is to be executed or carried out and such other place(s) for purpose of performing the Contract.
2.14 The "Specifications" shall mean the various technical and other specifications attached and referred to in the tender documents. It shall also include the latest editions, including all addenda/corrigenda or relevant Indian Standard Specifications and Bureau Of Indian Standards.
2.15 The "Sub-Contractor" means any person or firm or Company (other than the Contractor) to whom any part of the work has been entrusted by the Contractor with the prior written consent of the Owner/Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in- Charge and their legal heirs, representatives, successors and permitted assignees of such person, firm or Company.
2.16 The "Temporary Work" means and includes all such works which are a part of the contract for execution of the permanent work but does not form part of the permanent work confirming to practices, procedures applicable rules and regulations relevant in that behalf.
2.17 The "Tender" means the document submitted by a person or authority for carrying out the work and the Tenderer means a person or authority who submits the tender offering to carry out the work as per the terms and conditions.
2.18 The "Work" shall mean the works to be executed in accordance with the Contract or part thereof as the case may be and shall include extra, additional, altered or substituted works as maybe required for the purposes of completion of the work contemplated under the Contract.
3. SUBMISSION OF TENDER
3.1 Before submitting the Tender, the Tenderer shall at their own cost and
expenses visit the site, examine and satisfy as to the nature of the existing roads, means of communications, the character of the soil, state of land and of the excavations, the correct dimensions of the work facilities for procuring various construction and other material and their availability, and shall obtain information on all matters and conditions as they may feel necessary for the execution of the works as intended by the Owners and shall also satisfy of the availability of suitable water for construction of civil works and for drinking purpose and power required for fabrication work etc. Tenderer, whose tender may be accepted and with whom the Contract is entered into shall not be eligible and be able to make any claim on any of the said counts in what so ever manner for what so ever reasons at any point of time and such a claim shall not be raised as a dispute and shall not be arbitrable.
A pre-bid meeting may be held as per the schedule mentioned in the tender.
3.2 The Tenderer shall be deemed to have satisfied fully before tendering as to the
correctness and sufficiency of his tender for the works and of the rates and prices quoted in the schedule of quantities which rates and prices shall except as otherwise provided cover all his obligations under the contract.
3.3 It must be clearly understood that the whole of the conditions and specifications are intended to be strictly enforced and that no work will be considered as extra work and allowed and paid for unless they are clearly outside the scope, spirit, meaning of the Contract and intent of the Owner and have been so ordered in writing by Owner and/or Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge, whose decision shall be final and binding.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 53 of 170
3.4 Before filling the Tender the Contractor will check and satisfy all drawings and
materials to be procured and the schedule of quantities by obtaining clarification from the Owner on all the items as may be desired by the Tenderer. No claim for any alleged loss or compensation will be entertained on this account, after submission of Tender by the Tenderer/Contractor and such a claim shall not be arbitrable.
3.5 Unless specifically provided for in the tender documents or any Special
Conditions, no escalation in the Tender rates or prices quoted will be permitted throughout the period of contract or the period of actual completion of the job whichever is later on account of any variation in prices of materials or cost of labour or due to any other reasons. Claims on account of escalation shall not be arbitrable.
3.6 The quantities indicated in the Tender are approximate. The approved schedule of
rates of the contract will be applicable for variations upto plus or minus 25% of the contract value. No revision of schedule of rates wil l be permitted for such variations in the contract value, including variations of individual quantities, addition of new items, alterations, additions/deletions or substitutions of items, as mentioned above. Quantities etc. mentioned and accepted in the joint measurement sheets shall alone be final and binding on the parties.
3.7 Owner reserve their right to award the contract to any tenderer and their decision in this regard shall be final. They also reserve their right to reject any or all tenders received. No disputes could be raised by any tenderer(s) whose tender has been rejected.
3.8 The Rates quoted by the Tenderer shall include Costs and expenses on all counts viz. cost of materials, transportation of machine(s), tools, equipments, labour, power, Administration charges, price escalations, profits, etc. etc. except to the extent of the cost of material(s), if any, agreed to be supplied by Owner and mentioned specifically in that regard in condition of Contract, in which case, the cost of such material if taken for preparation of the Contractor's Bill(s) shall be deducted before making payment of the Bill(s) of the Contractor. The description given in the schedule of quantities shall unless otherwise stated be held to include wastage on materials, carriage and cartage, carrying in and return of empties, hoisting, setting, fitting and fixing in position and all other expenses necessary in and for the full and complete execution and completion of works and in accordance with good practice and recognised principles in that regard.
3.9 Employees of the State and Central Govt. and employees of the Public Sector Undertakings, including retired employees are covered under their respective service conditions/rules in regard to their submitting the tender. All such persons should ensure compliance to the respective/applicable conditions, rules etc. etc. Any person not complying with those rules etc. but submitting the tender in violation of such rules, after being so noticed shall be liable for the forfeiture of the Earnest Money Deposit made with the tender, termination of Contract and sufferance on account of forfeiture of Security Deposit and sufferance of damages arising as a result of termination of Contract.
3.10 In consideration for having a chance to be considered for entering into a
contract with the Owner, the Tenderer agrees that the Tender submitted by him shall remain valid for the period prescribed in the tender conditions, from the date of opening of the tender. The Tenderer shall not be entitled during the
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 54 of 170
said validity period, to revoke or cancel the tender without the consent in writing from the Owner.
In case the tenderer revokes or cancels the tender or varies any of terms of the tender without the Consent of the Owner, in writing, the Tenderer forfeits the right to the refund of the Earnest Money paid along with the tender.
3.11 The prices quoted by the Tenderer shall be firm during the validity period of
the bid and Tenderer agrees to keep the bid alive and valid during the said period. The Tenderers shall particularly take note of this factor before submitting their tender(s).
3.12 The works shall be carried out strictly as per approved specifications. Deviations, if
any, shall have to be authorised by the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge in writing prior to implementing deviations. The price benefit, if any, arising out of the accepted deviation shall be passed on to the Owner. The decision of Engineer- in-Charge shall be final in this matter.
3.13 The contractor shall make all arrangements at his own cost to transport the
required materials outside and inside the working places and leaving the premises in a neat and tidy condition after completion of the job to the satisfaction of Owner. All materials except those agreed to be supplied by the Owner shall be supplied by the contractor at his own cost and the rates quoted by the Contractor should be inclusive of all royalties, rents, taxes, duties, octroi, statutory levies, if any, etc. etc.
3.14 The Contractor shall not carry on any work other than the work under this Contract
within the Owner’s premises without prior permission in writing from the Engineer- in-Charge/Site-in-charge.
3.15 The Contractor shall be bound to follow and ensure compliance to all the safety
and security regulations and other statutory rules applicable to the area. In the event of any damage or loss or sufference caused due to non-observance of such rules and regulations, the contractor shall be solely responsible for the same and shall keep the Owner indemnified against all such losses and claims arising from the same.
3.16 At any time after acceptance of tender, the Owner reserves the right to add,
amend or delete any work item, the bill of quantities at a later date or reduce the scope of work in the overall interest of the work by prior discussion and intimation to the Contractor. The decision of Owner, with reasons recorded therefor, shall be final and binding on both the Owner and the Contractor. The Contractor shall not have right to claim compensation or damage etc. in that regard. The Owner reserves the right to split the work under this contract between two or more contractors without assigning any reasons.
3.17 Contractor shall not be entitled to sublet, sub contract or assign, the work
under this Contract without the prior consent of the Owner obtained in writing.
3.18 All signatures in tender document shall be dated as well as all the pages of all sections of the tender documents shall be initialed at the lower position and signed, wherever required in the tender papers by the Tenderer or by a person holding Power of Attorney authorising him to sign on behalf of the tenderer before submission of tender.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 55 of 170
3.19 The tender should be quoted in English, both in figures as well as in words. The rates
and amounts tendered by the Tenderer in the Schedule of rates for each item and in such a way that insertion is not possible. The total tendered amount should also be indicated both in figures and words with the signature of tenderer.
If some discrepancies are found between the rates given in words and figures of the amount shown in the tender, the following procedure shall be applied :
(a) When there is a difference between the rates in figures and words, the rate
which corresponds to the amount worked out by the tenderer shall be taken as correct.
(b) When the rate quoted by the tenderer in figures and words tallies but the amount is incorrect, the rate quoted by the tenderer shall be taken as correct.
(c) When it is not possible to ascertain the correct rate in the manner prescribed above the rate as quoted in words shall be adopted.
3.20 All corrections and alterations in the entries of tender paper will be signed in full by the tenderer with date. No erasures or over writings are permissible.
3.21 Transfer o f tender document by one intending tenderer to the another one is not
permissible. The tenderer on whose name the tender has been sent only can quote.
3.22 The Tender submitted by a tenderer if found to be incomplete in any or all
manner is liable to be rejected. The decision of the Owner in this regard is final and binding.
4. DEPOSITS
a) EARNEST MONEY DEPOSIT (EMD)
The tenderer will be required to pay a sum as specified in the covering letter, as earnest money deposit along with the tender either thru a crossed demand draft or a non-revokable Bank Guarantee in favour of Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited, from any Scheduled Bank (other than a Co-Operative Bank) payable at Mumbai in favour of Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited, Mumbai in the proforma enclosed. The earnest money deposit will be refunded after finalisation of the contract.
Note: Public sector enterprises and small scale units registered with National Small Scale Industries are exempted from payment of Earnest Money Deposit. Small scale units registered with National Small Scale Industries should enclose a photocopy of their registration certificate with their quotation to make their quotation eligible for consideration. The Registration Certificate should remain valid during the period of the contract that may be entered into with such successful bidder. Such tenderers should ensure validity of the Registration Certificate for the purpose.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 56 of 170
b) SECURITY DEPOSIT:
The tenderer, with whom the contract is decided to be entered into and intimation is so given will have to make a security deposit of one percent (1%) of the total contract value in the form of account payee crossed demand draft drawn in favour of the Owner, within 15 days from the date of intimation of acceptance of their tender, failing which the Owner reserves the right to cancel the Contract and forfeit the EMD.
1% of PO/Contract value as Security deposit will be acceptable in the form of Demand
draft upto ` 50,000/- and in the form of Demand draft / Bank guarantee beyond ` 50,000/-.
®
Composite Performance Bank Guarantee (CPBG) valid upto a period of 3 months beyond the expiry of defect liability period. Demand Draft should be
drawn on Scheduled Banks, other than co-operative bank. Quantum of Performance Bank Guarantee inclusive of Security Deposit should be
as follows: - All items (other than CVR items) : 10% of PO value
- For CVR items: ₹ 10.0 lakhs or 5% of the order value whichever is lower. Composite PBG of above value towards Performance Bank Guarantee inclusive of Security Deposit shall be accepted (in lieu of deduction of retention money of 10% from each bill); Such composite PBG shall be valid upto a period of 3 months beyond the expiry of defect liability period. Demand Draft should be drawn on Scheduled Banks (other than cooperative banks).
5. EXECUTION OF WORK
All the works shall be executed in strict conformity with the provisions of the contract documents and with such explanatory details, drawings, specifications and instructions as may be furnished from time to time to the Contractor by the Engineer-in-Charge/ Site- in-Charge, whether mentioned in the Contract or not. The Contractor shall be responsible for ensuring that works throughout are executed in the most proper and workman- like
manner with the quality of material and workmanship in strict accordance with the
specifications and to the entire satisfaction of the Engineer-in- Charge/Site-in-Charge.
The completion of work may entail working in monsoon also. The contractor must maintain the necessary work force as may be required during monsoon and plan to execute the job in such a way the entire project is completed within the contracted time schedule. No extra charges shall be payable for such work during monsoon. It shall be the responsibility of the contractor to keep the construction work site free from water during and off the monsoon period at his own cost and expenses.
For working on Sundays/Holidays, the contractor shall obtain the necessary permission from Engineer Incharge/Site Incharge in advance. The contractor shall be permitted to work beyond the normal hours with prior approval of Engineer-In-Charge/Site-In-Charge and the contractors quoted rate is inclusive of all such extended hours of working and no extra amount shall be payable by the owner on this account.
5.a. SETTING OUT OF WORKS AND SITE INSTRUCTIONS
5.a.1. The Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge shall furnish the Contractor with only the four corners of the work site and a level bench mark and the Contractor shall set out the works and shall provide an efficient staff for the purpose and shall be solely responsible for the accuracy of such setting out.
® REVISION: PROC-003/18.08.2014
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 57 of 170
5.a.2. The Contractor shall provide, fix and be responsible for the maintenance of all necessary stakes, templates, level marks, profiles and other similar things and shall take all necessary precautions to prevent their removal or disturbance and shall be responsible for consequences of such removal or disturbance should the same take place and for their efficient and timely reinstatement. The Contractor shall also be responsible for the maintenance of all existing survey marks, either existing or supplied and fixed by the Contractor. The work shall be set out to the satisfaction of the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge. The approval thereof or joining in setting out the work shall not relieve the Contractor of his responsibility.
5.a.3. Before beginning the works, the Contractor shall, at his own cost, provide all necessary reference and level posts, pegs, bamboos, flags ranging rods, strings and other materials for proper layout of the work in accordance with the scheme, for bearing marks acceptable to the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in- Charge. The Centre longitudinal or face lines and cross lines shall be marked by means of small masonary pillars. Each pillar shall have distinct marks at the centre to enable theodolite to be set over it. No work shall be started until all these points are checked and approved by the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in- Charge in writing. But such approval shall not relieve the contractor of any of his responsibilities. The Contractor shall also provide all labour, materials and other facilities, as necessary, for the proper checking of layout and inspection of the points during construction.
5.a.4. Pillars bearing geodetic marks located at the sites of units of works under construction should be protected and fenced by the Contractor.
5.a.5. On completion of works, the contractor shall submit the geodetic documents according to which the work was carried out.
5.a.6. The Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge shall communicate or confirm his instructions to the contractor in respect of the executions of work in a "work site order book" maintained in the office having duplicate sheet and the authorised representative of the contractor shall confirm receipt of such instructions by signing the relevant entries in the book.
5.a.7. All instructions issued by the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge shall be in writing. The Contractor shall be liable to carry out the instructions without fail.
5.a.8. If the Contractor after receipt of written instruction from the Engineer-in-Charge/ Site-in-Charge requiring compliance within seven days fails to comply with such drawings or 'instructions' or both as the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge may issue, owner may employ and pay other persons to execute any such work whatsoever that may be necessary to give effect to such drawings or `instructions' and all cost and expenses incurred in connection therewith as certified by the Engineer-in-Charge/ Site-in-Charge shall be borne by the contractor or may be deducted from amounts due or that may become due to the contractor under the contract or may be recovered as a debt.
5.a.9. The Contractor shall be entirely and exclusively responsible for the horizontal and vertical alignment, the levels and correctness of every part of the work and shall rectify effectually any errors or imperfections therein. Such rectifications shall be carried out by the Contractor, at his own cost.
5.a.10. In case any doubts arise in the mind of the Contractor in regard to any expressions, interpretations, statements, calculations of quantities, supply of material rates, etc. etc., the contractor shall refer the same to the Site-in-Charge/ Engineer-in-Charge for his clarification, instructions, guidance or clearing of
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 58 of 170
doubts. The decision of the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge shall be final and the contractor shall be bound by such a decision.
5.a.11."The Contractor shall take adequate precautions, to ensure that his operations
do not create nuisance or misuse of the work space that shall cause unnecessary disturbance or inconvenience to others at the work site".
5.a.12. "All fossils, coins articles of value of antiquity and structure or other remains
of geological or archaeological discovered on the site of works shall be declared to be the property of the Owner and Contractor shall take reasonable precautions to prevent his workmen or any other persons from removing or damaging any such articles or thing and shall immediately inform the Owner/ Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge."
5.a.13. "Contractor will be entirely and exclusively responsible to provide and
maintain at his expenses all lights, guards, fencing, etc. when and where even necessary or/as required by the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge for the protection of works or safety and convenience to all the members employed at the site or general public."
5.b. COMMENCEMENT OF WORK
The contractor shall after paying the requisite security deposit, commence work within 15 days from the date of receipt of the intimation of intent from the Owner informing that the contract is being awarded. The date of intimation shall be the date/day for counting the starting day/date and the ending day/date will be accordingly calculated. Penalty, if any, for the delay in execution shall be calculated accordingly.
Contractor should prepare detailed fortnightly construction programme for approval by the Engineer-in-Charge within one month of receipt of Letter Of Intent. The work shall be executed strictly as per such time schedule. The period of Contract includes the time required for testing, rectifications, if any, re-testing and completion of work in all respects to the entire satisfaction of the Engineer-in-Charge.
A Letter of Intent is an acceptance of offer by the Owner and it need not be accepted by the contractor. But the contractor should acknowledge a receipt of the purchase order within 15 days of mailing of Purchase Order and any delay in acknowledging the receipt will be a breach of contract and compensation for the loss caused by such breach will be recovered by the Owner by forfeiting earnest money deposit/bid bond.
5.c. SUBLETTING OF WORK
5.c.1. No part of the contract nor any share or interest thereof shall in any manner or
degree be transferred, assigned or sublet, by the Contractor, directly or indirectly to any firm or corporation whatsoever, without the prior consent in writing of the Owner.
5.c.2. At the commencement of every month the Contractor shall furnish to the Engineer-
in-charge/Site-in-Charge list of all sub-contractors or other persons or firms engaged by the Contractor.
5.c.3 The contract agreement will specify major items of supply or services for which the
Contractor proposes to engage sub-Contractor/sub-Vendor. The contractor may
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 59 of 170
from time to time propose any addition or deletion from any such list and will submit the proposals in this regard to the Engineer-in-charge/Designated officer-in- charge for approval well in advance so as not to impede the progress of work. Such approval of the Engineer-in-charge/Designated officer-in-charge will not relieve the contractor from any of his obligations, duties and responsibilities under the contract.
5.c.4. Notwithstanding any sub-letting with such approval as resaid and notwithstanding
that the Engineer-in-Charge shall have received copies of any sub-contract, the Contractor shall be and shall remain solely to be responsible for the quality and proper and expeditious execution of the works and the performance of all the conditions of the contract in all respects as if such subletting or sub-contracting had not taken place and as if such work had been done directly by the Contractor.
5.c.5 Prior approval in writing of the Owner shall be obtained before any change is made
in the constitution of the contractor/Contracting agency otherwise contract shall be deemed to have been allotted in contravention of clause entitled “sub-letting of works” and the same action may be taken and the same consequence shall ensue as provided in the clause of “sub- letting of works”.
5.d EXTENSION OF TIME
1) If the Contractor anticipates that he will not be able to complete the work
within the contractual delivery/ completion date (CDD), then the Contractor shall make a request for grant of time extension clearly specifying the reasons for which he seeks extension of time and demonstrating as to how these reasons were beyond the control of the contractor or attributable to the Owner. This request should be made well before the expiry of the Contractual Delivery/ Completion Date (CDD).
2) If such a request for extension is received with a Bank Guarantee for the full
Price Reduction amount calculated on the Total Contract Value, the concerned General Manager of the Owner shall grant a Provisional extension of time, pending a decision on the request.
3) The concerned General Manager of the Owner shall expeditiously decide upon
the request for time extension and decide the levy of price reduction within a maximum period of 6 months fom the CDD or date of receipt of the request, whichever is earlier.
4) Grant of any extension of time shall be by means of issuance of a Change
Order.
5) In order to avoid any cash crunch to the Contractor, a Bank Guarantee could be accepted against Price Reduction, as stated above. Once a decision is taken, the Price Reduction shall be recovered from any pending bills or by encashment of the BG. Any balance sum of Contractor or the BG (if Price Reduction is fully recovered from the bills) shall be promptly refunded/returned to the Contractor.
5.e. SUSPENSION OF WORKS
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 60 of 170
5.e.1. Subject to the provisions of this contract, the contractor shall if ordered in writing by the Engineer- in-Charge/Site-in-Charge for reasons recorded suspend the works or any part thereof for such period and such time so ordered and shall not, after receiving such, proceed with the work therein ordered to suspended until he shall have received a written order to re-start. The Contractor shall be entitled to claim extension of time for that period of time the work was ordered to be suspended. Neither the Owner nor the Contractor shall be entitled to claim compensation or damages on account of such an extension of time.
5.e.2. In case of suspension of entire work, ordered in writing by Engineer-in-
Charge/Site-in-Charge, for a period of 30 days, the Owner shall have the option to terminate the Contract as provided under the clause fortermination. The Contractor shall not be at liberty to remove from the site of the works any plant or materials belonging to him and the Employer shall have lien upon all such plant and materials.
5.e.3. The contractor shall, in case of suspension have the right to raise a dispute
and have the same arbitrated but however, shall not have the right to have the work stopped from further progress and completion either by the owner or through other contractor appointed by the owner.
5.f. OWNER MAY DO PART OF WORK
Not withstanding anything contained elsewhere in this contract, the owner upon failure of the Contractor to comply with any instructions given in accordance with the provisions of this contract, may instead of Contract and undertaking charge of entire work, place additional labour force, tools, equipment and materials on such parts of the work, as the Owner may decide or engage another Contractor to carryout the balance of work. In such cases, the Owner shall have the right to deduct from the amounts payable to the Contractor the difference in cost of such work and materials with ten percent overhead added to cover all departmental charges. Should the total amount thereof exceed the amount due to the contractor, the Contractor shall pay the difference to the Owner within 15 days of making demand for payment failing which the Contractor shall be liable to pay interest at 24% p.a. on such amounts till the date of payment.
5.g. INSPECTION OF WORKS
5.g.1. The Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge and Officers from Central or State
Government will have full power and authority to inspect the works at any time wherever in progress, either on the site or at the Contractor's premises/workshops of any person, firm or corporation where work in connection with the contract may be in hand or where the materials are being or are to be supplied, and the Contractor shall afford or procure for the Engineer-in- Charge/Site-in-Charge every facility and assistance to carryout such inspection. The Contractor shall, at all times during the usual working hours and at all other times at which reasonable notice of the intention of the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in- Charge or his representative to visit the works shall have been given to the Contractor, either himself be present to receive orders and instructions, or have a responsible agent, duly accredited in writing, present for the purpose. Orders given to the Contractor's agent shall be considered to have the same force as if they had been given to the Contractor himself. The Contractor shall give not less than seven days notice in writing to the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge before covering up or otherwise placing beyond reach of inspection and
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 61 of 170
measurement any work in order that the same may be inspected and measured. In the event of breach of above, the same shall be uncovered at Contractor's expense for carrying out such measurement and/or inspection.
5.g.2. No material shall be removed and despatched by the Contractor from the site
without the prior approval in writing of the Engineer-in-charge. The contractor is to provide at all times during the progress of the work and the maintenance period proper means of access with ladders, gangways, etc. and the necessary attendance to move and adapt as directed for inspection or measurements of the works by the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge.
5.h. SAMPLES
5.h.1. The contractor shall furnish to the Engineer-in-charge/Site-in-Charge for
approval when requested or required adequate samples of all materials and finishes to be used in the work.
5.h.2. Samples shall be furnished by the Contractor sufficiently in advance and before commencement of the work so as the Owner can carry out tests and examinations thereof and approve or reject the samples for use in the works. All material samples furnished and finally used/applied in actual work shall fully be of the same quality of the approved samples.
5.i. TESTS FOR QUALITY OF WORK
5.i.1. All workmanship shall be of the respective kinds described in the contract
documents and in accordance with the instructions of the Engineer-in-Charge / Site-in- Charge and shall be subjected from time to time to such tests at Contractor's cost as the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge may direct at the place of manufacture or fabrication or on the site or at all or any such places. The Contractor shall provide assistance, instruments, labour and materials as are normally required for examining, measuring and testing any workmanship as may be selected and required by the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge.
5.i.2. All the tests that will be necessary in connection with the execution of the work as decided by the Engineer-in- charge/Site-in-Charge shall be carried out at the contractors cost and expenses.
5.i.3. If any tests are required to be carried out in connection with the work or materials or workmanship to be supplied by the owner, such tests shall be carried out by the Contractor as per instructions of Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge and expenses for such tests, if any, incurred by the contractor shall be reimbursed by the Owner. The contractor should file his claim with the owner within 15 (fifteen) days of inspection/test and any claim made beyond that period shall lapse and be not payable.
5.j. ALTERATIONS AND ADDITIONS TO SPECIFICATIONS, DESIGNS AND WORKS
5.j.1. The Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge shall have powers to make any alterations,
additions and/or substitutions to the schedule of quantities, the original
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 62 of 170
specifications, drawings, designs and instructions that may become necessary or advisable or during the progress of the work and the Contractor shall be bound to carryout such altered/extra/new items of work in accordance with instructions which may be given to him in writing signed by the Engineer-in- Charge/Site- in-Charge. Such alterations, omissions, additions or substitutions shall not invalidate the contract. The altered, additional or substituted work which the Contractor may be directed to carryon in the manner as part of the work shall be carried out by the Contractor on the same conditions in all respects on which he has agreed to do the work. The time for completion of such altered added and/or substituted work may be extended for that part of the particular job. The rates for such additional altered or substituted work under this Clause shall, be worked out in accordance with the following provisions:
5.j.2. If the rates for the additional, altered or substituted work are specified in the contract for similar class of work, the Contractor is bound to carryout the additional, altered or substituted work at the same rates as are specified in the contract.
5.j.3. If the rates for the additional, altered or substituted work are not specifically provided in the contract for the work, the rates will be derived from the rates for similar class of work as are specified in the contract for the work. In the opinion of the Engineer-in- Charge/Site-in-Charge as to whether or not the rates can be reasonably so derived from the items in this contract, will be final and binding on the Contractor.
5.j.4. If the rates for the altered, additional or substituted work cannot be determined in the manner specified above, then the Contractor shall, within seven days of the date of receipt of order to carry out the work, inform the Engineer-in-Charge/ Site-in-Charge of the rate at which he intends to charge for such class of work, supported by analysis of the rate or rates claimed and the Engineer-In-Charge/ Site-in-Charge shall determine the rates on the basis of the prevailing market rates for both material and labour plus 10% to cover overhead and profit of labour rates and pay the Contractor accordingly. The opinion of the Engineer-in- Charge/Site-in-Charge as to current market rates of materials and the quantum of labour involved per unit of measurement will be final and binding on the contractor.
5.j.5. In case of any item of work for which there is no specification supplied by the Owner and is mentioned in the tender documents, such work shall be carried out in accordance with Indian Standard Specifications and if the Indian Standard Specifications do not cover the same, the work should be carried out as per standard Engineering Practice subject to the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge/ Site-in-Charge.
5.k. PROVISIONAL ACCEPTANCE
Acceptance of sections of the works for purposes of equipment erection, piping, electrical work and similar usages by the Owner and payment for such work or parts of work shall not constitute a waiver of any portion of this contract and shall not be construed so as to prevent the Engineer from requiring replacement of defective work that may become apparent after the said acceptance and also shall not absolve the Contractor of the obligations under this contract. It is made clear that such an acceptance does not indicate or denote or establish to the fact of execution of that work or the Contract until the work is completed in full in accordance with the provisions of this Contract.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 63 of 170
5.l. COMPLETION OF WORK AND COMPLETION CERTIFICATE
As soon as the work is completed in all respects, the contractor shall give notice of such completion to the site in charge or the Owner and within thirty days of receipt of such notice the site in charge shall inspect the work and shall furnish the contractor with a certificate of completion indicating:
a) defects, if any, to be rectified by the contractor
b) items, if any, for which payment shall be made in reduced rates
c) the date of completion.
5.m. USE OF MATERIALS AND RETURN OF SURPLUS MATERIALS
5.m.1. Notwithstanding anything contained to the contrary in any or all of the clauses of
this contract, where any materials for the execution of the contract are procured with the assistance of Government either by issue from Government stocks or procurement made under orders or permits or licences issued by Government, the contractor shall use the said materials economically and solely for the purpose of the contract and shall not dispose them of without the permission of the Owner.
5.m.2. All surplus(serviceable) or unserviceable materials that may be left over after
the completion of the contract or at its termination for any reason whatsoever, the Contractor shall deliver the said product to the Owner without any demur. The price to be paid to the Contractor, if not already paid either in full or in part, however, shall not exceed the amount mentioned in the Schedule of Rates for such material and in cases where such rates are not so mentioned, shall not exceed the CPWD scheduled rates. In the event of breach of the aforesaid condition the contractor shall become liable for contravention of the terms of the Contract.
5.m.3. The surplus (serviceable) and unserviceable products shall be determined by joint
measurement. In case where joint measurement has failed to take place, the Owner may measure the same and determine the quantity.
5.m.4. It is made clear that the Owner shall not be liable to take stock and keep
possession and pay for the surplus and unserviceable stocks and the Owner may direct the Contractor to take back such material brought by the Contractor and becoming surplus and which the Owner may decide to keep and not to pay for the same.
5.n. DEFECT LIABILITY PERIOD
The contractor shall guarantee the work executed for a period of 12 months from the date of completion of the job. Any damage or defect that may arise or lie undiscovered at the time of completion of the job shall be rectified or replaced by the contractor at his own cost. The decision of the Engineer In-charge/Site-Incharge/Owner shall be the final in deciding whether the defect has to be rectified or replaced.
Equipment or spare parts replaced under warranty/guarantees shall have further warranty for a mutually agreed period from the date of acceptance.
The owner shall intimate the defects noticed in writing by a Registered A.D. letter or otherwise and the contractor within 15 days of receipt of the intimation shall start the
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 64 of 170
rectification work and complete within the time specified by the owner failing which the owner will get the defects rectified by themselves or by any other contractor and the expenses incurred in getting the same done shall be paid by the Contractor under the provision of the Contract.
Thus, defect liability is applicable only in case of job/works contract (civil, mechanical, electrical, maintenance etc. ) where any damage of defect may arise in future (i.e. within 12 months from the date of completion of job) or lie undiscovered at the time of completion of job.
In other words, in case of service contracts (like car hire etc.) where there is no question of damage or defect arising in future, the defect liability clause is not applicable.
5.o. DAMAGE TO PROPERTY
5.o.1. Contractor shall be responsible for making good to the satisfaction of the Owner
any loss of and any damage to all structures and properties belonging to the Owner or being executed or procured by the Owner or of other agencies within the premises of the work of the Owner, if such loss or damage is due to fault and/or the negligence or willful acts or omission of the Contractor, his employees, agents, representatives or sub-contractors.
5.o.2. The Contractors shall indemnify and keep the Owner harmless of all claims for
damage to Owner's property arising under or by reason of this contract.
6. DUTIES AND RESPONSIBILITIES OF CONTRACTOR
6.a. EMPLOYMENT LIABILITY TOWARDS WORKERS EMPLOYED BY THE
CONTRACTOR
6.a.1 The Contractor shall be solely and exclusively responsible for engaging or
employing persons for the execution of work. All persons engaged by the contractor shall be on Contractor's payroll and paid by Contractor. All disputes or differences between the Contractor and his/their employees shall be settled by Contractor.
6.a.2. Owner has absolutely no liability whatsoever concerning the employees of the Contractor. The Contractor shall indemnify Owner against any loss or damage or liability arising out of or in the course of his/their employing persons or relation with his/their employees. The Contractor shall make regular and full payment of wages and on any complaint by any employee of the Contractor or his sub contractor regarding non-payment of wages, salaries or other dues, Owner reserves the right to make payments directly to such employees or sub- contractor of the Contractor and recover the amount in full from the bills of the Contractor and the contractor shall not claim any compensation or reimbursement thereof. The Contractor shall comply with the Minimum Wages Act applicable to the area of work site with regard to payment of wages to his employees and also to employees of his sub contractor.
6.a.3. The Contractor shall advise in writing or in such appropriate way to all of his employees and employees of sub-contractors and any other person engaged by him that their appointment/employment is not by the Owner but by the Contractor and that their present appointment is only in connection with the construction contract with Owner and that therefore, such an
employment/appointment would not enable or make them eligible for any
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 65 of 170
employment/appointment with the Owner either temporarily or/and permanent basis.
6.b. NOTICE TO LOCAL BODIES
The contractor shall comply with and give all notices required under any Government authority, instruction, rule or order made under any act of parliament, state laws or any regulations or by-laws of any local authority relating to the works.
6.c. FIRST AID AND INDUSTRIAL INJURIES
6.c.1 Contractor shall maintain first aid facility for his employees and those of his
sub-contractors. 6.c.2. Contractor shall make arrangements for ambulance service and for the
treatment of all types of injuries. Names and telephone numbers of those providing such services shall be furnished to Owner prior to start of construction and their name board shall be prominently displayed in Contractor's field office.
6.c.3. All industrial injuries shall be reported promptly to owner and a copy of contractor's report covering each personal injury requiring the attention of a physician shall be furnished to the Owner.
6.d. SAFETY CODE
6.d.1. The Contractor shall at his own expenses arrange for the Safety provisions
as may be necessary for the execution of the work or as required by the Engineer-in-Charge in respect of all labours directly or indirectly employed for performance of the works and shall provide all facilities in connections therewith. In case the contractor fails to make arrangements and provide necessary facilities as aforesaid, the Owner shall be entitled to do so and recover the cost thereof from the Contractor.
6.d.2. From the commencement to the completion of the works, the contractor shall take full responsibility for the care thereof and of all the temporary works (defined as meaning all temporary works of every kind required in or for the execution, completion or maintenance of the works). In case damage, loss or injury shall happen to the works or to any part thereof or to temporary works or to any cause whatsoever repair at his (Contractor's) own cost and make good the same so that at the time of completion, the works shall be in good order and condition and in conformity in every respect with the requirement of the contract and Engineer-in-Charge's instructions.
6.d.3. In respect of all labour, directly or indirectly employed in the work for the performance of the Contractor's part of this agreement, the contractor shall at his own expense arrange for all the safety provisions as per relevant Safety Codes of C.P.W.D Bureau of Indian Standards, the Electricity Act/I.E. Rules. The Mines Act and such other Acts as applicable.
6.d.4. The Contractor shall observe and abide by all fire and safety regulations of the Owner. Before starting construction work, the Contractor shall consult with Owner's Safety Engineer or Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge and must make good to the satisfaction of the Owner any loss or damage due to fire to
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 66 of 170
any portion of the work done or to be done under this agreement or to any of the Owner's existing property.
6.d.5. The Contractor will be fully responsible for complying with all relevant provisions of the Contract Labour Act and shall pay rates of Wages and observe hours of work/conditions of employment according to the rules in force from time to time.
6.d.6. The Contractor will be fully responsible for complying with the provision including documentation and submission of reports on the above to the concerned authorities and shall indemnify the Corporation from any such lapse for which the Government will be taking action against them.
6.d.7. Owner shall on a report having been made by an inspecting Office as defined in the Contract Labour Regulations have the power to deduct from the money due to the Contractor any sum required or estimated to be required for making good the loss suffered by a worker(s) by reasons of non-fulfillment of conditions of contract for the benefit of workers no-payment of wages or of deductions made from his or their wages which are not justified by the terms of contract or non observance of the said contractor's labour Regulation.
6.e. INSURANCE AND LABOUR
Contractor shall at his own expense obtain and maintain an insurance policy with a Nationalised Insurance Company to the satisfaction of the Owner as provided hereunder.
6.e.1. EMPLOYEES STATE INSURANCE ACT
i. The Contractor agrees to and does hereby accept full and exclusive
liability for the compliance with all obligations imposed by Employees State Insurance Act, 1948, and the Contractor further agrees to defend indemnify and hold Owner harmless from any liability or penalty which may be imposed by the Central, State or local authority by reason of any asserted violation by Contractor, or sub-contractor of the Employees' State Insurance Act, 1948 and also from all claims, suits or proceedings that may be brought against the Owner arising under, growing out of or by reason of the work provided for by this contract whether brought by employees of the Contractor, by third parties or by Central or State Government authority or any political sub-division thereof.
ii. The Contractor agrees to file with the Employees State Insurance Corporation, the Declaration forms and all forms which may be required in respect of the Contractor's or sub-contractor's employee whose aggregate emuneration is within the specified limit and who are employed in the work provided or those covered by ESI Act under any amendment to the Act from time to time.
The Contractor shall deduct and secure the agreement of the sub- contractor to deduct the employee's contribution as per the first schedule of the Employee's State Insurance Act from wages and affix the employee's contribution cards at wages payment intervals. The Contractor shall remit and secure the agreement of the sub contractor to remit to the State Bank of India, Employee's State Insurance Corporation Account, the Employee's contribution as required by the Act.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 67 of 170
ii. The Contractor agrees to maintain all records as required under the Act in respect of employees and payments and the Contractor shall secure the agreement of the sub contractor to maintain such records. Any expenses incurred for the contributions, making contribution or maintaining records shall be to the Contractor's or sub-contractor's account.
iv. The Owner shall retain such sum as may be necessary from the total contract value until the Contractor shall furnish satisfactory proof that all contributions as required by the Employees State Insurance Act, 1948, have been paid.
v. WORKMAN'S COMPENSATION AND EMPLOYEE'S LIABILITY INSURANCE
Provide Insurance for all the Contractor's employees engaged in the performance of this contract. If any of the work is sublet, the Contractor shall ensure that the sub contractor provides workmen's compensation and Employer's Liability Insurance for the latter's employees who are not covered under the Contractor's insurance.
vi. AUTOMOBILE LIABILITY INSURANCE
Contractor shall take out an Insurance to cover all risks to Owner for each of his vehicles plying on works of this contract and these insurances shall be valid for the total contract period. No extra payment will be made for this insurance. Owner shall not be liable for any damage or loss not made good by the Insurance Company, should such damage or loss result from unauthorised use of the vehicle. The provisions of the Motor Vehicle Act would apply.
vii. FIRE INSURANCE
Contractor shall within two weeks after award of contract insure the Works, Plant and Equipment and keep them insured until the final completion of the Contract against loss or damage by accident, fire or any other cause with an insurance company to be approved by the Employer/Consultant in the joint names of the Employer and the Contractor (name of the former being placed first in the Policy). Such Policy shall cover the property of the Employer only.
6.e.2. ANY OTHER INSURANCE REQUIRED UNDER LAW OR REGULATION OR BY
OWNER
i. Contractor shall also provide and maintain any and all other insurance which
may be required under any law or regulations from time to time. He shall also carry and maintain any other insurance which may be required by the Owner.
ii. The aforesaid insurance policy/policies shall provide that they shall not be
cancelled till the Engineer-in-Charge has agreed to their cancellation.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 68 of 170
iii. The Contractor shall satisfy to the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge from time to time that he has taken out all insurance policies referred to above and has paid the necessary premium for keeping the policies alive till the expiry of the defects liability period.
iv. The contractor shall ensure that similar insurance policies are taken out
by his sub-contractor (if any) and shall be responsible for any claims or losses to the Owner resulting from their failure to obtain adequate insurance protections in connection thereof. The contractor shall produce or cause to be proceed by his sub-contractor (if any) as the case may be, the relevant policy or policies and premium receipts as and when required by the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge.
6.e.3. LABOUR AND LABOUR LAWS
i. The contractor shall at his own cost employ persons during the period of
contract and the persons so appointed shall not be construed under any circumstances to be in the employment of the Owner.
ii. All payments shall be made by the contractor to the labour employed by
him in accordance with the various rules and regulations stated above. The contractor shall keep the Owner indemnified from any claims whatsoever inclusive of damages/costs or otherwise arising from injuries or alleged injuries to or death of a person employed by the contractor or damages or alleged damages to the property.
iii. No labour below the age of eighteen years shall be employed on the
work. The Contractor shall not pay less than what is provided under the provisions of the contract labour (Regulations and Abolition) Act, 1970 and the rules made thereunder and as may be amended from time to time. He shall pay the required deposit under the Act appropriate to the number of workman to be employed by him or through sub contractor and get himself registered under the Act. He shall produce the required Certificates to the Owner before commencement of the work. The Owner recognises only the Contractor and not his sub contractor under the provisions of the Act. The Contractor will have to submit daily a list of his workforce. He will also keep the wage register at the work site or/and produce the same to the Owner, whenever desired. A deposit may be taken by the Owner from the Contractor to be refunded only after the Owner is satisfied that all workmen employed by the Contractor have been fully paid for the period of work in Owner's premises at rates equal to or better than wages provided for under the Minimum Wages Act. The contractor shall be responsible and liable for any complaints that may arise in this regard and the consequences thereto.
iv. The Contractor will comply with the provisions of the Employee's Provident
Fund Act and the Family Pension Act as may be applicable and as amended from time to time.
v. The Contractor will comply with the provisions of the payment of Gratuity
Act, 1972, as may be applicable and as amended from time to time.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 69 of 170
vi. IMPLEMENTATION OF APPRENTICES ACT, 1961
The Contractor shall comply with the provisions of the Apprentices Act, 1961 and the Rules and Orders issued thereunder from time to time. If he fails to do so, his failure will be a breach of the contract and the Engineer-in- Charge may, at his discretion, cancel the contract. The Contractor shall also be liable for any pecuniary liability arising on account of any violation by him of the provision of the Act.
vii. MODEL RULES FOR LABOUR WELFARE
The Contractor shall at his own expenses comply with or cause be complied with Model rules for Labour Welfare as appended to those conditions or rules framed by the Government from time to time for the protection of health and for making sanitary arrangements for worker employed directly or indirectly on the works. In case the contractor fails to make arrangements as aforesaid the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge shall be entitled to do so and recover the cost thereof from the contractor.
6.f. DOCUMENTS CONCERNING WORKS
6.f.1. All documents including drawings, blue prints, tracings, reproducible models,
plans, specifications and copies, thereof furnished by the Owner as well as all drawings, tracings, reproducibles, plans, specifications design calculations etc. prepared by the contractor for the purpose of execution of works covered in or connected with this contract shall be the property of the Owner and shall not be used by the contractor for any other work but are to be delivered to the Owner at the completion or otherwise of the contract.
6.f.2. The Contractor shall keep and maintain secrecy of the documents, drawings
etc. issued to him for the execution of this contract and restrict access to such documents, drawings etc. and further the Contractor shall execute a SECRECY agreement from each or any person employed by the Contractor having access to such documents, drawings etc. The Contractor shall not issue drawings and documents to any other agency or individual without the written approval by the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in- Charge.
6.f.3. Contractor will not give any information or document etc. concerning details of
the work to the press or a news disseminating agency without prior written approval from Engineer-in-charge/Site-in-Charge. Contractor shall not take any pictures on site without written approval of Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in- Charge.
7. PAYMENT OF CONTRACTOR'S BILLS
7.1. Payments will be made against Running Accounts bills certified by the Owner's
Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge within 15 days from the date of receipt of the bill..
7.2. Running Account Bills and the final bill shall be submitted by the Contractor together
with the duly signed measurements sheet(s) to the Engineer-in-Charge/ Site-in- Charge of the Owner in quadruplicate for certification.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 70 of 170
The Bills shall also be accompanied by quantity calculations in support of the quantities contained in the bill along with cement consumption statement, actual/theoretical, wherever applicable duly certified by the Engineer-in-Charge/ Site-in- Charge of the Owner.
7.3. All running account payments shall be regarded as on account payment(s) to be finally
adjusted against the final bill payment. Payment of Running Account Bill(s) shall not determine or affect in any way the rights of the Owner under this Contract to make the final adjustments of the quantities of material, measurements of work and adjustments of amounts etc.etc. in the final bill.
7.4. The final bill shall be submitted by the Contractor within one month of the date of
completion of the work fully and completely in all respects. If the Contractor fails to submit the final bill accordingly Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge may make the measurement and determine the total amount payable for the work carried out by the Contractor and such a certification shall be final and binding on the Contractor. The Owner/Engineer- in-Charge/Site-in-Charge may take the assistance of an outside party for taking the measurement, the expenses of which shall be payable by the Contractor.
7.5. Payment of final bill shall be made within 30 days from the date of receipt of the certified
bill by the Disbursement Section of the owner.
7.6 Wherever possible, payment shall be tendered to the contractor in electronic mode (e-payment) through any of the designated banks. The contractor will comply by furnishing full particulars of Bank acount (mandate) to which the payments will be routed. Owner reserves the right to make payment in any alternate mode also.
7.a. MEASUREMENT OF WORKS
7.a.1. All measurements shall be in metric system. All the works will be jointly measured by the representative of the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge and the Contractor or their authorised agent progressively. Such measurement will be recorded in the Measurement Book/Measurement Sheet by the Contractor or his authorised representative and signed in token of acceptance by the Owner or their authorised representative.
7.a.2. For the purpose of taking joint measurement, the Contractor/representative shall be bound to be present whenever required by the Engineer-in-Charge/Site- in-Charge.
If, however, they are absent for any reasons whatsoever, the measurement will be taken by the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge or his representative and the same would be deemed to be correct and binding on the Contractor.
7.a.3. In case of any dispute as to the mode of measurement for any item of work, the latest Indian Standard Specifications shall be followed. In case of any further dispute on the same the same shall be as per the certification of an outside qualified Engineer/ Consultant. Such a measurement shall be final and binding on the Owner and the Contractor.
7.b. BILLING OF WORKS EXECUTED
The Contractor will submit a bill in approved proforma in quadruplicate to the Engineer- in-Charge/Site-in-Charge of the work giving abstract and detailed measurement for the various items executed during a month, before the expiry of the first week of the
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 71 of 170
succeeding month. The Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge shall take or cause to be taken the requisite measurements for the purpose of having the bill verified and/or checked before forwarding the same to the disbursement office of the Owner for further action in terms of the Contract and payment thereafter. The Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in- Charge shall verify the bills within 7 days of submission of the Bill by the Contractor.
7.c. RETENTION MONEY
10% of the total value of the Running Account and Final Bill will be deducted and retained by the Owner as retention money on account of any damage/defect liability that may arise for the period covered under the defect liability period clause of the Contract free of interest. Any damage or defect that may arise or lie undiscovered at the time of issue of completion certificate connected in any way with the equipment or materials supplied by contractor or in workmanship shall be rectified or replaced by the contractor at his own expense failing which the Owner shall be entitled to rectify the said damage/defect from the retention money. Any excess of expenditure incurred by the Owner on account of damage or defect shall be payable by the Contractor. The decision of the Owner in this behalf shall not be liable to be questioned but shall be final and binding on the Contractor.
Thus, deduction towards retention money is applicable only in case of job/works contracts (civil, mechanical, electrical, maintenance etc.) where any damage or defect may arise in future (i.e. within 12 months from the date of completion of job) or lie undiscovered at the time of issue of completion certificate.
7.d. STATUTORY LEVIES
7.d.1 The Contractor accepts full and exclusive liability for the payment of any and all
taxes, duties, octroi, rates, cess, levies and statutory payments payable under all or any of the statutes etc.
Variations of taxes and duties arising out of the amendments to the Central / State enactments, in respect of sale of goods / services covered under this bid shall be to HPCL’s account, so long as :
• They relate to the period after the opening of the price bid, but before the
contracted completion period ( excluding permitted extensions due to delay on account of the contractors, if any) or the actual completion period, whichever is earlier; and
• The vendor furnishes documentary evidence of incurrence of such variations, in addition to the invoices/documents for claiming Cenvat /Input Tax credit, wherever applicable.
All contributions and taxes for unemployment compensation, insurance and old age pensions or annuities now or hereafter imposed by Central or State Governmental authorities which are imposed with respect to or covered by the wages, salaries or other compensations paid to the persons employed by the Contractor and the Contractor shall be responsible for the compliance with all obligations and restrictions imposed by the Labour Law or any other law affecting employer-employee relationship and the Contractor further agrees to comply and to secure the compliance of all sub-contractors with all applicable Central,
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 72 of 170
State, Municipal and local laws, and regulations and requirements of any
Central, State or Local Government agency or authority.
Contractor further agrees to defend, indemnify and hold harmless from any liability or penalty which may be imposed by the Central, State or Local authorities by reason of any violation by Contractor or sub-contractor of such laws, regulations or requirements and also from all claims, suits or proceedings that may be brought against the Owner arising under, growing out of, or by reasons of the work provided for by this contract by third parties, or by Central or State Government authority or any administrative sub-division thereof. The Contractor further agrees that in case any such demand is raised against the Owner, and Owner has no way but to pay and pays/makes payment of the same, the Owner shall have the right to deduct the same from the amounts due and payable to the Contractor. The Contractor shall not raise any demand or dispute in respect of the same but may have recourse to recover/receive from the concerned authorities on the basis of the Certificate of the Owner issued in that behalf.
7.d.2. The rates quoted should be inclusive of all rates, cess, taxes and sales tax on
works contracts wherever applicable. However, wherever the sales tax on works contract is applicable and is to be deducted at source, the same will be deducted from the bills of the Contractor and paid to the concerned authorities. The proof of such payments of sales tax on works contract will be furnished to the contractor.
7.d.3. Income tax will be deducted at source as per rules at prevailing rates, unless
certificate, if any, for deduction at lesser rate or nil deduction is submitted by the Contractor from appropriate authority.
7.d.4 The contractor shall provide accurate particulars of PAN number as required, under
Section 206AA of Income Tax Act 1961.
7.d.5 The contractors having their ‘tax residency status’ outside India shall provide Tax Residency Certificate (TRC), issued by Government of the Country or the specified territory where the Contractor is a Resident. Rule 21AB of the Income Tax Rules, 1962 has prescribed the contents of a TRC. This would enable the Corporation to deduct tax at source by duly considering the ‘treaty relief’, if any, under Double Taxation Avoidance Agreement (DTAA) entered into between GOI and the respective country/specified territory in which the Contractors’ ‘tax residency status’ is currently in force.
7.e. MATERIALS TO BE SUPPLIED BY CONTRACTOR
7.e.1. The Contractor shall procure and provide the whole of the materials required for construction including Spares, Tools, Tackles, construction plant and equipment for the completion and maintenance of the works except the materials viz. steel and cement which may be agreed to be supplied as provided elsewhere in the contract. The contractor shall make arrangement for procuring such materials and for the transport thereof at their own cost and expenses.
7.e.2. The Owner may give necessary recommendation to the respective authority if so desired by the Contractor but assumes no responsibility of any nature.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 73 of 170
The Contractor shall procure materials of ISI stamp/certification and supplied by reputed suppliers borne on DGS&D list.
7.e.3. All materials procured should meet the specifications given in the tender
document. The Engineer-in-charge may, at his discretion, ask for samples and test certificates for any batch of any materials procured. Before procuring, the Contractor should get the approval of Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge for any materials to be used for the works.
7.e.4. Manufacturer's certificate shall be submitted for all materials supplied by the
Contractor. If, however, in the opinion of the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge any tests are required to be conducted on the material supplied by the Contractor, these will be arranged by the Contractor promptly at his own cost.
7.f. MATERIALS TO BE SUPPLIED BY THE OWNER
7.f.1. Steel and Cement maybe supplied by the Owner to the contractor against
payment by Contractor from either godown or from the site or within work premises itself and the contractor shall arrange for all transport to actual work site at no extra cost.
7.f.2. The contractor shall bear all the costs including loading and unloading, carting
from issue points to work spot storage, unloading, custody and handling and stacking the same and return the surplus steel and cement to the Owner's storage point after completion of job.
7.f.3. The contractor will be fully accountable for the steel and cement received from the
Owner and contractor will give acknowledgement/receipt for quantity of steel and cement received by him each time he uplifts cement from Owner's custody.
7.f.4. For all computation purposes, the theoretical cement consumption shall be
considered as per CPWD standards.
7.f.5. Steel and Cement as received from the manufacturer/stockists will be issued to the contractor. Theoretical weight of cement in a bag will be considered as 50 Kg. Bags weighing upto 4% less shall be accepted by the contractor and considered as 50 Kg. per bag. Any shortage in the weight of any cement bag by more than 4% will be to the Owner's account only when pointed out by the Contractor and verified by Engineer-in-Charge/Site in Charge at the time of Contract or taking delivery.
7.f.6. The contractor will be required to maintain a stock register for receipt, issuance
and consumption of steel and cement at site. Cement will be stored in a warehouse at site. Requirement of cement on any day will be taken out of the warehouse. Cement issued shall be regulated on the basis of FIRST RECEIPT to go as FIRST ISSUE.
7.f.7. Empty cement bag shall be the property of the Contractor. Contractor shall
be penalised for any excess/under consumption of cement. The penal rate will be twice the rate of issue of cement for this work.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 74 of 170
7.f.8. All the running bills as well as the final bills will be accompanied by cement consumption statements giving the detailed working of the cement used, cement received and stock-on-hand.
7.f.9. The Contractor will be fully responsible for safe custody of cement once it is
received by him and during transport. Owner will not entertain any claims of the contractor for theft, loss or damage to cement while in their custody.
7.f.10. The contractor shall not remove from the site any cement bags at any time.
7.f.11. The Contractor shall advise Engineer-in-charge/Site-in-charge in writing atleast 21
days before exhausting the Cement stocks already held by Contractor to ensure that such delays do not lead to interruptions in the progress of work.
7.f.12. Cement shall not be supplied by the Owner for manufacturing of mosaic tiles,
precast cement jali and any other bought out items which consume cement and for temporary works.
7.f.13. Cement in bags and in good usable condition left over after the completion of
work shall be returned by the contractor to the Owner. The Owner shall make payment to the Contractor at the supply rate for such stocks of cement they accept and receive. Any refused stock of cement shall be removed by the Contractor from the site at his cost and expenses within 15 days of completion of the work.
8. PAYMENT OF CLAIMS AND DAMAGES
8.1. Should the Owner have to pay money in respect of claims or demands as aforesaid the
amount so paid and the costs incurred by the Owner shall be charged to and paid by the Contractor and the Contractor shall not be entitled to dispute or question the right of the Owner to make such payments notwithstanding the same may have been without his consent or authority or in law or otherwise to the contrary.
8.2. In every case in which by virtue of the provisions of Workmen's Compensation Act,
1923, or other Acts, the Owner is obliged to pay Compensation to a Workman employed by the Contractor in execution of the works, the Owner will recover from the Contractor the amount of compensation so paid and without prejudice to the rights of Owner under the said Act. Owner shall be at liberty to recover such amount or any part thereof by deducting it from the security deposit or from any sum due to the Contractor whether under this contract or otherwise. The Owner shall not be bound to contest any claim made under Section 12 sub section (1) of the said Act, except on the written request of the Contractor and upon his giving to the Owner full security for all costs for which the owner might become liable in consequence of contesting such claim.
8.a. ACTION AND COMPENSATION IN CASE OF BAD WORK
If it shall appear to the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge that any work has been executed with bad, imperfect or unskilled workmanship, or with materials, or that any materials or articles provided by the Contractor for execution of the work are not of standards specified/inferior quality to that contracted for, or otherwise not in accordance with the contract, the CONTRACTOR shall on demand in writing from the Engineer-in-
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 75 of 170
Charge/Site-in-Charge or his authorised representative specifying the work, materials or articles complained of, notwithstanding that the same may have been inadvertently passed, certified and paid for, forthwith rectify or remove and reconstruct the work so specified and at his own charge and cost and expenses and in the event of failure to do so within a period of 15 days of such intimation/ information/knowledge, the Contractor shall be liable to pay compensation equivalent to the cost of reconstruction by the Owner. On expiry of 15 days period mentioned above, the Owner may by themselves or otherwise rectify or remove and re-execute the work or remove and replace with others, the materials or articles complained of as the case may be at the risk and expenses in all respects of the Contractor. The decision of the Engineer- in- Charge/ Site-in-Charge as to any question arising under this clause shall be final and conclusive and shall not be raised as a dispute or shall be arbitrable.
8.b. INSPECTION AND AUDIT OF CONTRACT AND WORKS
This project is subject to inspection by various Government agencies of Government of India. The contractor shall extend full cooperation to all the Government and other agencies in the inspection of the works, audit of the Contract and the documents of Contract Bills, measurements sheets etc. etc. and examination of the records of works and make enquiries interrogation as they may deem fit, proper and necessary. Upon inspection etc. by such agencies if it is pointed out that the contract work has not been carried out according to the prescribed terms and conditions as laid down in the tender documents and if any recoveries are recommended, the same shall be recovered from the contractors running bills/final bill/from ordered/suggested Security Deposit/retention money. The Contractor shall not rise any dispute on any such account and the same shall not be arbitrable.
9. CONTRACTOR TO INDEMNIFY THE OWNER
The Contractor shall indemnify the Owner and every member, officer and employee of the Owner, also the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge and his staff against all the actions, proceedings, claims, demands, costs, expenses, whatsoever arising out of or in connection with the works and all actions, proceedings, claims, demands, costs, expenses which may be made against the Owner for or in respect of or arising out of any failure by the Contractor in the performance of his obligations under the contract. The Contractor shall be liable for or in respect of or in consequence of any accident or injury to any workmen or other person in the employment of the Contractor or his sub contractor and Contractor shall indemnify and keep indemnified the Owner against all such damages, proceedings, costs, charges and expenses whatsoever in respect thereof or in relation thereto.
10. Price reduction
i) In case of any delay in completion of the work beyond the CDD, the Owner
shall be entitled to be paid Price Reduction by the Contractor. The price reduction shall be initially at the rate of 0.5% (half percent) of the total contract value for every week of the delay subject to a maximum of 5% of the total contract value. The price reduction shall be recovered by the Owner out of the amounts payable to the Contractor or from any Bank Guarantees or Deposits furnished by the Contractor or the Retention Money retained from the Bills of the Contractor, either under this contract or any other contract.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 76 of 170
ii) The Contractor shall be entitled to give an acceptable unconditional Bank
Guarantee in lieu of such a deduction if Contractor desires any decision
on a request for time extension.
iii) Once a final decision is taken on the request of the Contractor or otherwise, the price reduction shall be applicable only on the basic cost of the contract and on each full completed week(s) of delay (and for part of the week, a pro-rata price reduction amount shall be applicable).
iv) This final calculation of price reduction shall be only on the value of the unexecuted portion/quantity of work as on the CDD.
v) Contractor agrees with the Owner, that the above represents a genuine pre-
estimate of the damages which the Owner will suffer on account of delay in the performance of the work by Contractor. The Contractor further agrees that the price reduction amount is over and above any right which owner has to risk purchase under Clause 12.4 and any right to get the defects in the work rectified at the cost of the contractor.
11. DEFECTS AFTER TAKING OVER OR TERMINATION OF WORK CONTRACT BY
OWNER
The Contractor shall remain responsible and liable to make good all losses or damages that may occur/appear to the work carried out under this Contract within a period of 12 months from date of issue of the Completion Certificate and/or the date of Owner taking over the work, whichever is earlier. The Contractor shall issue a Bank Guarantee to the Owner in the sum of 10% of the work entrusted in the Contract, from any Scheduled Bank (other than a Co-Operative Bank) acceptable to the Owner and if however, the Contractor fails to furnish such a Bank Guarantee the Owner shall have right to retain the Security Deposit and Retention Money to cover the 10% of the Guarantee amount under this clause and to return/refund the same after the expiry of the period of 12 months without any interest thereon. (Please refer to clause 4. Deposits)
12. TERMINATION OF CONTRACT
12.1 The owner may terminate the contract at any stage of the construction for reasons to
be recorded in the letter of termination.
12.2 The Owner inter alia may terminate the Contract for any or all of the following reasons that the contractor
a) has abandoned the work/Contract.
b) has failed to commence the works, or has without any lawful excuse under these
conditions suspended the work for 15 consecutive days.
c) has failed to remove materials from the site or to pull down and replace the work within 15 days after receiving from the Engineer written notice that the said materials or work were condemned and/or rejected by the Engineer under specified conditions.
d) has neglected or failed to observe and perform all or any of the terms acts, matters
or things under this Contract to be observed and performed by the Contractor.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 77 of 170
e) has to the detriment of good workmanship or in defiance of the Engineer's instructions
to the contrary sub-let any part of the Contract.
f) has acted in any manner to the detrimental interest, reputation, dignity, name or prestige of the Owner.
g) has stopped attending to work without any prior notice and prior permission for a
period of 15 days.
h) has become untraceable.
i) has without authority acted in violation of the terms and conditions of this contract and has committed breach of terms of the contract in best judgement of the owner.
j) has been declared insolvent/bankrupt.
k) in the event of sudden death of the Contractor.
12.3 The owner on termination of such contract shall have the right to appropriate the
Security Deposit, Retention Money and invoke the Bank Guarantee furnished by the contractor and to appropriate the same towards the amounts due and payable by the contractor as per the conditions of Contract and return to the contractor excess money, if any, left over.
12.4 In case of Termination of the contract, Owner shall have the right to carry out the
unexecuted portion of the work either by themselves or through any other contractor(s) at the risk and cost of the Contractor. In view of paucity of time, Owner shall have the right to place such unexecuted portion of the work on any nominated contractor(s). However, the overall liability of the Contractor shall be restricted to 100 % of the total contract value.
12.5 The contractor within or at the time fixed by the Owner shall depute his authorised
representative for taking joint final measurements of the works executed thus far and submit the final bill for the work as per joint final measurement within 15 days of the date of joint final measurement. If the contractor fails to depute their representative for joint measurement, the owner shall take the measurement with their Engineer-in- Charge/Site-in-Charge or any other outside representatives. Such a measurement shall not be questioned by the Contractor and no dispute can be raised by the Contractor for purpose of Arbitration.
12.6 The Owner may enter upon and take possession of the works and all plant, tools,
scaffoldings, sheds, machinery, power operated tools and steel, cement and other materials of the Contract at the site or around the site and use or employ the same for completion of the work or employ any other contractor or other person or persons to complete the works. The Contractor shall not in any way object or interrupt or do any act, matter or thing to prevent or hinder such actions, other Contractor or other persons employed for completing and finishing or using the materials and plant for the works. When the works shall be completed or as soon thereafter the Engineer shall give a notice in writing to the Contractor to remove surplus materials and plant, if any, and belonging to the Contractor except as provided elsewhere in the Contract and should the Contractor fail to do so within a period of 15 days after receipt thereof the Owner may sell the same by public auction and shall
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 78 of 170
give credit to the contractor for the amount realised. The Owner shall thereafter ascertain and certify in writing under his hand what (if anything) shall be due or payable to or by the Owner for the value of the plant and materials so taken possession and the expense or loss which the Owner shall have been put to in procuring the works, to be so completed, and the amount if any, owing to the Contractor and the amount which shall be so certified shall thereupon be paid by the Owner to the Contractor or by the Contractor to the Owner, as the case may, and the Certificate of the Owner shall be final and conclusive between the parties.
12.7 When the contract is terminated by the Owner for all or any of the reasons mentioned
above the Contractor shall not have any right to claim compensation on account of such termination.
13. FORCE MAJEURE
13.1. Any delay in or failure of the performance of either part hereto shall not constitute
default hereunder or give rise to any claims for damage, if any, to the extent such delays or failure of performance is caused by occurrences such as Acts of God or an enemy, expropriation or confiscation of facilities by Government authorities, acts of war, rebellion, sabotage or fires, floods, explosions, riots, or strikes. The Contractor shall keep records of the circumstances referred to above and bring these to the notice of the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge in writing immediately on such occurrences. The amount of time, if any, lost on any of these counts shall not be counted for the Contract period. Once decision of the Owner arrived at after consultation with the Contractor, shall be final and binding. Such a determined period of time be extended by the Owner to enable the Contractor to complete the job within such extended period of time.
13.2. If Contractor is prevented or delayed from the performing any of its obligations
under this Agreement by Force Majeure, then Contractor shall notify Owner the circumstances constituting the Force Majeure and the obligations performance of which is thereby delayed or prevented, within seven days of the occurrence of the events.
14. ARBITRATION
14.1 All disputes and differences of whatsoever nature, whether existing or which shall at any
time arise between the parties hereto touching or concerning the agreement, meaning, operation or effect thereof or to the rights and liabilities of the parties or arising out of or in relation thereto whether during or after completion of the contract or whether before after determination, foreclosure, termination or breach of the agreement (other than those in respect of which the decision of any person is, by the contract, expressed to be final and binding) shall, after written notice by either party to the agreement to the other of them and to the Appointing Authority hereinafter mentioned, be referred for adjudication to the Sole Arbitrator to be appointed as hereinafter provided.
14.2 The appointing authority shall either himself act as the Sole Arbitrator or nominate
some officer/retired officer of Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (referred to as owner or HPCL) or a retired officer of any other Government Company in the Oil Sector of the rank of Ch. Manager & above or any retired officer of the Central Government not below the rank of a Director, to act as the Sole Arbitrator to adjudicate the disputes and differences between the parties. The contractor/vendor shall not be entitled to raise any objection to the appointment of such person as
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS OF WORKS CONTRACT
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 79 of 170
the Sole Arbitrator on the ground that the said person is/was an officer and/or shareholder of the owner, another Govt. Company or the Central Government or that he/she has to deal or had dealt with the matter to which the contract relates or that in the course of his/her duties, he/she has/had expressed views on all or any of the matters in dispute or difference.
14.3 In the event of the Arbitrator to whom the matter is referred to, does not accept the
appointment, or is unable or unwilling to act or resigns or vacates his office for any reasons whatsoever, the Appointing Authority aforesaid, shall nominate another person as aforesaid, to act as the Sole Arbitrator.
14.4 Such another person nominated as the Sole Arbitrator shall be entitled to proceed
with the arbitration from the stage at which it was left by his predecessor. It is expressly agreed between the parties that no person other than the Appointing Authority or a person nominated by the Appointing Authority as aforesaid, shall act as an Arbitrator. The failure on the part of the Appointing Authority to make an appointment on time shall only give rise to a right to a Contractor to get such an appointment made and not to have any other person appointed as the Sole Arbitrator.
14.5 The Award of the Sole Arbitrator shall be final and binding on the parties to the
Agreement.
14.6 The work under the Contract shall, however, continue during the Arbitration proceedings and no payment due or payable to the concerned party shall be withheld (except to the extent disputed) on account of initiation, commencement or pendency of such proceedings.
14.7 The Arbitrator may give a composite or separate Award(s) in respect of each dispute or
difference referred to him and may also make interim award(s) if necessary.
14.8 The fees of the Arbitrator and expenses of arbitration, if any, shall be borne equally by the
parties unless the Sole Arbitrator otherwise directs in his award with reasons. The lumpsum fees of the Arbitrator shall be ₹ 40,000/- per case for transportation
contracts and ₹ 60,000/- for engineering contracts and if the sole Arbitrator
completes the arbitration including his award within 5 months of accepting his
appointment, he shall be paid ₹ 10,000/- additionally as bonus. Reasonable actual
expenses for stenographer, etc. will be reimbursed. Fees shall be paid stage wise
i.e. 25% on acceptance, 25% on completion of pleadings/documentation, 25% on
completion of arguments and balance on receipt of award by the parties
14.9 Subject to the aforesaid, the provisions of the Arbitration and Conciliation Act, 1996 or
any statutory modification or re-enactment thereof and the rules made thereunder, shall apply to the Arbitration proceedings under this Clause.
14.10 The Contract shall be governed by and constructed according to the laws in force in
India. The parties hereby submit to the exclusive jurisdiction of the Courts situated at “location given in tender header” (say Mumbai*) for all purposes. The Arbitration shall be held at “location mentioned for such purpose in Tender header” (say Mumbai*) and conducted in English language.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
80 of 170
14.11 The Appointing Authority is the Functional Director of Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited.
(Note:- * = While printing the GTCs, each Procurement Authorities at various location, may mention the correct place before printing the GTC and not leave Clause 14.10 blank or as stated above. Bracketed portion is to be removed.
15. GENERAL
15.1. Materials required for the works whether brought by the or supplied by the
Owner shall be stored by the contractor only at places approved by Engineer-in- Charge/Site-in-Charge. Storage and safe custody of the material shall be the responsibility of the Contractor.
15.2. Owner and/or Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge connected with the contract, shall be entitled at any time to inspect and examine any materials intended to be used in or on the works, either on the site or at factory or workshop or at other place(s) manufactured or at any places where these are laying or from which these are being obtained and the contractor shall give facilities as may be required for such inspection and examination.
15.3. In case of any class of work for which there is no such specification supplied by the owner as is mentioned in the tender documents, such work shall be carried out in accordance with Indian Standard Specifications and if the Indian Standard Specifications do not cover the same the work should be carried out as per standard Engineering practice subject to the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in- Charge.
15.4. Should the work be suspended by reason of rain, strike, lockouts or other cause the contractor shall take all precautions necessary for the protection of the work
and at his own expense shall make good any damages arising from any of these causes.
15.5 The contractor shall cover up and protect from injury from any cause all new work also for supplying all temporary doors, protection to windows and any other requisite protection for the whole of the works executed whether by himself or special tradesmen or sub- contractors and any damage caused must be made good by the contractors at his own expense.
15.6 If the contractor has quoted the items under the deemed exports, then it will be the responsibility of the contractor to get all the benefits under deemed exports from the Government. The Owner’s responsibility shall only be limited to the issuance of required certificates. The quotation will be unconditional and phrases like “subject to availability of deemed exports benefit” etc. will not find place in it.
16. Integrity Pact: Effective 1st September, 2007, all tenders and contracts shall comply
with the requirements of the Integrity Pact (IP) if the value of such tenders or
contracts is ₹ 1 crore & above. Failure to sign the Integrity Pact shall lead to outright
rejection of bid. # 17. Grievances of parties participating or intend to participate i n the tender shall
be addressed in writing to the officer designate of the Grievance Redressal Cell where the tenders have to be submitted within the stipulated period. Detailed mechanism of Grievance Redressal is available on the HPCL website.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
81 of 170
Chapter – 4 b
GENERAL TERMS & CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
82 of 170
INDEX
1. PRELIMINARY 2. DEFINITION 3. REFERENCE FOR DOCUMENTATION 4. CONFIRMATION OF ORDER 5. SALES CONDITIONS 6. COMPLETE AGREEMENT 7. INSPECTION-CHECKING-TESTING 8. OFFICIAL INSTITUTIONAL TESTING 9. WEIGHTS AND MEASUREMENTS 10. DESPATCH INSTRUCTIONS 11. OILS & LUBRICANTS 12. SPARE PARTS 13. PACKING AND MARKING 14. SHIPMENT AND SHIPMENT NOTICES 15. CONTROL REGULATIONS 16. TRANSIT RISK 17. RESPECT FOR DELIVERY DATES 18. DELAYED DELIVERY 19. DELAYS DUE TO FORCE MAJEURE 20. REJECTION, REMOVAL OF REJECTED GOODS AND REPLACEMENT 21. TRANSFER OF PROPERTY FROM THE VENDOR TO THE CORPORATION 22. PRICE 23. TAXES & DUTIES 24. CUSTOMS DUTY (CD) VARIATION 25. FOREIGN EXCHANGE (FE) VARIATION 26. TERMS OF PAYMENT 27. RECOVERY OF SUMS DUE 28. CHANGES 29. CANCELLATION / RISK PURCHASE CLAUSE 30. PATENTS AND ROYALTIES 31. PERFORMANCE GUARANTEE 32. NONWAIVER 33. NON ASSIGNMENT 34. PART ORDER/ SPLIT ORDER / REPEAT ORDER 35. VENDOR’S DRAWINGS AND DATA REQUIREMENT 36. TECHNICAL INFORMATION 37. SERVICES OF VENDOR’S PERSONNEL 38. VENDOR’S LIABILITY 39. CORPORATION’S MATERIAL 40. GUARANTEE FOR SPARE PARTS 41. ARBITRATION 42. JURISDICTION 43. VALIDITY OF OFFER 44. INTEGRITY PACT 45. ORDER OF PRECEDENCE 46. GENERAL
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
83 of 170
GENERAL TERMS & CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
1. PRELIMINARY
1.1 This is a Contract for execution of job as defined in tender document at the
specified location
1.2 The tenderer for the abovementioned supply is the company/ proprietary concern/ individual (as per details & address mentioned in the unpriced bid) and undersigned (digitally) is authorized to submit the bid on behalf of tenderer.
1.3 The terms and conditions mentioned hereunder are the terms and conditions
of the Contract for the execution of the job mentioned under item 1.1 above.
1.4 It is the clear understanding between Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited and the tenderer that in case the bid of tenderer is accepted by Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited and an intimation to that effect is so issued and also a Procurement Order is on the tenderer this document shall form part of the Contract between the parties and terms and conditions hereunder would govern the parties interest.
1.5 Interpretation of Contract Documents: All documents forming part of the
Contract are to be taken mutually explanatory. Should there be any discrepancy, inconsistency, error or omission in the contract, the decision of the Owner/Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge shall be the final and the contractor shall abide by the decision. The decision shall not be arbitrable. Items shown upon the drawings but not mentioned in the specification or described in the specifications without being shown on the drawings shall nevertheless be deemed to be included in the same manner as if they are shown in the drawings and described in the specifications.
1.6 Special conditions of Purchase : The special conditions of Purchase, if
any provided and whenever and wherever referred to shall be read in conjunction with General Terms and Conditions of contract for Supply, specifications, drawings, and any other documents forming part of this contract wherever the context so requires. Notwithstanding the subdivision of the documents into separate sections, parts volumes, every section, part or volume shall be deemed to be supplementary or complementary to each other and shall be read in whole. In case of any misunderstanding arising the same shall be referred to decision of the Owner/ Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge and their decision shall be final and binding and the decision shall not be arbitrable.
It is the clear understanding that wherever it is mentioned that the Contractor
shall do/perform a job and/or provide facilities for the performance of the job, the
doing or the performance or the providing of the facilities is at the cost and expenses of
the Contractor not liable to be paid or reimbursed by the Owner.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
84 of 170
2. DEFINITIONS
a. The following expressions used in the Purchase Order shall have meaning as indicated against each of these:
b. The CORPORATION / OWNER means HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM
CORPORATION LIMITED, a company incorporated in India having its registered office at 17, Jamshedji Tata Road, Mumbai- 400 020 and shall include its successors and assignees.
Owner’s CONSULTANT means WorleyParsons India Pvt Limited, having registered office at 5th Floor, B Wing, Lodha “I Think” Techno campus, off Pokhran road no.2, Thane (W) Maharashtra 400 607
c. “Goods / Materials”: Goods and/or Materials shall mean any of the articles,
materials, machinery, equipments, supplies, drawings, data and other property and all services including but not limited to design, delivery, installation, inspection, testing and commissioning specified to complete the order.
d. “Vendor / Seller / Supplier”: Vendor / Seller / Supplier shall mean the person, firm
or corporation to whom this Purchase Order is issued.
e. “Contractual Delivery Date”: Contractual Delivery date is the date on which goods shall be delivered F.O.R/F.O.T. Despatching Point/ Destination in accordance with the terms of the Purchase Order. This contractual delivery date / period is inclusive of all the lead time for engineering, procurement of raw materials, manufacturing, inspection, testing, packing and any other activity whatsoever required to be accomplished for affecting the delivery at the agreed delivery point.
f. “Inspectors”: Inspectors deputed by
Corporation. g. ‘Total Order Value’ means:-
i. For Material Supply Contract: - The basic cost excluding taxes, duties, levies, freight etc. unless and until specifically mentioned in the purchase order.
ii. For Lump sum / Turnkey contract: - The total cost & all other cost inclusive of taxes, duties, levies, freight etc.
h. ‘Total Order Value’ shall be considered for the purpose of calculation of:
1. Price reduction on account of delay 2. Performance bank Guarantee Amount 3. Payment of advance, if any to be made.
i. Note: - The total order for levy of Price Reduction on account of delay shall include
all types of escalation (including on account of Foreign Exchange Variation) agreed to in terms of Purchase Order.
3. REFERENCE FOR DOCUMENTATION
Purchase Order number must appear on order confirmation, correspondence, drawings, invoices, shipping notes, packings and on any documents or papers connected with the order.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
85 of 170
4. CONFIRMATION OF ORDER
The Vendor shall acknowledge the receipt of the Purchase Order within ten days following the mailing of this order and shall thereby confirm his acceptance of this Purchase Order in
its entirety without exceptions. The acknowledgment will bear on both purchase order and General Procurement Conditions.
5. SALES CONDITIONS
With Vendor’s acceptance of provisions of this Purchase Order, he waives and considers as cancelled any of his general sales conditions.
6. COMPLETE AGREEMENT
The terms and conditions of this Purchase Order shall constitute the entire agreement between the parties hereto. Changes will be binding only if the amendments are made in writing and signed by an authorized representative of the Corporation and the Vendor.
7. INSPECTION-CHECKING-TESTING
a. The equipment, materials and workmanship covered by the Purchase Order shall be subject to inspection and testing at any time prior to shipment and or despatch and to final inspection within a reasonable time after arrival at the place of delivery. Inspectors shall have the right to carry out the inspection and testing which will include the raw materials at manufacturer’s shop, at fabricator’s shop and at the time of actual despatch before and after completion of packing.
b. All tests, mechanical and others and particularly those required by codes will be performed at the Vendor’s expenses and in accordance with Inspector’s instructions. The Vendor will also bear the expenses concerning preparation and rendering of tests required by Boiler Inspectorate or such other statutory testing agencies or by any other reputed inspection agencies as may be nominated by the Corporation.
c. Before shipping or despatch, the equipment and or materials will have to be checked and stamped by inspectors who are authorized also to forbid the use and despatch of any equipment and/or materials which during tests and inspection fail to comply with the specifications, codes and testing requirements.
d. The vendor shall inform the Corporation at least eight days in advance of the exact place, date and time of rendering the equipment or materials for required inspection.
e. The vendor shall provide free access to inspectors during normal working hours at Vendor’s or his/its sub-Vendor’s works and place at their disposal all useful means of performing, checking, marking, testing, inspection and final stamping.
f. Even if the inspections and tests are fully carried out, Vendor would not be absolved to any degree from his responsibilities to ensure that all equipments and materials supplied comply strictly with requirements as per agreement both during construction, at the time of delivery, inspection, on arrival at site and after its erection or start-up and guarantee period as stipulated in clause 30 hereof.
g. The Vendor’s responsibility will not be lessened to any degree due to any comments made by the Corporation and Inspectors on the Vendor’s drawings or by Inspectors witnessing any chemical or physical tests.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
86 of 170
h. In any case, the equipment and materials must be in strict accordance with the Purchase order and/or its attachments failing which the Corporation shall have the right to reject the goods and hold the Vendor liable for non-performance of contract.
8. OFFICIAL INSTITUTIONAL TESTING
a. In addition to testing and inspection by Inspectors mentioned above, nominated
agencies or similar institutional agencies like Boiler Inspectorate may be assigned for official testing of all coded equipment. The Vendor shall ensure that all Procedures for preparation and Performance of tests prescribed by such Institutions shall be completed scrupulously.
b. The Vendor is required to send to such Institutions as may be designated by the
Corporation at least three sets of construction drawings for each equipment and calculations. All manufacturer’s mill’s tests certificates and analytical reports from material laboratories in respect of all raw materials and components employed shall have to be presented to such institution’s Inspectors in the number of copies required. Vendor shall be responsible for any delay in submission of necessary certificates. The Vendor shall maintain close liaison with the Corporation and Institution’s Inspectors to maintain schedule and delay, if any in this process will not be taken into consideration as a cause of Force Majeure.
9. WEIGHTS AND MEASUREMENTS
a. All weights and measurements recorded by the Corporation on receipt of goods at site will be treated as final.
b. Vendor’s shipping documents and invoices must contain the following data:
i. Unit net weight
ii. Unit gross weight (packing included)
iii. Dimensions of packing.
10. DESPATCH INSTRUCTIONS
a. Unless otherwise specifically advised in writing, goods shall not be despatched without prior inspection, testing and Release Order / Materials Acceptance Certificates issued by Inspectors.
b. In case despatch by rail is specified in the Purchase Order, vendor shall exercise due care and ensure that the consignment shall be booked under appropriate railway classification, failing which, any additional freight incurred by Corporation due to Vendor’s booking the material under a wrong classification shall be to Vendor’s account.
c. The goods shall be consigned in the name of consignee as applicable.
d. Corporation’s warehouse is open to receive stores between 9.00 A.M and 3 P.M on all working days. No goods will be accepted after 3.00 P.M.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
87 of 170
e. Corporation reserves the right to advise any change in despatching point / destination and / or mode of transport, as may be required. Any extra expenditure on this account supported by documentary evidence will be reimbursed by the Corporation.
11. OILS & LUBRICANTS
The first filling of oils and lubricants, if any, required for every equipment shall be included in the price and appropriate products manufactured by the Corporation (HPCL) shall be used. The Vendor shall also recommend the quality / quantity of oils and lubricants required for one-year continuous operation.
12. SPARE PARTS
a. The Vendor must furnish itemised price list of spare parts indicating quantity, unit rate & total rate required for two years operation of the main equipment and prime movers also, if mentioned in the tender.
b. The Vendor shall provide the necessary cross sectional drawing to identify the spare parts numbers and their location as well as inter-changeability chart.
13. PACKING AND MARKING
a. The Materials shall be suitably packed for safe transportation till receipt at site and should be commensurate with best possible practices of packing, unless specifically stipulated in the Technical specifications, to avoid any damage during transit.
b. All fragile and exposed parts shall be packed carefully and the package shall bear the words ‘HANDLE WITH CARE’, ‘THIS SIDE UP’ and ‘FRAGILE’.
c.All holes and openings and also other delicate surfaces shall be carefully protected against bad weather. All threaded fittings shall be greased and provided with plastic caps. All small pieces shall be packed in cases.
d. The Supplier shall be liable for all damages or breakage to the Materials due to defective or insufficient packing as well as for corrosion due to insufficient protection.
e. Detailed packing list in waterproof envelope shall be kept in each package together with material and one copy of packing list shall be fastened outside the box in waterproof envelope.
f. Each package shall be marked in bold letters on the external three surface of the package as follows:
i. From: Address of Supplier / Sub-supplier.
ii. For: Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. (location)
iii. Item:
iv. Package No. : of total packages
v. Dimensions: (Dimensions of each package)
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
88 of 170
vi. Weight: (Weight of each package)
vii. Special Instruction for storage, if any.
viii. Special unloading arrangements, if required, shall be clearly mentioned in the
Packing List.
ix. All packages containing the following items shall be packed separately as ordered and shall have additional clear marking for identification.
1. Mandatory Spares. 2. Commissioning Spares.
14. SHIPMENT AND SHIPMENT NOTICES
a. The Vendor shall make shipment only after prior approval by Inspectors whenever specifically mentioned. In the event of the Vendor having been advised to hold
shipments(s) for any reason whatsoever the Vendor shall hold the materials in his / its warehouse for at least 30 days without any compensation; or without prejudice to any reduction in price already accrued on account of delay.
b. Within 24 hours of shipment, Vendor shall inform despatch particulars to Corporation & Consultant’s Project office & site office by fax / courier / email.
c. The Vendor shall carefully note the destination of materials.
d. The demurrage or other expenses incurred owing to any negligence, delay, default on the part of the Vendor will be to Vendor’s account.
15. CONTROL REGULATIONS
The supply, despatch and delivery of goods shall be arranged by the Vendor in strict conformity with the statutory regulations including provision of Industries (Development and Regulation) Act 1951 and any amendment thereof as applicable from time to time. The Corporation disowns any responsibility for any irregularity or contravention of any of the statutory regulations in manufacture or supply of the stores covered by this order.
16. TRANSIT RISK
Transit Risk insurance shall be covered by the Corporation. The Vendor shall advise the despatch particulars to Corporation immediately after shipment.
17. RESPECT FOR DELIVERY DATES.
Time of delivery as mentioned in the Purchase Order shall be the essence of the contract and no variation shall be permitted except with prior authorization in writing from the Corporation. Goods should be delivered securely packed and in good order and condition at the place and within the time specified in the Purchase Order for their delivery.
18. PRICE REDUCTION FOR DELAYED DELIVERY
In case of delayed delivery, prices will be reduced @1/2% of the total basic order value for every week of delay or part thereof subject to a maximum of @5% of the total basic order value.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
89 of 170
NOTE :
a. Price Reduction shall be applicable only on the basic cost and on Full complete week (s) and for fractional days Price reduction shall be applicable on pro-rata, if any.
b. Initially Price Reduction shall be applicable for total basic order value and
final Price Reduction settlement to be on undelivered portion in the contractual delivery period.
19. DELAYS DUE TO FORCE MAJEURE
a. Any delay in or failure of the performance of either part hereto shall not constitute default hereunder or give rise to any claims for damage, if any, to the extent such delays or failure of performance is caused by occurrences such as Acts of God or an enemy, expropriation or confiscation of facilities by Government authorities, acts of war, rebellion, sabotage or fires, floods, explosions, riots, or strikes. The Contractor shall keep records of the circumstances referred to above and bring these to the notice of the Engineer-in-Charge/Site-in-Charge in writing immediately on such occurrences. The amount of time, if any, lost on any of these counts shall not be counted for the Contract
period. Once decision of the Owner arrived at after consultation with the Contractor, shall be final and binding. Such a determined period of time be extended by the Owner to enable the Contractor to complete the job within such extended period of time.
b. If Contractor is prevented or delayed from the performing any of its obligations under this Agreement by Force Majeure, then Contractor shall notify Owner the circumstances constituting the Force Majeure and the obligations performance of which is thereby delayed or prevented, within seven days of the occurrence of the events.
20. REJECTION, REMOVAL OF REJECTED GOODS AND REPLACEMENT
a. In case the testing and inspection at any stage by Inspectors reveal the equipment, material and workmanship do not comply with specification and requirements, the same shall be removed by the Vendor at their / its own expense and risk within the time allowed by the Corporation. The Corporation shall be at liberty to dispose of such rejected goods in such manner as they may think appropriate. In the event the Vendor fails to remove the rejected goods within the period as aforesaid, all expenses incurred by the Corporation for such disposal shall be to the account of the Vendor. The freight paid by the Corporation, if any, on the inward journey of the rejected materials shall be reimbursed by the Vendor to the Corporation before the rejected materials are removed by the Vendor.
b. The Vendor will have to proceed with the replacement of that equipment or part of equipment without claiming any extra payment if so required by the Corporation. The time taken for replacement in such event will not be added to the contractual delivery period.
21. TRANSFER OF PROPERTY FROM THE VENDOR TO THE CORPORATION
a. The transfer of property shall be deemed to have taken place as follows subject to the provisions herein contained:
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
90 of 170
i. Exworks: when the vendor places the goods at the disposal of the buyer at the vendor’s premises or another named place (i.e. works, factory, warehouse, etc.)
ii. F.O.R. or F.O.T despatch point: On handing over the equipment to the carrier against receipt and such receipt having been passed over to the Corporation.
iii. FOT / FOR destination station: On taking delivery from the transporters/railways at the destination station.
iv. Equipment sent freight carriage paid to the project Site: On arrival under lifting hook
at the job site. v. Equipment erected by the Vendor: On temporary acceptance at job site. vi. Equipment commissioned by the Vendor: On taking over by the Corporation for
regular operation after test runs at maximum capacity for specified period satisfactorily performed.
22. PRICE
a. Unless otherwise agreed to in the terms of the Purchase Order, the price shall be firm and not subject to escalation for any reason whatsoever till the execution of entire order, even though it might be necessary for the order execution to take longer than the delivery period specified in the order.
b. Exclusive of Central / State sales Tax, Excise Duty and / or such taxes & duties, which are leviable by law on sale of finished goods to Corporation and/or entry tax ,if any,
leviable at destination state. The nature and extent of such levies shall be shown separately.
23. TAXES & DUTIES:
a. Excise Duty, Central Sales Tax, VAT, Service Tax as applicable shall be reimbursed for the materials consigned to Corporation as per limits indicated in the offer against documentary evidence to be furnished by the Supplier. Corporation shall pay only those taxes, duties and levies as indicated by Supplier at the time of bid submission/as agreed subsequently (prior to opening of priced bids). Taxes / Duties and/or Levies not indicated by supplier in Bid, but payable, shall be to Supplier’s account. In case of any increase applicable in Excise Duty, Central Sales Tax, VAT, Service Tax, Octroi indicated with reference to limits mentioned in the offer / bid or new taxes / duties / levies imposed by the Indian Government through Gazette notification after the date of submission of last Price bid but prior to Contractual Delivery Date, the Corporation shall reimburse the increase in taxes & duties on satisfactory supporting documents.
b. Corporation will issue C-Form on all inter-state sales of materials by supplier to
Corporation to enable supplier to avail concessional rate of Sales Tax on such sales.
c. Supplier shall be responsible for availing all applicable concessions in taxes, duties, levies etc. as per terms of Purchase Order. Any loss, direct or implied, accrued to Corporation on account of supplier’s failure to avail concessions shall be borne by Supplier.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
91 of 170
d. Supplier shall indicate the Cenvatable Service Tax applicable on the services provided by them if any and the same shall be governed by GCC.
24. CUSTOMS DUTY (CD) VARIATION
a. The prices mentioned in offer are subject to Customs Duty (CD) variation. In case of any increase in rates of Customs Duty, Countervailing Duty, Special Additional Duty by the Indian Government through Gazette notification after the submission of last priced offer but within the time schedule for import of materials, as mentioned. Corporation shall reimburse the increase in taxes & duties at actuals against satisfactory supporting documents.
b. All downward variations in the rates of all such duties shall be to Corporation’s account and same shall be calculated on actual CIF value of imported materials subject to the limit mentioned. Supplier shall submit all relevant documents to Corporation for the proof of duty paid by them within one month from the date of Bill of Entry (BOE).
c. Custom Duty variation shall be paid by Corporation up to the limit of maximum CIF value of imported components as indicated in the offer.
d. Rate of Custom Duty along with tariff number considered by Supplier in the prices shall be indicated in the offer.
25. FOREIGN EXCHANGE (FE) VARIATION
a. The CIF value in Indian Rupees / Foreign Currency to be declared should cover the currencies of the countries from which import of materials / components are envisaged to administer foreign currency variation.
b. The FE variation will be paid for if imports are made at the listed currency subject to
ceiling limit.
c. The list of foreign currency, country of origin, ceiling of foreign value of import envisaged against each item of materials / components for import and rate of conversion into Rupees envisaged to be furnished in the tender. The period within which import shall be made after placement of LOI (i.e. Contractual Completion date of imports, herein after called CDD) shall also be indicated in the offer.
d. For reimbursement of foreign exchange variation, documentary evidence like bank certificates of remittance showing the date of payment and rate of foreign currency to Indian rupees to be furnished along with a copy of bills of entry duty attested by Customs department. All downward variations in conversion rate will be to Corporation’s account.
e. Variation will be paid only if imports are made within the period as specified in offer for import. For imports made beyond that period, foreign currency variation will be paid based on the conversion rates prevailing on the last date of period of agreed to for imports. The last date for imports agreed will be the import landing date in India envisaged by Bill of Entry.
f. Bidder shall indicate the maximum CIF component along with currency of import. In case supplier imports less than the CIF value indicated in the bid, Duty. FE variation etc. shall be reimbursed only for the actual import carried out.
g. Foreign exchange variation, if any, downward or upward, will be paid only if imports
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
92 of 170
are made within the agreed completion period.
h. For the purpose of Foreign Exchange variation reimbursement, State Bank of India (SBI) selling rate applicable on the bill of entry date or SBI selling rate on Bank remittance date or actual remittance rate, whichever is lower shall be considered. The following clause also to be considered.
i. The BOE date may fall within Contractual Completion Date or beyond, it has already been stipulated as above conditions that no reimbursement for FE / CD variation will be paid if the actual import is beyond Contractual completion date. In such a case, the variation reimbursement will be restricted to the difference between the rate quoted in the tender and the lower of the following:
i. The actual remittance rate.
ii. SBI Bill selling rate on the date of CDD.
26. TERMS OF PAYMENT
a. The following payment terms shall be applicable:
i. 75% of the bill amount duly recommended by user on receipt of materials / docs. at
HPCL shall be paid within 7 days of receipt of bill.
ii. Balance 25% to be paid after verification/ certification within 15 days of receipt of bill. However, the final bill payment will not exceed 30 days.
b. HPCL has taken the initiative to expedite the payment to vendors through e-payment.
Hence confirm that you have filled the HPCL bank mandate for e-payment.
c. Payment against invoice shall be made on receipt of equipment/materials at site against submission of following documents along with your Bill/Invoice:-
i. Delivery Challan / Lorry Receipt. ii. Manufacturer’s Test Certificate
iii. Inspection/Clearance report iv. Manufacturer’s Guarantee Certificate v. Performance Bank Guarantee for 10% Basic Order Value vi. Any other document specified in the Purchase Order.
d. The financial settlement of Vendor’s invoice is liable to be withheld in the event
the Vendor has not complied with submission of drawing data and such documentation as called for in the Purchase Order and/or as required otherwise.
e. HPCL will furnish their approved format for bank guarantee/ indemnity bond for all the advance payments directly to vendor along with FOA/ PO, wherever applicable.
f. In case of delayed supplies, bills will be paid after recovering the amount as per price reduction clause of the P.O.
g. All bank guarantees shall be non revocable and from Scheduled / Nationalised Banks other than cooperative banks in India and as per HPCL’s proforma.
h. PBG shall be valid till expiry of guarantee period. All other Bank Guarantees shall
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
93 of 170
be valid till contractual completion period, unless otherwise specified. All bank guarantees shall have a claim period of 1(one) month after expiry date of bank guarantee.
27. RECOVERY OF SUMS DUE
Whenever any claim against the Vendor for payment of a sum of money arises out of or under the contract, the Corporation shall be entitled to recover such sums from any sum then due or which at any time thereafter may become due from the Vendor under this or any other contract with the Corporation and should this sum be not sufficient to cover the recoverable amount, the Vendor shall pay to the Corporation on demand the balance remaining due.
28. CHANGES
The Corporation has the option at any time to make changes in quantities ordered or in specification and drawings. If such changes cause an increase or decrease in the price or in the time required for supply, an equitable adjustment under this provision must be finalised within 10 days from the date when change is ordered.
29. CANCELLATION / RISK PURCHASE CLAUSE:
a. The Corporation reserves the right to cancel this purchase order or any part thereof and shall be entitled to rescind the contract wholly or in part with a written notice to the vendor if:
i. The vendor fails to comply with the terms of this purchase order.
ii. The vendor fails to delivery the goods on time and / or replace the rejected goods promptly.
iii. The Vendor becomes bankrupt or goes into liquidation.
iv. The vendor makes a general assignment for the benefit of
creditors. v. A receiver is appointed for any of the property owned
by the vendor.
b. Upon receipt of the said cancellation notice, the vendor shall discontinue all work on the
Purchase Order and matters connected with it. The vendor is aware that the said goods are required by the Corporation for the ultimate purpose of materials production and that non delivery may cause loss of production and consequently loss of profit to the Corporation.
c. Therefore, in case of Termination of the contract, Corporation shall have the right to carry out the unexecuted portion of the supply/work either by themselves or through any other vendor(s)/contractor(s) at the risk and cost of the vendor/ contractor. In view of paucity of time, Corporation shall have the right to place such unexecuted portion of the supply/work on any nominated vendor(s)/contractor(s). However, the overall liability of the vendor/Contractor shall be restricted to 100% of the total contract value.
d. The provision of this clause shall not prejudice the right of the Corporation from invoking the provisions of clause “Delayed Delivery” as a fore said.
30. PATENTS AND ROYALTIES
On acceptance of this order, the Vendor will be deemed to have entirely
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
94 of 170
indemnified the Corporation from any legal action or claims regarding compensation for breach of any patent rights.
31. PERFORMANCE GUARANTEE
a. The supplies made against this order shall be fully guaranteed against any manufacturing defects/poor workmanship/inferior quality etc. for a period of 12 months from the date of commissioning or 18 months from the date of supply whichever is earlier. During this period, you will arrange to repair/replace any defective parts free of cost or replace complete set if required. Guarantee Certificate should be submitted along with despatch documents. You will furnish performance Bank Guarantee in favour of HPCL issued by Scheduled bank (other than co-operative banks) for 10% value of the material supplied and valid during the above guarantee period.
® b. Composite PBG valid upto a period of 3 months beyond the expiry of defect liability period. Demand Draft should be drawn on Scheduled Banks (other than cooperative banks).
Quantum of Performance Bank Guarantee inclusive of Security Deposit should be as follows: - All items (other than CVR items) : 10% of PO value - For CVR items: ₹ 10.0 lakhs or 5% of the order value whichever is
lower. Composite PBG of above value towards Performance Bank Guarantee inclusive of Security Deposit shall be accepted (in lieu of deduction of retention money of 10% from each bill); Such composite PBG shall be valid upto a period of 3 months beyond the expiry of defect liability period. Demand Draft should be drawn on Scheduled Banks (other than cooperative banks).
32. NON WAIVER
Failure of the Corporation to insist upon any of the terms or conditions incorporated in the Purchase Order or failure or delay to exercise any right or remedies or by law or failure to properly notify Vendor in the event of breach, or the acceptance of, or payment of any goods hereunder or approval of design shall not release the Vendor and shall not be deemed a waiver of any right of the Corporation to insist upon the strict performance thereof or of any of his or their rights or remedies as to any such goods regardless of when goods are shipped, received or accepted nor shall any purported oral modification or revision of the order by the Corporation act as waiver of the terms hereof.
® REVISION: PROC-003/18-
08-2014
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
95 of 170
33. NON ASSIGNMENT
The Purchase Order shall not be assigned to any other agency by the Vendor without obtaining prior written consent of Corporation.
34. PART ORDER/ SPLIT ORDER / REPEAT ORDER
Vendor hereby agrees to accept part orders, split order at Corporation’s option without any limitation whatsoever and also accept repeat order up to 100% of each item during a period of 12 months after placement of purchase order at the same unit prices, terms and conditions.
35. VENDOR’S DRAWINGS AND DATA REQUIREMENT
The Vendor shall submit drawings, data and documentation in accordance with but not limited to what is specified in the requisition and / or in Vendor drawings and data form attached to the Purchase Order as called for in clause 8, viz, ‘Expediting’ above. The types, quantities and time limits of submitting this must be respected in its entirety failing which the Purchase Order shall not be deemed to have been executed for all purposes including settlement of payment since the said submission is an integral part of Purchase Order execution.
36. TECHNICAL INFORMATION
a. Drawings, specifications & details shall be the property of the Corporation and shall be returned by the Vendor on demand. The Vendor shall not make use of drawing and specifications for any purpose at any time save and except for the purpose of the Corporation.
b. The Vendor shall not disclose the technical information furnished to or gained by the Vendor under or by virtue or as a result of the implementation of this Purchase Order to any person, firm or body or corporate authority and shall make all endeavours to ensure that the technical information is kept CONFIDENTIAL. The technical information imparted and supplied to the Vendor by the Corporation shall at all times remain the absolute Property of the Corporation.
37. SERVICES OF VENDOR’S PERSONNEL
Unless otherwise specified in the PO, services of vendor’s personnel shall be made within two weeks advance notice and the Vendor shall depute the necessary personnel to site for supervision of erection and start up of the equipment and train a few of the Corporation’s personnel for the operation and maintenance of the equipment if required, by the Corporation. The terms and conditions for the services of the Vendor shall be mutually settled.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
96 of 170
38. VENDOR’S LIABILITY
The Vendor’s workmen or employees shall under no circumstances be deemed to be in Corporation’s employment and the Vendor shall hold himself responsible for any claim or claims which they or their heirs, dependents, personal representatives may have or make for damages or compensation for anything done or committed to be done in the course of carrying out the work covered by this Purchase Order, whether arising on Corporation
premises or elsewhere and agrees to indemnify the Corporation against any such claim or claims if made against the Corporation and all cost (as between attorney and client) of proceedings, suits or action which the Corporation may incur/sustain in respect of the same. The Vendor shall also procure and keep in force at his own cost comprehensive Automobile Liability insurance for adequate coverage in respect of all his vehicles visiting or plying in project premises. The Vendor shall also be responsible for compliance of existing laws in respect of their workmen and employees. Extent of Liability shall be read in conjunction with clause no. 28 above.
39. CORPORATION’S MATERIAL
a. Corporation’s material shall be delivered to the Vendor against submission of Bank Guarantee for indemnifying the full value there of strictly in the manner and as per proforma of bank Guarantee approved by the Corporation.
b. Wherever possible the material shall be consigned to Vendor’s siding. In the event the Vendor does not have any siding, materials shall be consigned to the Public siding / goods depot to be specifically confirmed by Vendor Loading / Unloading and any handling from the siding / destination shall be arranged by the Vendor at his responsibility and cost.
c. The Vendor shall give a firm and binding list of Corporation issue materials and the desired schedule of its delivery to Shop floor strictly in accordance with the sequence of fabrication vis-à-vis the contract delivery period.
d. Unused material or scrap from material supplied by the Corporation to the Vendor shall be returned by the Vendor to the Corporation or if the Corporation so directs, the Vendor may dispose of the same by sale or otherwise on such terms and conditions as the Corporation may stipulate and the Vendor shall pay to the Corporation the sale proceeds of the material so disposed by sale deducting there from expenses incurred by the Vendor on such sale, the quantum of such deduction to be mutually agreed upon in advance between the Corporation and the Vendor.
40. GUARANTEE FOR SPARE PARTS:
a. The seller shall undertake that before going out of production of the spare parts he will give adequate advance notice to the Procurement so that the latter may order his requirements of spares in one lot if so desires .
b. The seller shall further guarantee that if he goes out of production of spare parts , then he will make available blue prints , drawings of spare parts and specification of materials at no extra cost to the Procurement , if and when required in connection with the equipment to enable the procurer to fabricate or procure spare parts from other source.
c. The provision of this clause shall remain effective and binding upon the seller even after the completion or expiry of the order and till the plant / machinery / equipment / instrument supplied under the order is in use by the procurer.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
97 of 170
41. ARBITRATION
a. All disputes and differences of whatsoever nature, whether existing or which shall at any time arise between the parties hereto touching or concerning the agreement, meaning, operation or effect thereof or to the rights and liabilities of the parties or arising out of or in relation thereto whether during or after completion of the contract or whether before after determination, foreclosure, termination or breach of the agreement (other than those in respect of which the decision of any person is, by the contract, expressed to be final and binding) shall, after written notice by either party to the agreement to the other of them and to the Appointing Authority hereinafter mentioned, be referred for adjudication to the Sole Arbitrator to be appointed as hereinafter provided.
b. The appointing authority shall either himself act as the Sole Arbitrator or nominate some officer/retired officer of Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (referred to as Corporation or HPCL) or a retired officer of any other Government Company in the Oil Sector of the rank of Ch. Manager & above or any retired officer of the Central Government not below the rank of a Director, to act as the Sole Arbitrator to adjudicate the disputes and differences between the parties. The contractor/vendor shall not be entitled to raise any objection to the appointment of such person as the Sole Arbitrator on the ground that the said person is/was an officer and/or shareholder of the Corporation, another Govt. Company or the Central Government or that he/she has to deal or had dealt with the matter to which the contract relates or that in the course of his/her duties, he/she has/had expressed views on all or any of the matters in dispute or difference.
c. In the event of the Arbitrator to whom the matter is referred to, does not accept the appointment, or is unable or unwilling to act or resigns or vacates his office for any reasons whatsoever, the Appointing Authority aforesaid, shall nominate another person as aforesaid, to act as the Sole Arbitrator.
d. Such another person nominated as the Sole Arbitrator shall be entitled to proceed with the arbitration from the stage at which it was left by his predecessor. It is expressly agreed between the parties that no person other than the Appointing Authority or a person nominated by the Appointing Authority as aforesaid, shall act as an Arbitrator. The failure on the part of the Appointing Authority to make an appointment on time shall only give rise to a right to a Contractor to get such an appointment made and not to have any other person appointed as the Sole Arbitrator.
e. The Award of the Sole Arbitrator shall be final and binding on the parties to the
Agreement.
f. The work under the Contract shall, however, continue during the Arbitration proceedings and no payment due or payable to the concerned party shall be withheld (except to the extent disputed) on account of initiation, commencement or pendency of such proceedings.
g. The Arbitrator may give a composite or separate Award(s) in respect of each dispute or difference referred to him and may also make interim award(s) if necessary.
h. The fees of the Arbitrator and expenses of arbitration, if any, shall be borne equally by the parties unless the Sole Arbitrator otherwise directs in his award with reasons. The lumpsum fees of the Arbitrator shall be ₹ 40,000/- per case for transportation
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
98 of 170
contracts
and ₹ 60,000/- for engineering contracts and if the sole Arbitrator completes the arbitration including his award within 5 months of accepting his appointment, he shall be
paid ₹ 10,000/- additionally as bonus. Reasonable actual expenses for stenographer,
etc. will be reimbursed. Fees shall be paid stage wise i.e. 25% on acceptance, 25% on completion of pleadings/documentation, 25% on completion of arguments and balance on receipt of award by the parties.
i. Subject to the aforesaid, the provisions of the # Arbitration and Conciliation Act, 1996 or
any statutory modification or re-enactment thereof and the rules made thereunder, shall apply to the Arbitration proceedings under this Clause.
j. The Contract shall be governed by and constructed according to the laws in force in India. The parties hereby submit to the exclusive jurisdiction of the Courts situated at for all purposes. The Arbitration shall be held at Visakhapatnam and conducted in English language.
k. The Appointing Authority is the Functional Director* of Hindustan Petroleum
Corporation Limited.
l. Procurement Authorities may mention, if considered necessary, the proper designation such as Director-Refineries, etc.
42. JURISDICTION
The Vendor hereby agrees that the Courts situated in location given in tender header” shall have the jurisdiction to hear and determine all actions and proceedings arising out of this contract.
CLAUSE
a. Vendor needs to clarify whether you are registered with NSIC. If registered, vendor needs to submit the following documents along with their offer.
b. Photocopy of the NSIC Registration Certificate, which clearly shows the following details/ information:
i. Name of the Bidder
ii. Address of the Bidder
iii. Validity of the Registration
iv. Items for which the Bidder is registered v. Monetary Limit
and acknowledged copy of Entrepreneurs Memorandum Part II
c. Also vendor has to clarify whether you have secured Orders for same items, during the preceding 12 months, in competition with Large Scale Units, WITHOUT any Price Preference.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
99 of 170
d. In case vendor have secured Orders for same items, during the preceding 12 months, in competition with Large Scale Units, WITHOUT any Price Preference, then vendor has to furnish a Declaration on their Letter Head accordingly.
e. Please note that in the absence of the above information, offer will be evaluated without considering Price Preference.
1.0 Preference to MSEs
a. In case the bidder is a Micro or Small Enterprises registered with District Industries Centers or Khadi and Village Industries Commission or Khadi and Village Industries Board or Coir Board or National Small Industries Corporation or Directorate of Handicrafts and Handloom or any other body specified by Ministry of Micro and Small Enterprises, the bidder shall be entitled for following:
i. Issue of Tender Documents to MSEs free of cost.
ii. Exemption to MSEs from payment of EMD.
iii. Micro and Small Enterprises quoting price within price brand of Ll+15% shall also be allowed to supply a portion of requirement by bringing down their prices to LI price in a situation where LI price is from someone other than a micro and small enterprises and such micro and small enterprises shall be allowed to supply upto
20% of the total tendered value. In case of more than one such Micro and Small Enterprises, the supply of 20% portion shall be shared amongst them. Further, out of above 20%, 4% (20% of 20%) shall be from MSEs owned by SC/ST entrepreneurs. This quota is to be transferred to other MSEs in case of non- availability of MSEs owned by SC/ST entrepreneurs.
b. The quoted prices against various items shall remain valid in case of splitting of quantities of the items as above.
c. MSE bidder shall submit the following:
i. Documentary evidence that the bidder is a Micro or Small Enterprises registered with District Industries Centers or Khadi and Village Industries Commission or Khadi and Village Industries Board or Coir Board or National Small Industries Corporation or Directorate of Handicrafts and Handloom or any other body specified by Ministry of Micro, Small and Medium Enterprises.
ii. If the MSE is owned by SC/ST Entrepreneurs, the bidder shall furnish appropriate documentary evidence in this regard.
iii. The above documents submitted by the bidder shall be duly certified by the Statutory Auditor of the bidder or a practicing Chartered Accountant (not being an employee or a Director or not having any interest in the bidder's company/firm) where audited accounts are not mandatory as per law.
d. If the bidder does not provide the appropriate document or any evidence to substantiate the above, then it will be presumed that they do not qualify for any preference admissible in the Public Procurement Policy (PPP), 2012.
43. VALIDITY OF OFFER:
Offer shall be valid for 3 months from the due date / extended due date of the tender enquiry.
44. INTEGRITY PACT:
All tenders shall comply with the requirements of the Integrity Pact (IP) if the value of such tenders is ₹ 1 crore & above. Failure to sign the Integrity Pact shall lead to outright rejection of bid.
GENERAL TERMS &
CONDITIONS FOR SUPPLY
100 of 170
45. ORDER OF PRECEDENCE
In case of any discrepancy between the conditions stated in the GPC (which is an integral part of the Order) and those specifically mentioned in the Purchase Order, the later shall prevail over the former.
46. GENERAL:
a. Deviations to Terms and Conditions shall lead to loading of prices or make your offer liable for rejection.
b. All resident/non-resident parties to obtain and furnish their PAN in order to avoid tax withholding at a higher rate. Even though the non-residents may not have permanent establishment (PE), branch, local office in India, they can apply with their foreign address.
For your information, the web address for applying for PAN in Form No. 49A to NSDL or UTISL online as given in the following sites:
(AO details for International Taxation are also available online).
i. http://tin.tin.nsdl.com/pan/index.html/
ii. http://incometaxindia.gov.in/
iii. https://incometaxindiaefiling.gov.in/portal/index.jsp
iv. http://www.utitsl.co.in/
c. GRIEVANCE REDRESSAL: There is a grievance redressal mechanism in HPCL for vendors participating in the tender, the details of which are available on HPCL’s website www.hindustanpetroleum.com.
d. PBG Format is attached with Chapter-9 ,Annexure-B.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0049 101 of 170
Chapter 5
A Terms and conditions for Installation, Testing and Commissioning B Terms and conditions for Training- Not Applicable. C Terms & Conditions for Annual Maintenance Charges- Not
Applicable
14495-00-PP-ITT-0049 102 of 170
A) Terms & Conditions for Installation & Commissioning /Erection, Testing & Commissioning
1) Bidder shall quote for Lumpsum charges of Installation & Commissioning as per SOQ. 2) Deleted 3) Deleted. 4) No payment will be made for travel days/period. 5) Bidder will be responsible for all liabilities towards corporate tax, personal income tax and
GST (as may be applicable) for their personnel deputed for the Installation & Commissioning job. Any variation (s), including statutory, shall be to Vendor’s account and the Owner shall not be liable for the same. Such tax(s) shall be deducted at source by Owner while making payments against each invoice.
6) Working hours prevailing at site, normally 8 hours/day – Monday through Saturday and
holidays as applicable to Owner’s site personnel shall apply. 7) Vendor’s supervisory personnel to observe/abide by the working conditions, safety codes &
Indian Laws. 8) Vendor’s personnel shall be required to reach site within 15 days from the date of intimation
by HPCL/ WorleyParsons India Pvt. Ltd. for the Installation & Commissioning.
9) Bidder to quote per diem rate considering the above provisions in e-portal of HPCL and for detail refer preamble to price Schedule. The Unpriced price Schedule (submitted along with Unpriced bid with prices blanked out) should contain the words ‘Quoted’ or ‘Not quoted’ or “Not Applicable” against each item.
10) For evaluation of bids, Installation charges shall be added to the rates quoted against
supply items.
B) Training- Not applicable.
C) Annual Maintenance Charges- Not Applicable.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0049 103 of 170
Chapter - 6
Bid Form & Price Schedule Formats
14495-00-PP-ITT-0049 104 of 170
BID FORM
To: (Name and address of Owner/Consultant) Date: Gentlemen, Having examined the Conditions of Contract and Specifications including Addenda Nos (Insert Numbers) the receipt of which is hereby duly acknowledged, we the undersigned, offer to execute job in conformity with the said Drawings, Conditions of Contract and specifications for the same (total bid amount in words and figures) or such other sums as may be ascertained in accordance with the Schedule of Prices attached herewith and made part of this bid. We undertake if our bid is accepted, complete execution for SUPPLY AND INSTALLATION OF CAR PARKING SHEDS FOR IPS1, IPS2 & IPS 3 LOCATIONS as agreed and specified in the IFB document. If our bid is accepted we will obtain the guarantee of a Bank in a sum not exceeding (10) % of the Contract price for the due performance of the Contract. We agree to abide by this bid for a period of 120 days from the date fixed for bid opening under Instructions to Bidders and it shall remain binding upon us and may be accepted at any time before the expiration of that period. Until a formal contract is prepared and executed, this bid, together with your written acceptance thereof in your notification of award (Letter of Award) shall constitute a binding Contract between us. We understand that you are not bound to accept the lowest or any bid, you may receive. Dated this Day of
Signature ………………………………………
In the capacity of duly authorized to sign bid for an on behalf of Witness: __________________ Address: __________________
Signature
Note :
1. Bidder to submit Bid-form on Company Letterhead duly signed and stamped by Competent Personal having power of attorney.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0049 105 of 170
REFER PRICE SCHEDULE UPLOADED
ON HPCL E-TENDER PORTAL:
https://etender.hpcl.co.in
14495-00-PP-ITT-0049 106 of 170
PREAMBLE TO PRICE SCHEDULE
S.N0 Description Unit Quantity
1
Supply and installation of Car Parking shed structure with integrated solar
panels and rain water harvesting system as per scope of work attached
with the tender document at MB Patnam (IPS-1) Booster Station
Location.
Nos 1
2
Supply and installation of Car Parking shed structure with integrated solar
panels and rain water harvesting system as per scope of work attached
with the tender document at JK Gudem (IPS-2) Booster Station Location.
Nos 1
3
Supply and installation of Car Parking shed structure with integrated solar
panels and rain water harvesting system as per scope of work attached
with the tender document at Bogaram (IPS-3) Booster Station Location.
Nos 1
14495-00-PP-ITT-0049 107 of 170
Sr. No.
Notes
1 Scope of supply including testing, inspection, documentation etc. shall be strictly as per Material Requisition and other documents which are part of IFB. Bidder shall confirm that he has noted the contents of the Preamble to the Price Schedule, Price Schedule, IFB, Material Requisition etc. and quoted the prices accordingly without any deviation.
2 Bidder must quote the price only in online Price schedule in e-portal of HPCL in line with above format. Bidder to clearly indicate 'Quoted' / 'Not Quoted' against each item description in the price column in the unpriced Price Schedule. Bidders to submit Price in the Price Schedule in their Priced Bid and Unpriced Part with indicating 'Quoted' / 'Not Quoted' in the Unpriced Bid.
3 Bidder confirm that he has noted the contents of the Preamble to the Price Schedule, Price Schedule, IFB/e-tender, Material Requisition etc. and quoted his prices accordingly without any deviation.
4 Bidder to quote firm freight charges in the space provided in the price Schedule in line with instructions provided in IFB document which shall be considered for evaluation and ordering.
5 Bidder must quote the price in enclosed Price Schedule formats only. The formats shall not be changed and/or retyped. For any deviation to the formats, offer may be rejected.
6 Bidder should quote only for the item for which he is approved with HPCL /Consultant. Bidder should indicate "Not Applicable" in the price Schedule against the items for which the bidder is not eligible to quote (based on their enlistment with HPCL/Consultant ).In case Bidder quotes for the item for which he is not enlisted with HPCL /WorleyParsons, that item shall not be considered for evaluation.
7 Quoted prices are firm and fixed till complete execution of the entire order and no variation on any account is allowed, unless otherwise categorically Specified in IFB.
8 Quoted Prices to include Mandatory Spares , Pre-commissioning / commissioning spares, all special tools and tackles & documentation, as per MR. However, bidder to provide list of two years Operational & Maintenance Spares along with Unpriced (Technical) Bid.
9 Bidder to note that Technical loading, if any, shall be as per loading criteria specified in the MR and the same shall be considered for evaluation. Hence, bidder shall quote accordingly.
10 Bidders to upload the Un-priced and Priced part of their bids strictly in the Un-priced & Priced folders respectively in the e-tender portal of HPCL
11 Bidder to provide item wise price as mentioned in online price schedule format. However, evaluation and ordering shall be done on Overall Lowest basis. Bidder to note that evaluation and ordering shall be done on Overall Lowest basis including Installation & Commissioning.
12 Bidder’s quoted prices shall be deemed to include bidder’s entire scope of work and all obligations and responsibilities, as mentioned in Material Requisition and IFB / e-tender documents, irrespective of whether the same are specifically covered in the “Description” under above price Schedule or not.
13 The Lumpsum charges quoted by Bidder for Installation & Commissioning shall be as per “Terms & Conditions for Installation, Testing & Commissioning" enclosed with the IFB. Lumpsum charges as quoted by the Bidder shall be considered for evaluation.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 108 of 170
Chapter - 7
Delivery Schedule
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 109 of 170
DELIVERY SCHEDULE Name of Bidder :
Bid Document No. : 18000010-HD-11994
Item: Supply and Installation of Car Parking Sheds For IPS1, IPS2 &
Item Description Delivery from the date of Letter of Award (LOA)
All items as per MR
For Supply, Installation & Commissioning - 04 (Four) months from Date of L.O.A
Note :
1. Above referred delivery period shall be considered for liquidates damages. 2. The above delivery for Items at FOR site basis shall be reckoned from the date of LOA
Signature & Stamp of Bidder
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 110 of 170
The detailed addresses of sites are mentioned in Annexure-V of Chapter-9
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 111 of 170
Chapter - 8
BRIEF SUMMARY
OF AGREED TERMS & CONDITIONS
(A T & C)
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 112 of 170
AGREED TERMS AND CONDITIONS
This questionnaire duly filled shall be returned along with each copy of Un-priced
bid. Clauses confirmed hereunder should not be repeated in the bid. ALL THE
COMMERCIAL TERMS AND CONDITIONS SHOULD BE INDICATED IN THIS
FORMAT ONLY. IF REQUIRED DETAILS INCLUDING DEVIATION TO GTC, IF
ANY, SHOULD BE INDICATED IN ONLINE DEVIATION FORMAT ONLY.
In view of the rejection clause no. 16.0 of Chapter-2, ITB, will be strictly adhered
to, bidders are advised to comply to the terms and conditions of the bid document
in the First Instance itself.
S.NO. DESCRIPTION BIDDER'S CONFIRMATION
1 Confirm Your Offer is in complete compliance with the scope of supplies as specified in the Bid document
2 Confirm you have quoted your prices strictly in the applicable Price schedule format (enclosed with the Bid document) along with Unit and Total Prices
3 INSPECTION : Confirm your quoted prices are inclusive of all testing and inspection requirements as specified in the bid document. However, in addition to Bidder’s own inspection, goods and services will be subject to inspection (stage wise and final as specified in MR) by Owner/Owner’s Consultant for which no extra charges shall be payable by Owner, since all travel, personal and incidental expenses of Owner’s inspectors shall be borne by Owner/owners’ consultant.
4 Confirm acceptance / compliance with the following conditions /clauses of the Bid document (i) Confirm price basis of your offer is
strictly in accordance with Cl. nos 1 and 2 of Chapter-3.
(ii) Confirm You have furnished Bid security
(Bank Guarantee) for the requisite amount in the required format as per
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 113 of 170
terms of bid document (iii) Confirm that You shall furnish Contract
Performance Bank Guarantee (Performance Security) as per terms of Bid document.
(iv) Confirm your Firm delivery period shall
be strictly as per requirement specified in the Bid Document.
(v) Confirm that Your offer will remain Valid
for acceptance for a period of 120 DAYS from the Bid due date or extended due date (if the same is extended).
(vi) Confirm that the quoted prices shall
remain FIRM AND FIXED till complete execution of Order
(viii) Confirm that the Force Majeure shall
be as per General Purchase Conditions
(ix) Confirm acceptance of Price Reduction
for delay in delivery as per Chapter-3 of Bid document.
(x) Confirm total acceptance to Payment
Terms as per Chapter-3 Special Conditions of Purchase
xi) Arbitration clause shall be as per
Special Purchase Conditions xii) Confirm that Defect Liability period
shall be as per Bid Document
5 Confirm Terms related to Taxes and Duties shall be as per Provisions of Bid document
6 All correspondence must be in English Language Only
7 Indicate dispatch Point
8 Confirm Basis Quoted prices are exclusive
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 114 of 170
of transit Insurance.
9 Indicate Rate of GST Tax payable extra on finished goods
10 Deleted
11 Deleted
12 Deleted
13 Statutory variation in GST during the contractual delivery period on Finished goods only will be to Owner's account.
14 Confirm, if there is delay beyond contractual delivery date for reasons attributable to Bidder, any increase in GST will be borne by the Bidder and any decrease shall be passed on to Owner.
15 Confirm, in case of delay in delivery, due to reasons attributable to Bidder, any new or additional taxes and duties imposed after contractual delivery dates shall be to Bidder's account.
16 Please confirm that you have not been banned or delisted by any Government or Quasi Government agencies or PSUs. If you have been banned, then this fact must clearly be stated. This does not necessarily be cause for disqualification. However, if this declaration is not furnished the bid shall be rejected as non-responsive.
17 Please confirm that you have filed in, signed and attached the enclosed “Proforma of Declaration of Black Listing/Holiday Listing” along with your Unpriced offer.
18 Owner reserves the right to make any changes in the terms and conditions of bid document. Confirm
19 The Bidder is required to state whether any of the Director's Bidder is a relative of any Director of Owner or the Bidder is a firm in which any Director of Owner or his relative is a partner.
20 (a) Confirm acceptance in Toto of the Terms and Conditions contained in the Bid document (i) Instructions to Bidders.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 115 of 170
(ii) Special Conditions of Contracts (ii) General Terms & conditions of Supply (iii) All other commercial documents /
attachments / Chapters of the bid document
(b) In case of reservations, confirm that
clause wise comments have been specified as annexure to this format.
(c) All the terms and conditions have been
indicated in this format (including Annexure, if any) and have been repeated in the Bid elsewhere. It is noted that terms and conditions indicated elsewhere including any printed terms and conditions shall not be considered by the owner
21 Bidder shall furnish details of the Concurrent Commitment with their schedule / expected completion dates.
22 Furnish Financial Turnover figures of last 3 years of bidder / manufacturer and or trading company (house) which ever is applicable TURNOVER
2014-2015 (2015) 2015-2016 (2016) 2016 - 2017 (2017)
In support of above Bidder shall enclose copies of its published Annual reports of preceding 3 years. Confirm compliance.
BIDDERS NAME :
ADDRESS :
SIGNATURE & SEAL:
FAX NO. TEL NO.: EMAIL:
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 116 of 170
Chapter - 9
Proforma & Annexures
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 117 of 170
1) Annexure-A : Bid Security Form (EMD)
2) Annexure-B : Performance Bank Guarantee (PBG)
3) Annexure-C : Letter of Authority for attending Pre-Bid and Subsequent Negotiations/Conferences
4) Annexure-D : Declaration Form
5) Annexure-E : Undertaking for Concurrent commitment
6) Annexure-F : Bidder’s Queries
7) Annexure-G : MSME/NSIC Certificate Details
8) Annexure-H : Bar Chart/Pert Chart Schedule for Construction
9) Annexure- I : Proforma for Details of Indian Agent 10) Annexure- J : Composite BG - Mobilization Advance, Security
Deposit / Retention Money/Performance Guarantee
11) Annexure-K : Bidder’s General Information
12) Annexure-L : Annual Turnover Form
13) Annexure-M : Integrity Pact
14) Annexure-N : Bank Guarantee Format for advance
15) Annexure- P : Technical Check list
16) Annexure- Q : Reference list
17) Annexure-R : Compliance Statement
18) Annexure-S : Grievance Redressal Mechanism
19) Annexure-T : Advice from supplier/contractor for E-payment
20) Annexure-U : Reverse Auction Clause.
21) Annexure- V : Detailed Addresses of sites
22) Annexure-X : Bank Guarantee For Security Deposit
23) Annexure-Y : Arbitration Clause
24) Annexure-Z : Details of P.F. Registration TDS / TAN / ESIC
25) Annexure-AA : Details of Plant and Equipment owned by Bidder
26) Annexure-AB : Details of Proposed Head Office and Site Organization
27) Annexure-AC : List of Technical Staff
28) Annexure-AD : Details of Measuring & Testing Equipment
29) Annexure-AE : Commercial Questionnaire
30) Annexure- AF : Check List for Submission of Bid
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 118 of 170
ANNEXURE-A
BANK GUARANTEE IN LIEU OF EARNEST MONEY DEPOSIT (On Non-Judicial stamp paper of appropriate value)
TO: Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (Address as applicable)
IN CONSIDERATION OF MESSRS. HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LIMITED a Government of India Company registered under the Companies Act, 1956, having its registered office at 17, Jamshedji Tata Road, Bombay-20 (hereinafter called “the Corporation” which expression shall include its successor in business and assigns)issued a tender on Messrs. ................................................ a partnership firm/sole proprietor business/a company registered under the Companies Act, 1956 having its office at (hereinafter called “the Tenderer” which expression shall include its executors, administrators and assigns) against Tender no............ dated .................... (hereinafter called ‘the tender’ which expression shall include any amendments/ alterations to ‘the tender’ issued by “the Corporation”) for the supply of goods to/execution of services for “the Corporation” and “the Corporation” having agreed not to insist upon immediate payment of Earnest Money for the fulfillment of the said tender in terms thereof on production of an acceptable Bank Guarantee for an amount of ₹....... (Rupees ................................. only). We, ................................... Bank having office at ..................................................... (hereinafter referred to as “the Bank” which expression shall include its successors and assigns) at the request and on behalf of “the Tenderer” hereby agree to pay to the Corporation without any demur on first demand an amount not exceeding ₹........... (Rupees ...................................... only)against any loss or damage, costs, charges and expenses caused to or suffered by “the Corporation” by reason of non-performance and fulfillment or for any breach on the part of “the Tenderer” of any of the terms and conditions of the said ‘tender’. 2. We,........................................ Bank further agree that “the Corporation” shall be
sole Judge whether the said ‘Tenderer’ has failed to perform or fulfill the said ‘tender’ in terms thereof or committed breach of any of the terms and conditions of ‘the order’ and the extent of loss, damage, cost, charges and expenses suffered or incurred or would be suffered or incurred by “the Corporation” on account thereof and we waive in favour of “the Corporation” all the rights and defenses to which we as guarantors and/or “the Tenderer” maybe entitled to.
3. We,................................. Bank further agree that the amount demanded by “the
Corporation” as such shall be final and binding on “the Bank” as to “the Bank” 's liability to pay and the amount demanded and “the Bank” to undertake to pay “the Corporation” the amount so demanded on first demand and without any demur notwithstanding any dispute raised by “the Tenderer” or any suit or other legal proceedings including arbitration pending before any court, tribunal or arbitrator relating thereto, our liability under this guarantee being absolute and unconditional.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 119 of 170
4. We,.......................................Bank further agree with “the Corporation” that “the Corporation” shall have the fullest liberty without our consent and without affecting in any manner our obligations hereunder to vary any of the terms and conditions of the said ‘tender’/or to extend time of performance by “the Tenderer” from time to time or to postpone for any time to time any of the powers exercisable by “the Corporation” against “the Tenderer” and to forbear to enforce any of the terms and conditions relating to “the tender” and we shall not be relieved from our liability by reason of any such variation or extension being granted to “the Tenderer” or for any forbearance, act or omission on the part of “the Corporation” or any indulgence by “the Corporation” to “the tenderer” or by any such matter or things whatsoever which under the law relating to sureties would but for this provision have the effect of relieving us.
5. NOTWITHSTANDING anything hereinbefore contained, our liability under this
Guarantee is restricted to.₹ ......... (Rupees....................................... only). Our liability under this guarantee shall remain in force until expiration of six months from the due date of opening of the said ‘tender’. Unless a demand or claim under this guarantee is made on us in writing within said period, that is, on or before .................................... all rights of “the Corporation” under the said guarantee shall be forfeited and we shall be relieved and discharged from all liabilities thereunder.
6. We, …………………………………. Bank further undertake not to revoke this
guarantee during its currency except with the previous consent of the “the corporation” in writing.
7.0 We,......................................... Bank lastly agree that “the Bank” 's liability under
this guarantee shall not be affected by any change in the constitution of “the Tenderer” .
8.0 “The Bank” has power to issue this guarantee in favour of “the Corporation” in
terms of the documents and/or the agreement/Contract or MOU entered into between “the Tenderer” and “the Bank” in this regard.
IN WITNESSW HEREOF the Bank has executed this document on this ........................ day of ………
For ........................ Bank
(by its constituted attorney) (Signature of a
person authorized to sign on behalf of “the Bank”)
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 120 of 170
ANNEXURE-B
BANK GUARANTEE FOR PERFORMANCE OF THE OBLIGATIONS OF
SUPPLIER / CONTRACTOR (On Non-Judicial stamp paper of appropriate value)
TO : Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (Address as applicable)
IN CONSIDERATION OF THE HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LTD. a
Government of India Company registered under the Companies Act,1956, having its
registered office at 17, Jamshedji Tata Road, Bombay -400 020 (hereinafter called "the
Corporation" which expression shall include its successors and assigns) having awarded
to
M/s ___________________________________________________ a partnership
firm/sole
proprietor business/a company registered under the Companies Act, 1956 having its office
at
______________________________ (hereinafter referred to as "the Supplier" which
expression shall wherever the subject or context so permits includes its successors and
assigns) a supply contract in terms inter alia, of "the Corporation's" Order No.
____________
dated __________________ and the General procurement conditions of "the Corporation"
and upon the condition of "supplier's" furnishing security for the performance of "the
Supplier's" obligations and/or discharge of "the supplier's" liability under and/or in
connection with the said supply contract upto a sum of ₹. _______________
(Rupees_____________________) amounting to 10% (ten percent) of the total contract
value.
We, ______________________ (hereinafter called "the Bank" which expression shall
include its successors and assigns) hereby jointly and severally undertake and guarantee
to pay to "the Corporation" in rupees forthwith on demand in writing and without protest or
demur of any and all moneys anywise payable by "the Supplier" to "the Corporation"
under, in respect of or in connection with the said supply contract inclusive of all the
Corporation's losses and damage and costs, (inclusive between attorney and client)
charges, and expenses and other moneys anywise payable in respect of the above as
specified in any notice of demand made by "the Corporation" to the Bank with reference to
this Guarantee upto and aggregate limit of ₹ ___________ (Rupees
__________________________ ) and "the Bank" hereby agrees with "the Corporation"
that:
1 This Guarantee/Undertaking shall be a continuing Guarantee / Undertaking and shall
remain valid and irrecoverable for all claims of "the Corporation" and liabilities of "the
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 121 of 170
Supplier" arising upto and until midnight of _______________ 2 This Guarantee/Undertaking shall be in addition to any other guarantee or security
whatsoever that "the Corporation" may now or any time anywise have in relation to "the Supplier's obligation/liabilities under and/or connection with the said supply contract, and "the Corporation" shall have full authority to take recourse to or enforce this security in preference to the other security(ies) at its sole discretion and no failure on the part of "the Corporation" to enforcing or requiring enforcement to any other security shall have the effect of releasing "the Bank" from its full liability hereunder.
2 "The Corporation" shall be at liberty without reference to "the Bank" and without
affecting the full liability of "the Bank" hereunder to take any other security in respect of "the Supplier's" obligation and/or liabilities under or in connection with the said supply contract and to vary the term vis-a-vis "the supplier" of the said supply contract or to grant time and/or indulgence to "the Supplier" or to reduce or to increase or otherwise vary the prices of the total contract value or to release or to forebear from enforcement of all or any of the obligations of "the supplier" under the said supply contract and/or the remedies of "the Corporation" under any other security(ies) now or hereafter held by "the Corporation" and no such dealing(s), variation(s) or other indulgence(s) or agreement(s) with "the supplier" or release of forbearance whatsoever shall have the effect of releasing "the Bank" from its full liability to "the Corporation" hereunder or of prejudicing rights of "the Corporation" against "the Bank".
4. This Guarantee/Undertaking shall not be determined or affected by the liquidation or winding up, dissolution or change of constitution or insolvency of "the supplier" but shall in all respects and for all purposes be binding and operative until payment of all moneys payable to "the Corporation" in terms hereof
5. "The Bank" hereby waives all rights at any time inconsistent with the terms of this
Guarantee/Undertaking and the obligations of "the Bank" in terms hereof shall not be anywise affected or suspended by reason of any dispute having been raised by "the suppliers" (whether or not pending before any arbitrator, officer, tribunal or court) or any denial of liability by "the supplier" or any other order of communication whatsoever by "the supplier" stopping or preventing or purporting to stop or prevent any payment by "the Bank" to "the Corporation" in terms hereof.
6. The amount stated in any notice of demand addressed by "the Corporation" to "the Bank" as liable to be paid to "the Corporation" by "the supplier" or as suffered or incurred by "the Corporation" on account of any losses or damages or costs, charges/and/or expenses shall be as between "the Bank" and "the Corporation" be conclusive of the amount so liable to be paid to "the Corporation" or suffered or incurred by "the Corporation", as the case may be, and payable by "the Bank" to "the Corporation", in terms hereof.
7. Notwithstanding anything contained herein above:
i) Our liability under this guarantee shall not exceed R.......... ii) This Bank Guarantee shall be valid upto and including .......; and
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 122 of 170
iii) We are liable to pay the guarantee amount or any part thereof under this Bank Guarantee only and only if you serve upon us a written claim or demand on or # before the expiry of 30 days from the date of expiry of this guarantee.
8. "The Bank" has power to issue this guarantee in favour of "the Corporation" in
terms of the documents and/or the agreement/contract or MOU entered into between "the supplier" and "the Bank" in this regard.
IN WITNESS Where of __________________ Bank, has executed this document at ________________ on _______________ 20…..____________________________ Bank (by its constituted attorney)
(signature of a person authorized to sign on behalf of "the Bank")
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 123 of 170
ANNEXURE-C
LETTER OF AUTHORITY
PROFORMA FOR LETTER OF AUTHORITY FOR ATTENDING AND
SUBSEQUENT NEGOTIATIONS/CONFERENCES
To. Date: HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LIMITED,
(Address as applicable) Attn...................................... Dear Sirs, We..................................................hereby authorize following representatives (s) to attend the Pre Bid meeting / Negotiation or for any other correspondence and communication against your Bidding document number No. ...........................for.................................... (Item Name)....................................... 1. Name & Designation : ......................... Signature............................ 2. Name & Designation : ........................ Signature............................ We confirm that we shall be bound by all and whatsoever our representative (s) shall commit. Yours faithfully,
Signature........................................... Name & Designation.........................
For & on behalf of............................
Note: This Letter of Authority should be on the letterhead of the Bidder and should be signed by a person competent and having the power of attorney to bind the Bidder.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 124 of 170
ANNEXURE-D
DECLARATION
(To be submitted along with Un-priced bid)
We (M/s. __________________________) hereby declare that we have not been
banned or delisted or blacklisted or put on holiday list by any government or quasi
Government agencies or PSUs.
We (M/s. __________________________) confirm that we are not on Holiday/ Negative /
Suspension / Banning list of HPCL on due date of submission of bid.
We (M/s. __________________________) confirm that we are not under liquidation, court
receivership or similar proceedings.
I/we also (Co. name), _________________________________________herewith declare that we are registered as MSME/NSIC/SSI or other _______________ (Please specify and provide supporting document).
I/we also (Co. name), _________________________________________herewith declare
that we are registered under GST with GSTIN No _______________ (Please
specify and provide supporting document).
Stamp and Signature of Bidder
Note : 1. If a bidder has been banned or delisted or blacklisted or put on holiday list by any
Government or quasi Government agencies or PSU, this fact must be clearly stated with details and it may not necessarily be a cause for disqualifying him. If this declaration is not given, the bid will be rejected as nonresponsive.
2. In case of Limited Liability Partnership, all partners should sign it. 3. This Declaration should be on the letter head of the Bidder and should be signed
by a person competent and having the power of attorney to bind the Bidder.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 125 of 170
ANNEXURE -E
UNDERTAKING OF ADEQUATE CAPACITY
An Undertaking from the Bidder Confirming that their Plant / Facility has Adequate Capacity to handle Concurrent Orders and the Supplies to be made to HPCL will not get delayed due to the concurrent orders from other Clients
PRESENT COMMITMENTS AS ON 31/05/2018
SR. NO.
CLIENT/ OWNER/ CONSULTANT
DESCRIPTION OF THE WORK & SITE
VALUE OF CONTRACT (In Rupees)
DATE OF COMMENCEMENT OF WORK
SCHEDULE COMPLETION PERIOD
%AGE COMP. AS ON DATE
EXPECTED DATE OF COMPLETION
REMARKS
Stamp and Signature of Bidder
Note: To be submitted on letter head of company.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 126 of 170
Annexure F
BIDDER’S QUERIES
SL. NO.
BIDDING DOCUMENT
SUBJECT BIDDER'S
QUERY OWNER'S REPLY
PAGE NO. CLAUSE
NO.
NOTE: Bidder’s Queries may be submitted online.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 127 of 170
Annexure –G
MSME / NSIC CERTIFCATE DETAILS
TO BE FILLED BY BIDDERS REGISTERED WITH MSME
TO BE FILLED BY ALL BIDDERS
1 NAME OF BIDDER
2 WHETHER REGISTERED WITH MSE : YES/NO,
IF YES PLEASE UPLOAD THE MSE
CERTIFICATE
YES/NO
2.1 NSIC/ MSE REGISTRATION CERTIFICATE IS
VALID
UPTO
2.2 MONETARY LIMIT OF NSIC REGISTRATION
CERTIFICATE
3 WHETHER ITEM QUOTED IS COVERED IN
NSIC / MSE REGISTRATION CERTIFICATE IF
YES. PLEASE MENTION THE ITEM NAME IN
NSIC / MSE CERTIFICATE UNDER WHICH
TENDERED ITEM IS COVERED
4 WHETHER YOU HAVE SUCCEEDED IN
SECURING ORDERS FOR SAME ITEMS (ITEM
QUOTED), IN COMPETITION (I.E. WITHOUT
PRICE PREFERENCE) WITH LARGE SCALE
UNITS DURING THE PRECEEDING 12
MONTHS FROM THE DATE OF THIS TENDER
(SAY : YES OR NO)
5 WHETHER FIRM IS OWNED BY SC/ST
ENTERPRENEURS (SAY YES OR NO) IF YES,
PLEASE UPLOAD SC/ST CERTIFICATE
Stamp and Signature of Bidder
Note to Bidder:
1. It is mandatory for all the bidders to provide above data, in case bidder is non MSE,
please mention “N.A”.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 128 of 170
Annexure –H
BAR CHART/PERT CHART SCHEDULE FOR CONSTRUCTION -
DELETED
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 129 of 170
Annexure –I
PROFORMA FOR DETAILS OF INDIAN AGENT –DELETED
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 130 of 170
Annexure –J
COMPOSITE BANK GUARANTEE FOR MOBILISATION ADVANCE, SECURITY DEPOSIT/RETENTION MONEY/PERFORMANCE GUARANTEE
(On Non-Judicial stamp paper of appropriate value) To:
Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (Address as applicable) IN CONSIDERATION OF MESSRS. HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LIMITED, a Government of India Company registered under the Companies Act, 1956, having its registered office at 17, Jamshedji Tata Road, Bombay-20 (hereinafter called "The Corporation" (which expression shall include its successor in business and assigns) having placed an order on Messers ............................ a partnership firm/sole proprietor business/a company registered under the Companies Act, 1956 having its office at .............. (hereinafter called "the supplier" (which expression shall include executors, administrators and assigns) vide order No.......................dated.............. (hereinafter called "the order" which expression shall include any amendments/alterations to "the order" issued by "the Corporation") for the supply of goods to/execution of services for "the Corporation" and "the Corporation" having agreed : a) not to insist upon immediate payment of Security deposit for the fulfilment and performance of the said order b) to pay "the supplier" as and by way of advance upto a sum of ₹ __________ (Rupees _____________________________ only) being ____% of the value of "the order"; c) that "the supplier" shall furnish a security for the performance of "the supplier's" obligations and/or discharge of "the supplier's" liability in connection with the said "order"; and "the Corporation" having agreed with "the supplier" to accept a composite Bank Guarantee for the mobilisation advance, security deposit, retention money and performance guarantee. We, .................................................... Bank having office at .......................................... (hereinafter referred to as "the Bank" which expression shall includes its successors and assigns) at the request and on behalf of "the supplier" hereby agree to pay to "the Corporation"without any demur on first demand an amount not exceeding ₹........... (Rupees.............................only) against any loss or damage, costs, charges and expenses caused to or suffered by "the Corporation" by reason of non performance and fulfilment or for any breach on the part of "the supplier" of any of the terms and conditions of the said "order". 2. We, ............................. Bank further agree that "the Corporation" shall be sole judge whether the said "Supplier" has failed to perform or fulfill the said "order" in terms thereof or committed breach of any terms and conditions of "the order" and the extent of loss, damage, cost, charges and expenses suffered or incurred or would be suffered or incurred
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 131 of 170
by "the Corporation" on account thereof and we waive in the favour of "the Corporation" all the rights and defences to which we as guarantors and/or "the Supplier" may be entitled to. 3. We, ................................. Bank further agree that the amount demanded by "the Corporation" as such shall be final and binding on "the Bank" as to "the Bank" 's liability to pay and the amount demanded and "the Bank" undertake to pay "the Corporation" the amount so demanded on first demand and without any demur notwithstanding any dispute raised by "the Supplier" or any suit or other legal proceedings including arbitration pending before any court, tribunal or arbitrator relating thereto, our liability under this guarantee being absolute and unconditional. 4. We, .................................. Bank further agree with "the Corporation" that "the Corporation" shall have the fullest liberty without our consent and without affecting in any manner our obligations hereunder to vary any of the terms and conditions of the said "order"/or to extend time of performance by "the Supplier" from time to time or to postpone for any time to time any of the powers exercisable by "the Corporation" against "the Supplier" and to forbear to enforce any of the terms and conditions relating to "the order" and we shall not be relieved from our liability by reason of any such variation or extension being granted to "the Supplier" or for any forbearance, act or ommission on the part of "the Corporation" or any indulgence by "the Corporation" to "the Supplier" or by any such matter or things whatsoever which under the law relating to sureties would but for this provision have the effect of relieving us. 5. However, it has been agreed between "the Supplier" and "the Corporation" that there shall be only one Composite Bank Guarantee for both the advance and security deposit performance guarantee/Retention Money @ of ____% valid till the end of the defects liability period as per the terms of the P.O. No. _______________ dated ______________ and that in proportion with the recovery of advance @ ______% per bill the same amount/value automatically stands credited to the defects liability account/security deposit or retention money as the case may be and will continue to be credited/treatedtill the entire advance of ₹ _______________________ is fully recovered from the running bills and from the date of full recovery of the advance of ₹ __________________ this guarantee automatically, shall stand valid towards the ____% retention money/defects liability, fully valid in all ® respects unto a further period of 3 (three) months, as per the Purchase Order of "the Corporation". 6. Not withstanding anything contained herein above : i) Our liability under this guarantee shall not exceed ₹ .......... ii) This Bank Guarantee shall be valid upto and including .......; and iii) We are liable to pay the guarantee amount or any part thereof under this Bank Guarantee only and only if you serve upon us a written claim or demand on or before the expiry of 30 days from the date of expiry of this guarantee. 7. We, ........................................ Bank further undertake not to revoke this guarantee during its currency except with the previous consent of "the Corporation" in writing.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 132 of 170
8. We, ......................................... Bank lastly agree that "the Bank"'s liability under this guarantee shall not be affected by any change in the constitution of "the Supplier". 9. "The Bank" has power to issue this guarantee in favour of "the Corporation" in terms of the documents and/or the Agreement/Contract or MOU entered into between "the Supplier" and "the Bank" in this regard. IN WITNESS WHEREOF the Bank has executed this document on this ............................. day of ...........................
For ........................ Bank
(by its constituted attorney)
(Signature of a person authorised
to sign on behalf of "the Bank")*
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 133 of 170
ANNEXURE-K
BIDDER’S GENERAL INFORMATION
Bid Document No. ……………………………………………………………… To Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (Address as applicable)
1.1 Bidder Name ____________________________
1.2 Number of Years in Operation:
____________________________________
1.3 Registered Address __________________________________________ __________________________________________
1.4 Operation Address if different from above: ___________________________________________ 1.5 Telephone Number __________________________________________ (Country code) (Area Code) (Tel. Number) 1.6 E-mail address __________________________________________ 1.7 Website : ____________________________________________ 1.7 Telefax Number __________________________________________ (Country Code) (Area Code) (Tel. Number) 1.8 Name & Mobile no. of Concerned person(s) ______________________________________________ 1.8 ISO Certification, if any (if yes, please furnish details)
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 134 of 170
2.0 GENERAL 2.1 Income Tax PAN No. of the firm. ___________________________________________________ 2.2 Provident Fund Registration No. of the firm. ____________________________________________________ 2.3 ESI Registration No. of the firm. ____________________________________________________ 2.4 GST Registration No. of the firm. _____________________________________________________ 2.5 GST Registration No. of the firm ______________________________________________________ 2.6 Excise Registration number, if any ______________________________________________________ 2.7 Excise Range _______________________________________________________ 2.8 Local Sales Tax No, if any _______________________________________________________
Stamp and Signature of Bidder
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 135 of 170
ANNEXURE-L
ANNUAL TURNOVER STATEMENT
Bid Document No. ………………………………………………………..
The Bidder shall indicate herein his annual turnover during preceding Three(3) years based on the audited balance sheet/profit & loss account statement.
Financial Year Annual Turnover (Rs.)
Networth (Rs.)
2016-2017 / 2017 2015-2016 / 2016 2014-2015 / 2015
AVERAGE ANNUAL TURNOVER FOR
LAST THREE YEAR
NOTE:
1. Networth means paid up share capital, Share Application Money pending allotment* and reserves # less accumulated losses and deferred expenditure to the extent not written off.
# Reserves to be considered for the purpose of networth shall be all reserves created out of the profits and securities premium account but shall not include reserves created out of revaluation of assets, write back of depreciation and amalgamation. *Share Application Money pending allotment will be considered only in respect of share to be allotted. Accordingly, the definition of Networth shall be as follows:
Paid up share capital XXXX Add: Share Application Money pending allotment XXXX Add: Reserves (As defined Above) XXXX Less: Accumulated Losses XX Less: Deferred Revenue Expenditure to the extent not written off
XX
Net worth XXXX
x. Bidder shall furnish necessary documentary evidence by uploading the documents in the e-portal of HPCL, such as notarized copies of audited Annual Report/Balance Sheet for last three (3) years as mentioned above, Original Certificate from Chartered Account indicating Turnover & Net worth.
Stamp and Signature of Bidder
Name of Bidder Company:
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 136 of 170
ANNEXURE-M
Deleted.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 137 of 170
ANNEXURE-N
BANK GUARANTEE FOR ADVANCES (On non-judicial stamp paper of appropriate value)
To, Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd., (Address as applicable) In CONSIDERATION OF MESSRS. HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LIMITED, a Government of India Company registered under the Companies Act 1956, having its registered office at 17, Jamshedji Tata Road, Bombay - 400 020 (hereinafter called "the Corporation" which expression shall include its successors in business and assigns) having placed an order on Messrs ___________________ a partnership firm/sole proprietor business / a company registered under the Companies Act, 1956 having its office at _______________________ (hereinafter called "the Supplier" which expression shall include its successors and assigns) vide Order No. ____________ dated _________ (hereinafter called "the Order" which expression shall include any amendments/alterations thereto as issued by "the Corporation") for the supply of goods/to the execution of Service for "the Corporation" and having agreed to pay the supplier as and by way of advance upto a sum of ₹. _________ (Rupees ____________________________________ only ) being _____ % of the value of the order in terms of "the Order" on production of an acceptable Bank Guarantee for an amount of ₹. ____________ (Rupees __________________________________ only) 1. We, ____________________ Bank having office at _________________ (hereafter
referred to as "the Bank") do at the request and on behalf of "the Supplier's" hereby agree to pay "the Corporation" without any demur on first demand an amount not exceeding ₹. _________ (Rupees ______________________ only) against any loss or damage, costs, charges and expenses caused to or suffered or would be caused to or suffered by "the Corporation" by reason of any breach on the part of "the Supplier" of any of the terms and conditions of the said order.
2. We, _______________ Bank further agree that "the Corporation" shall be sole judge
whether the said "Supplier" has committed breach of any of the terms and conditions of "the Order" and the extent of loss, damage, cost charges and expenses suffered or incurred or would be suffered or incurred by "the Corporation" on account thereof and we waive in favour of "the Corporation" all the rights and defences to which we as guarantors and/or "the Supplier" may be entitled to.
3. We, ___________________ Bank further agree that the amount demanded by "the
Corporation" as such shall be final and binding on "the Bank" as to "the Bank's" liability to pay and amount demanded and "the Bank" undertake to pay "the Corporation" the amount so demanded on first demand and without any demur notwithstanding any dispute raised by "the Supplier" or any suit or other legal proceedings including arbitration pending before any court tribunal or arbitrator relating thereto, our liability under this guarantee being absolute and unconditional. (We __________________ Bank further agree that the guarantee herein contained shall remain in full force and continue to have full effect so long as the said amount remains unadjusted, provided, however, the value of the guarantee shall
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 138 of 170
progressively reduce upon any adjustments being made by "the Corporation" against the said advance and "the Corporation" rights shall extend only to the value of the unadjusted amount.
4. We, __________________ Bank further agree with "the Corporation" that "the
Corporation" shall have the fullest liberty without our consent and without affecting in any manner our obligations hereunder to vary any of the terms and conditions of the said "order"/or to extend time of performance by "the Supplier" from time to time or to postpone for any time or from time to time any of the powers exercisable by "the Corporation" against "the Supplier" and to forbear to enforce any of the terms and conditions relating to "the Order" and we shall not be relieved from our liability by reason of any such variation or extension being granted to "the Supplier" or for any forbearance, act or omission on "the Supplier" or by any such matter or things whatsoever which under the Law relating to sureties would be for this provisions have the effect of relieving us.
5. Notwithstanding anything contained herein above: i) Our liability under this guarantee shall not exceed Rs.......... ii) This Bank Guarantee shall be valid upto and including .......; and
iii) We are liable to pay the guarantee amount or any part thereof under this Bank Guarantee only and only if you serve upon us a written claim or demand on or # before the expiry of 30 days from the date of expiry of this guarantee
6. We, ________________ Bank further undertake not to revoke this guarantee during
its currency except with the previous consent of "the Corporation" in writing. 7. We, ____________________ Bank lastly agree that "the Bank" liability under this
guarantee shall not be affected by any change in the constitution of "the Supplier". 8. We, _________________ Bank has power to issue this guarantee in favour of "the
Corporation" in terms of the documents and/or the agreement/contract or MOU entered into between" the supplier" and "the Bank" in this regard.
IN WITNESS WHEREOF the Bank has executed this document on this
________________ day of ___________________
____________________________ (FOR _________ BANK)
(by its constituted attorney) (Signature of a person authorized
to sign on behalf of "the Bank")
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 139 of 170
ANNEXURE-P
CHECKLIST-TECHNICAL
Requisition for Supply & Installation of Car Parking Sheds Project VVSPL Capacity Augmentation Project
Bidder confirms the following, as a minimum, is enclosed in the offer: Sr. No.
Requirement Complied by Bidder
1.0 Total compliance to technical requirements of the Material Requisition, as per Compliance Statement document, enclosed.
Yes/No
2.0 Bidder has quoted for all Schedules items covered in specification. Yes/No
3.0
Bidder meets Bidder’s qualification criteria (BQC) and documentary evidence in support of BQC is enclosed in the offer as per following, as a minimum:
Yes/No
a) Name & Location of Plant Yes/No
b) Past track record for Supply and Installation of Car Parking Sheds For IPS1, IPS2 & IPS 3 Locations as specified in BQC for the last seven years (i.e. copies of W.O./PO, Inspection release notes, completion certificate etc.)
Yes/No
4.0 Bidder confirms that for the items quoted by the bidder, the entire process of Medium Voltage Switchgear manufacturing shall be carried out in the proposed plant.
Yes/No
5.0 Documents/ Catalogues etc.as per specification enclosed. Yes/No
To be filled, signed and stamped by Bidder. Stamp and Signature of Bidder
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 140 of 170
ANNEXURE-Q
Reference List of Supply and Installation of Car Parking Sheds for IPS1, IPS2 & IPS 3 Locations for Last Seven
Years
1 2 3 4 5
SR No.
Client (Company Name, Address, Email ID, Contact Phone No.)
Year, Month, date of Work Completions
Purchase Order & Date Work Completion Certificate & Date
To be filled by Bidder.
Stamp and Signature of Bidder
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 141 of 170
ANNEXURE-R
COMPLIANCE TO BID REQUIREMENT
Requisition for Supply & Installation of Car Parking Sheds Project VVSPL Capacity Augmentation Project Bidding Document No 18000010-HD-11994
We hereby agree to fully comply with, abide by and accept without variation, deviation or reservation all technical, commercial and other conditions whatsoever of the bidding Documents and Addendum to the Bidding Documents for subject work issued by Owner/Consultant. We hereby further confirm any terms and conditions mentioned in our bid (Un-priced as well as Priced Part) shall not be recognized and shall be treated as null and void.
Bidder’s Seal Signature of Bidder
Name of Bidder
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 142 of 170
ANNEXURE-S GRIEVANCE REDRESSAL MECHANISM
1.0 Background
Hindustan Petroleum Corporation (HPCL) has developed the following mechanism to deal with references/grievances if any that are received from Parties who participated /intends to participate in the Corporation Tenders. The scheme is as under:
2.0 Definitions : Grievance
For the purpose of this scheme, the word ‘Grievance’ would mean a written and signed representation received from party, who has participated/intends to participate in the tender of the Company, seeking inter-alia a review of the process of finalization of tender on the grounds that his right as a party to the tender has been affected for the reason to be provided by him which needs to be examined and decided in the interest of equity.
Grievance Redressal Cell (GRC)
It is the group that will review the references received from the Parties and decide the matter.
3.0 Authorities to handle grievances 3.1 There will be a process to deal with the grievances received from the
tendering parties of the prospective tenderers based on the Tender document issued.
3.2 The first level, say Level-I of such process will comprise of a Grievance
Redressal Cell (GRC). This Cell will consist of the following:
Sr. No.
SBU/Function
Head
Member Finance Member Procurement (Co-ordinator)
Refineries GRCs
1
Visakh Refinery
Head-Refinery
Head- Finance
Head- Materials
2
Mumbai Refinery
Head-Refinery
Head- Finance
Head- Materials
Marketing GRCs
1
Retail SBU
Head-Retail
Head- Comml.**
Head- Proc.**
2
Direct Sales
Head-Direct Sales
Head- Comml. **
Head- Proc.**
3
LPG
Head-LPG
Head- Comml. **
Head- Proc.**
4
Aviation
Head-Aviation
Head- Comml.**
Head- Proc.**
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 143 of 170
* includes Marketing Projects, ** concerned SBU,
® *** concerned SBU/dept
5
Projects & Pipelines*
Head-P&P
Head- Comml.**
Head- Proc.**
6
Operaions & Distributions(O&D)
Head-O&D
Head- Comml.**
Head- Proc.**
® 7
Gas, Renewable & Business Develop- ment, Mktg SBU/dept
Head - Gas, Renewable & Business Development, Mktg SBU/dept
Head–Comml. ***
Head- Proc.***
Corporate GRCs
1
Corporate Head-IS/HR
(as applicable)
Head- Finance (Corp.)
Head- Procurement
(DGM-Administration)
® REVISION : PROC-004/23.12.2014
3.3 The Co-ordinator for each of the Cell is respective Head –
Materials/Procurement of Visakh Refinery, Mumbai Refinery, Marketing SBUs & Corporate.
3.4 All the grievances will be lodged with the Co-ordinator of the Cell. 3.5 This Cell will examine the grievances and decide the matter. 3.6 The second level of Grievances Redressal Mechanism is the Executive
Committee – Refineries for both Mumbai & Visakh Refineries, Executive Committee - Marketing & Executive Committee – Corporate for respective functions. The decision of the Executive Committee is final.
4.0 Grievances Redressal Process
LEVEL –I 4.1 If a grievance is received by the Grievance Redressal Cell, the Co-ordinator
will first acknowledge the receipt of the grievance to the aggrieved party within 48 hours from the time of receipt of the grievance (Excluding intervening Holidays).
4.2 The Grievance Redressal Cell (GRC) will forward the Grievance to the
Tender Inviting Authority at the earliest, who will offer his comments/views to the Cell within 2 days of receipt from GRC.
4.3 On receipt of comments from Tender Inviting Authority, the Grievance
Redressal Cell will meet and look into the grievances expressed by the aggrieved party along with the views/comments of the Tender Inviting
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 144 of 170
Authority. The Grievance Redressal Cell can call for relevant records and documents to enable it to firm up its decision on the grievance.
4.4 The Grievance Redressal Cell will decide the matter within 14 days and
thereafter communicate the decision to the aggrieved party.
LEVEL –II
4.5 The second level of Grievance Redressal Mechanism is the Executive Committee - Refineries for both Mumbai & Visakh Refineries and Executive Committee – Marketing & Executive Committee – Corporate for respective functions which would examine and decide on any appeal/ representation on the decision of the Grievance Redressal Cell.
4.6 Parties aggrieved by the decision of the Grievance Redressal Cell, can
appeal / represent to the Executive Committee within 7 days of receipt of the decision with a copy to GRC Level-I for co-ordination. Appeal received
after seven days will not be considered. 4.7 The EC will decide the matter in appeal within 14 days and thereafter
communicate the decision to the aggrieved party. The decision of the Executive Committee is final.
5.0 Time limitation for the handling of grievances 5.1 Grievances regarding the Pre-qualification process should be lodged by the
aggrieved party within one week from the date of Publication calling for pre-qualification bid Grievances received after one week from date Publication will not be considered.
5.2 The decision on Grievance pertaining to Pre-Qualification should be
finalized before the shortlisting of the parties is concluded. 5.3 Specific Grievances regarding the Notice Inviting Tender (NIT) should be
lodged by the aggrieved party within one week from the last date of sale of tender document or one week prior to the Due date for Bid Submission, whichever is earlier. Grievance regarding NIT, received thereafter shall not be considered.
5.4 Grievances relating to the tender process (other than “Notice Inviting
Tender related grievances”) should be lodged within one week the date of operating the unpriced bids.
5.5 The Grievance Redressal Cell shall examine the case and decide within 15
working days from the date of receipt of the grievance and advise the function concerned of the same so that they can process the tender further.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 145 of 170
5.6 Any grievance after price bid opening should be redressed before award of the contract No grievances shall be entertained which are received after one week of price bid opening.
5.7 The Co-ordinator of the Grievance Redressal Cell, on receipt of the
grievance by the aggrieved party, should inform the Tender Inviting Authority not to finalise the contract till the disposal of the grievance by the Grievance Redressal Cell. The grievance lodged should be disposed of within a reasonable period of 14 working days so that there is no undue delay in awarding the contract.
6.0 Interim Suspension of Tendering Process 6.1 After any grievance is received by the Co-ordinator of the Grievance
Redressal Cell, the Cell Members will meet and examine whether the tendering process relating to the concerned matter is to be suspended or not in consultation with the Tender Inviting Authority. The Cell will examine whether there exists a prima facie ground for suspending the tendering process and decide the matter. It may consult, if required, the Executive Committee as to whether the tendering process has to be suspended till a final decision is taken on the grievance.
6.2 The decision to suspend the tendering process or not and disposal of the grievance should preferably be taken by the Grievance Redressal Cell and/ or Executive Committee at the earliest but not later than 14 working days from the receipt of grievance keeping in mind the Schedule of activities connected with the tender concerned.
6.3 When it is decided to suspend the Tendering Process, the grievance should be examined and disposed off by the Grievance Redressal Cell & Executive Committee at the earliest, but not later than 15 days since it will be necessary to either continue with the tender as per earlier norms or it is decided to re-invite the tender with suitable changes.
7.0 Other General Provisions 7.1 A final written reply to the aggrieved party will be given by coordinator of
Grievance Redressal Cell / Executive Committee within 21 working days from the date of receipt of the grievance in line with the minute of respective GRC/EC.
7.2 The Grievance Redressal Cell / Executive Committee, while firming up its
recommendations, can seek the views of other relevant Department like Finance, Vigilance and Legal or any other Department concerned with the issue.
7.3 The Grievance Redressal Cell & / Executive Committee is entitled to give a personal hearing to the aggrieved party, if necessary.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 146 of 170
7.4 If a Grievance is related to a contract already awarded and acted upon, and
if the Grievance Cell & Executive Committee is of the view that the grievance needs review for remedial action for future tenders, it would submit its recommendation to the concerned SBU/Dept. head for future tenders.
7.5 Company’s Tender Grievance Redressal Mechanism will be displayed in its
Website in the Tenders Page. 7.6 The Grievance Redressal Cell & Executive Committee will maintain a
grievance register giving details of the tender number, date of receipt of grievance letter, nature of grievance in brief, details of the decisions taken and the date of communication to the aggrieved party.
7.7 The Grievance Redressal Cell & Executive Committee will also submit a
quarterly report on the grievances handled to the Committee of Functional Directors. A copy of Yearly Report will be submitted to the Board for information.
7.8 The relevant clause of Grievance Redressal Mechanism Procedure
should be incorporated in GTC of all Tender documents along with the name and address of the Officer-designate of the Grievance Redressal Cell/ Secretary of the concerned Executive Committee, to whom the grievance letter/ Appeal should be addressed to.
8.0 Integrity Pact
Notwithstanding the GRP guidelines above, the provisions of the Integrity Pact will be applicable independently to tenders of ₹ 1 Crore & above.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 147 of 170
Annexure - T ADVICE FROM SUPPLIER/CONTRACTOR FOR E-PAYMENT
(ON LETTER HEAD) Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (Address as applicable) Dear Sirs, The following is a confirmation/ updation of may bank details and I hereby affirm my our choice to opt for payment of amounts due to me under various contracts through electronic mode. I understand that Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited also reserves the right to send the payments due to me by a cheque/ demand draft/ electronics mode or through a banker. A) Supplier/Contractor Details
1. Supplier/Contractor Name
2. Supplier Contractor Code
3. Address (including Pin Code)
4. Controlling officer name/SBU: E&P
5. P.A. No.
6. E-mail ID
B) Particulars of bank Account
1. Bank Name
2. Branch Name & branch code
3. Branch Address (incl. Pin Code)
4. 9 digit MICR No. of Bank and Branch
(As appearing in the MICR Cheque issued by Bank)
(Please do not give multicity cheque book code Number)
5. Account Type (Saving/Cash Credit/Current)
6. Account Number (as appearing on cheque)
7. IFSC Code of the Branch (for RTGS)
8. IFSC Code of the Branch (for NEFT)
9. NEFT Code No.
I/we hereby declare that the particulars given above are correct and the complete and also undertake to promptly advise and changes to the above details to HPCL. If the transaction is delay or not effected for reasons of incomplete or incorrect information or banking delays. I shall not hold Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited responsible. I also agree for printing of the bank details on the cheque or DD if the payment is effected by cheque/DD. The charges, if any, levied by my bank shall be settled by me/us.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 148 of 170
Name (in capital) & signature of supplier / contractor
Authorized signatory
Date: Official rubber stamp
Note
1. Bank details (B.1 to 9) to be confirmed by the bankers. Such confirmation shall duly signed & stamped by the bankers. Supplier code, bank account number and RTGS/NEFT number required essentially.
2. Please enclosed cancelled /photocopy of a cheque
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 149 of 170
Annexure – U
Reverse Auction – Terms & Conditions and Procedure HPCL proposes to conduct Reverse auction for the items or schedules or on overall basis as specified in the tender. Please go through the Terms & Conditions and Procedure given below and submit your acceptance to the same by signing and uploading this document along with unpriced bid.
Terms and Conditions:
1. HPCL reserves the right to carryout ‘Online Reverse Auction’ with techno-
commercially accepted bidders for determining the lowest bidder for the requirements mentioned in this tender enquiry.
2. Online reverse auction shall be conducted by HPCL on a specified date and
time. The vendors shall be participating in the reverse auction from their own offices / place of their choice. Internet connectivity shall have to be ensured by the bidders themselves. In extreme case of failure of Internet connectivity, (due to unforeseen circumstances), fax/ E- Mail communication shall have to be made immediately to Purchase Dept. HPCL may decide to extend the bidding time, at their discretion, but not as the right of the bidder.
3. Bidders are requested to confirm their willingness to participate in ‘Online Reverse
Auction’ during their bid submission by confirming compliance to the Terms & Conditions and Procedure specified herewith. Please note that non acceptance to participate in the Reverse Auction process may lead to rejection of the bid without any further evaluation.
4. HPCL will pre-decide the commercial loading, if any, on the basis of the taxes
& duties quoted by the bidder, and loading on account of commercial deviations, if any. The loading factors shall be displayed in the portal prior to the date scheduled for Reverse Auction Event.
5. As part of Reverse Auction process, the Start Bid price shall be specified by HPCL
on Reverse Auction Portal, which shall be the lowest of the price bids submitted by the bidders on the e-procurement portal i.e. ‘Bids opened for RA event’ and HPCL’s in-house estimate. Please note that such priced bid opening shall be system driven and therefore bidder’s identity vis-à-vis quoted price shall be confidential.
6. In case of overall evaluation tenders, the Reverse auction shall be conducted on the
bottom line, net delivered cost. 7. Reverse auction shall be held for a period of 60 minutes and shall be
automatically extended by a further period of 5 minutes in case of receipt of any bid during the last 5 minutes of the auction period. This process shall continue until no bids are received in the last 5 minutes of the auction. Thereafter reverse auction shall get automatically closed. This shall be an automated process.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 150 of 170
8. Any time extensions due to Force Majeure or unforeseen circumstance shall be
granted at the sole discretion of HPCL. 9. Order may be placed on the lowest bidder, emerging out of the reverse auction process and
HPCL’s decision on award of contract shall be final and binding on all the bidders.
10. HPCL reserves the right to further rationalize the prices with lowest bidder for
reducing the price at any time before ordering.
11. HPCL reserves the right to cancel the reverse auction after event is scheduled but
before actual event taking place or after the reverse auction has completed in case of failure or any other reason. The reasons for cancellation shall be conveyed to all vendors.
12. In cases where tender is required to be cancelled after opening of priced
bid and identification of L1 vendor and Reverse Auction was also part of tender, reasons for cancellation shall be conveyed to all vendors.
13. During Reverse Auction Process, if no bids are received within the
scheduled/rescheduled date & specified time of the reverse auction, HPCL at its discretion can scrap the reverse auction and proceed with the opening of the Electronic priced bids submitted by the bidders. In which case HPCL shall display the bidder’s identity and original rates.
14. The bid on the Reverse Auction Portal will be taken as an offer to sell. Bids
once made, cannot be cancelled / withdrawn and the bidder shall be bound to sell the material/services at the final bid price, and as per the specifications mentioned in the tender. Should the bidder back out and not make the supplies as per the rates quoted or in case the material supplied/services is not as per specifications mentioned in the tender, HPCL shall take appropriate action as per the terms & conditions mentioned in the tender.
15. At the end of the Reverse Auction, HPCL will decide the successful bidder,
basis the evaluation criteria specified in the tender. HPCL’s decision on award of Contract shall be final and binding on all the Bidders.
16. HPCL shall not have any liability to bidders for any interruption or delay in
access to the reverse auction portal irrespective of the cause. 17. The participation of vendors in the tendering process shall be construed as
acceptance to the terms & conditions and procedure for the reverse auction until and unless the contrary is explicitly mentioned in the deviation sheet.
18. In case any bidder does not accept Reverse Auction Terms & Conditions and
Procedure, HPCL reserves the right to reject the vendor at the Techno-commercial evaluation stage.
19. In case a bidder agrees for reverse auction in the un-priced bid but withdraws
acceptance any time after tender due date & time, the EMD of such bidder may be forfeited along with rejection of offer at the sole discretion of HPCL.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 151 of 170
20. Once Auction is started, no communication from vendor is entertained.
21. The Bidder shall not involve himself or any of his representatives in Price
manipulation of any kind directly or indirectly by communicating with other suppliers / bidders.
22. The Bidder shall not divulge either his Bids or any other exclusive details of
HPCL to any other party.
23. HPCL’s decision on award of Contract shall be final and binding on all the Bidders.
24. HPCL can decide to extend, reschedule or cancel any Auction. If any changes are
made by HPCL after the first posting and the Bidder continues to access the site after that time, it shall be presumed that the bidder has accepted the changes.
25. HPCL shall not be responsible for any damages, including damages that result from,
but are not limited to negligence. HPCL will not be held responsible for consequential damages, including but not limited to systems problems, inability to use the system, loss of electronic information etc.
Reverse Auction Procedure
1. In case HPCL decides to conduct Reverse Auction, the qualified bidders would
be communicated on the same thru E-mails about the date and time of the Reverse Auction event. The Reverse auction event shall be conducted in the HPCL e-tender portal under link “Reverse auction”.
2. Reverse Auction shall be available to Bidder only after two factor authentication.
Initially vendor will login to the site https://etender.hpcl.co.in with his Login Id and password. Thereafter they shall click on the “Reverse auction” link in the portal to view/participate in ongoing/upcoming reverse auctions.
3. Brief procedure to participate in RA:
I. Bidders may click on “Reverse Auction”, followed by click on 'password' and
Download the encrypted password.
II. Save the downloaded password and open Signing Utility, Select action as
"Decrypt Reverse Auction Password".
III. Browse the downloaded file. Select appropriate certificate and click on Decrypt Password. Copy the password and paste in "Password" field and click on Reverse Auction.
4. HPCL will display Start Bid price i.e., Bench Mark price (which shall be the
lowest of the price bids submitted by the bidders on the e-procurement portal i.e. ‘Bids opened for RA event’ and HPCL’s in-house estimate), which shall be visible to all the vendors at the start of the Reverse Auction.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 152 of 170
5. Identity of bidders never gets disclosed during reverse auction process
6. HPCL shall specify the minimum amount/percentage by which the bidders can
reduce their bids at a time on the Reverse Auction Portal. This amount is referred as the ‘bid decrement factor’ and shall be specified by HPCL.
7. Bidders shall start bidding from this Bench Mark Price. The bidder can bid
lower than the prevailing Lowest Bid at any time during the event by one decrement or multiples of the Bid decrement.
8. The bidder shall be able to view the following values on his screen along with
the other necessary fields in the Reverse Auction:
• Item-wise Leading Bid in the Auction (Delivered Cost)
• Bid Placed by bidder (Delivered Cost)
• Bid value contemplated by bidder before submission(Delivered Cost)
9. Bidder can reduce his bid repeatedly during the auction period 10. Bidders shall be provided information on item wise pro-rated reduction in the
rates, for guidance.
11. Deleted
12. The Closing Price(s) offered by the bidders at the conclusion of the Reverse
Auction shall be valid for a minimum period of 30 days or as mentioned in tender, from the date of conclusion of the Reverse Auction.
13. In case of Item-wise evaluation tenders, any or all items may undergo Reverse
Auction separately at the discretion of HPCL.
14. Deleted
15. In case of SOR type tenders, where vendor has quoted a single percentage plus
or minus against the offered rate, the decrement shall be applicable on the bench mark value on base of 100 (i.e. it could be 107 in case of plus 7% or 94 in case of minus 6 percent). This value shall be delivered cost i.e. inclusive of taxes and loading factor.
16. HPCL reserves right to conduct single reverse auction for multiple items with
separate decrement option.
17. Deleted
18. Successful vendor shall be required to submit the final prices digitally signed and submitted as token of acceptance without any new condition other than those
already agreed to before start of auction.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 153 of 170
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 154 of 170
Annexure – V
Address of Site Representatives of HPCL
S.No Location Address
Location-in-
charge (LIC) Contact Person Contact details
1 VVSPL-
Visakha
VVSPL- Visakha:
Hindustan Petroleum
Corporation Limited:
VVSPL, Visakha
Dispatch Station, VR-
ATP area, Naval Base
Post,Visakhapatnam,
Andhra Pradesh- 530
014
Y V N
SHARMA,
DGM-VVSPL
C Pratap, Chief Manager-
Maintenance 0891-2858908
Project Office
K V Sreenivas Raju- Chief
Manager- Projects 0891-2858909
SURYANARAYANARAJU
N V - Senior Manager-
Projects
0891-2858902,
Mob-
+918885507755
Vikram Singh- Manager-
Projects
0891-2858902,
Mob-
+918881702111
Kilaru Vamsi Krishna-
Senior Project Engineer
0891-2858902,
Mob-
+919845262466
2 IPS-1
VVSPL, IPS-1:
Hindustan Petroleum
Corporation Limited
VVSPL, Intermediate
Pigging Station-1,
M.B.Patnam (V),
Nathavaram (M),
Narsipatnam (T)
Visakhapatnam
Andhra Pradesh- 531
115
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 155 of 170
3 VVSPL-
Rajahmundry
VVSPL- Rajahmundry:
Hindustan Petroleum
Corporation Limited,
VVSPL, Rajahmundry
Booster Station,
Korukonda-
Gokavaram Highway,
Gummaladoddi
Rajahmundry
Andhra Pradesh - 533
289
BANOTHU
KRISHNA,
Manager
Operations
BANOTHU KRISHNA,
Manager Operations
0883-2496602 ,
0883-2496595
Project office -Komma
Vikas Reddy 09493568286
4 IPS-2
IPS-2:Hindustan
Petroleum Corporation
Limited
VVSPL, CP station-115/
IPS-2
Guntupalli,
Kamavarapukota, West
Godavari
Andhra Pradesh- 534
449
5 VVSPL-
Vijayawada
VVSPL- Vijayawada:
Hindustan Petroleum
Corporation Limited
VVSPL, Vijayawada
Booster Station
Kattubadipalem,
Kondapalli
Krishna District,
Vijayawada
Andhra Pradesh- 521
228
RANJAN
BHOWMICK,
Chief
manager-
Operations
RANJAN BHOWMICK,
Chief Manager-
Operations
0866-2872606
6 VVSPL-
Suryapet
VVSPL- Suryapet:
Hindustan Petroleum
Corporation Limited
VVSPL, Suryapet
Booster Station
Imam pet village,
Suryapet, Nalgonda
District
Andhra Pradesh- 508
213
P ANAND
VICTOR ,
Manager-
Operations
P ANAND VICTOR,
Manager-Operations 08684-200558
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 156 of 170
7 SV-17
VVSPL, SV-17:
Hindustan Petroleum
Corporation Limited
VVSPL, Sectionalizing
valve station-
17Bogaram village,
Ramanapeta mandal
Nalgonda District
Telangana- 508 113
8 VVSPL-
Ghatkesar
VVSPL- Ghatkesar:
Hindustan Petroleum
Corporation Limited
VVSPL, Ghatkesar
receiving station
Ankushapur village,
Ghatkesar,Rangareddy
District
Telangana- 501 301
SURESH
KUMAR R,
Chief
Manager-
Operations
SURESH KUMAR R, Chief
Manager- Operations 040-939366689
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 157 of 170
Annexure-X BANK GUARANTEE FOR SECURITY DEPOSIT
(On Non-Judicial stamp paper of appropriate value)
To : Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (Address as applicable) IN CONSIDERATION OF MESSRS. HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM CORPORATION LIMITED, a Government of India Company registered under the Companies Act, 1956, having its registered office at 17, Jamshedji Tata Road, Bombay-20 (hereinafter called "The Corporation" (which expression shall include its successor in business and assigns) having placed an order on Messers ............................ a partnership firm/sole proprietor business/a company registered under the Companies Act, 1956 having its office at .............. (hereinafter called "the supplier") (which expression shall include executors, administrators and assigns) vide order No....................... dated.............. (hereinafter called "the order" which expression shall include any amendments/alterations to "the order" issued by "the Corporation") for the supply of goods to/execution of services for "the Corporation" and "the Corporation" having agreed : a. not to insist upon immediate payment of Security Deposit for the fulfilment and
performance of the said order b. that "the supplier" shall furnish a security for the performance of "the supplier's"
obligations and/or discharge of "the supplier's" liability in connection with the said "order"; and "the Corporation" having agreed with "the supplier" to accept Bank Guarantee for the security deposit.
We, .................................................... Bank having office at ............................................ (hereinafter referred to as "the Bank" which expression shall includes its successors and assigns) at the request and on behalf of "the supplier" hereby agree to pay to "the Corporation" without any demur on first demand an amount not exceeding ₹ ........... (Rupees.............................only) against any loss ordamage, costs, charges and expenses caused to or suffered by "the Corporation" by reason of non performance and fulfilment or for any breach on the part of "the supplier" of any of the terms and conditions of the said "order".
2. We, ............................. Bank further agree that “the Corporation" shall be sole judge whether the said "Supplier" has failed to perform or fulfill the said "order" in terms thereof or committed breach of any terms and conditions of "the order" and the extent of loss, damage, cost, charges and expenses suffered or incurred or would be suffered or incurred by "the Corporation" on account thereof and we waive in the favour of "the Corporation" all the rights and defences to which we as guarantors and/or "the Supplier" may be entitled to.
3. We, ................................. Bank further agree that the amount demanded by "the Corporation" as such shall be final and binding on "the Bank" as to "the Bank's” liability to pay and the amount demanded and "the Bank"undertake to pay "the Corporation" the amount so demanded on first demand and without any demur notwithstanding any dispute raised by "the Supplier" or any suit or other legal
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 158 of 170
proceedings including arbitration pending before any court, tribunal or arbitrator relating thereto, our liability under this guarantee being absolute and unconditional.
4. We, .................................. Bank further agree with "the Corporation" that "the Corporation" shall have the fullest liberty without our consent and without affecting in any manner our obligations hereunder to vary any of the terms and conditions of the said "order"/or to extend time of performance by "the Supplier" from time to time or to postpone for any time to time any of the powers exercisable by "the Corporation" against "the Supplier" and to forbear to enforce any of the terms and conditions relating to "the order" and we shall not be relieved from our liability by reason of any such variation or extension being granted to "the Supplier" or for any forbearance, act or ommission on the part of "the Corporation" or any indulgence by "the Corporation" to "the Supplier" or by any such matter or things whatsoever which under the law relating to sureties would but for this provision have the effect of relieving us.
5. However, it has been agreed between "the Supplier" and "the Corporation" Bank Guarantee for security deposit is Valid upto a period of 3 (Three) months beyond the expiry of the defects liability period as per the terms of the Order No. _______________ dated __________.
6. Not withstanding anything contained herein above : i. Our liability under this guarantee shall not exceed ₹ .......... ii. This Bank Guarantee shall be valid upto and including .......; and i. We are liable to pay the guarantee amount or any part thereof under this Bank
Guarantee only and only if you serve upon us a written claim or demand on or # before the expiry of 30 days from the date of expiry of this guarantee.
7. We, ........................................ Bank further undertake not to revoke this guarantee
during its currency except with the previous consent of "the Corporation" in writing.
8. We, ......................................... Bank lastly agree that "the Bank"'s liability under this guarantee shall not be affected by any change in the constitution of "the Supplier".
9. “The Bank" has power to issue this guarantee in favour of "the Corporation" in terms of the documents and/or the Agreement/Contract or MOU entered into between "the Supplier" and "the Bank" in this regard.
IN WITNESS WHEREOF the Bank has executed this document on this ............................. day of ...........................
For ........................ Bank (by its constituted attorney)
(Signature of a person authorised to sign on behalf of "the Bank")*
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 159 of 170
Annexure- Y
ARBITRATION CLAUSE
1) All disputes and differences of whatsoever nature, whether existing or which shall at any time arise between the parties hereto touching or concerning the contract, meaning, operation or effect thereof or to the rights and liabilities of the parties or arising out of or in relation thereto whether during or after completion of the contract or whether before after determination, foreclosure, termination or breach of the contract (other than those in respect of which the decision of any person is, by the contract, expressed to be final and binding) shall, after written notice by either party to the contract to the other of them and to the Appointing Authority hereinafter mentioned, be referred for adjudication to the Sole Arbitrator to be appointed as hereinafter provided.
2) The appointing authority shall nominate an officer/ retired officer of Hindustan
Petroleum Corporation Limited (referred to as owner or HPCL) or a retired officer of any other Government Company in the Oil Sector of the rank of Chief Manager & above or any retired officer of the Central Government not below the rank of a Director to the Govt. of India, to act as the Sole Arbitrator to adjudicate the disputes and differences between the parties. The contractor/vendor shall not be entitled to raise any objection to the appointment of such person as the Sole Arbitrator on the ground that the said person is/was an officer (employee) and/or shareholder of the owner, another Govt. Company or the Central Government or that he/she has to deal or had dealt with the matter to which the contract relates.
3) In the event of the Arbitrator to whom the matter is referred to, does not accept
the appointment, or is unable or unwilling to act or resigns or vacates his office for any reasons whatsoever, the Appointing Authority, shall nominate another person as aforesaid, to act as the Sole Arbitrator.
4) Such another person nominated as the Sole Arbitrator shall be entitled to
proceed with the arbitration from the stage at which it was left by his predecessor.
5) It is expressly agreed between the parties that no person other than the Appointing Authority or a person nominated by the Appointing Authority as aforesaid, shall act as an Arbitrator. The failure on the part of the Appointing Authority to make an appointment on time shall only give rise to a right to a Contractor to get such an appointment made and not to have any other person appointed as the Sole Arbitrator.
6) The Award of the Sole Arbitrator shall be final and binding on the parties to the
contract The work under the Contract shall however, unless suspended by the Owner, continue during the Arbitration proceedings and no payment due or payable to the concerned party shall be withheld (except to the extent disputed) on account of initiation, commencement or pendency of such proceedings.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 160 of 170
7) The Arbitrator may give a composite or separate Award(s) in respect of each dispute or difference referred to him and may also make interim award(s) if necessary.
8) The fees of the Arbitrator and expenses of arbitration, if any, shall be borne equally by the Parties unless the Sole Arbitrator otherwise directs in his award with reasons. The
lumpsum fees of the Arbitrator shall be ₹ 70,000/- per case for transportation contracts and ₹1,00,000/- for engineering contracts. Reasonable actual expenses for stenographer, etc. will be reimbursed. Fees shall be paid stage wise i.e. 25% on acceptance, 25% on completion of pleadings/documentation, and balance 50% on completion of arguments and receipt of award by the parties.
9) Subject to the aforesaid, the provisions of the Arbitration and Conciliation Act,
1996 or any statutory modification or re-enactment thereof and the rules made thereunder, shall apply to the Arbitration proceedings under this Clause.
10) The Contract shall be governed by and constructed according to the laws in force in
India. The parties hereby submit to the exclusive jurisdiction of the Courts situated at (say Mumbai*) for all purposes. The Arbitration shall be held at a place convenient to both parties and failing an agreement, the Arbitrator shall decide the venue. The Arbitration shall be conducted in English language.
11) The Appointing Authority is the Functional Director** of Hindustan Petroleum Corporation
Limited.
(Note:- * = Delete the bracketed portions after mentioning the correct place. )
** Procurement Authorities may mention, the proper designation whether Director-Marketing or Director-Refineries.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 161 of 170
Annexure- Z
DETAILS OF P.F. REGISTRATION TDS / Tan / ESIC
Bidder to furnish details of Provident Fund/TDS/Tan/ESIC Registration:
PF REGISTRATION NO. :
DISTRICT & STATE/ DETAILS :
We hereby confirm that the above PF/tds/Tan/ESIC Account is under operation presently and shall be used for all PF/TDS/Tan/ESIC related activities for the labor engaged by us in the present work (if awarded to us).
(SIGNATURE OF BIDDER)
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 162 of 170
Annexure- AA
DETAILS OF PLANT AND EQUIPMENT OWNED BY BIDDER AND AVAILABLE FOR IMMEDIATE DEPLOYMENT & LIST OF EQUIPEMENTS, TOOLS & TACKLES PROPOSED TO BE DEPLOYED FOR RESPECTIVE JOBS TO BE SUBMITTED IN THE FOLLOWING FORMAT. – DELETED
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 163 of 170
Annexure- AB
DETAILS OF PROPOSED HEAD OFFICE AND SITE ORGANIZATION –DELETED
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 164 of 170
Annexure- AC
LIST OF TECHNICAL STAFF - DELETED
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 165 of 170
Annexure- AD
DETAILS OF MEASURING & TESTING EQUIPMENT AVAILABLE WITH BIDDER FOR USE ON THIS WORK – DELETED
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 166 of 170
Annexure- AE
COMMERCIAL QUESTIONNAIRE NOTE: The Commercial Questionnaire has been posted online only for e-tender.
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 167 of 170
Annexure- AF
CHECK LIST FOR SUBMISSION OF BID
(COMMERCIAL PART)
Bidders are requested to submit the checklist duly filled-in along with original and each copy of “Unpriced bid”. This check list will facilitate the bidder to ensure that the necessary data/ information as called for in the bidding document has been submitted by them along with their offer. This, however, does not relieve the bidder of his responsibilities to make sure that his offer is otherwise complete in all respects:
Please confirm compliance and submission of documents by marking tick ( )
S. N0. DESCRIPTION COMPLIED/
SUBMITTED
1.0 Techno-commercial part of the bid with all the details have been submitted
Yes/No
2.0 Following details have been submitted in the Unpriced part:
i)
ii)
Covering letter
Power of Attorney in favour of the person who has signed the bid on stamp paper of appropriate value.
Yes/No
Yes/No
iii) Bid Security/ Earnest Money Deposit (EMD) as per the
Proforma enclosed with General Terms and Conditions for Works Contract.
EMD complies requirement of Yes/No
a) Speci f ied Bank Yes/No
b) A m o u n t Yes/No
c) V a l i d i t y Yes/No
iv)
Specific Experience as called for in "Qualification Criteria" of Notice Inviting Tender along with Annexure- AC of Chapter-9 – DELETED
Yes/No
v) Details of experience on works of similar nature executed during the last seven years as per Annexure-Q of Chapter-9
duly filled in all the columns against “Yes under column titled “Complied/Submitted”: Yes/No
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 168 of 170
S. N0. DESCRIPTION COMPLIED/
SUBMITTED
Vi) List of plants & equipments proposed to be deployed as per Annexure-AA of Chapter-9 – DELETED
Yes/No
vii) Site Organization Chart proposed as per Annexure-AB of Chapter-9 - DELETED
Yes/No
Viii) Annual turnover Statement as per Annexure -L of Chapter -9 Yes/No
ix) Compliance to Bid Requirement as per Annexure-R of Chapter -9
Yes/No
x) Reply to commercial questionnaire as per Annexure- AE
to ITB.
Yes/No
Xi)
xii)
Details of PF/TDS/Tan/ESIC Registration No. as per Annexure- Z to Chapter-9.
Fresh solvency certificate from your Bankers Date of Issue of this certificate should not be earlier than one year from the due date of opening of Techno-Commercial part.
a) Certif icate date
Yes/No
Yes/No
b) From (Name of Bank)
xiii) Organization Details:
a) In case of a proprietorship firm, the name and address of proprietor, and certified copy of "Certificate of Registration of firm".
b) In case Bidder is a partnership firm, certified copy of the partnership deed.
c) In case of company (whether private or public), certified copy of the `Certificate of Incorporation' together with certified Memorandum/Articles of Association.
Yes/No
Yes/No
Yes/No
xiv) Schedule of construction in the form of Bar Chart/Pert Chart- DELETED
Yes/No
xv) QA/QC Program relevant to this work Yes/No
xvi) HSE Program relevant to this work Yes/No
3.0 Confirm that proper page nos. have been given in sequential way in all the documents submitted along with your offer with Index. DELETED
Yes/No
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 169 of 170
4.0 Original copy of Bidding Document and its Addendum (if any), duly signed & stamped on each page by authorized bid signatory.
Yes/No
5.0 Price bid is submitted on-line
Yes/No
6.0 Confirm that any cutting/overwriting in the "PRICE-PART" has been signed in full and stamped. - DELETED
Yes/No
SIGNATURE OF BIDDER :
NAME OF BIDDER :
COMPANY SEAL :
14495-00-PP-ITT-0047 170 of 170
Chapter - 10
1. CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
Document No: 14495-00-HS-PLN-0001
2. TECHNICAL
(SCOPE OF WORKS No.: 14495-00-CI-SOW-
0005)
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 1 of 83
VVSPL CAPACITY AUGMENTATION PROJECT
Contractor HSE Management Plan
Project No: 403102-14495
Document No: 14495-00-HS-PLN-0001
16-Feb-17
I-Think Lodha Techno Campus, 5
th Floor, Tower B,
Pokhran Road No. 2 Thane (West) – 400607 Tel: +91 2266515700 Fax: +91 2267818000
© Copyright 2017 WorleyParsons
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 3 of 83
CONTENTS
1 INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................ 6
1.1 Purpose and Scope ............................................................................................................ 6
2 EVALUATION, ALIGNMENT AND LEADERSHIP ............................................................. 8
2.1 Evaluation of Contractor HSE ............................................................................................ 8
2.2 HSE Alignment and Leadership ......................................................................................... 9
3 PLANNING AND GOVERNANCE .................................................................................... 11
3.1 HSE Planning and Readiness .......................................................................................... 11
3.2 Change Management ....................................................................................................... 15
3.3 Governance and Assurance ............................................................................................. 16
3.4 Analysis and Performance Reporting .............................................................................. 17
3.5 Lessons Learned .............................................................................................................. 18
4 SUBCONTRACTORS AND SUPPLY CHAIN .................................................................. 19
4.1 Subcontractor HSE Selection........................................................................................... 19
4.2 Subcontractor HSE Planning and Readiness .................................................................. 20
4.3 Subcontractor HSE Management .................................................................................... 21
4.4 Procurement and Suppliers .............................................................................................. 21
5 HSE COMPETENCY AND TRAINING ............................................................................. 23
5.1 Safety Critical Positions ................................................................................................... 23
5.2 Short Term Service Employees ....................................................................................... 24
6 COMMUNICATIONS AND ENGAGEMENT ..................................................................... 25
6.1 Behavioral Based Safety - Serious about Zero (SAZ) ..................................................... 25
6.2 Employee Assistance Program (EAP) ............................................................................. 26
7 INCIDENT AND NEAR MISS NOTIFICATION AND INVESTIGATION ........................... 27
8 MINIMUM HSE STANDARDS AND FIELD PRACTICES ................................................ 28
8.1 Site Establishment and Access ........................................................................................ 28
8.2 Blasting and Use of Explosives ........................................................................................ 31
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 4 of 83
8.3 Communicable Diseases ................................................................................................. 32
8.4 Confined Spaces .............................................................................................................. 33
8.5 Control of Work ................................................................................................................ 34
8.6 Decommissioning and Demolition .................................................................................... 36
8.7 Drilling and Piling ............................................................................................................. 37
8.8 Earthworks ....................................................................................................................... 38
8.9 Electrical ........................................................................................................................... 39
8.10 Environment Licensing and Controls ........................................................................... 41
8.11 Ergonomics .................................................................................................................. 42
8.12 Excavation .................................................................................................................... 42
8.13 Fall Prevention ............................................................................................................. 43
8.14 Fitness for Work ........................................................................................................... 44
8.15 Hand and Power Tools ................................................................................................. 45
8.16 Hazard and Risk Field Based Tools ............................................................................. 46
8.17 Hazardous Substances and Dangerous Goods ........................................................... 48
8.18 Health Surveillance ...................................................................................................... 50
8.19 Health Promotion.......................................................................................................... 50
8.20 First Aid and Medical Treatment .................................................................................. 51
8.21 Injury/Illness Management ........................................................................................... 51
8.22 Lifting and Rigging........................................................................................................ 51
8.23 Lone and Remote Work ............................................................................................... 53
8.24 Mobile Plant and Mechanized Equipment .................................................................... 53
8.25 Performance Testing, Commissioning and Start-up .................................................... 56
8.26 Personal Protective and Lifesaving Equipment ........................................................... 57
8.27 Safe Work Conditions .................................................................................................. 58
8.28 Scaffold, Stairways and Ladders .................................................................................. 60
8.29 Simultaneous Operations/Activities.............................................................................. 60
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 5 of 83
8.30 Transport ...................................................................................................................... 62
8.31 Underground ................................................................................................................ 63
8.32 Waste Management ..................................................................................................... 64
8.33 Welding and Cutting ..................................................................................................... 65
8.34 Golden rules for reducing risks. ................................................................................... 66
8.35 SHE Passport – A Good practice guide. ...................................................................... 68
APPENDIX 1 - APPENDIX 1RELEVANT LEGISLATIVE AND AUTHORITY LICENSE CONDITIONS
APPENDIX 2- CONTRACTOR MOBILIZATION HSE TASK CHECKLIST
APPENDIX 3- APPENDIX 3CONTRACTOR HSE LEADING AND LAGGING KEY PERFORMANCE
INDICATORS
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 6 of 83
1 INTRODUCTION
Achieving successful HSE outcomes across our business is fundamental to WorleyParsons. Poor HSE
outcomes are unacceptable, and a major cost and risk to our people, our communities and our reputation. In
order to successfully achieve our vision of zero harm, it is necessary that we clearly outline our minimum
standards for operating.
This document aligns with the WorleyParsons framework and HSE standards, and provides an outline of the
key expectations and minimum requirements of our contractors and their subcontractors.
1.1 Purpose and Scope
The purpose of this HSE Specification is to describe the minimum HSE requirements to contractors for the
project. It outlines the expectations and provides the framework for achieving zero harm to people and
assets zero environmental incidents. Contractors and their subcontractors must adhere to these
Specifications and resource and budget accordingly.
1.1.1 Scope
This specification is applicable to the work that contractors and their subcontractors are engaged to provide
under WorleyParsons managed projects. It applies to the project at all contractor and subcontractor
worksites unless specified otherwise.
This specification will be subject to review and applicability in relation to any project/ contract work sites
where WorleyParsons does not have day to day responsibility for HSE.
This specification does not attempt to identify every policy, process, procedure or work practice to be
implemented for the safe execution of the work. This specification only identifies the most critical
requirements for each health, safety and environment discipline topic.
Each contractor and its subcontractors are responsible to identify and comply with all HSE legislation
applicable to its scope of work.
The commitments made by contractors in compliance with the Contractor HSE Specification applicable
requirements and other plans, processes and procedures must be costed and built into the contractor’s
proposal. This is to be documented adequately to satisfy WorleyParsons management that suitable and
sufficient provision for HSE resources and processes (including subcontractor) has been made during the
proposal.
Contractors are accountable for the HSE performance and compliance of all subcontractors they engage.
Contractors are therefore required to ensure appropriate selection, management, control and budgetary
processes are in place and implemented throughout the project. Subcontractors under the control of
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 7 of 83
contractors are required to work to all HSE requirements stipulated within this document as applicable to the
scope of works.
A list of Minimum Applicable Legislation, Country Standards and Codes of Practice has been
provided in Appendix 1.
.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 8 of 83
2 EVALUATION, ALIGNMENT AND LEADERSHIP
WorleyParsons expects dedication to the health and safety of people and property and the protection of the
environment from its contractors and their subcontractors. WorleyParsons acknowledges clear description of
critical HSE requirements is fundamental to consistently achieving successful project HSE outcomes.
WorleyParsons requires contractors and subcontractors under their responsibility to adopt, implement and
enforce practices and behaviors necessary for the safe and environmentally responsible performance of the
contract scope of works.
Each contractor’s executive management team must embrace and role model the project HSE values,
beliefs and responsibilities within their scope. WorleyParsons strongly believes that to achieve a strong HSE
culture within any organization, it must be led from an aligned and well prepared executive and senior
management team. A collaborative approach with our contractors will also promote internal learning and
development for both parties in further improving HSE performance.
Leadership communication and collaboration between WorleyParsons and contractor executive and project
management will occur early to align expectations, define roles, responsibilities and assess the HSE culture.
This process will involve considerable time commitments by contractor executive and project management
up front and throughout the various stages of the project to ensure alignment of expectations is maintained.
The initial alignment sessions will provide the basis for the development of the risk based contractor HSE
program, tailored to the outcomes from the HSE evaluation.
2.1 Evaluation of Contractor HSE
WorleyParsons evaluates the HSE capability and competence of contractor organizations to ensure their
ability to meet minimum HSE standards and deliver successful project HSE outcomes. Typically evaluation
starts with prequalification, however in cases where contractors have already been appointed evaluation is
focused on identifying any gaps the contractor may need to address prior to commencement of works.
2.1.1 HSE Prequalif ication and Evaluation
Contractors will be assessed for their alignment to WorleyParsons and project HSE objectives, and their
ability to meet minimum HSE standards. Typically this will be done through prequalification and may involve
desktop review of contractor documentation, statistics, references, site visits and interviews of key
personnel. Contractors must in turn prequalify their subcontractors.
Regardless of whether HSE prequalification is undertaken by WorleyParsons, all contractors working under
the management of WorleyParsons are evaluated to determine their ability to deliver zero harm outcomes.
Any identified areas of weakness are addressed within a tailored management strategy for the contractor.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 9 of 83
2.2 HSE Alignment and Leadership
When project leadership takes personal accountability for HSE it leads to successful HSE outcomes. This is
underpinned by corporate leadership prioritizing HSE, both within WorleyParsons and within our contractor
organizations. In recognition of this, and in order to best set up our projects and our contractors to succeed a
series of alignment workshops are run, initially with contractor executive and project leadership and later with
the entire contractor and subcontractor workforce.
2.2.1 HSE Leadership and Recognition
WorleyParsons expects from contractor executive their full commitment to a strong and proactive culture.
WorleyParsons requires contractor executive management to adopt, implement and enforce rules and
practices necessary for the safe and environmentally responsible performance of the contract scope of
works. The contractor executive management team must be the first to embrace and be the role model for
the project HSE values, beliefs and responsibilities within their scope. Leadership communication and
collaboration between WorleyParsons and contractor executive and project management will occur early to
align expectations and define responsibilities.
Contractor executive shall ensure overall responsibility to provide a safe workplace during the term of the
contract. In meeting this commitment contractor executive shall ensure:
• The contractor HSE Policy is in place, articulated to the whole workforce and reviewed annually;
• Consultation and engagement with personnel and subcontractors to ensure project alignment is
conducted regularly;
• HSE compliance and resource provisions are clearly outlined in project budgets covering personnel
and subcontractors;
• Frequent monitoring of HSE performance and regulatory compliance is conducted and appropriate
action taken where required; and
• Contractor executive are visible role models in HSE performance.
2.2.1.1 V ISIBLE HSE LEADERSHIP
Contractors must develop their own HSE leadership program outlining and defining visible HSE leadership
activities which should include personal HSE Key Performance Indicators, site visit programs, engagement
with personnel, participation in behavioral based programs such as Serious About Zero (SAZ), response to
incidents, stewarding the implementation of improvement initiatives, action plans to improve HSE
performance and celebrating success (recognition). It must be clear in the program who from outside of the
immediate project team is participating.
Additionally, it must be outlined how contractor corporate/ executive management is to engage, and be
visible to their crews working on the project. Contractor HSE programs must incorporate any subcontractors
as applicable.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 10 of 83
2.2.1.2 RECOGNITION PROGRAMS
Contractors must develop and implement an HSE recognition program for the duration of work. The
recognition program shall focus primarily on leading HSE indicators, HSE behaviors and actions by teams
and individuals. The program shall be tailored to achieve the established objectives and desired outcomes
that give due consideration to the local culture, norms and values.
Contractors shall describe the structured means that it will utilize which serves as the basis for determining
recognition, active line management and worker/subcontractor participation and achievement of
performance indicators.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 11 of 83
3 PLANNING AND GOVERNANCE
3.1 HSE Planning and Readiness
Project specific pre and post mobilization deliverables, tasks and activities must be established and
documented for the contractor scope of works, and must as a minimum meet the requirements outlined in
this document. Any contractual, legislative or project specific HSE requirements must be identified and
addressed during planning, along with minimum site setup HSE requirements, including medical and
security arrangements. Contractor HSE budgeting, resourcing and delegations must be confirmed adequate
in line with the requirements of this document.
Formal review that all HSE requirements have been successfully met is undertaken during the readiness
review (described further below).
3.1.1 HSE Risk Assessment
It is a requirement to conduct a scope specific HSE risk assessment to detail the HSE risks, controls and
mitigating action plans for the contractor and subcontractor scope with WorleyParsons construction and HSE
personnel as an input to contractor planning. Controls must be identified for all extreme and high risks and
incorporated into HSE planning and programs.
The contractor will also be expected to participate in an overall project HSE risk assessment.
The WorleyParsons Risk Management Process is based on International Standard ISO 31000, “Risk
Management- Principles and guidelines”. The use of an alternate process by the contractor needs to be
endorsed by WorleyParsons. The WorleyParsons process concentrates on a qualitative assessment of risks
and the development by the contractor of a Risk Register and Action Plan to manage and control identified
risks
The contractor shall describe and implement a systematic and structured hazard and risk management
process to identify, assess and manage HSE risks to As Low As Reasonably Practicable (ALARP)
throughout all stages of the project (i.e. execution planning, pre/post mobilization through to worksite
execution) associated with its scope. The contractor shall describe how its hazard and risk management
process is integrated into all key discipline activities (i.e. engineering, procurement, construction,
maintenance and pre-commissioning) associated with its scope.
The contractor shall ensure their risk assessment processes conducted (and resulting risk register)
incorporate the subcontractor activities and together are integrated to any overarching project risk
assessment process conducted by the WorleyParsons project team. The contractor will be required to
participate in any project overarching risk assessment process and shall ensure appropriate resources, time
and budget is allowed for follow up of issues which arise during the process. Based on the HSE risk
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 12 of 83
assessment outcomes, the contractor shall identify specific HSE programs/initiatives needed that are not
already covered by the WorleyParsons project program.
These may include but not limited to identify programs/initiatives around:
• High risk activities
• Physical, chemical and other hazards
• Medical surveillance requirements
• Construction environmental impact
• Project security
• Emergency action and response
• Special training requirements
High and extreme HSE risks may require notification to the Project HSE Manager and status reporting at
project reviews. The risk register and progress on action plans shall be an integral component of the project
readiness reviews.
3.1.2 HSE Planning
The Contractor Mobilization HSE Task Checklist contained in Appendix 1 outlines the requirements to be
addressed during planning which cumulatively build up the HSE program. The progress of the HSE program
should be tracked within an HSE s-curve.
The contractor shall prepare and submit to WorleyParsons for review and approval a Project Health, Safety
and Environment Management Plan outlining how the contractor shall manage HSE, address any extreme
or high risks identified in the Risk Assessment, and make clear all HSE procedures, forms and other control
documents that will be used on the project.
On projects where non-WorleyParsons, or hybrid, systems are adopted by the contractor, Bridging Plans will
be required to provide a comparison of each system element to demonstrate that the WorleyParsons
minimum standards have been achieved. This includes projects where the contractor requires the use of
their HSE management systems.
3.1.2.1 REGULATION
The contractor shall always remain in compliance with its obligations as required under local/state/federal
legislation governing the conduct of their work on the project. The contractor is required to identify and
familiarize with applicable statutory acts, regulations and codes applicable to the scope. The
contractor shall identify and familiarize with statutory licensing and or permit requirements and maintain
currency with the applicable licenses and or permits for the duration of the project.
The project scope of work may require compliance with applicable industry, customer specific codes of
practice and/or accreditation schemes. The contractor shall identify and maintain compliance and
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 13 of 83
accreditation with these as applicable to the scope of works and throughout the term of the project where
required.
The contractor may be required to establish liaison protocols and communication with the regulators. A
register of HSE compliance shall be maintained by the contractor and be incorporated with HSE KPI’s
reporting at applicable performance review meetings.
3.1.2.2 HSE POLICIES
The HSE Plan shall include current copies of the contractor Health, Safety and Environmental Policy and all
other related policies as appendices.
The HSE Plan shall include a statement confirming that the Policy statement shall be made available to all
customer, WorleyParsons, contractor and subcontractor personnel and shall be explained as part of their
HSE induction and periodically reviewed by the contractor management for project compliance and
alignment to WorleyParsons HSE requirements.
3.1.2.3 CONTRACTOR HEALT H SAFETY AND ENVIRONMENT MANAGEMENT PLAN
In accordance with the general requirements defined within this document, the contractor shall prepare and
submit a Project Health, Safety and Environment Management Plan to WorleyParsons for review and
approval after Contract Award. The contractor Project Health, Safety and Environment Management Plan
shall describe how the contractor will manage project health, safety and environmental considerations
across all its work sites. The contractor shall ensure adequate budget is allocated for the delivery of the HSE
Plan.
The contractor may utilize a Project Health, Safety and Environment Management Plan structure that aligns
with the contractor internal current management system requirements and which is known and understood
within its organization. The contractor shall develop and include a compliance matrix which demonstrates
the linkage between WorleyParsons Health, Safety and Environment requirements as defined within the
Contract to the relevant sections of the contractor Health, Safety and Environment Management Plan as an
attachment.
Where requested the contractor shall develop a specific Environmental Management Plan that describes its
arrangements (i.e. processes, procedures and work practices) for managing environmental issues and
associated risks in accordance with all applicable licenses, permits and approval conditions issued by the
applicable regulator.
The Health and Safety Management Plan must address:
• Contract conditions and requirements;
• HSE roles of key parties, and the HSE responsibilities and levels of authority of key project persons;
• Outcomes of the risk assessment (with emphasis on extreme and high risks and control mitigation
measures);
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 14 of 83
• Evaluation outcomes of contractor/ sub-contractor experience and HSE performance where
relevant;
• Outline of the reporting system (leading, lagging key performance indications (KPI’s), incidents,
reward and recognition);
• Outline of the project HSE leadership program, including KPIs and incorporating the HSE alignment
strategy with integration of alignment activities;
• Identification of the legislative, regulatory and other requirements governing HSE matters on the
project and escalation of breaches or material risks;
• Align and reference the HSE methods, processes and tools to be used during the project; and
• Competency, induction and training requirements
For projects with field execution, HSE planning must also
• Take account of site establishment (i.e. input to camp/ accommodation layout, medical, hygiene,
messing, waste, traffic management, site security, environmental management);
• Site HSE rules;
• Emergency response plans;
• Remote sites; and
• Demobilisation
The contractor shall ensure their HSE Plan is integrated to any overarching project HSE Management Plan
as implemented by the WorleyParsons project team.
3.1.2.4 HSE ORGANIZAT ION AND RESOURCES
A risk based resource allocation process shall be used by the contractor to define the roles, responsibilities
and composition for the organization. This process shall be reflective of the required management control
measures to be implemented as identified outcomes from the contractor risk assessments.
In defining the contractor organization composition the level of risk based resourcing and supervision shall
include consideration of the following:
• Type of work to be undertaken;
• The overall level of risk within the scope of works;
• Competency requirements of roles;
• Numbers of personnel engaged overall within the project;
• Cultural and language barriers; and level of HSE sophistication within contractor and subcontractor
organizations
In establishing the risk based resource allocation the contractor shall ensure:
• The contractor HSE Plan clearly defines roles and responsibilities for the implementation of HSE
arrangements (i.e. processes, procedures, key activities, etc.);
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 15 of 83
• Roles and Responsibilities shall be provided for all contractor key project management and
supervision (i.e. Project Manager, Relevant Discipline Managers and Line Supervision) through to
worker level personnel; and
• Roles and responsibilities shall be included for contractor corporate or other management positions
that contribute whether full time or part time to the project HSE management for services under the
contract.
The contractor shall define the structured method of how roles and responsibilities are formally
communicated to their personnel.
A copy of and/or reference to a HSE organization chart shall be included as an appendage to the contractor
HSE Plan. The contractor shall provide the names and CV’s of proposed HSE professionals, project team
managers and supervisors who will be engaged on the project for review and approval by WorleyParsons
prior to commencing.
3.1.3 Readiness Reviews
The project will undertake a review of the contractor preparedness prior to their mobilization, and again post
mobilization to determine readiness for field execution works. These reviews are undertaken to ensure that
the required contractor HSE planning, preparation and resourcing is in place, and will include the contractor
project HSE program and agreed pre/post mobilization HSE deliverables. Reviews will be tailored to the
contractor scope of work (including subcontractor activities), HSE risk and outcomes from evaluation and
alignment workshops, and the contractor HSE Strategy, (an outcome from the maturity evaluation which will
tie back to the evaluation of strengths and weaknesses), with the emphasis on improvement measures
undertaken to identified weaknesses.
Typically readiness reviews occur in two parts: a review of the contractor preparedness prior to their
mobilization, and again post mobilization to determine readiness for field execution works.
Should the contractor be found to be underprepared pre mobilization, the contractor must provide to
WorleyParsons a proposal from their executive management defining how the identified gaps will be rectified
and by when. If a post mobilization readiness review finds that the contractor is not ready, then field work
cannot commence by the contractor without the written permission from WorleyParsons.
The Contractor Mobilization HSE Task Checklist contained in Appendix 1 will be used in assessing the
contractor status in relation to the pre and post mobilization readiness review processes.
3.2 Change Management
Effective change management is crucial to effective project delivery. All project related temporary and
permanent changes to personnel, systems, procedures, equipment, technology, products and materials,
physical environment and legislation shall be identified and managed by the contractor to ensure HSE risks
arising from these changes remain at an acceptable level.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 16 of 83
Change management procedures shall be established by the contractor including risk identification,
assessment, the development of control measures and recording and tracking of any change which has the
potential to affect the health and safety of people or the environment.
The risk assessment of a change is appropriate to the nature of the change and the exposure associated
with it. The risks and impacts arising from changes are communicated to relevant stakeholders, monitored
and managed; and personnel impacted are appropriately trained.
The contractor process for managing changes shall address the authority for approval of changes,
compliance with all relevant regulations, applicable standards and permits, licence or authority requirements,
documentation (including reasons for the changes), deadlines and training requirements. Records for all
change management activity are retained
Contractor systems shall ensure change management actions have been completed, their intended
outcomes validated, relevant systems and documentation, (including drawings) updated and any unintended
risks identified and managed.
The original project scope and duration for temporary changes shall not exceed original authorisation without
formal WorleyParsons review and approval.
3.3 Governance and Assurance
Ongoing alignment sessions will be held between WorleyParsons and the contactor in maintaining a clear
view of the project HSE deliverables. The contractor HSE program s-curve is a key control document for
tracking the progress of HSE activities and milestones and will be used along with agreed leading and
lagging performance indicators to evaluate the contractor’s progress.
3.3.1 Assurance (audits and actions)
WorleyParsons will undertake HSE assessments (audits) for the contractor engaged on WorleyParsons
managed projects. Assessments on projects with a field execution component will include evaluation of key
field practices and tools such as the hazard identification process, Serious About Zero conversations, reward
and recognition, job starts, pre-task talks, step back and JHA. Assessment of the effectiveness of key HSE
management, reporting and leadership processes will also be appraised. The WorleyParsons assurance
program will include peer reviews, and may be integrated with other functions such as quality and security
(R3).
WorleyParsons will conduct annual HSE assessments or at a greater frequency as determined by
WorleyParsons depending upon the scope activities and Health and Safety performance of Contractor.
Outcomes from assurance activity will be communicated to Project Management, and as applicable the
contractor project and executive management.
It is expected in turn that the contractor develop and deploy a project assurance plan and schedule to
undertake self-assessment, and assessment of subcontractor HSE performance. The contractor shall define
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 17 of 83
the types, frequency, location and assessor of the various HSE assessments to be conducted during the
execution of the work. Key focus areas will be those defined ‘high risk’ activities as determined from the risk
assessments undertaken and on HSE performance incurred during the project.
In the development of the contractor assessment plan, the following must be considered:
• WorleyParsons and contractor shall participate in jointly held HSE assessments;
• The contractor shall conduct HSE assessments on a minimum quarterly basis;
• Each HSE assessment shall include a Terms of Reference that details objectives, scope,
boundaries, timing methodology, facilitator roles, reporting, etc.;
• A kick off meeting with key the contractor personnel prior to commencement;
• A debrief meeting upon completion to communicate preliminary findings, observations and
suggestions;
• A written report that describes the findings, observations and Corrective / Improvement Actions;
• All corrective / improvement actions to entered into the AIM database, or other agreed project action
tracking database to monitor status of action close out;
• The contractor shall take responsibility to verify the effectiveness of actions taken in the field; and
• The contractor to share the results of HSE assessments with WorleyParsons.
3.3.2 Inspections and Monitoring
A program of Health, Safety and Environmental site inspections shall be established, implemented and
maintained by the contractor. The program of inspections shall cumulatively address all significant hazards /
environmental aspects and their associated controls.
The frequency and specific nature of each inspection shall be appropriate to the nature of the workplace and
the hazards and environmental aspects associated with the scope of works. All inspections shall be led by
an appropriate member of the contractor line management, with others in attendance as necessary.
All inspections shall be documented in a form that is appropriate to the needs of the workplace. It is
recommended that inspections are conducted using a checklist as an aide to those conducting the
inspections of focus areas / topics. Actions arising from inspections are to be entered into AIM, or other
agreed project action tracking database and stewarded by the appropriate level of contractor management
and actions are closed out in a timely manner.
The contractor shall be prepared to discuss the results at the progress meeting with WorleyParsons.
3.4 Analysis and Performance Reporting
Contractors shall measure, assimilate and report leading and lagging indicator performance applicable to the
scope of works and level of risk. The indicators shall be incorporated within the contractor HSE Plan
together with the outline of the project reporting requirements.
In establishing and reporting HSE performance the contractor shall:
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 18 of 83
• Apply any overarching project targets and indicators;
• Set aggressive yet attainable targets for leading HSE performance indicators applicable to their
scope of work;
• Evaluate HSE performance indicators trends against the established targets on a monthly basis as a
minimum;
• Utilize the HSE s-curve to track progress of key HSE activities and milestones;
• Develop and steward structured action plans to address performance indicator trends which are not
meeting established targets;
• Communicate performance indicator trends, emerging themes and risks associated with upcoming
work tasks to WorleyParsons and its contractor personnel on a monthly basis as a minimum; and
• Submit hours worked and HSE performance reporting in accordance with any timeframes and
templates provided by WorleyParsons.
3.5 Lessons Learned
3.5.1 Shared Learnings
Contractors shall conduct a project level lessons learnt workshop post contract award to capture lessons
learnt and best practices from previous projects and apply them into their HSE planning process.
WorleyParsons shall participate at its sole discretion.
Contractors shall capture, evaluate and apply lessons learnt and best practices identified throughout the
execution of the work. The capture of learnings is expected to be predominately from inspections, HSE
assessments, near miss reporting and incident investigations.
The sharing of lessons learnt may be conducted through frequent site communication / toolbox meetings or
alerts.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 19 of 83
4 SUBCONTRACTORS AND SUPPLY CHAIN
The contractor is accountable for the HSE performance and compliance of all subcontractors engaged by
the contractor. The contractor is required to ensure appropriate selection, management, control and
budgetary processes are in place and implemented throughout the project.
Subcontractors under the control of the contractor are required to work to all HSE requirements stipulated
within this document as applicable to the scope of works.
4.1 Subcontractor HSE Selection
The contractor shall utilize a systematic process for the evaluation and selection of subcontractors engaged
by the contractor to provide services and HSE capability for the execution of the work. This process may
require a desktop prequalification and follow up with site visits and interviews.
4.1.1 Evaluation
The contractor shall provide to WorleyParsons the process used in the subcontractor screening and
evaluation in assessing the subcontractors capability and capacity to perform the scope of works safely. This
process should include but not limited capturing the subcontractor technical capabilities and experience,
relevant qualifications and licenses, HSE management systems, HSE performance, supporting processes
and applicable insurances.
The Areas requiring improvement shall be identified and a subcontractor management strategy shall be
implemented by the contractor in addressing potential gaps.
4.1.2 Contract
Contract conditions between the contractor and subcontractor must clearly state the HSE processes and
performance outcomes of the project. At all times, the contractor shall be accountable for subcontractor
compliance and performance with the requirements of this specification.
4.1.3 Al ignment and Engagement
HSE alignment is required with all subcontractors. Interface requirements must be defined and agreed by
the contractor and subcontractor. The contractor shall either include subcontractors within their alignment
workshops, or conduct specific alignment workshops with their subcontractors through the initial phases of
the project and ongoing throughout the term of the project in maintaining a clear view of HSE deliverables
and expectations by subcontractors.
The contractor and subcontractor frontline supervisors must participate in an engagement program, and
undertake training specific to their duties on the project. This engagement program will specifically address
what personal commitment and action is expected of the contractor and subcontractor individuals. Activities
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 20 of 83
and methods to rollout the alignment program to subcontractor must be defined in the contractor project
plans.
4.2 Subcontractor HSE Planning and Readiness
Project specific pre and post mobilization deliverables must be established for subcontractor scope of works
and communicated to the subcontractor.
4.2.1 Risk Assessment
The contractor shall ensure subcontractor risk assessment processes conducted (and resulting risk register)
are integrated to any overarching project risk assessment process conducted by the contractor and
WorleyParsons project teams.
4.2.2 Health Safety and Environment Management Plan
The contractor HSE Plan shall describe how subcontractors engaged will integrate project health, safety and
environmental considerations across all its work sites. Subcontractors may utilize a Project Health, Safety
and Environment Management Plan structure that aligns with the contractor
4.2.3 Resourcing and Budget
The risk based resource allocation process shall be used by the contractor to define the roles,
responsibilities and composition for the organization shall include subcontractor scope of works.
The contractor shall ensure that sufficient budgeting provision has been included for compliance
requirements covering the subcontractor scope of work. Budget provisions shall ensure the HSE
requirements associated with leadership, alignment, planning, and execution and field practices are
included.
4.2.4 Subcontractor Readiness Review
The contractor must undertake a review of the subcontractor preparedness prior to their mobilization, and
again post mobilization to determine readiness for field execution works. The readiness review process of
the subcontractor shall be integrated with the overall the contractor readiness review conducted with
WorleyParsons. Readiness reviews are to include the subcontractor project HSE plans, program and HSE
deliverables.
Approval to proceed will align with the approval of the WorleyParsons project team processes. Where the
subcontractor is found to be underprepared in either of the readiness review processes, the contractor will
be held accountable to remedy any compliance gaps prior to commencement of any field work by the
subcontractor.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 21 of 83
4.3 Subcontractor HSE Management
Subcontractor management includes the evaluation, monitoring, and control processes to address HSE
considerations throughout the subcontracting process for subcontractors engaged by the contractor to
provide services for the execution of the work.
The contractor must have in place appropriate formal systems, procedures and safe practices for the
management and control of subcontractor, including without limitation:
• Integration of subcontractors into the activities and processes included in the contractor HSE Plan;
• Active and continuous oversight of subcontractors to verify safe work practices are employed and
they are complying with the HSE contract requirements and applicable HSE Plans;
• A systematic approach for managing subcontractor non-compliance with HSE contract requirements
and applicable HSE Plans;
• Active monitoring of subcontractor HSE performance indicators, and integration of them into
contractor overall HSE performance indicators for the work;
• Details of qualifications/certificates of competency and competency assessments approved for all
personnel required to commence works;
• Training programs developed and subcontractor personnel undertake applicable training;
• Structured forums for providing periodic feedback to subcontractors senior management regarding
their HSE performance; and
• The contractor shall summarize its subcontractor management process within the contractor HSE
Plan.
4.4 Procurement and Suppliers
The contractor shall ensure that the planning, design and procurement of new sites, plant and equipment
takes into account known and projected HSE aspects and risks, and considers provisions for maintenance,
modification, decommissioning, disposal and closure. The contractor is required to provide to
WorleyParsons, information on the risk assessment performed and the identified hazards associated with
equipment and products prior to their delivery or commencement of work.
The contractor ensures that the health, safety and environmental requirements related to equipment and
materials are specified to suppliers prior to purchase and compliance with these requirements are verified
prior to, or upon, delivery. Where required, appropriate health and safety documentation (e.g. SDS's) is be
provided by the supplier.
The procurement and supply of plant and equipment shall ensure no short or long term adverse
consequence to people and the environment. Procured plant and equipment shall not contain the
following:
• Ozone depleting substances, e.g. PCB’s – poly chlorinated biphenyls
• Asbestos
• Lead based paints
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 22 of 83
Technical standards for design, construction and commissioning (including any modifications) of procured
and supplied plant and equipment shall ensure compliance with health, safety and environmental legislation,
relevant industry codes and standards.
WorleyParsons supports the core conventions of the International Labour Organisation’s 1998 ‘Declaration
on Fundamental Principles and Rights at Work’. The procurement and supply processes of plant and
equipment and associated activities by the contractor and their suppliers shall ensure they have strong
governance and visibility across the total supply chain. This governance and visibility shall confirm
compliance and responsibility of the contractor and their suppliers with human and labour rights practices
and the protection of the natural environment.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 23 of 83
5 HSE COMPETENCY AND TRAINING
The contractor is responsible for the selection, screening, training and verifying the competence of its
personnel, including subcontractors. The contractor shall conduct a competency assessment that covers all
aspects of their scope of work. Competency requirements shall be detailed in Position Descriptions. A
training need analysis matched with the competency requirements shall form the Contractor Training
Strategy and Training Matrix for the scope of work. The Contractor Training Strategy and Training Matrix
shall identify the target audiences and the timeframe for each package/module (including refresher training)
to be delivered. This information shall be included as an attachment to the contractor HSE Plan and be
subject to periodic review.
All project personnel must undergo orientation / induction (industry, project and site). The contractor shall
also ensure that orientation and familiarization with equipment and safe working procedures is carried out for
new personnel or personnel using equipment or undertaking duties that they are unfamiliar with.
The contractor shall utilize qualified, and when required by WorleyParsons, Accredited HSE Training
Professionals to conduct training. The contractor shall also develop and implement in-house training
packages that cover various HSE topics associated with the work. The contractor training packages shall
have a process to verify knowledge, understanding and/or competency of individual personnel.
The contractor shall provide copies of the various training packages to be implemented for the work to
WorleyParsons for review and acceptance.
The contractor must ensure all qualifications, licenses; certificates and employment history are included in
individual profiles. Dates for refresher training shall also be included on individual profiles. The contractor
shall keep site records summarizing all competencies and qualifications of its personnel.
WorleyParsons reserves the right to mandate project specific training to all people working on the project.
This training may be specific to field based tools, work practices, or in relation to an identified high risk.
5.1 Safety Critical Positions
It is incumbent on the contractor to evaluate the competency of all nominated personnel employed in safety
critical positions prior to commencement on site. The WorleyParsons project team will plan to conduct ad
hoc evaluations post commencement on site. If it is deemed an individual does not meet the required
competency it will be the responsibility of the contractor to train/re-train the person to meet the required
standards set down in the defined task specific competency requirements.
Safety Critical Positions:
• Must have clearly defined HSE position requirements established and documented (position
descriptions);
• Are subject to random and post incident drug and alcohol testing where permissible legally;
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 24 of 83
• Are required to undertake pre-employment medicals to project defined criteria; and
• Are subject to dismissal for first offences.
Defined safety critical positions in the field as a minimum include:
• Those in a role managing field work (i.e. tram leaders, supervisors, managers etc.)
• Heavy equipment operators, includes crane and elevated work platform operators
• Riggers, Dogman
• Scaffolders
• Electricians
• Permit issuers
• Confined space watchers
• Flagman
• Designated passenger vehicle drivers
5.1.1 Supervisors and Frontline Managers
Supervisors and Frontline Managers must receive training in HSE leadership, supervising teams and
addressing unsafe work practices. They must have participated in Alignment Workshops as outlined in
section 2.2.1 of this document.
5.2 Short Term Service Employees
The short term service employee (STSE) process provides for the identification of inexperienced personnel
so that the contractor will 1) provide additional oversight 2) provide additional assistance and 3) implement
additional controls and/or restrictions for activities performed, as deemed appropriate.
The criteria to be applied by the contractor to determine a STSE is as follows:
• Length of employment shall be no greater than 1 year
• Length of service within industry shall be no greater than 2 years
The contractor shall ensure appropriate processes are in place to manage risks identified with STSA and
report the average ratio of STSE relative to total number of personnel at the work site to WorleyParsons on a
monthly basis.
The contractor shall develop and submit to WorleyParsons for review and approval a written mitigation plan
when the established STSE threshold exceeds a 1:15 ratio or when the performance of STSE is negatively
impacting HSE performance.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 25 of 83
6 COMMUNICATIONS AND ENGAGEMENT
The contractor shall develop and implement structured methods to communicate and engage with its
workforce regarding various workplaces HSE issues associated with the work. The contractor shall define
within the HSE Plan its various communication methods (both internal and external). As a minimum, the
following meetings shall be included:
• Pre-Mobilization HSE Kick off meeting (on site)
• Job Start / Daily Pre-Start meetings (Each shift change)
• Weekly Toolbox meetings
• Weekly Progress Meeting
• Weekly HSE Walkthrough
• Quarterly Contractor HSE Committee Meeting
A Contractor HSE Committee with representatives from management, field workforce and subcontractors
shall be established under an agreed terms of reference. Contractor HSE Committee meetings shall be held
on a minimum monthly basis.
The contractor shall develop and implement a series of structured HSE campaigns in order to educate and
raise awareness regarding the risks associated with their scope of work and the control measures in place.
Campaigns are expected to focus on identified actions from the contractor HSE Strategy. The HSE
campaigns shall form part of the contractor continuous improvement. The contractor shall develop and
submit a schedule of HSE campaigns for the life of the Project after contract award.
There shall be at least one HSE notice board at each contractor site. The notice board shall be displayed in
a prominent position at the site, including information in multiple languages as applicable, and be maintained
by the contractor HSE department. The HSE Policy and map of evacuation muster points shall be visible on
the notice board. Recommended documents to be displayed on notice board include:
• Internal HSE alerts;
• External HSE alerts;
• HSE campaign information and initiatives;
• Issue resolution process;
• How to report hazards, near misses and incidents;
• Future training courses (if provided); and
• Emergency numbers
6.1 Behavioral Based Safety - Serious about Zero (SAZ)
Serious about Zero conversations are the WorleyParsons initiated behavior based conversation process
performed by trained observers (WorleyParsons and/or Contractor Managers, Supervisors, HSE Advisors
and / or Workers) who periodically engage in HSE conversations with personnel whilst they carry out a job
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 26 of 83
task. The objective of SAZ is to positively reinforce safe behaviors and to change at-risk behavior through
constructive feedback.
Contractors shall adopt and implement the WorleyParsons Serious About Zero (SAZ) conversation program,
or agreed equivalent. If contractors wish to submit an alternative behavior based conversation program for
WorleyParsons review and approval, the program shall meet the following minimum requirements:
• The level of implementation (i.e. who within the Contractor project organization performs behavioral
based observations) is defined;
• The behavior based conversation process shall include both observation and conversation
components, regardless of the level of implementation;
• Provides a structured training program for the workforce;
• Provides structured guidelines which describe the methodology for performing conversations;
• Promotes systematic resolution to address at-risk behavior trends on a weekly basis (e.g. at – risk
behaviors are actioned via pre-start shift meetings, toolbox meetings, specific training, etc.); and
• Trend Analysis data should be submitted to WorleyParsons Project HSE Manager.
6.2 Employee Assistance Program (EAP)
Employee Assistance Programs (EAP) and Peer Support programs provide an avenue for intervention,
which aims to minimize the impact of work and personal issues on the individual’s fitness for work. It can
also assist in reducing occupational stress and conflict levels. The contractor shall provide an EAP service
for their personnel and subcontractors.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 27 of 83
7 INCIDENT AND NEAR MISS NOTIFICATION AND INVESTIGATION
When a Contractor incident or near miss occurs immediate action shall be taken by the contractor to make
the workplace safe. The contractor shall report all near misses and incidents to WorleyParsons immediately.
The contractor shall record the incident or near miss into the AIM database on projects where they have
direct access, or shall otherwise submit an initial incident summary within 24 hours post incident to
WorleyParsons. A final report within 5 working days to WorleyParsons unless otherwise agreed.
A Root Cause Analysis (RCA) investigation will be undertaken for defined HSE incidents and near misses as
directed by the WorleyParsons. The contractor shall be required to provide full participation in any
investigation and attend Incident Review Board (IRB) meeting/s where requested to attend.
Contractor related actions arising from investigations shall be entered into the AIM database, or other
agreed project action tracking database, and closed out within the nominated timeframe. Timely completion
of actions shall form part of the Contractor HSE Performance Evaluation by WorleyParsons.
Contractor incidents that involved damage to the environment and/or assets may require contractor action(s)
to return the workplace or other place / facility to the state that it was in prior to the incident. Claims for
environmental remediation and/or asset repair replacement will be made on the contractor to make good
such action(s)
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 28 of 83
8 MINIMUM HSE STANDARDS AND FIELD PRACTICES
The contractor is expected to have systems, processes, procedures and forms in place applicable to their
scope of work. The contractor is accountable for ensuing that any contractor or subcontractor processes and
practices that will be applied on the project comply with the minimum standards outlined in this specification.
Any exceptions to the requirements in this specification must be formally requested in writing by the
contractor, and must be formally approved by the WorleyParsons Project Manager ahead of any field work
commencing.
8.1 Site Establishment and Access
For projects with field execution requiring site establishment, the Contractor shall take into account the
following:
A survey of the site is carried out before work commences on site with consideration of the following:
• Location of the site. (Is/Was the surrounding area of a high security risk which may include
remaining ordinance, land mines?)
• Conditions on site and surrounds. (What was the site usage prior that may have unseen existing
hazards, heritage significance, contamination)
• Access to the site.
• Drainage of the site and other environmental factors.
• Ground conditions (wet weather conditions, marshy conditions, ground movements).
• Services available (water, sewers, electricity, gas, telephones, etc.).
• Disposal sites for excess soil or rubbish.
• Security on site (access security, security of materials delivered, etc.).
• Medical facilities and services as determined by a Health Risk Assessment
• Accommodation requirements.
Before work commences on site any parties who will be affected by the works are notified of the intention to
commence work.
Structures which cannot or shall not be removed for the duration of the works and which may be affected by
the works (i.e. buildings, trees, overhead cables) are protected to avoid accidental damage.
Boundaries are established and once set out they are treated in accordance with the contract to make the
works safe and secure. Fencing with lockable gates are provided in every case where possible.
All amenities on site are established including:
• Office facilities
• Welfare facilities (accommodation, camp kitchens, etc.)
• Workshops and storage for materials, tools, plant etc.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 29 of 83
• Medical facilities and response services
• Training centers
Once established depending upon location and nature of the contract, the boundary security of the
compound, offices, plant etc. necessary security arrangements implemented to protect against theft and
vandalism.
Services (e.g. water, gas, and electricity, waste) to the site are provided as soon as practicable.
Arrangements are made to regularly clean and maintain all offices and welfare facilities
Site clearance activities as a component of the site establishment also takes into account any license
requirements.
8.1.1 Emergency Response Management
The Contractor shall develop and implement structured processes for the planning and management of
emergency events in order to minimize the potential impacts to people, the environment, property and
reputation.
The Contractor shall develop a Project Emergency Response Plan which shall be submitted to
WorleyParsons for review and approval after contract award. The Contractor Project Emergency Response
Plan shall interface with the respective WorleyParsons Project Emergency Response Plan.
Minimum risk scenarios to be addressed include:
• Personal injury and illness that constitutes being a medical emergency;
• Environmental spill or release;
• Property damage;
• Security breaches;
• Fire/explosion; and
• Significant weather related event
The contractor shall summarize its project emergency response arrangements within the Contractor HSE
Plan. The contractor shall be appropriately resourced (i.e. relevant manning and equipment) to undertake
and manage emergency rescues for their own emergency situations that may be associated to their scope of
work i.e. working at height, confined space etc.
8.1.2 Severe Weather / Adverse Natural Event Conditions
In preparation of the local operating environment and possible severe weather and/or adverse natural
events, the contractor may be required to develop a Project Severe Weather / Natural Disaster Response
Plan in accordance with overarching Response Plans. The Plan shall address areas of likelihood including
but not limited to a high winds, cyclone/hurricane/typhoon, tornado, lightning, heavy rains, flood, dust storm,
bushfire, earthquake, and tsunami.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 30 of 83
The plan shall manage the safety of contractor personnel when the project shuts down in response to an
approaching event where sufficient notification is provided. Contractor personnel and subcontractor
personnel shall be trained in the appropriate precautions and responses in the event of severe weather
occurring.
As part of the plan the contractor shall outline how they intend to address the issue that all materials, plant,
equipment and items in their work areas should be able to be adequately secured and in a state of readiness
during the event so when an alert is issued, all abovementioned items can be confirmed as secure.
8.1.3 Fire Risk Management
The contractor shall have in place a system to determine and implement adequate fire prevention and
suppression provisions, including the location/placement of provisions and firefighting support required to
protect the contractor scope of works.
Such a system shall comply with legislative requirements and manufacturer’s specification. In addition to the
fire prevention/suppression provisions the system shall ensure:
• Training and competency of the contractor personnel required to operate provisions;
• Contractor personnel aware of safe means of site evacuation and regular evacuation drills
conducted;
• Availability where required of 3rd party resources to respond to fire emergency situations;
• All such equipment and supplies shall be provided, replenished and maintained by competent
person(s);
• Hot work performed in designated areas and under hot work permit; and
• Smoking prohibited where fire hazards exist.
8.1.4 Site Access
8.1.4.1 INDUCTION – CONTRACTOR PERSONNEL
All contractor personnel (including temporary and permanent transfers) to any will be required to undergo a
work location specific induction, introduced by a member of the work location senior management team prior
to site access.
The site specific content of the induction shall be identified during the development of the project and prior to
commencement at site and documented in brief in checklist format.
Subcontractors engaged by the contractor and engaged for a one-off job (e.g. crane mechanic during a
repair or maintenance of a crane) will be required to undergo an abridged site specific induction and will be
required to be escorted by a nominated inducted person while on the site.
The HSE induction training is valid for the duration of the contract for work onsite. All contractor personnel
may be required to undergo an HSE induction refresher when the site is under commissioning control.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 31 of 83
8.1.4.2 V ISITORS
All contractor visitors to site shall initially report to the security office/ reception where they will sign in and
the person they are visiting is informed. Site management can deny visitor access if an appropriate host
cannot be contacted. The contractor is responsible for advising of all visitors prior to the visitor’s arrival.
Contractor visitors must undergo an escorted visitor’s induction after which security/ reception will hand them
over to their host. The escorted visitor’s induction and validity processes shall be developed by the
contractor in consultation with WorleyParsons to reflect local safety and operating requirements.
The contractor is responsible for vendor administration and communication associated with meeting these
requirements, which must be complete prior to an individual gaining access to the site for work. The
contractor is responsible for their personnel behavior at accommodation facilities and will demonstrate
accountability should there be any reported incidents or events of inappropriate or unacceptable behavior.
.
8.2 Blasting and Use of Explosives
8.2.1 Abrasive Blasting
All contactor abrasive blasting work must be subject to a WorleyParsons approved work permit (hot work,
confined space etc.). Pressure blast vessels shall be manufactured in accordance with and an approved
Boiler and Pressure Vessel code.
The contractor engaged in abrasive blasting operations is to establish a blasting enclosure of a design and
at a location approved by WorleyParsons. Blasting in work areas shall be fully enclosed and where dust may
enter other work areas, dust extraction and filters will be put in place by the contractor.
Garnet shall be used as the blasting media unless specified otherwise. Garnet used shall ensure limit free
silica generated by the operations. Blasting medium shall be fully removed (either manually or vacuumed)
from work areas daily and scaffold platforms prior to being dismantled. Blasting medium shall not be allowed
to enter the marine environment.
All air hoses and associated connections / coupling used shall be manufactured by an internationally
reputable proprietor (e.g. Atlas Copco, Ingersoll Rand) which comply with a recognized international
standard. The contractor shall establish a safe and efficient means of discharging static electricity from the
blast nozzle when dry blasting and sufficient supply of water when executing wet blasting operations. The
blast nozzle shall be of a dead-man’s handle type, and be equipped with an operating valve that must open
manually and cannot be tied to prevent automatic cut off
Machines, hoses respirators and other applicable safety and operational equipment shall be inspected in
accordance with a schedule and all inspections shall be documented. Testing and repairs shall be
undertaken by qualified personnel only
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 32 of 83
Carbon monoxide monitoring alarm system shall be in place – activated to statutory levels or 10ppm as a
minimum
8.2.2 Explosive Blasting Operations
The contractor shall submit a Blast Management Plan to identify the processes and manage all risks
associated with drilling and use of explosives in blasting within the scope of works. The plan shall include all
safe working procedures for the security, supply, and storage, on site transport, use, handling, security and
disposal of explosives.
The contractor shall permit only authorized and qualified persons to handle and use explosives. All
equipment used in the drilling and blasting operations shall be regularly inspected and maintained and
certified.
8.2.2.1 DRILLING
The contractor is to monitor dust levels and implement appropriate corrective actions when necessary during
drilling operations. Drilling noise shall be minimized by the use of down hole hammer machines wherever
practicable. Exclusion Zones and Signage shall be placed around drilling operations where noise levels
exceed 85dBA
8.2.2.2 BLASTING
The contractor shall provide all licenses for transportation, storage and use of explosives to WorleyParsons
prior to bringing any explosives on to client premises. Personnel authorized to prepare explosive charges or
conduct blasting operations shall use every reasonable precaution including, but not limited to, visual and
audible warning signals, flags, or barricades, to ensure personnel safety. Insofar as possible, blasting
operations above ground shall be conducted between sunup and sundown.
8.3 Communicable Diseases
The contractor shall have a system in place to identify, assess and control activities which may place
personnel at risk of acquiring a communicable disease during the course of their work. The controls
identified by the system shall be adequate to protect personnel from communicable diseases.
The contractor system shall be inclusive of and not limited to:
• The provision of appropriate information and instruction to contractor personnel at risk of acquiring a
communicable disease during the course of their work;
• The provision of appropriate medical services including first aid, immunization, counselling and
medical follow up for potential exposures;
• The development and promotion of relevant safe working practices to minimize exposure to blood
borne pathogens;
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 33 of 83
• Reporting and investigating incidents which place personnel at risk of acquiring a communicable
disease; and
• Regular review of the system in place for identifying, assessing and controlling communicable
diseases
8.4 Confined Spaces
WorleyParsons classifies any entry to a confined space as high risk and defines a confined space as an
enclosed or partially-enclosed space which:
• Is at atmospheric pressure during occupancy;
• Is not intended or designed primarily as a place of work;
• May have restricted means of entry and exit, and may:
o Have an atmosphere which contains harmful levels of components
o Not have a safe oxygen content
o Cause engulfment
Site activities including construction, commissioning, and maintenance and decommissioning may require
works in defined confined space areas including but not limited to:
• Storage tanks, process vessels, boilers, pressure vessels, silos and other tank-like compartments,
internal structural compartments; and
• Pipes, sewers, shafts, ducts, trenches, excavations and similar.
The contractor shall have a detailed process in place for works requiring confined space entry. The process
shall include but not be limited to the:
• Identity of confined spaces;
• Permits;
• Hazard assessment;
• Personnel competency and training;
• Operational execution of works and precautions;
• Safety equipment; and
• Emergency response.
A register of confined spaces shall be maintained for each site and regularly updated. Notices shall be
placed at each confined space identified on the register, stating that a permit is required for entry. The
requirement for notices shall also apply to temporary confined spaces such as trenches.
All entry into confined spaces will be subject to a WorleyParsons approved confined space entry work
permit. A confined space entry permit shall only be authorized by person(s) certified by WorleyParsons to
generate a confined space entry permit.
All contractor personnel conducting work in relation to confined spaces (including Standby Person) must
have received training in accordance with WorleyParsons recognized standards. Only competent contractor
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 34 of 83
personnel can enter a confined space. The contractor shall maintain a register of competent persons and
training undertaken.
A Confined Space Risk Assessment shall be undertaken prior to any entry to a confined space. The
completed risk assessment shall be attached to the Confined Space Entry Permit. Openings for entry to and
exit from the confined space shall be of adequate size to permit rescue of all persons who may enter the
confined space. Those persons involved in an emergency response shall be made aware of the conditions
and the number of persons in the confined space
The contractor must provide their own gas testing / monitoring and calibration equipment in addition to
providing their own confined space rescue capability. All equipment provided by the contractor shall be
inspected and tested in accordance with a schedule to ensure fit for purpose and all inspections shall be
documented. Testing and repairs shall be undertaken by qualified personnel only.
8.5 Control of Work
8.5.1 Isolation and Lock Out
The contractor shall have in place a procedure to manage isolations including, at minimum, requirements
for:
• Identification of the equipment to be isolated;
• Approval to work from equipment owner;
• Confirmation that effectiveness of isolation can be proven;
• Isolation of the equipment using Safety Lock and Danger Tag; and
• Testing that the equipment is isolated.
The procedure shall include managing isolations for stored mechanical energy and hazardous substances.
As a minimum the requirements shall include equipment under pressure of vacuum, pneumatic and
hydraulic drives, moving parts and hazardous materials within the system.
The procedure shall include managing isolations from electrical energy. The procedure shall require that
after an isolation and prior to any work commencing, testing for "dead" shall be carried out by a competent
person using test lamps or test sticks; and test lamps or test sticks shall be supplied to local or internationally
recognized Standards, and checked before and after ‘testing for dead’ to ensure they are functioning
correctly.
The procedure shall include the identification of which pieces of equipment are isolated by a specific isolator.
Labels shall be used for this purpose. They shall be permanently attached on or adjacent to the means of
isolation and the equipment to be isolated. Labels shall not be attached to items that may be removed, e.g.
motor or coupling guards.
The procedure shall include managing de-isolations including, at minimum, requirements for: assurance that
all personnel are clear and cannot be injured, removal of the isolation lock and tag, restoration of energy
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 35 of 83
source (de-isolate), a second check again that personnel are clear, test operation of equipment, and
handover of equipment control back to the owner.
Isolations shall only be undertaken by trained and competent contractor persons.
8.5.2 Permit to Work
The contractor shall have a system in place where work categories requiring a permit to work (permit) shall
be defined for each site, group of sites, or project as appropriate, based on the risks involved. Work requiring
a permit shall be defined after considering factors such as work type, work location, complexity of the job,
environmental conditions and the types of potential hazards. The permit to work system shall address all the
hazards identified by experience, history, and the hazard register(s) developed during risk assessments of
operations at the site or sites. It shall provide specific controls for work where regulatory and / or customer
requirements exist and will provide specific controls where indicated by industry best practice (for example,
all confined space entry is controlled by a specific permit).
The contractor shall nominate and document the Permit Authorities and their responsibilities. There shall be
nominated contractor personnel to manage the permit to work system. The contractor personnel assigned to
designated permit roles will be trained in the permit to work system, its operation and shall be competent in
their specific roles in its operation.
Each contractor work location will have a system for the approval of works to be conducted. The work
location shall also designate who is authorized to give approval. WorleyParsons, as a minimum expects the
following work types to be covered by a permit to work:
• Simultaneous operations;
• Confined space entry;
• Hot work in a hazardous environment;
• Work in hazardous atmospheres (asbestos, silica dust, H2S, etc.);
• Excavation;
• Explosives use;
• High voltage / high energy access;
• Radioactive substances use;
The contractor shall develop and implement a documented work permit process. The Permit to Work
document shall specify:
• Work nature and scope;
• Equipment isolation and preparation for work;
• Personal protection; and
• Checks, responsibilities and approvals
The operational requirement of the permit system is required to include:
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 36 of 83
• Permit display and distribution (completed and approved permit to be held by permit holder and
displayed at location);
• Permit lifespan (shall not permit work permits to remain current beyond a reasonable work interval);
• Permit handling on completion of work (declaration work is complete and site clean and in a safe
condition);
• Permit handling on failure to complete work (communication of the work status);
• Permit retention for completed work (as required by law or three months, whichever period is longer)
NOTE: The customer or project may require the contractor to follow the customer or project permit to
work system.
8.6 Decommissioning and Demolition
8.6.1 Decommissioning
All planned contractor decommissioning activities/projects shall require a risk assessment to assist with
hazard identification, and risk control identification, prior to the work commencing. The assessment shall
include, but not be limited to:
• State of knowledge of what is to be decommissioned;
• Current condition of item/s including contents of vessels / pipes / other hollow items;
• Complexity of decommissioning operations;
• Hazards to personnel working at site;
• Hazards to adjacent property or the public (including public facilities and infrastructure);
• Simultaneous operations within the site or at adjacent sites;
• Health hazards due to toxic or other wastes generated by the decommissioning operations
• Wastes or potential discharges that constitute an environmental discharge that must meet all
statutory and WorleyParsons requirements;
• Electrical energy; and
• Potential energy such as contained pressure
A site audit shall be conducted by the contractor to identify potentially hazardous substances, and a register
of hazardous materials anticipated during decommissioning operations shall be kept at the site. A Site
Decommissioning Risk Management Plan shall be written by the contractor to support the planned
operations, and shall include work controls as appropriate to the associated hazards and be approved by a
designated authority. The plan shall include removal of hazardous materials to the extent practicable before
decommissioning begins such as by purging, gravity drainage, replacement with inert fluid etc.
A check shall be made of regulatory requirements associated with the decommissioning plans to ensure that
all requirements have been satisfied prior to commencement of operations.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 37 of 83
Prior to commencing decommissioning work, a physical inspection shall be completed by the contractor.
This is particularly important to confirm plant or equipment readiness for decommissioning. The inspection
should check for:
• Structural condition including degradation, materials of construction and potential weaknesses;
• Physical and controls interface with items that are not to be decommissioned
• Confined spaces inventory;
• “Interim hazards” that can exist (e.g. fluids to be removed, unexpected contents, etc.);
• Confirm location and marking of hazardous sites such as contaminated areas; and
• Confirm location, type and status of overhead hazards (power lines, lighting towers, etc.).
Documentation shall be generated that records the final decommissioned status of all items especially where
this status may represent hazards to later demolition operations. This documentation shall be complete prior
to commencement of planning for demolition
8.6.2 Demolit ion
All contractor planned demolition shall require a risk assessment to assist with hazard identification, and risk
control identification, prior to the work commencing. The contractor shall ensure all legal and regulatory
requirements associated with the demolition are in place and title, permits and approvals have been satisfied
prior to commencing demolition.
Prior to the commencement of demolition, a site audit shall be conducted by the contractor to identify
potentially hazardous substances, and a register of hazardous materials anticipated during demolition
operations shall be kept at the site. The plan shall include removal where practicable before demolition
begins
A Site Demolition Risk Management Plan shall be written by the contractor to support the planned demolition
operations, and shall include work controls as appropriate to the associated hazards and be approved by a
designated authority where required.
An authorized, documented execution plan shall be developed and communicated to all Supervisors and
contractors. It shall include site clean-up operations. The execution plan shall link to the Risk Management
Plan and include requirements for daily / shift planning meetings.
8.7 Dril l ing and Piling
Contractor personnel involved with drilling operations shall monitor dust levels and implement appropriate
corrective actions when necessary during drilling operations. Drilling noise is minimized by the use of down
hole hammer machines wherever practicable. The Contractor shall ensure exclusion zones and signage is
placed around drilling operations where noise levels exceed 85dBA.
Refer also Hand and Power Tool section.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 38 of 83
8.7.1 Piling
The contractor shall ensure safe operational and maintenance procedures are in place for any piling
activities conducted within the project. These procedures incorporate processes on pile driving and
extraction, correct selection of plant and equipment, works on or over water, use of sheet piles and work
platforms, ramps and berms.
Procedures shall be in place by the contractor to manage health, safety and environmental hazards from
support equipment including: trailer mounted concrete pumps; concrete holding drums, concrete hoses, air
compressors, vibrating hammers, bentonite plants, concrete skips and tremie equipment. All piling
operations equipment shall have current inspection records that meet statutory requirements where present.
8.8 Earthworks
8.8.1 Land Clearing
Vegetation clearing within the contractor scope of works, will occur in accordance with licensed approvals
and WorleyParsons approval. Prior to any proposed clearing activities, WorleyParsons written approval
must be given as the area may be preserved as a unique habitat area, or a cultural heritage area or other
sensitive place. The contractor is required to carry out a risk assessment for the proposed clearing activity.
All disturbed areas are required to be formed into stabilized slopes no greater than 1 in 3, batters,
embankments, stockpiles, and bare areas.
8.8.2 Topsoil Preservation
Where possible, topsoil (if any) will be removed from beneath building sites, roads and other excavated sites
prior to construction. This material will be preserved in piles, and will be recycled for rehabilitation and re-
vegetation landscaping activities.
Short term stockpiles will be located in a position approved by WorleyParsons usually near to the source of
the soil, that is, along roads and adjacent to cleared pads. All soil stockpiles will be protected from erosion
by means of drainage ditches, berms, coverings and or other methods. Stockpiles will have final slopes no
greater than 1 in 3
8.8.3 Erosion control
The contractor (if it is within the scope of work) will keep erosion control devices in working condition; will
maintain sediment retention basins and all other sediment control structures. The conditions with erosion
potential will be minimized at the source area by grading and providing drainage to cleared areas as soon as
possible after their creation. Where indicated by WorleyParsons, graded areas will control sediment runoff by
incorporating appropriate final slopes and berms with culverts into their design.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 39 of 83
8.8.4 Surface Storm Water Controls – Minimizing & Avoiding Local Water
Pollution
The aim of existing storm water controls is to eliminate the pollution of local natural waterways. The types of
water produced by the contractor on site have been classified into three groups:
• Group 1: Contaminated water containing miscible and non-miscible oils, i.e. Oily water, Continuous
Oil Contaminated (COC) will be directed to the Waste Water Treatment Plant (WWTP), or if
sufficient oil quantity and quality occurs will be contained and recycled.
• Group 2: Site surface waters that may or may not be polluted are directed to a first flush basin and to
Effluent Treatment Plant (ETP) if contaminated.
• Group 3: Natural unpolluted rain water – directed via sedimentation ponds to the drainage channel
for discharge to the sea, inland waterway or land.
8.8.5 Dust Control
The contractor shall have in place dust suppression and control measures for dust generated on the project
site as a result of undertaking the scope of works. Dust impact shall be managed and controlled to satisfy all
local and national regulatory requirements. Work procedures should be designed or redesigned to minimize
the production and dispersion of dust.
In deciding the method of controlling dust hazards the contractor will consider;
• The use of fume/dust extractor and filtration systems where possible, such as in workshops for
power tools, spray painting etc.
• Vacuuming dust from areas where cutting processes take place.
• Use of dust suppressants, such as water for large roadwork activities in the form of water carts or
integrated into plant.
Dust will be controlled with fresh water sprays, treated effluent water or by the application of WorleyParsons-
approved dust suppressants. Sea water will not be used as a dust control spray on the road or for
compaction activities. The frequency of water application will be controlled by the contractor meeting
specific maximum dust measurements as required by Environmental Approvals, with the goal of no dust
going beyond the boundary of the work area.
Monitoring and review processes shall be undertaken by the contractor to assess the current controls and
effectiveness and implement corrective action where required.
8.9 Electrical
All installations, and work performed on installations by the contractor, shall meet the requirements of
relevant statutory regulatory authorities. The hazards and risks from the use, installation, repair;
maintenance and testing of electrical equipment and systems (including high voltage) shall be assessed by
the contractor.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 40 of 83
Only competent and licensed contractor personnel shall work on electrical equipment and systems
applicable to the scope of works. The contractor shall have a procedure in place to ensure this competency
is maintained (annually at minimum), and recorded formally
A formal preventative maintenance and testing system shall be in place to ensure that all contractor
electrical equipment and power supplies are maintained and in a serviceable condition. A procedure shall be
in place to ensure regular examination of equipment and supplies (minimum three (3) months). A register
shall be maintained by the contractor of all electrical equipment used within the scope of works, the
preventative maintenance undertaken on this equipment and results of regular compliance testing.
All tested equipment shall be durably and legibly tagged with the following information:
• Plant or item number;
• Date of inspection/test;
• Next due test date;
• Electrician’s certificate number; and
• Tester’s signature.
The contractor electrical equipment shall only be used by trained and competent persons
When electrical equipment including hired equipment is tested and found to be unsatisfactory, it shall be
withdrawn from service immediately and have a warning tag attached to it warning against further use.
Equipment shall not be returned to service until it has been repaired and retested by a licensed electrician.
8.9.1 High Voltage
Work near high voltage equipment shall be avoided where possible. The contractor shall put in place
controls to eliminate or minimize the risks to personnel where work on HV equipment is necessary. High
Voltage Regulatory and International Standard requirements pertinent to a region shall be identified,
documented, maintained and communicated. The contractor shall have in place a procedure to ensure all
high voltage equipment and systems have current inspection and maintenance records and only competent
and authorized personnel shall work with high voltage equipment or near high voltage equipment.
The contractor shall ensure a minimum of two persons when working on high voltage equipment inside a
high voltage substation, such as applying portable grounds (earths) or carrying out works under an Electrical
Access Permit. Where the substation contains high voltage equipment with exposed live parts, a person
shall be posted as a Safety Observer. The role of the Safety Observer shall be documented.
8.9.2 Overhead Power Lines
Where the need to work near or under overhead power-lines is unavoidable, the contractor shall ensure
controls are in place to eliminate or minimize the risks to personnel.
A documented risk assessment shall be carried out before any work commences in consultation with all
relevant parties involved in the work. A procedure shall be in place to define the requirements and
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 41 of 83
responsibilities of personnel operating mobile equipment, in or adjacent to the vicinity of overhead power
lines. A procedure shall be in place to manage inadvertent contact with power lines to ensure safe recovery
of personnel and equipment.
8.9.3 Ground Fault Circuit Interrupters (Earth Leakage Circuit Breakers)
The Contractor shall ensure that ground fault circuit interrupters (also known as an earth leakage circuit
breaker or residual current device), be installed in order to reduce the severity of electric shock to personnel
and to provide protection for electrical equipment.
Ground fault protection at the following levels as a minimum shall be required on the following underground
installations:
• High voltage distribution;
• All multi-phase low voltage fixed installations (1000mA);
• All single phase low voltage fixed installations (30-300mA);
• All single phase and 3 phase outlets (30mA);
• Transportable electrical equipment (30-500mA); and
• All mobile electric machines (150-500mA).
Ground fault protection at the following levels as a minimum shall be required on the following surface
installations:
• Low voltage distribution (1A);
• Medium and high voltage distribution (5A);
• All single phase outlets (30mA);
• Transportable electrical equipment (100-500mA); and
• All mobile electric machines (150-500mA).
The Contractor shall have a system in place to ensure that all such installation test results are checked,
signed and recorded in a register. All records shall be retained for a minimum period of seven years.
8.10 Environment Licensing and Controls
Depending on the contractor scope, the provisions detailed in this section of the Contractor HSE
Specification may be incorporated into the Contractor Environmental Management Plan. Everyone that
works for the contractor onsite is required to understand and implement the control measures utilized. The
contractor must minimize their environmental impact by implementing work control strategies that will ensure
minimal disturbance and zero harm to the environment.
Note: Environmental matters relating to site demolition and site excavation are covered in the appropriate
sections of Demolition and Earthworks. Further information on waste can be found further down under
Waste.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 42 of 83
8.10.1 Air Quality Control
The contractor shall have an established system in place to identify, assess and control activities that have
the potential to affect local air quality and cause environmental nuisance to local residential and surrounding
areas
All mechanical plant (including power plant) utilized within the contractor scope of work shall be assessed
and considered for use on site that minimizes the environmental impact of the work, including greenhouse
gas emissions.
The burning of wastes or unwanted materials will not be permitted on site unless in a purpose-built and
Company approved incinerator with appropriate emissions control system(s)
Where required, the contractor shall monitor and report greenhouse gas emissions to WorleyParsons and
the appropriate authorities.
8.11 Ergonomics
8.11.1 Manual Handling
The Contractor shall ensure the risks associated with project manual handling tasks are assessed prior to
the activities undertaken and control measures implemented to ALARP (As Low As Reasonably Practicable)
in minimizing the likelihood of musculo-skeletal injuries from occurring. The risk assessment and associated
risk control program shall address both construction and office (ergonomic) activities.
The program shall include full prestart and pre-task planning and assessment, general information for all
new personnel as well as the development of onsite Champions / Focal Points and a refresher / coaching
process to ensure ongoing compliance. The contractor shall submit relevant details of its manual handling
program to WorleyParsons for review and acceptance.
The contractor shall provide all its personnel with specific manual handling training related to work tasks
associated with its scope. The contractor shall plan to utilize mechanical lifting aids to minimize the number
of manual lifts performed by several workers and repetitive lifts so far as reasonably practicable. The
contractor shall not at any time use ladders, regardless of type, as a working platform for any manual
handling activity
8.12 Excavation
The contractor shall have a detailed process in place for works requiring excavation. The process shall
include the requirements around:
• Access and egress into excavations;
• Prevention of falls into excavations;
• Safe number of workers in an excavation;
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 43 of 83
• Excavated material deposits;
• Prior excavation works site inspection process (underground services, protected vegetation,
archeologically site);
• Shoring and trench box usage;
• Slope battering;
• Daily inspection;
• When caves, old mine, tunnels and sink holes ae detected;
• Atmospheric and fluid entry testing; and
• Excavations near load bearing foundations and road surfaces
All excavation work undertaken by the contractor requires a work permit.
8.13 Fall Prevention
Wherever practicable, the need for working at height, if there is a reasonably foreseeable risk of a contractor
personnel or object falling resulting in either injury or property damage, should be eliminated. The contractor
work shall be planned at the earliest stage possible to preclude the necessity of work at height.
Each working at height scenario shall have a risk assessment conducted. Before working at heights, an
approved work method shall be selected. Work at heights shall be carried out from permanent platforms
when they are suitable for the work. When a suitable permanent platform does not exist, a temporary
platform shall be provided to prevent the risk of falling.
Where a risk assessment identifies the need for a permanent means of control such as guardrails/ handrails;
permanent fixed platform/walkways; and permanent industrial fall arrest system, these shall be managed in
accordance with recognized local, national or internationally standards.
Where a risk assessment identifies the need for temporary or mobile means of control such as mobile
platforms; scaffolding, hung scaffolding, scissor lift, swinging stages, mechanical elevating platforms,
ladders, man cages/workboxes/sully boxes/boatswain’s chair, fall arrest systems or industrial rope access.
The contractor shall have a system in place to ensure that:
• All mobile elevating work platform (MEWP) operators hold National Certification applicable in the
Country of operation regardless of the height;
• Only authorized and certified as competent contractor operators shall use mobile elevated work
platforms equipment;
• All contractor personnel who operate MEWPs are trained by a competent trainer to be competent in
the safe use and inspection of all equipment used;
• A copy of all authorized and certified as competent operators certificates shall be retained in the site
office files and a register of Competencies and Certification maintained; and
• Emergency rescue plans shall be developed and communicated to Operators and Spotters.
Emergency retrieval systems shall be tested regularly.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 44 of 83
The Contractor shall have in place fall prevention and protection system/s to address situations at a work
site where personnel may fall 6 ft. (1.8 m) or more and where personnel are not protected by guardrails.
The fall prevention / protection system shall specify:
• The fall hazards at the work site;
• The equipment to be used at the work site;
• Calculations on fall distances when using a harness that includes the original length of the lanyard,
maximum energy absorber extension, the height of the individual and clearances;
• The procedures used to assemble, maintain, inspect, use and disassemble the fall protection
system; and
• The rescue procedures to be used if personnel suffer a fall, or are suspended by a personal fall
arrest system or safety net.
A contractor training program shall be in place to train contractor personnel in the use of the fall prevention /
protection system before working at heights in an area with a vertical fall greater than 6 ft. (1.8 m).
The contractor shall ensure a system is in place for equipment used that it is:
• Inspected by personnel as required by the manufacturer before it is used on each work shift,
• Kept free from substances and conditions that could contribute to deterioration of the equipment,
and
• Re-certified as specified by the manufacturer.
8.13.1 Fall ing Object Protection
The contractor shall ensure additional protection when working on elevated platforms and roofs from falling
hand tools, debris, and other small objects by securing these objects from falling or through the installation
of toe-boards, screens, guardrail systems, erection of debris nets, catch platforms, or canopy structures that
contain or deflect the falling objects.
8.14 Fitness for Work
The contractor shall ensure responsibilities, resources, training and competencies required to manage
fitness for work programs are identified and implemented. These programs to include but not be limited to
fatigue management, physical and psychological conditions, drugs and alcohol, return to work management.
Potential changes in fitness for work during extended absences shall be considered and managed for
contractor personnel who take extended leave or who for other reasons are away from their work for an
extended period. When contractor personnel return to work after a fitness for work issue, they are medically
certified as being physically and/or psychologically capable of carrying out the duties proposed for them.
The contractor shall maintain applicable fitness to work records including personnel and site monitoring
assessments and results. Records shall be kept at intervals defined by local legislation.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 45 of 83
8.14.1 Drugs and Alcohol
WorleyParsons prohibits the possession or use of illegal drugs in any of its facilities, including in
accommodation such as construction site camps.
The contractor shall as part of the contractor health program, provide information, instruction and training
programs concerning substance misuse to promote safety and health in the workplace. Where local
legislation permits, the contractor shall implement an active and regular ongoing testing program at work
sites as a method for managing possible impairment due to substance use.
8.15 Hand and Power Tools
The contractor shall ensure that personnel are properly instructed in the selection and use of the correct tool
for the job and that they have the correct safe tool for the job. The contractor personnel shall thoroughly
inspect tools before, during and after use and shall ensure faulty or damaged hand tools are repaired.
In minimizing the possibility of dropped objects, tools left on equipment etc. the contractor shall implement
the following:
• Tools shall be stored in an orderly fashion with an identification system and easy accessibility; e.g.
hooks, shadow boards, cabinets etc. ;
• Tools shall be stored in a clean and dry environment to prevent deterioration of the tool;
• A sign out, sign in register shall be implemented in racking the movement and location of tools;
• Lanyards fitted to tools used in elevated locations; and
• Hand tools visibility with flouro handles
The contractor shall ensure personnel have tools that are safe for use and that personnel are properly
trained in their use.
The following list of tools and equipment are banned on site by WorleyParsons:
• 1mm cutting / knifing discs;
• Knives;
• 9” Grinders;
• Pocket knives / Leatherman tools;
• Stanley knives;
• Shifters;
• Ladders without fall arrest;
• Open Hooks (Lifting); and
• 3 step ladders
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 46 of 83
8.15.1 Hand Tool Quality and Cleanliness
The contractor shall provide fit for purpose hand tools. No handmade home tools will be permitted on the
project. If wear or damage is observed, the tool should be withdrawn from use for repair or disposal.
The contractor shall implement a program of regular inspection, lubrication, cleaning and maintenance of
hand, air and electrical tools to ensure safe and optimal performance.
8.15.2 Electrical Risks
All portable electrical tools used by the Contractor shall be doubled insulated type. The insulation resistance
shall be tested by a suitably Qualified and experienced Electrician formally every 3 months in line with the
electrical inspection, re testing and tagging system.
Ground Fault Circuit Interrupter (GFCI) shall be installed on all electrical tools.
8.15.3 Powder Actuated Tools
The contractor shall obtain WorleyParsons approval prior to mobilizing any powder actuated (explosive
power) tools onto the work site.
The contractor shall develop a specific procedure that defines the responsibilities and controls to be
implemented related to the safe use, inspection, storage and security related to powder actuated tools.
Maintenance of explosive powered tools shall be carried out at least once weekly, when the explosive
powered tool is used and completely overhauled by the manufacturer or authorized personnel yearly. A
maintenance register shall be kept by the contractor for all explosive powered tools in each area.
8.15.4 Vibration
The contractor shall undertake a risk assessment for all activities which use vibratory tools like pneumatic
drills, impact wrenches, grinders, electric drills etc.). The contractor shall assess personnel exposed to
potentially high levels of vibration against the fatigue decreased proficiency boundary in accordance with
international standards (ISO 5349, ISO 2631-1). Any working environment likely to expose personnel above
the daily exposure action value (EAV) shall introduce immediate actions to reduce the exposure limit and a
program of controls to reduce exposure to a level that is as low as reasonably practicable (ALARP).
The contractor shall keep a record of the risk assessment, control actions and personnel exposures.
8.16 Hazard and Risk Field Based Tools
8.16.1 Job Hazard Analysis (JHA) Standard
The contractor shall utilize a Job Hazard Analysis process as a pre-task planning tool for its First Line
Supervisors / Foreman and Work Groups to analyze the task prior to commencement. All personnel involved
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 47 of 83
in the job tasks shall participate in the development of the JHA and shall sign their acceptance of the risks
and controls agreed.
A procedure shall be in place to define the methodology for conducting, recording and reviewing a Job
Hazard Analysis for all job tasks. The JHA procedure shall include the following basic steps in the process:
Identification of job steps; Hazard Identification; Risk Assessment; Risk Control; and Monitoring and Review.
A register of completed JHA’s shall be maintained. All JHA’s shall be filed for future reference and where
possible be in an electronic format.
8.16.2 Job Start / Pre Start Meetings / Tool Box Talks
The contractor shall ensure the implementation of Job Start / Pre Start meetings as outlined below:
The contractor supervisors shall hold pre-start meetings with their workgroups:
• At the beginning of every shift;
• Immediately prior to the start of any new (i.e. significantly different) task;
• When new personnel join the workgroup;
• After any significant change that may affect the work; e.g. bad weather, etc.
The following topics shall be discussed:
• The detailed requirements of the JHA and work method statement;
• The nature of the work to be completed for the period;
• Permit conditions / requirements;
• Personal protective equipment needed;
• General HSE issues; e.g. weather, access, housekeeping, etc.;
• Tools and equipment required to complete the job;
• Emergency preparedness requirements;
• Interface issues with other contractors / the Customer
Any points of concern should be documented and attended to prior to work commencing.
8.16.3 Personal Hazard Identif ication
Personal Hazard Identification is a pre-task planning process that facilitates the involvement of an individual
worker of hazard identification and control for a specific task that they are going to undertake.
WorleyParsons utilizes Step back as its Personal Hazard Identification process. The contractor may utilize
an alternative Personal Hazard Identification process that is mutually agreed with WorleyParsons prior to
mobilization.
The contractor shall ensure personnel are trained and competent in the Personal Hazard Identification
process and the process is undertaken prior to task commencement and/or when conditions change.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 48 of 83
8.17 Hazardous Substances and Dangerous Goods
Any hazardous substance and /or dangerous good that is intended to be used on site shall have an
applicable risk assessment (with the appropriate Safety Data Sheet (SDS) attached) completed by the
contractor to identify the hazards associated with the activities and appropriate control measures are
implemented. The risk assessment shall be provided for approval to company site management at least 2
weeks prior to their arrival onsite.
A hazardous substance and dangerous goods register shall be maintained on site by the contractor HSE
department. The contractor shall maintain a register of all toxic, flammable and combustible liquids. The
register shall be readily accessible and available in the immediate vicinity to usage at all times and reviewed
monthly to ensure accuracy in the site storage and register content.
All documentation, marking, labelling and placarding requirements are in compliance with local and
international standards. All hazardous and dangerous goods packaging shall be in compliance with the
requirements of the UN Global Harmonized System of Classification of Chemicals (GHS) ST/SG/AC.10/30.
The contractor shall ensure that all storage, utilization and recording and reporting procedures for hazardous
substances and dangerous goods shall comply with local legislation.
Routes for Contractor arranged road vehicles transporting hazardous substances and dangerous goods
must be pre-planned whenever possible to the extent practicable, taking into account routes should be
selected to minimize the risk of personal injury or harm to the environment or property during the journey. All
contractor arranged road vehicles used in the transport of hazardous substances and dangerous goods shall
at all times be in compliance with local and international standards. Drivers of Contractor arranged road
vehicles shall be trained and where required appropriately licensed to operate the vehicle and its cargo.
The Contractor shall have shovels, drip pans and absorbent materials which shall be strategically located
throughout their work site and a means to contain spills should they occur. The contractor shall train site
personnel in spill prevention and management, including chemicals and fuel.
All contractor work sites where waste or waste containing hazardous substances and / or a dangerous good
is generated shall provide for appropriate storage and disposal of that waste from the site. Disposal shall be
through licensed operators and to licensed waste disposal sites which accept hazardous and dangerous
goods
8.17.1 Asbestos
The contractor shall not procure or permit on site, any goods containing asbestos or asbestos containing
materials in the performance of the site works.
The contractor performing site works which may result in exposure to asbestos containing material are
required to have implemented a Permit to Work and supporting Work Method Statement (WMS) to prevent
the exposure of airborne asbestos fibers to personnel and the environment. The WMS shall also contain
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 49 of 83
processes around the safe and disposal methods of asbestos removed from plant and equipment. Disposal
of asbestos shall only be through authorized site locations
Prior to commencing any works the contractor shall obtain the site Asbestos Management Plan and
Asbestos Register to determine the location of plant and material where asbestos is contained. Only trained,
competent and in some jurisdictions licensed, contractor personnel and/or subcontractors are permitted to
work on plant and material where exposure to asbestos will be evident.
The contractor shall establish safe work zones where asbestos removal or repair work is to be undertaken.
Air monitoring is to be undertaken by a competent person and analyzed by an accredited laboratory /testing
authority. Air monitoring reports shall be provided to the site manager when required. The contractor shall
establish procedures in managing unplanned exposure to asbestos during project work.
The subsequent disposal of asbestos or asbestos containing material shall only be through disposal sites
authorized to accept asbestos waste. Asbestos waste shall be appropriately contained and labelled prior to
any transportation to the authorized disposal site.
8.17.2 Radioactive Material
The contractor shall develop and implement structured processes for the planning and management of
activities involving the use of radioactive material in order to minimize the potential impacts to people and
the environment.
The contractor shall undertake a hazard identification process (e.g. Job Hazard Analysis/Work Method
Statement) applicable to the scope of works to ensure that procedures and controls are implemented to
protect personnel from radiation exposure.
The contractor conducting works with radiation equipment; i.e. through radiation contractors, are responsible
for all health, safety and environmental protection arrangements relating to the transport, storage, use and
ultimate disposal of the radiation equipment. Prior to using radiation equipment on site, the contractor shall
provide the following information to the Site Manager.
This following information shall be on file before the radiography contractor begins work:
• A copy of the contractor’s radioactive material license or registration;
• The name and phone number of the contractor’s radiation safety officer;
• The type and size of the source of radiation being used or expected to be used in the future;
• The type of radiation equipment, x-ray machine, or source handling equipment to be used;
• A description and location of the project site storage facility to be used; and
• A copy of the contractor’s operating and emergency procedures.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 50 of 83
8.18 Health Surveillance
The contractor shall have in place a system to identify, assess and manage physical, chemical, biological,
ergonomic and psychological hazards in the workplace. The contractor shall identify through health risk
assessment processes the health hazards associated with the scope of works and implement control
measures.
8.18.1 Workplace Exposure Monitoring
The contractor shall have a process in place to measure and monitor potential exposure to the hazards to
health which are identified through the health risk assessment. Industrial hygiene assessments may include,
but are not limited to the following hazards that can be present at the workplace:
• Noise;
• Dust;
• Biological agents;
• Vibration;
• Lead;
• Asbestos;
• Synthetic Mineral Fibers;
• Silica;
• Hexavalent chromium
• Cadmium
• Radiation;
• Temperature – extreme heat / cold;
• Other identified chemicals and hazardous substances.
The contractor monitoring program shall be established and documented detailing baseline survey
outcomes, exposure limit levels per hazard and monitoring results. Where any substance is to be used that
has significant potential to cause an adverse health effect, exposure to that substance shall not exceed
local, national or internationally (as appropriate) recognized occupational exposure limits. Baseline exposure
levels shall be recorded and referenced during workplace exposure monitoring.
Contractor management shall ensure that the required control measures including protective equipment is
properly used, maintained and every person shall make full and proper use of the control measures and
equipment provided and report any defects.
A copy of the monitoring program shall be forwarded to WorleyParsons.
8.19 Health Promotion
The contractor shall develop a health promotion program, and include in the HSE Plan. The health
promotion program shall align with health and hygiene hazards identified within the project
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 51 of 83
8.20 First Aid and Medical Treatment
As part of the overall Emergency Response Plan (ERP), a Medical Emergency Plan shall be developed and
implemented by the contractor to cover medical resources available both onsite and offsite to respond to
incidents and the medical facilities to be made available. The Plan shall consider the nature and location of
the work undertaken, likelihood of specific outcomes being realized and any legal requirements.
The contractor shall provide sufficient portable first aid kits and qualified first aid trained personnel for each
work area or team. Training and competence level(s) required of those who shall respond shall meet
recognized international standards for a First Aid at Work Certificate.
Contractor personnel shall be made aware of the location of first aid resources (internally and externally) and
the requirement to report all injuries/ illnesses. All medical injuries and illnesses shall be recorded.
Emergency drills, which involve tests of the medical response capability, shall be conducted at least
quarterly
8.21 Injury/I l lness Management
The contractor shall have systems for workplace injury/illness management (rehabilitation) in place for the
rehabilitation of contractor personnel following work-related injury or illness. These systems shall be made
available to all affected contractor personnel and shall include:
• The steps that will be taken when a work related injury/illness occurs.
• The contact details of the person who has day to day responsibility for the injury management
system.
• The contact details of the person who has responsibility for return to work.
• The steps to be taken to ensure the confidentiality of all personal medical information.
The rehabilitation process shall include the identification of a member of the contractor management to
coordinate the implementation of the return to work programs, when an personnel has been certified unfit for
work or unable to return to full duties
8.22 Lift ing and Rigging
8.22.1 Crane Lift
The contractor shall have in place a system to manage the risks and hazards of crane lifting operations for
the works. This system shall provide details for the following:
• Risks associated with all lifting, crane maintenance, assembly activities and environmental
conditions shall be identified and assessed as part of the planning process;
• Ensuring all cranes/lifting equipment have current inspection records that meet statutory and
customer requirements;
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 52 of 83
• Only competent personnel shall work with cranes and lifting equipment. This competency shall be
regularly reviewed. Proof of competency shall include license evidence, theoretical competency and
practical competency on the particular crane to be used;
• A competent single point of accountability shall oversee, direct and control all lifting operations;
• All cranes and lifting equipment shall be periodically (minimum 3 monthly) inspected and tested
(including non-destructive testing as required by the relevant standard) prior to being operated or put
into service;
• A formal selection and acceptance process based on risk assessment shall be in place for all new
(to site) and modified lifting equipment;
• Controls to prevent objects from lifting equipment and loads falling from above;
• The National and or Regulated agreed and documented communication signs to be used as a
minimum; and
• The selection of slings shall be based upon the weight, shape and type of the load (temperature and
sensitivity of material to be moved), and the environmental conditions of the workplace.
The contractor shall have implemented a Lift Study and Checklist process for required lifting operations. A
Lift Study shall be submitted to the Contractor HSE for review 48 hours prior to any critical lift operations as
follows:
• Lifts exceeding 75% of crane rated capacity in the configuration required for the proposed lift;
• Lifts requiring two or more cranes lifting simultaneously (tandem lifts);
• Lifts with helicopters over areas defined as “congested areas”. Which are defined as areas people
utilize or inhabit (e.g., non-wilderness areas);
• The lift is considered to be unusual, awkward or complicated;
• The lift requires the use of specialist one-off lifting equipment;
• The lift needs to be tailed by one or more mobile cranes;
• Multiple crane lifts using cranes of different configurations;
• Lifts involving hazardous materials (e.g., explosives, highly volatile substances); and
• Lifts involving submerged loads.
8.22.2 Lift ing Equipment and Plant
All contractor crane bodies and lifting equipment shall display a unique identity label. High wear items (e.g.
shackles, slings, pad-eyes, shipping and handling basket) shall be color coded to confirm compliance with
certification and inspection requirements.
All contractor cranes shall display their manufacturer defined safe working load (SWL) and the Working Load
Limit (WLL).
Safe Working Loads and Working Load Limits shall not be exceeded. Lifting equipment known or suspected
to have been overloaded shall be withdrawn from service. Lifting shall only be used if the lifting equipment
due date for examination has not been exceeded. A register of all lifting equipment shall be maintained. All
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 53 of 83
clamps and lifting beams shall be clearly identified / labelled. Slings, chains, hooks and shackles shall be
stamped with the approved load limitation.
Lifting shall only be used if the lifting equipment due date for examination has not been exceeded. A register
of all lifting equipment shall be maintained. All clamps and lifting beams shall be clearly identified / labelled.
Slings, chains, hooks and shackles shall be stamped with the approved load limitation.
Rigging equipment shall ensure:
• All equipment is permanently marked with a unique identification code/tag;
• An inventory of owned or leased rigging equipment is maintained;
• A log is maintained to track all rigging equipment, noting when items are checked out, their
acceptance condition at issuance and the date and condition when they are returned; and
• Periodic inspections are conducted and formally recorded.
• Rigging equipment shall not be exposed to the elements and shall be stored and maintained in
accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions. When required for protection, items shall be stored
on cribbing and covered.
8.23 Lone and Remote Work
Working alone is considered a high risk activity and the contractor shall address the risks, mitigation and
control processes to eliminate this activity wherever possible. WorleyParsons does not permit personal
working alone on activities that include work unsuitable for one person especially where equipment is to be
operated, working at heights and working over water/ice or other difficult environmental conditions.
A risk assessment shall be conducted by the contractor for all lone and isolated work activities. Contractor
personnel are not permitted to work alone or in isolated areas without appropriate procedures and controls
being implemented. Controls shall include communication equipment and processes, emergency response
and contractor training.
8.24 Mobile Plant and Mechanized Equipment
8.24.1 Mobile Plant
The contractor shall have a system in place for the use of mobile equipment associated with the scope of
works. The system shall include the requirements for:
• A documented risk-based process for selection of new and modified mobile surface equipment prior
to purchase and use;
• A documented risk-based for on the job assessment for both operations and maintenance works
off/on mobile surface equipment;
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 54 of 83
• Equipment pre start procedures in place and implemented for all surface mobile equipment,
including daily operator checklists. This procedure shall include assessment of safe gradients and
surface stability requirements;
• A maintenance and inspection program for surface mobile equipment in place and implemented.
Procedures shall nominate works the machine operator may undertake unsupervised and those that
must be undertaken by a competent tradesperson and confirmation testing for safe operation after
any maintenance;
• Operator competency assessment to meet the skills, experience, knowledge, training and
performance expectations of the mobile plant assigned to operate.
All mobile plant shall be fitted with:
• Seatbelt;
• A clearly audible reversing beeper;
• A flashing / rotating amber light that shall be illuminated at all times that the plant is operational; and
• Additional safety equipment and precautions as identified by specific work tasks risk assessments.
8.24.2 Static Plant and Equipment
The contractor shall develop and implement structured control measures and records for the purchase, hire,
transportation, inspection, use and maintenance of static plant and equipment.
8.24.2.1 PURCHASE OR H IRE OF ST ATIC PL ANT AND EQUIPMENT
Prior to the purchase or hire of static plant and equipment the contractor shall consider a range of HSE
issues to ensure the risks to personnel and the environment are managed in accordance with Legislative
and project requirements, which may include but not limited to the following:
• Labelling & Packaging requirements (size, weight)
• Specific Loading, Transportation and Unloading requirements (e.g. fabricated lifting frame)
• Storage / Separation requirements
• Any permits or specific approvals or Certification required?
• Material Safety Data Sheets
• Noise limits (85 dBA) and subsequent noise reduction measures
• Health Assessments
• Operator Licenses, Certificates
• Specific Personal Protective Equipment
• Specific Fire or emergency instructions
• Specific environmental monitoring
• Waste Management /Disposal requirements
• Subsequent impacts on interfacing with other construction work groups or client operations
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 55 of 83
8.24.2.2 INSPECTION
Contractor qualified competent person (i.e. Electrician and/or Mechanical Personnel) shall inspect and verify
the condition of all static plant and equipment prior to delivery to the work site.
All static plant and equipment shall be formally inspected every 3 months and color tagged in accordance
with the portable electrical inspection and tagging requirements.
8.24.2.3 MAINTENANCE
The contractor shall perform plant and equipment maintenance in areas within the work site approved by
WorleyParsons. The contractor shall ensure all static plant and equipment under its direct and indirect
control is maintained in good working condition, leak free and in accordance with the manufacturer’s
requirements.
8.24.2.4 RECORDS
The contractor shall establish and maintain records of all static plant and equipment used at the worksite for
the duration of its scope.
8.24.3 Machine Guarding
The Contractor shall ensure machines are fitted with guards so as to prevent access to parts, which may
constitute a hazard to personnel (e.g. moving parts, very hot or very cold parts, etc.). Guards to parts where
access is not necessary for operation, inspection, and maintenance or cleaning shall be fixed. The design
and installation of guards shall be such so as not to interfere with the normal operation or maintenance of
the equipment. Machine guarding and interlocks shall be inspected and maintained at regular intervals. Full
records of inspection and maintenance shall be kept.
8.24.4 Spray Painting & Powder Coating
The contractor shall develop and implement structured methods for spray painting and powder coating
activities associated with its scope of work. The processes shall include
• Risk assessment
• Spray painting and powder coating inside and outside a spray booth
• Ventilation and extraction systems
• Training and instruction
• Maintenance of plant and equipment
• Storage and disposal of paint solvents and chemicals used in the processes.
• Fire and explosion con prevention
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 56 of 83
8.24.5 Noise
The contractor shall have a system in place to identify those at risk from noise exposure and to reduce that
exposure. A Noise Exposure Assessment shall be carried out as part of the site planning process and then
reviewed and updated when circumstances change for works conducted under the control of the contractor.
Noise reduction measures should be developed throughout the period of the project. Where a noise
assessment indicates personnel may be exposed to noise levels equivalent to excess of 85 dBA (or lower
when mandated by local regulation) for the duration of an 8 hour working shift, a noise management plan for
the work shall be implemented. A noise management plan (potentially part of a broader environmental
management plan) may require advice from an acoustic specialist, particularly where works are proposed
outside of normal working hours in noise sensitive areas.
All mechanical plant (including power plant) is to be silenced by the best practical means using current
technology and maintained to the manufacturer’s specifications. Internal combustion engines are to be fitted
with a suitable muffler in good repair.
Community consultation may be required for large-scale projects or high-impact works. Where the
community will be significantly impacted, consultation with the community shall be done in conjunction with
WorleyParsons and/or customer.
The exposure measurement levels shall be defined and assessed by applied local legislation, international
standard or equivalent (e.g. utilizing dBA, Lex or Leq).
Equivalent noise exposures
Noise level in dBA Minimum exposure
83 dBA 12 hours
85 dBA 8 hours
88 dBA 4 hours
91 dBA 2 hours
95 dBA 50 minutes
105 dBA 5 minutes
140 dBA (LC, peak noise) Nil
8.25 Performance Testing, Commissioning and Start-up
A programmed schedule of works shall be provided to Worley Parsons in support of the overall
commissioning process. The Contractor shall establish a series of performance testing, commissioning and
start up work method statements applicable to the scope of works. The procedures may cover but not limited
to
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 57 of 83
• installation verification;
• pre-functional testing;
• functional performance testing;
• calibration;
• adjustment; and
• Tuning.
The work method statements shall be submitted to Worley Parsons for approval 21 days prior to
commencing the commissioning process.
The contractor shall ensure effective HSE risk control measures are incorporated into the established
procedures/checklists associated with each step of the commissioning process for each item of equipment/
system. The outcomes from the risk assessment will deliver, but not limited to, the recommended safety
control measures to be implemented by the Contractor.
The contractor shall maintain Permit to Work processes throughout the performance testing, commissioning
and start up works. All personnel (including subcontractor) engaged by the contractor to conduct the
performance testing, commissioning and start up work shall be qualified and experienced in such works.
During all the commissioning activities, the contractor shall involve customer operating personnel (nominated
by Client) and impart necessary techniques and knowhow required for safe operation and maintenance of
the facilities.
8.26 Personal Protective and Lifesaving Equipment
The contractor shall develop and implement a Personal Protective Equipment (PPE) program that addresses
the hazards to be encountered; selection, safe use, inspection and maintenance, training of personnel and
monitoring to ensure ongoing effectiveness.
The contractor PPE selection process shall not solely be based upon cost. Consideration needs to include
but not limited to: 1) work environment factors, 2) job task factors (e.g. degree of dexterity, durability,
characteristics of items being handled), 3) personal factors (different sizes and shapes).
The contractor shall develop in table format information relating to the minimum PPE to wear for various
work activities to be performed associated with its scope.
Minimum PPE standard for site entry is as follows:
• Long sleeve shirt made from natural fibers only, with collar and with sleeves rolled down and
buttoned at the cuff, preferably with high visibility and reflective strips;
• Long Trousers / Overalls made from natural fibers only shall be worn at all times, preferably with
high visibility and reflective strips;
• High visibility vest (if no high visibility apparel);
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 58 of 83
• For night or underground operations, all persons wear an outer vest or webbing harness fitted with
reflective material so as to be visible from all directions; or have panels or strips of reflective material
securely attached to their clothing so as to be visible from all directions.
• Safety helmets or hard hats; i.e. NOT bump-caps shall be worn at all times. Hat accessories such as
wide brim, hard hat liners and other apparel to protect neck and head are recommended for outdoor
climatic conditions;
• Steel capped safety footwear with ankle support and mid-sole penetration protection shall be worn at
all times. Non-metallic composite toe capped boots, slip on or elastic sided boots are not permitted,
• Safety glasses with side shields shall be worn at all times. (If required to wear prescription glasses
these will also be safety glasses with side shields. Contact lenses are permitted, provided safety
glasses/goggles are worn, but are not permitted when wearing a full face respirator in presence of
H2S). Over-spectacles are only permitted for visitors; i.e. not for those carrying out work at the site;
• Gloves shall be worn for all work tasks except where the task risk assessment demonstrates that
wearing gloves significantly increases the risk. Gloves shall be suitable to the work task involved
and be in good condition. All personnel, including visitors, shall carry a pair of gloves on their person
at all times;
• Hearing protection shall be worn in designated and sign-posted areas and when undertaking noisy
tasks or in areas where there is excessive noise.
Lifesaving equipment (fall protection, fall arrest harness, respiratory protection, and floatation devices) may
be required by hazard identification processes. Contractor personnel shall be trained and where required
certified to use this equipment.
All PPE and lifesaving equipment provided by the Contractor shall comply with relevant local and
international standards e.g. ANSI, ISO, EEC, AS/NZS, API, etc. and be maintained to manufacturer’s
recommendations.
8.27 Safe Work Conditions
8.27.1 Barricading and Signage
The contractor shall ensure barricades and barriers are in place where required by risk assessments or
methods of work and include but not limited to such works as civil installation works, explosive powered tool
use, demolition, hazardous installation works, commissioning and start-up etc.
Barricades and barriers are required for:
• Segregation of personnel from operating equipment (cranes, forklifts, etc.)
• Segregation of operating equipment from operating plant, including high voltage power lines, and
excavations / mines
• Prevention of access to potentially unsafe areas (confined space, high voltage, rotating equipment
etc.)
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 59 of 83
• Proximity to high temperature or pressure or high voltage
• Traffic management and segregation
• Containment of dust or particulate substances in the atmosphere (e.g. spray paint, sand blasting
dust, asbestos etc.)
• Falling into open penetrations/cavities/man-holes/where grating or decking has been removed etc.
• Prevention of access to decommissioned facilities, walkways, lifts etc.
• Prevention of access to non-authorized personnel (as controlled by permit to work – not security)
including during non-work hours
• Segregation from specific potentially hazardous work processes (i.e. radiation, pneumatic/hydro
testing, scaffolding, rigging,
• Segregation from discharges from use, storage or transport of hazardous materials
• Prevention of falling: from elevated work areas, or into water.
• Maintaining a controlled condition to allow certain work to take place (e.g. wind breaks, tents or work
covers for electrical work, welding)
• Segregation of installation personnel from commissioning and start-up activities
The use of plastic warning or hazard tape as a barricade is not permitted.
All barricading shall be accompanied with appropriate signage and information tags communicating the type
of hazard associated with the barricading and applicable contact information. The contractor shall maintain
all barricading and warning signs to a high standard and immediately remove it when no longer required.
8.27.2 Notices and Signs
Where an identified workplace hazard cannot be eliminated, the contractor shall ensure that signage
appropriate to the hazard is posted. Signs shall be highly visible from all directions of approach,
standardized in color, shape, size, lettering, symbols and content while meeting local regulatory
requirements. Where there are no local regulatory requirements, the international standard ISO3864 shall be
adopted.
Symbolic signs shall be used in preference to word only or combined word-symbol signs. Where words are
used, they shall be in all languages that are in common usage at the site. Personnel shall be trained to
understand symbolic, safety and road signs, and take appropriate actions required.
Warning signs shall be periodically inspected to ensure they are clean and in the correct position.
8.27.3 Housekeeping
A systematic housekeeping program shall be implemented by the Contractor to eliminate hazards and
potential incidents occurring from substandard housekeeping practices.
Contractor line management shall communicate and frequently reinforce expectations regarding
housekeeping standards. The contractor shall conduct weekly safety walkthroughs and loss prevention
inspections to systematically monitor housekeeping standards
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 60 of 83
The contractor shall provide containers for the collection and separation of waste, trash, oily and used rags
and other refuse. Metal (Dumpster type) containers must be used and emptied promptly. Garbage and other
waste shall be disposed of at frequent and regular intervals to approved waste disposal facilities.
The contractor shall bear all costs associated with the cessation of work and clean-up including, where
necessary, Third Parties being brought in to facilitate the clean-up process to the required standard.
8.28 Scaffold, Stairways and Ladders
The contractor shall have in place a system to ensure only competent personnel design, supervise, erect
and approve scaffolding, stairs and walkways. The Competency Register shall be used as a minimum to
record this. Scaffolds, stairs and walkways shall be constructed and loaded in accordance with the
competent person’s design capabilities and experience.
The contractor shall verify all scaffolding, stairs and walkways comply with the requirements of
WorleyParsons recognized standards.
8.28.1 Scaffolding
The design and construction of scaffolding shall comply with a recognized local, national or international
standard. The contractor shall implement systems and processes in meeting the required standards for the
various scaffold configurations and types in use within the scope of works.
8.28.2 Ladders
The contractor shall ensure all portable and fixed ladders are inspected by a competent person on each
occasion before use; actions shall be taken to correct defects immediately. A ladder which has been
damaged or is defective in any way shall not be used for any purpose.
Glass reinforced plastic should be the material of choice and used for all portable ladders. Metal ladders and
ladders with metal stiles or reinforcing shall not be used in any application where they may come into close
proximity of any live electrical circuit. Wooden ladders, where allowed, shall not have any part painted other
than a small area for identification purposes.
Wire rope ladders shall be constructed from flexible steel wire rope. Wire rope ladders shall be proprietary
brand ladders manufactured to a recognized local, national or international standard.
8.29 Simultaneous Operations/Activities
The contractor shall have established procedures in place to manage the activities and risks associated with
Simultaneous Operations (SIMOPS). The procedures may involve SIMOPS processes incorporating but not
limited to the following:
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 61 of 83
The SIMOP process is repeated for each instance of SIMOPS activity. This takes place during the design
phase of the project allowing solutions to be designed and reviewed and a dossier prepared. This dossier
can then be reviewed as part of the preparation activities for implementation. In the event that simultaneous
operations introducing hazards are identified after the design phase (i.e. during construction and testing) the
SIMOPS methodology should be applied.
The first stage identifies the requirements for, and the specific area of operations involved and the parties
involved. Each operation is analyzed to ensure its requirements are fully understood. Once a SIMOPS has
been identified a kick off meeting should identify all the activities to be carried out.
An appropriate level risk assessment is conducted and should include known SIMOPS risks. A hierarchy of
control is developed for each work specific SIMOP activity and establishes the roles and responsibilities for
all involved with authority within the SIMOP.
Each party should draw up a dossier which provides a work specific summary for their part in the activities.
This shall include:
• The schedule and identification of main installation features and equipment to be utilized.
• A summary of the main hazards for each of the operations and work specific risk assessment.
• Mitigation strategies and precautions proposed.
• Escape route identification
• Weather limitations for each operation
• Communications including a schedule for normal work activities and emergencies
• Checklist of actions to be taken for each work specific SIMOPS operations
• Contingency plans
Each party reviews each other party’s work specific dossier in a systematic manner. This review will provide
a further analysis of any clashes to work and schedules and required interdependencies.
A SIMOPS Interface document is developed setting out the activities covered by the document and should
be applicable to all parties operations for the specified activity. A SIMOPS Matrix, where appropriate may be
developed to identify those activities permissible when conducted simultaneously.
Once the risk assessment has been completed an execution plan can be formulated taking into account the
prevention, control and mitigation measures identified. Part of the planning process shall include
preparation of emergency response identifying clear responsibilities and procedures to be followed in the
event of an incident
A daily pre operations briefing is undertaken to ensure that all parties are aware of roles and responsibilities
and hierarchy of controls and to validate all lines of communications, operational and emergency prior to
final authorization to proceed to begin. Job Hazard Analysis processes, pre start meetings etc. should be
used to brief personnel on the work to be carried out, what other activities are taking place and to ensure
that all are aware of the safety controls in place and they are satisfied with them
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 62 of 83
Permit to Work (PTW) and applicable authorizations are managed through a single PTW by the Project
Manager or authorized nominee
Coordination and management of the SIMOPS is achieved through the arrangements established and set
out in the interface document.
A system is in place to monitor the hierarchy of controls to ensure all parties recognize any deviation from
the control limits and therefore apply an ‘all stop’ or change management processes as appropriate.
8.30 Transport
8.30.1 Land Transport
8.30.1.1 TRAFFIC MANAGEMENT
Where requested by WorleyParsons, based upon the significant movement of light vehicles or heavy mobile
plant, work location and/or combination of all factors, the Contractor shall develop a Traffic Management
Plan for review and acceptance post Contract Award. The Traffic Management Plan and the implementation
of such shall incorporate but not limited where applicable to the design of roads, parking, site road rules,
operating inside live plant areas, vehicle/pedestrian segregation, breakdowns, towing and housekeeping The
Contractor Traffic Management Plan is to be updated as conditions change and communicated to the
workforce.
The movement of any heavy vehicle or mobile equipment by the contractor shall be subject, as a minimum,
to a job hazard analysis, or personal hazard identification, involving the equipment driver / operator and the
Company or the Contractor supervisor responsible for the movement.
8.30.1.2 VEHICLE LOADING AND UNLOADING
Contractual agreements incorporating delivery service requirements and loading/unloading processes
utilized by the Contractor shall include proactive measures to eliminate risk of falls from vehicles.
Consultation shall occur between the transport company and the Contractor to ensure that an appropriate
delivery receipt plan for the loading, transport and unloading has been developed. A Job Hazard Analysis
(JHA) shall be completed before the start of any loading or unloading operation. Delivery vehicles which
arrive on site in such a way that a safe means of loading or unloading is not achievable then they should be
refused access to site and turned away until a safe means is achieved.
Every load must be restrained to prevent unacceptable movement. The load restraint system must meet
relevant regulated performance standards so that the load doesn’t shift when subjected to specific forces.
Over center lever binders, shall not be used by transport service providers who are engaged to perform
services.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 63 of 83
8.31 Underground
The contractor shall take all necessary measures to eliminate or minimize the safety and health risks to
contractor personnel assigned to underground activities. In conjunction with the underground site client, the
following control measures as applicable shall be implemented:
• Adequate training and retraining programs and comprehensible instructions are provided for
Contractor personnel for the work assigned
• Communication and signaling processes
• Electrical, mechanical and other equipment, including a communication system, are health and
safety certified for use in underground operations
• Ensure the monitoring, assessment and regular inspection of the working environment to identify the
various hazards to which the workers may be exposed and to assess their level of exposure. This is
no limited to:
o ventilation and dust control,
o poisonous gases,
o control of ignition sources,
o noise and vibration monitoring,
o temperature and humidity levels.
• Regular health surveillance of workers exposed to occupational health hazards specific to
underground work
• Adequate sanitation and first aid facilities
• Sufficient lighting to the activity undertaken
• Plant / person interaction including those with automated and remotely controlled plant and
equipment
• All persons wear an outer vest or webbing harness fitted with reflective material so as to be visible
from all directions; or have panels or strips of reflective material securely attached to their clothing
so as to be visible from all directions.
• In addition to correct PPE, the Contractor must ensure that any persons travelling or working
underground in the mine are provided with battery operated cap lamps that are of an appropriate
standard and have a sufficient capacity, with an adequate reserve, for the duration of that shift
• An emergency response plan for reasonably foreseeable industrial accidents and natural disasters.
This is not limited to:
• hazardous substances,
• fire and explosion,
• spontaneous combustion,
• inundation (fluids or gases),
• outburst/rock burst,
• strata/lining failure, and
• Ventilation.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 64 of 83
The contractor shall ensure that a procedure is established at the mine for checking all persons in and out of
the mine so that all persons are accounted for at the end of each working shift.
Every contractor haulage vehicle that a person rides on, or might ride on, and that operates in an
environment in which people are working should be fitted with the following items:
• Adequate lights
• An emergency supplementary steering system,
• A suitable fail-to-safe braking system
• An effective method for ensuring the vehicle is visible under all circumstances.
• Suitable firefighting equipment
• A reverse warning system
No internal combustion engine, other than a compression ignition diesel engine, should be installed or used
in an underground mine or tunnel. It should have Sulphur content of not more than 0.05% by weight; and be
free from dirt, sediment, and water.
8.32 Waste Management
The contractor is responsible for managing all solid and liquid wastes within the Scope of Works. The
contractor shall have in place procedures outlining processes for the management, handling, treatment and
disposal of waste substances and materials generated on the project site. The process shall identify the
waste streams likely to be generated across the project sites and the methods of waste control required to
ensure that legislative requirements are not breached.
In developing the waste management processes, The contractor shall adopt across the scope of sorks the
following hierarchy of waste management options:
• reduce and avoid waste generation
• reuse and recycle; and
• treat and dispose (where disposal is only the appropriate option if none of the above offers an
appropriate solution)
Wastes defined as hazardous according to Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA) will be
taken off site to a licensed waste disposal facility for disposal. All sanitary wastewater will be directed to
package tertiary sewage treatment systems or removed offsite.
8.32.1 Liquid Emission / Discharge
The contractor shall have in place a Liquid Emissions / Discharges Management System used to identify,
assess and control activities that have the potential to cause discharges of liquids to surface water, drains,
and the ocean or onto land.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 65 of 83
The contractor system shall contain processes as applicable for the prevention of fugitive liquid emissions
through means including:
• bunding for all liquid storage facilities which are impervious and prevent the escape of liquids stored
• provision of oil in water interceptors and / or holding / settlement pits / tanks / ponds to allow the
separation of suspended solids and immiscible liquids;
• provision of continuous or batch sampling points for drainage systems with automatic or manual
rerouting facilities if specified liquid qualities are not met;
• provision of separate drainage systems / routing
• site vehicles require cleaning before they leave site and use public roadways to prevent their
contaminating the roadways with mud, etc.
• vehicles that require thorough seed, insect, rodent inspection and / or cleaning before entering the
site to prevent environmental contamination.
• opportunities for reuse / recycling of produced water from a dedicated site water treatment facility,
where provided, as is appropriate to the quality of the produced water:
• opportunities for the utilization of gray water and / or rain water should be considered where water
treatment facilities are unavailable.
Chemicals used on site will be waste managed according to their material safety data sheets.
8.32.2 Waste from works
The contractor shall avoid petroleum-based solvents where possible during construction and bio-degradable
cleaning products used instead.
The contractor must supply a waste volume update regularly to WorleyParsons, which will be recorded in a
register. This register is to track and detail final disposal of all wastes within the Contractor control.
8.33 Welding and Cutting
Unless in a designated hot work area, all welding and cutting activities undertaken by the Contractor shall be
covered by the appropriate hot/cold work permit and other permits as applicable e.g. confined space permit.
The contractor shall ensure safe work practices are implemented at all times during the welding and cutting
activities. Work method statements and supporting procedures shall be implemented to support the works
undertaken. The use of screens to protect nearby workers from welding glare shall be implemented by the
Contractor.
Exhaust and general ventilation systems used in the extraction/capture of toxic fumes, gases and dusts shall
ensure maximum exposure standard to personnel are not exceeded. In circumstances for which it is
impossible to provide such ventilation, airline respirators or hose masks approved for this purpose must be
used. Each contractor welder or cutter should have at least one 9.1Kg (20 lb.) all-purpose dry powder fire
extinguishers at the location where the welding or cutting is being performed.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 66 of 83
All contractor persons performing welding activities shall be competent and qualified for the class of work
being performed. The Contractor shall have a procedure in place to ensure this competency is maintained
and recorded formally
8.33.1 Compressed gas and oxygen cylinders
All cylinders shall be clearly marked stating contents and secured as per relevant local Standards. Cylinders
shall not be accepted onsite that are not properly labelled as to contents, capped and secured. The
contractor shall have procedures implemented to cover the transport and moving, placing, storing, use and
refilling of gas cylinders.
8.33.2 Grinding
The use of 9" (230mm) portable grinders for cutting and grinding activities is not allowed under any
circumstances. This requirement is effective for all new projects commencing from 1 July 2014.
The use of 7" (175mm) portable grinders for cutting should be avoided wherever possible. A Job Hazard
Analysis using the hierarchy of controls to eliminate the need to undertake this activity must be done by the
contractor and approved by a WorleyParsons. The use of 7" (175mm) grinders for grinding activities can
only be performed with approval by the WorleyParsons supervisor.
Prior to use all portable grinders shall:
• Be subject to a Job Safety Analysis (JSA) before use and the risk assessment reviewed and
updated accordingly if conditions change
• Be fitted with a 'dead man" switch if above 5" (125mm) in size
• Be fitted with a "soft start" / clutch mechanism if above 5" (125mm) in size
• Be fitted with a handle to allow two-handed operation.
All operators of portable grinders shall undertake Portable Grinder Safety training prior to commencing work
with grinders.
8.34 Golden rules for reducing risks.
Construction is a high-risk activity. This chapter covers the ‘5 Golden rules’ that will help you keep safe and healthy. Remember to:
• Plan and organize what you do
• Make sure you’re trained and competent and know the special risks in your trade
• Raise problems with your supervisor or safety representative. Rule # 1: THE BASICS Tidy sites and decent welfare
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 67 of 83
Tidy sites and decent welfare are the basics of a good site. Slips and trips are the most common cause of injuries at work. An untidy site is a poorly managed site. All sites need decent welfare facilities. The minimum welfare requirements are:
• Clean toilets
• Running hot and cold water with soap and towels
• Basins large enough to immerse your arms up to the elbows
• Drinking water
• Some- where warm, dry and clean to sit and eat
• Poor welfare facilities can lead to ill health Rule # 2: PROTECTION TO AVOID FALLS FROM HEIGHT Falls from height are the biggest cause of fatal and serious injuries in construction. They account for 50% of all deaths. Many accidents involve falls from roofs, through fragile materials, from ladders and from leading edges. Generally, make sure you:
• Work from a safe and secure place or platform with proper edge protection
• Use scaffolds and scaffold towers that are competently erected
• Use powered access equipment safely
• Protect holes and leading edges, e.g. with guardrails and toe boards
• When working on roofs never:
• Work in poor weather
• Work on sloping roofs without edge protection
• Throw down waste or equipment
• Take care when working on or near fragile material - you can fall through as well as off it. Ladders: Only use ladders for light work of short duration if there’s no safer alternative .Angle and secure them to prevent slipping (1 out for 4up) .Always make sure ladders are properly maintained Never over-reach Rule # 3: PROPER MANUAL HANDLING Manual handling injuries from working with heavy, awkward materials, often in wet conditions, are one of the most common reasons why workers leave construction. Injuries are made worse by repetitive jobs, such as laying heavy blocks.
• Use mechanical means, e.g. hoists, tele-porters and chutes
• Choose equipment suitable for the job and keep it maintained
• Change to lighter materials, bags etc.
• Avoid repetitive handling
• Avoid awkward movements
• Protect yourself and reduce the strain Rule # 4: PROPER TRANSPORT ARRANGEMENTS
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 68 of 83
Workplace transport incidents are the second most common cause of fatalities after falls from height.
• Use barriers and warning signs to separate vehicles and people
• Create clearance around slewing vehicles
• Avoid reversing – where you can’t, use trained banks men
• Make sure loads are secure
• Don’t use plant and vehicles on dangerous slopes
• Only take passengers on vehicles designed to take them
• Make sure vehicles are maintained and operators are trained
• When people and vehicles collide, people come off worse - so keep them apart! Rule # 5: PRECUATION WHILE WORKING ON ASBESTOS If you’re thinking of working in a building that was built or renovated up until the 1980s, you should assume it contains asbestos until proved otherwise. The main asbestos-containing materials (ACMs) are lagging, asbestos insulating board, sprayed insulation, decorative coatings and asbestos cement.
• Check if there is any ACM
• Find out what you need to do to work safely
• If in any doubt, leave it to the experts
8.35 SHE Passport – A Good practice guide.
This chapter on good practice guide describes that what a SHE Passport scheme is and also answers to some basic information about it and gives advice on good practice including a suggested core syllabus. SHE Passport scheme ensure that workers have basic health and safety awareness training and are a way of improving health and safety performance. They also help promote good practice and can help reduce accidents and ill health caused by work. They are especially useful for workers and contractors who work in more than one industry or firm. What are health, safety and environment Passports?
• SHE Passport shows that a worker has up-to-date basic health and safety or health, safety and environment awareness training. Some cover other subjects too.
• SHE Passports are a way of controlling access to work sites – only workers with valid Passports are allowed to work.
• They shall be of credit card size and made of strong plastic with a Photograph and signature.
• Workers can hold more than one SHE Passport if they have been trained for work in more than one industry.
• They are a very simple way for workers who move from one industry to another or work in more than one industry, to show employers they have basic training.
• A SHE Passport belongs to the worker not the employer.
• Some Certification Schemes operate like Passports.
• SHE Passport is a starting point for workers training for health, safety and environment qualifications.
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 69 of 83
What should SHE Passport training cover? A SHE Passport holder should know about:
• The hazards and risks they may face;
• The hazards or risks they can cause for other people;
• How to identify relevant hazards and potential risks;
• How to assess what to do to eliminate the hazard and control the risk
• How to take steps to control the risk to themselves and others;
• Their safety and environmental responsibilities, and those of the people they work with;
• Where to find any extra information they need to do their job safely; and How to follow a safe system of work
How SHE Passport scheme will work? An industry or group of companies decide they want a way of ensuring that their employees and any suppliers, contractors, self-employed or agency workers they use have basic health, safety and environment training. They need to decide or consider that:
• What training is needed for workers;
• Qualifications and resources needed by trainers;
• How training will be delivered and assessed;
• How long a Passport will be valid for;
• Need for refresher training before renewal; and
• How records will be kept and checked.
• A training scheme is developed, piloted and fine-tuned.
Courses are offered to workers. It is important to check that training has been successful, so workers must pass a test or an assessment must be made before a SHE Passport is issued. Once the scheme starts, the industry or group of companies will not allow workers on their sites unless they hold an up-to-date and valid SHE Passport. Large firms often have their own ‘approved’ list of contractors. To join this list, contractors may have to demonstrate their health, safety and environmental performance. Having workers with Passports is one way to do this. SHE Passports shall not be:
• A way of knowing or identifying that a worker is competent;
• A substitute for risk assessment;
• A way of showing ‘approval’ of a contractor;
• A reason to ignore giving site-specific information; or
• A substitute for effective on-site management Benefits and advantages of Passport schemes
• They can help reduce accidents and ill health caused by work.
• They can have a significant impact in reducing pollution incidents, minimizing waste and contributing to a cleaner environment for everyone.
• Passports save both time and money because workers need less induction training.
• They show a company’s commitment to having safe and healthy workers
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 70 of 83
Revision History
Section Description
Approval Table
Rev Description Originator Reviewer WorleyParsons Approval
Date Client Approval
Date
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 71 of 83
Appendix 1 Relevant Legislative and Authority License Conditions
[
• Oil Industry Safety Directorate (OISD) standards (latest) & recommendations
• Oil Industry Joint Implementation Committee’s recommendation
• Petroleum & Explosives Safety Organization (PESO)
• Oil Sector Infrastructure Protection Plan (OSIPP)
• Tariff Advisory Committee (TAC)
• Indian Boiler Regulations (IBR)
• Bureau of Indian Standards (BIS)
• National Building Code for Construction (NBCC)
• Indian Electricity Rules (IE Rules)
• NFPA
• Petroleum Rules and PNGRB guidelines
• Manufacture, Storage& Inspection of hazardous Chemicals(MSHIC)
• Storage Maintenance of Pressure Vessels(SMPV 1984)
• Factories Act, 1948;
• Petroleum Act, 1934 & the Petroleum Rules, 2002;
• Liquid effluent discharge, as per Minimal National Standards for liquid
• effluents and air emissions conforming to Pollution Control Board Standards;
• Civil Aviation Rules;
• Indian Boiler Regulation Act;
• The Electricity Act, 2003 and the Rules and Regulations made there under;
• Requirement of Chief Controller of Explosives;
• OISD Guidelines/norms (latest)
• Pollution Control Board Stipulations/Requirements;
• Requirements of Central/State Government Authorities;
• MOEF stipulations/requirements.
• Building and Other Construction Workers’ Act, 1996 / BOCW Rules (State Wise)
MB Lal Committee’s, OISPP& JIC Recommendation
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 72 of 83
Appendix 2 Contractor Mobilization HSE Task Checklist
The following checklist covers both pre-mobilization and post-mobilization HSE tasks for contractors. This checklist may be added to with project specific requirements.
Requirements BSC Before Site Commencement Status at: (insert date)
M Mandatory (where applicable to scope)
BAC Before Activity Commencement AC Activity Complete
R Recommended C + X X days after commencement AP Activity Pending
NA Not Applicable C – X X days before commencement
WORLEYPARSONS REQUIREMENTS Requirement Remarks
1 CUSTOMER, REGULATOR AND COMPANY REQUIREMENTS
1.1 Review contractual agreements and project HSE specifications for HSE requirements and build them into the relevant HSE plan and process.
M BSC
1.2
Identify and familiarize with applicable statutory acts, regulations and codes
Identify and familiarize with statutory licensing and or permit requirements
Confirm project regulator liaison and project protocol for communication with the regulators
M BSC
1.3 Review project scope of work and identify/ document key HSE activities and deliverables. M BSC
1.4 Identify WorleyParsons requirements and determine if a gap assessment and bridging plan is needed M BSC
2 RISK ASSESMENT
2.1
Conduct a scope specific HSE risk assessment with WorleyParsons construction and HSE personnel as an input to the HSE plan
• Discuss and determine the extent of coverage provided by the existing facility emergency response team (if applicable)
M BSC
2.2 Ensure controls are identified for all extreme and high risks and are incorporated into HSE planning and programs M BSC
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 73 of 83
2.3
Based on the HSE risk assessment identify specific HSE programs/initiatives needed that are not already covered by the WorleyParsons project program.
Develop (or raise awareness of existing) project specific plans or procedures addressing:
• High risk activities
• Physical, chemical and other hazards
• Medical surveillance requirements
• Construction environmental impact
• Project security
• Emergency action and response
• Special training requirements
M BSC
3 PLANNING AND APPROVALS
3.1
Review project schedule (particularly first six months) and identify key milestones. Input HSE aspects into the project start up plan i.e. 30/60/90 day look ahead
Add to the preliminary list of HSE deliverables based on schedule and ramp up/down/ holidays/phases of project, and submit for WorleyParsons approval
M BSC
3.2 Review HSE budget and confirm adequate for delivery of HSE program, or update R BSC
3.3 Clarify (and confirm alignment with what is documented) project HSE approval protocols and levels of authority associated with key positions
M BSC
3.4 Incorporate key deliverables and activities into project s-curve, and commence measurement and progress reporting
R BSC
3.5 Attend and participate in the project kick off meetings M BSC
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 74 of 83
3.6
Define linkage between contractor HSE documents and overarching WorleyParsons project HSE plans. Commence development of priority HSE plans, procedures, standards and requirements as applicable and incorporate relevant aspects of WorleyParsons HSE plans and initiatives.
The following generic plans have been identified as typical for most larger projects, however many of these may have been developed by WorleyParsons for the project and may satisfy the requirements for the contractor organizations also:
• Project HSE Plan
• Office HSE Plan
• Journey Management Plans (including requirements for project related travel including visiting vendor and fabrication shops)
• Assurance Plan
• Security Plan
• Emergency and Crisis Plan
• Offsite fabrication
• Minor contracts
M BSC
Discuss requirements with WorleyParsons and clarify which plans will be developed by WorleyParsons, and which must be developed at contractor level. In many cases there may be a single overarching plan that everyone on the project must work under, regardless of employer.
3.7
Gain formal WorleyParsons approval for the project plans, and ensure:
• Project HSE plans address the contract conditions, top HSE risks, and the legislative requirements of the country where the scheduled activities are to take place.
M BAC
3.8 Develop HSE leadership program, and define personal KPI, site visits, observation behavior program (SAZ), response to incidents and celebrating success
M BSC
3.9 Develop HSE organizational chart and submit to the WorleyParsons HSE manager for approval.
Submit CV of the proposed HSE Manager to the WorleyParsons HSE Manager for approval. M BSC
3.10 Attend project HSE alignment sessions as required by the project management team. M BSC
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 75 of 83
3.11 Develop key process metrics (KPI’s) specific to scope activities and identified risks in alignment with the project HSE program.
M BSC
3.12 Establish notification and reporting requirements including contractual and regulatory, and develop reporting templates
M BSC
3.13
Establish procedures and times for
• Job Start Meetings
• Prestart talks
• Tool Box Meetings
• Site HSE Meetings and communication
M BSC
3.14 Determine type and method of record-keeping, training database system and general files retention and procure if necessary (i.e., software programs etc.)
M BSC
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 76 of 83
3.15
Define task specific competency requirements and develop and implement training and practical assessment, including:
• Induction (industry, project and site) for all personnel
• Supervisor ( Team Leader ) orientation and engagement program
• Risk assessment /work method statements
• Root Cause Analysis overview
• Serious About Zero (SAZ) or other safety conversation program
• Craft training programs and craft competency testing program
• Other specialty training as determined by hazard assessments (i.e. hazardous chemicals, etc.)
• Course Languages
• Training on HSE tools – JHA, step back, behavioural safety etc.
Agree delivery method – balance lecture style classroom teaching with practical hands-on training and workshop discussion. Take into account literacy, culture and language
M BSC
3.16 Develop and submit for WorleyParsons approval the scope specific HSE induction program M BSC
3.17
Ensure details of Qualifications/Certificates of Competency and Competency Assessments are submitted/approved for all personnel required to commence works:
• Crane Drivers
• Machinery operators
• Scaffolders
• Riggers/Dogmen
• Welders
• Other (specify)
M BSC
3.18 Identify safety critical positions and competency verification process M BSC
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 77 of 83
3.19 If the project is to have golden rules, ensure a clear disciplinary process is in place to address any breaches. M BSC
3.20 Define the recognition program, including worker and supervisor recognition for safe work and safe behaviours M BSC
3.21
Develop templates for meeting schedules/agendas/Charters
Develop promotional and communications material, including:
• Posters/ banners/ stickers
• Newsletter/ weekly bulletin templates
• Other methods for providing whole of project HSE updates and communications
R BAC
3.22 Define the expectations and process for incident investigation, including expectations of line management and leadership.
R BAC
3.23 Plan for contractor readiness review (both desktop review of the premobilization deliverables, followed by an onsite post mobilization review prior to commencement of field execution work) to ensure that the required HSE planning, preparation and resourcing are in place.
M BAC
3.24
Develop risk based HSE assessment schedule. Include HSE self-assessments, independent assessments and readiness reviews in the schedule.
Ensure any sub-contractor organizations are included in the schedule. Top HSE risks associated with their scope must be assessed.
M BSC
3.25
Develop templates and schedule for HSE inspections on scope specific tasks aligned to HSE plan requirements and high risk activities (worksite, mobile equipment, rigging/lifting, scaffold etc.). Define level of management participation.
Include any sub-contractor organizations in the inspection schedule and associated activities.
M BSC
4 SUB-CONTRACTORS
4.1 Develop HSE prequalification and tender evaluation process for sub-contractors M BSC
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 78 of 83
4.2 Following sub-contractor evaluations determine the level of training needed, and the appropriate supervision ratios
M BSC
Higher supervision ratios and training are required for workers and sub-contractors with limited exposure to the type of scope, size, complexity and phase of the project.
4.3 Conduct HSE kick off meetings with each sub-contractor M BSC
4.4 Conduct scope specific risk assessment with each sub-contractor and ensure all extreme and high risks are adequately addressed through HSE plans.
M BSC
4.5
Provide sub-contractors with project and work scope specific pre and post mobilization deliverables as soon as possible after award of contact .i.e. kick off meeting.
Include clear outline of any non-negotiable HSE requirements for the project, and ensure sub-contractors can work to the requirements outlined in the project contractor HSE specifications provided by WorleyParsons.
M BSC
4.6 Approve any sub-contractor HSE plans and training processes.
Undertake competency assessments of critical position personnel prior to mobilization. M BSC
4.7
Review sub-contractor readiness pre and post mobilization to ensure the pre and post mobilization deliverables are achieved and sub-contractor is set up to achieve zero harm outcomes.
Identify any areas where the sub-contractor may provide additional support and agree to a suitable improvement plan.
M BAC
If needed request guidance from WorleyParsons on strategies to best support sub-contractors working on the project.
4.8 Establish contractor regular meetings with each sub-contractor organization to review HSE performance and plan for the activities in the coming period.
M BAC
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 79 of 83
4.9 Incorporate sub-contractor assurance activities into the assessment (audit) schedule M BAC
5 SITE SETUP
5.1
Identify and seek approval for any site establishment and mobilization. For remote sites or sites with camps consider:
• Medical and site emergency response
• Hygiene
• Messing
• Waste
• Security
• Site layout and traffic management
• Training facilities, including setups required for interactive training
M BAC
5.2 Identify the need for site wide radios and gain agreement to allocation of radio channels with WorleyParsons R BAC
5.3 Develop and submit work method statements and associated risk assessments for site mobilization/establishment works.
M BAC
5.4 If required by the contract obtain all necessary HSE related permits required for the performance of the work M BAC
5.5 Ensure project has made necessary arrangements with local emergency response authorities eg, Police, Ambulance, Hospitals, Fire Brigade.
R BAC
5.6
If not already provided by project, set-up local emergency transportation services provider, and confirm medical arrangements applicable for project personnel and subcontractors
Clarify what support (if any) is proposed to be provided by either WorleyParsons or the customer – security, emergency response, transport, etc.?
M BAC
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 80 of 83
5.7 Ensure Emergency Response Procedures are adequate for scope of work and make sure all personnel undertake training in emergency response.
M BAC
5.8
Establish primary medical provider and panel of specialists. Provide selected consulting physician with appropriate forms for personnel visits.
Establish medical protocols/standing orders with consulting physician; get appropriate approvals.
Provide consulting physician with craft job descriptions for pre-employment physicals and restrictive work availability.
Notify and instruct the designated emergency response team (client or project) of consulting physician and preferred emergency care facilities.
M BAC
5.9 Develop details of random drug testing activities (i.e. on site collection process, point-of-contact for results, personnel notification process, etc.) and details of service provider
M BAC
5.10
Establish (or sign up to existing project) occupational health program with medical provider (include on/off site)
Develop and submit a health surveillance and fitness for work including pre-employment medical for WorleyParsons approval
M BAC
5.11 Set-up medical management/ workers’ compensation program M BAC
5.12
Set up accounts with HSE service providers eg:
• Personal protective equipment suppliers
• Emergency response equipment and or providers
• Medical suppliers
• Security contractors
• Third Party equipment inspectors
R BAC
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 81 of 83
The following provides a suggested listing of HSE related documentation that may be required. It is not a comprehensive list. Go-bys (examples) can be provided by
WorleyParsons.
Specific initiatives that could be considered include: Consider establishing a library of: Training Programs should include but not be limited to the following:
• Buddy Manager Program
• Short Service Employee (SSE) Program
• Tool box talks
• Posters
• Project Induction
• Office HSE induction
• Contractor HSE supervisor
• JHA / WMS
5.13
Ensure inspections and tests have been performed on all equipment to be used on the site prior to mobilization
• Cranes and lifting apparatus
• Machinery and Equipment
• Vehicles
• Testing Equipment
M BAC
5.14
Ensure all temporary and portable electrical circuits are to be protected by Earth Leakage/Residual Current Detection devices and a process for regular maintenance and checks.
Ensure all portable electrical equipment items including leads inspected, tested and tagged
M BAC
5.15
Ensure all hazardous substances required for the work been identified and SDS approved and on site prior to bringing to site
Submit estimate and procedure for storage of fuel required where contractor is supplying
Submit for approval procedures and intended location for safe storage of gas bottles and hazardous materials.
M BAC
5.16 Ensure all facilities (lay down areas, fabrication yard, field and project offices are inspected to meet WorleyParsons and project requirements.
M BAC
5.17 Make appropriate arrangements for waste disposal including biological wastes (where applicable). If required develop a plan for disposal of solid, liquid and biological waste and submit for WorleyParsons approval.
M BAC
5.18 Identify and plan for any environmental monitoring and reporting activity M BAC
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A Page 82 of 83
• HSE Promotion and Awareness
• PPE Injury and Prevention Awards
• HSE Recognition Plan
• Project Golden Rules
• Haz-IDs and HSE Keys
• Take Time for Safety Program (Supervisors
• CARE Cards…step back 5x5
• Integrated Responsibility Table
• Behaviour Based Safety (BBS/SAZ) Program
• CARE and START Card Hazard
• Critical Safety Rules
• Monthly HSE Campaign
• Vulnerable Person (VP) Program
• Weekly Area HSE Assessment Program
• Craft competency assessment program
• Interactive learning program
• Stickers
• Flash reports
• Bulletin templates
• Screen savers
• Handbook
• D&A processes including testing
• Improvement campaigns
• Inclement weather
• short training/awareness packages
• Visitor Induction
• Returned worker induction
• H2S
• Norm
• Fire warden
• First aid
• Emergency response
• Height Safety
• Height rescue
• Confined Space
• Preventing Heat Stress
• Behavioral Based Safety
• Step back / pre-start risk assessment
• Hazardous substances
• D&A for supervisors
• Fire Extinguisher
• Manual Handling
• Permit to Work
• Incident investigation
• Defensive Driving
• Lifting & Rigging
• Scaffold awareness
• Office Safety Awareness
• Pre Start Talks for Supervisors
• Other craft specific training
CONTRACTOR HSE MANAGEMENT PLAN
14495-00-HS-PLN-0001 Rev : A
Appendix 3 Contractor HSE Leading and Lagging Key Performance Indicators
The below table includes typical project HSE KPI that may be utalised for monitoring HSE performance.
Purpose KPI Type
Review HSE Performance Lost Workday Case Frequency Rate (LWCFR) Lag
Review HSE Performance Total Recordable Case Frequency Rate (TRCFR) Lag
Review HSE Performance Business Motor Vehicle Crash Rate (BMVCR) Lag
Review HSE Performance Number of regulatory breaches Lag
Improve Leadership/Reduce HSE
Risks
HSE Observations/ Audits/ Inspections conducted vs. planned Lead
Improve HSE Communications % HSE Communications conducted v’s planned Lead
Reduce Risks and Impacts Response to audit findings % closed out Lead
Reduce reoccurring incidents and
near misses
% Incidents and near misses notified within 24 hours Lead
Reduce HSE Risks % actions closed out from HSE Risk Register Lead
Reduce Risks and Impacts/Improve
Leadership
% No. of HSE Observations planned versus actual.
% No. of HSE Workplace Inspections planned versus actual Lead
Reduce Risks and Impacts % Actions Implemented from HSE Behavioral Observations. Lead
Improve HSE Competency % Scheduled training and inductions completed. Lead
Reduce Incidents and
Impacts/Monitor HSE Commitment
% scheduled inspections completed Lead
Note:
Incident rates are based on injuries per 200,000 man hours worked
14495-00-CI-SOW-0005 Rev : A Page 1 of 13
VVSPL CAPACITY AUGMENTATION PROJECT
Scope Of Work- Car Parking structure
Project No: 403102-14495
Document No: 14495-00-CI-SOW-0005
20 Jun 18
I-Think Lodha Techno Campus, 5
th Floor, Tower B,
Pokhran Road No. 2 Thane (West) – 400607 Tel: +91 2266515700 Fax: +91 2267818000
© Copyright 2018 WorleyParsons
SCOPE OF WORK- CAR PARKING STRUCTURE
14495-00-CI-SOW-0005 Rev : A Page 2 of 13
SYNOPSIS This document presents the scope of work Car Parking structure at IPS-1, IPS-2 and IPS-3 locations for the VVSPL
Capacity Augmentation Project. This document shall be used in conjunction with the additional requirement
stipulated in Tender document.
Disclaimer
This report has been prepared on behalf of and for the exclusive use of HPCL, and is subject to and issued
in accordance with the agreement between HPCL and WorleyParsons India Pvt Ltd.
WorleyParsons India Pvt Ltd accepts no liability or responsibility whatsoever for it in respect of any use of or
reliance upon this document by any third party.
Copying this report without the permission of HPCL or WorleyParsons is not permitted.
VVSPL CAPACITY AUGMENTATION PROJECT
REV DESCRIPTION ORIG REVIEW WORLEY- PARSONS APPROVAL
DATE CUSTOMER APPROVAL
DATE
A Issued for Customer Review
MAK
PAR
KAK
20 Jun 18
SCOPE OF WORK- CAR PARKING STRUCTURE
14495-00-CI-SOW-0005 Rev : A Page 3 of 13
CONTENTS
1. INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................ 4
2. SCOPE OF WORK ............................................................................................................. 5
2.1 Battery Limits For Civil and Structural Scope of Works ..................................................... 5
2.2 Exclusions .......................................................................................................................... 6
2.3 Battery Limits For Electrical Scope of Works ..................................................................... 6
3. DESCRIPTION OF WORK - SPECIFIC ............................................................................ 8
3.1 Car Parking structure work ................................................................................................ 8
3.2 Car Parking Structure: Solar power system work............................................................. 8
3.3 Material and Consumables ................................................................................................ 9
4. HSE AND QUALITY ASSURANCE ................................................................................. 10
5. VENDOR DATA REQUIREMENT LIST .......................................................................... 11
6. LIST OF ATTACHEMENTS ............................................................................................. 12
6.1 List of Design Basis ......................................................................................................... 12
6.2 List of Specifications ........................................................................................................ 12
6.3 List of Standard Drawings ............................................................................................... 12
6.4 List of Architectural Drawings / Sketches ....................................................................... 12
6.5 List of Plot Plan ................................................................................................................ 13
SCOPE OF WORK- CAR PARKING STRUCTURE
14495-00-CI-SOW-0005 Rev : A Page 4 of 13
1. INTRODUCTION
Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (hereinafter referred to as "HPCL") has appointed WorleyParsons India Pvt. Ltd. as EPMC for the VVSPL capacity augmentation project.
Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (HPCL) intended to carry out capacity augmentation of their existing cross
country multiproduct white oil pipeline “Visakh Vijayawada Secunderabad Pipeline” (VVSPL). VVSPL is a 572 Km
long cross country petroleum pipeline from Visakhapatnam to Secunderabad.
VVSPL has the following intermediate facilities:
• Visakhapatnam dispatch station at Ch. 0 km.
• Intermediate pigging station-1 (IPS-1) at Ch. 92.9 km.
• Rajahmundry booster cum receiving station Ch. 181 km.
• Intermediate pigging station-2 (IPS-2) at Ch. 264.5 km.
• Vijayawada booster cum receiving station Ch.349 km.
• Suryapet booster cum receiving station Ch.460 km.
• Secunderabad receiving station Ch. 572 km.
• In addition to the above 32 nos. of SV / CP stations.
This document presents scope for Car Parking structure at IPS-1, IPS-2 and IPS-3 stations for the VVSPL Capacity
Augmentation Project. The purpose of Scope of Work is to clearly define the Civil & Structural scope for the
associated Works.
SCOPE OF WORK- CAR PARKING STRUCTURE
14495-00-CI-SOW-0005 Rev : A Page 5 of 13
2. SCOPE OF WORK
The scope of work of this tender involves supply of all materials, design, fabrication, transportation, construction,
erection/installation, finishing, inspection of the Car parking structure at IPS-1, IPS-2 and IPS-3 locations.
The scope of work for Contractor involves the following, but not limited to:
• Structural steel work – Contractor is responsible for design, structural stability, fabrication, transportation and
erection/installation of structural steel work and roof mesh structure (roof mesh preferably made from ETFE-
Ethylene Tetrafluoroethylene) envisaged for the car parking structure. Contractor shall submit base frame
drawings along with the foundation loads for foundation design to HPCL/WP.
• The Car parking structure shall be with integrated roof mounted solar panel system. The Contractor shall be
responsible for the design, supply, installation, integration, inspection, testing and commissioning of roof
mounted solar power system, system for collection of rainwater and local recharge pit for rainwater
harvesting, solar power generation and storage. The solar power system will include all necessary
equipment’s and accessories viz. panels, inverters and other components to generate & store renewable
energy. Integrated solar powered LED lighting system with integral battery backup for the Car parking
structure, which can provide illumination level of min. 60 lux at grade level for the covered area for approx.
12 hrs of night period. The system shall also house remote monitoring system for volume of rainwater
harvested, solar power generated and micro climate sensors.
• Providing all necessary measures like temporary hard barricading to protect the adjoining facilities/activities
at the construction area. Removal of all temporary barricades and restoration of the area to original condition
after completion of works and as advised by the Engineer-in-charge.
• Demonstration of the installed Car parking structure considering the maintenance aspect over the design life
of the structure. Providing supervision for the demonstration of operation and maintenance philosophy for
the personnel working within the premises.
• Design analysis for structural stability shall be carried out to cover maximum wind speed as per
Civil/Structural design basis (14495-00-CI-BOD-0001)
• Any other work as may be required to complete the job in all respects.
2.1 Battery Limits For Civil and Structural Scope of Works
The facility for Car parking structure shall be built within IPS-1, IPS-2 and IPS-3.
All work need to be carried out after receiving approval from HPCL/WP. HPCL will facilitate approval process,
however all approval supporting documents shall be prepared by the Contractor. Contractor shall start work only
after receiving such approvals in writing, wherever required.
Security approvals for machines, tools and labour/personnel shall be taken from concerned security agencies well in
advance. HPCL will facilitate approval process when required. However basic criteria shall be fulfilled by Contractor.
Work shall be carried out in such a manner that the work of other agencies operating at the site is not hampered due
to any action of the Contractor. Proper co-ordination with other agencies shall be the responsibility of the Contractor.
SCOPE OF WORK- CAR PARKING STRUCTURE
14495-00-CI-SOW-0005 Rev : A Page 6 of 13
In case of any dispute, the decision of Engineer-in-charge shall be final and binding on the Contractor with no extra
cost to Owner.
Any other design & drawing not listed herein above but covered in tender shall be in CONTRACTOR’s scope.
2.2 Exclusions
• Design and detailed drawings for Parking shed foundation.
• Construction of foundation for Parking shed.
• Design and construction of Pavement for Parking shed.
2.3 Battery Limits For Electrical Scope of Works
Contractor scope shall be as follows but not limited to,
2.3.1 Design, manufacturing, inspection, testing, supply, shipment, delivery to site, installation, integration,
inspection, testing and commissioning at site of integrated roof mounted Solar power system with all
accessories and including LED lighting fixtures with integral battery backup for 12 hrs for Car parking
structure.
Contractor shall meet or exceeds all the requirement of the latest edition of the relevant IS/IEC codes,
statutory regulations, IE rules and CEA regulations. Any deviation from the codes and standards must
be approved in writing by Purchaser/Consultant. Such written approval must be obtained prior to the
commencement of any work which would constitute such a deviation.
The installation work shall confirm to the latest applicable electricity rules, all currently applicable
standards, regulations and safety codes of the locality where the installation is to be carried out.
Nothing in this specification shall be construed to relieve the Contractor of this responsibility
Refer respective specification for applicable codes and standards. Wherever applicable standards are not
mentioned, then accepted good engineering practices shall be followed and implemented during
execution of project with prior Purchaser’s approval. Contractor shall note that, safety shall not be
compromised throughout the execution of project.
2.3.2 Actual billing shall be done only on permanantely installed quantities and not on supplied quantities. Any
balance material supplied by Contractor but not installed at site shall be taken back by Contractor and
shall not be billed to Purchaser and/or Consultant. Any as built data required for extension of existing
equipment shall be obtained by Contractor at site.
2.3.3 Liasoning/co-ordination with statutory authorities and state electricity boards as required for obtaining
approvals. Any modification or additional requirements suggested by them shall be carried out by
Contractor without cost and time implications.
2.3.4 After safe delivery to site, Contractor shall be responsible for loading/unloading and maintaining
equipment/materials during storage and until they are handed over to Purchaser.
SCOPE OF WORK- CAR PARKING STRUCTURE
14495-00-CI-SOW-0005 Rev : A Page 7 of 13
2.3.5 Contractor shall be responsible to replace the damaged material/equipment supplied by him without cost
and time implications.
2.3.6 Engineering, Supply, installation and dismantling of construction power supply and materials as
required shall be Contractor’s scope.
2.3.7 The method statements, sketches, shop drawings such as conduit layouts, framing layouts etc as
required for installation, site testing and commissioning shall be provided by the Contractor for
Purchaser’s approval. The Contractor shall obtain Purchaser approval before use or implementation.
2.3.8 Contractor shall maintain record of all punch list items during site acceptance tests and final handover to
Purchaser. All punch lists items must be cleared before final acceptance/handover by Purchaser.
2.3.9 Skilled and unskilled manpower required during construction shall be provided by the Contractor as
required. Contractor shall provide qualified and competent personnel to supervise the installation and
carryout site testing and commissioning of equipment specified.
2.3.10 The makes of all electrical equipment/materials shall be selected from approved Vendor list of Purchaser.
The make and type of equipment/materials, if not specified in approved Vendor list, then shall be subject
to Purchaser’s approval.
2.3.11 Any changes, if necessary due to site conditions/requirements shall be carried out after obtaining approval
of Purchaser / Consultant or their representatives at site. The changes carried out shall be marked clearly
in the layout drawings and forwarded to Purchaser / Consultant for preparation of necessary ‘AS BUILT
DRAWINGS’.
2.3.12 Contractor shall be responsible for complete integration of new equipment or work with existing equipment
or facilities for safe, sustainable and reliable operation. Liasoning, interfacing, as built data, survey, tests,
validations, inspections, assessments etc as required for existing equipment or facilities shall be part of
Contractor's scope.
SCOPE OF WORK- CAR PARKING STRUCTURE
14495-00-CI-SOW-0005 Rev : A Page 8 of 13
3. DESCRIPTION OF WORK - SPECIFIC
3.1 Car Parking structure work
Contractor shall be responsible for Design, Structural Stability, Detail, Fabrication, Transportation, Erection / Installation, Construction & Inspection of following work:
A. IPS-1
� Car Parking Structure - Guest house area as per drawing no. 14495-00-ST-DSK-0003.
B. IPS-2
� Car Parking Structure - Guest house area as per drawing no. 14495-00-ST-DSK-0003.
C. IPS-3
� Car parking structure as per drawing no. 14495-00-ST-DSK-0003.
Contractor’s scope of work shall include Structural Steel work and any other work related to completion of Car parking structure construction. The Contractor shall adhere to approved project specifications, design sketch supplied by Consultant for completion of the work.
3.2 Car Parking Structure: Solar power system work
Contractor shall be responsible for Design, manufacturing, inspection, testing, supply, shipment, delivery to site, installation, integration, inspection, testing and commissioning at site of integrated roof mounted Solar power system as described below:
A. IPS-1
� Solar power system with all accessories (including inverter etc.) above Car Parking structure
� LED lighting with integral 12 hrs battery backup under Car Parking structure to provide min. 60 lux under the structure at grade level
� All interconnections including cables, connector, glands, earthing etc. from inverter, solar panels etc. shall be designed, supplied and installed by Contractor.
B. IPS-2
� Solar power system with all accessories (including inverter etc.) above Car Parking structure
� LED lighting with integral 12 hrs battery backup under Car Parking structure to provide min. 60 lux under the structure at grade level
� All interconnections including cables, connector, glands, earthing etc. from inverter, solar panels etc. shall be designed, supplied and installed by Contractor.
C. IPS-3
� Solar power system with all accessories (including inverter etc.) above Car Parking structure
SCOPE OF WORK- CAR PARKING STRUCTURE
14495-00-CI-SOW-0005 Rev : A Page 9 of 13
� LED lighting with integral 12 hrs battery backup under Car Parking structure to provide min. 60 lux under the structure at grade level
� All interconnections including cables, connector, glands, earthing etc. from inverter, solar panels etc. shall be designed, supplied and installed by Contractor.
3.3 Material and Consumables Scope of supply by CONTRACTOR shall be as follows:
• All material and consumables required for engineering, construction, erection/ installation, finishing and commissioning to complete the job.
• All tools, tackles, plant machinery, labour etc. to complete the job.
• All materials used for Car parking structure shall comply to following standards: i. Class B1 of DIN4102-1 standard for fire test of building materials ii. EN 13501-1: Fire classification of construction products and building elements Part1:
Classification using data from reaction to fire tests In addition to above, refer table below :
Size 5m*5m (16.4ft*16.4ft)
Total Height 3.6m (11.8ft)
Springing Point 2.1m (6.8ft)
Total Weight 400 kg
Technical Textile Option of PVDF Titanium Dioxide coated Membrane OR PTFE Membrane
or similar
Wind Tolerance 140 kmph (87 mph)
Structure and Finish Option of SS316 grade stainless steel
Installation Standardised base plate. Foundation work by others.
Filtration In-mast physical filtration
Integrated Solar Lighting unit Monocrystalline flexible lightweight panel with Li-ion battery and charge
controller with automated sensor-based controls
Lighting 40W efficient LED lamps (150 lux)
Certification GreenPro Certified, Structural certification as per National Building Code
Warranty
15 years on structure and 5 years on electrical components and 2 years
on battery and bidder shall submit the relevant certificates while handing
over.
Any other activity / work which is not listed here but required for completion / execution of work shall be in the scope of Contractor.
SCOPE OF WORK- CAR PARKING STRUCTURE
14495-00-CI-SOW-0005 Rev : A Page 10 of 13
4. HSE AND QUALITY ASSURANCE
Contractor shall execute all defined in this document in compliance with HSE & Quality management plan (Annexure to SCC of tender) as applicable for this type of work. Contractor shall carry out material testing for all construction material as per relevant standrad or as directed by Engineer-in-charge. Records of test results shall be preserved and documented properly and shall be made available for inspection on demand.
SCOPE OF WORK- CAR PARKING STRUCTURE
14495-00-CI-SOW-0005 Rev : A Page 11 of 13
5. VENDOR DATA REQUIREMENT LIST
Following documents shall be submitted to Owner / EPMC Consultant after award of contract:
Sr.
No. Description
With
Bids
Post Order Final
Documents
For
Review
For
Records
Prints + 1
Electronic
file
1 Method of statement for all major activities * * *
2
Method of statement for rerouting/relocating existing underground piping & cables
* * *
3 All manufacturer Test certificate * *
4 All Lab Test Certificate * *
5 All registers and Inspection reports as maintained /issued * *
6 Installation drawings * *
7 Operation and maintenance manuals * *
8 Base frame detail drawings including the foundation loads and anchor bolt type(Anchor bolt Supplied by Vendor)
* * *
9 Lux level calculations * * *
10 Wiring / Circuit diagrams * *
11 Catalogues, manuals for all electrical items * *
* Documents and / or drawings required.
Note - Soft copy of all the drawings and documents shall be submitted in CDs organized in a manner as per the directions of the Engineer-In-Charge. Rates quoted shall be inclusive of the same.
SCOPE OF WORK- CAR PARKING STRUCTURE
14495-00-CI-SOW-0005 Rev : A Page 12 of 13
6. LIST OF ATTACHEMENTS
6.1 List of Design Basis
SR.NO DOC. NO. DESCRIPTION
1. 14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Civil / Structural Design Basis
2. 14495-00-EL-BOD-0001 Electrical System Design Basis
6.2 List of Specifications
SR.NO DOC. NO. DESCRIPTION
1. 14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Specification - Fence & Gate Work
2. 14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Specification - Miscellaneous Work
3. 14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Specification for Electrical Bulk Material
4. 14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Specification for Electrical Equipment Installation
5. 14495-00-EL-SPC-0015 Specification for Field Inspection, Testing and
Commissioning
6.3 List of Standard Drawings
SR.NO DOC. NO. DESCRIPTION
1. 14495-00-CI-DST-0001 General Notes Concrete Work
2. 14495-00-CI-DST-0005 Standard Details of Paving & Roads
3. 14495-00-CI-DST-0006 Standard Details Of Fencing
4. 14495-00-ST-DST-0001 General Notes Steel Structures
6.4 List of Architectural Drawings / Sketches
SR.NO DOC. NO. DESCRIPTION
1. 14495-00-ST-DSK-0003 Car Parking structure - Layout
SCOPE OF WORK- CAR PARKING STRUCTURE
14495-00-CI-SOW-0005 Rev : A Page 13 of 13
6.5 List of Plot Plan
SR.NO DOC. NO. DESCRIPTION
1. 14495-15-PI-DPP-0001 Plot Plan for MB Patnam Booster Station ( IPS-1)
2. 14495-25-PI-DPP-0001 Plot Plan for JK Gudem Booster Station ( IPS-2)
3. 14495-45-PI-DPP-0001 Plot Plan for Bogaram Booster Station SV-17 ( IPS-3)
Comment Response Sheet
EPF-0189-COR-EN Rev 4 (09-Nov-15) Page 1 of 1
Project Title VVSPL Capacity Augmentation Project Customer Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited
Project No. 403102-14495 CRS No. CRS-CI-010
Document Title Civil / Structural Design Basis Prepared By Pankaj Rane Date 21st Jun 2017
Document No. 14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev. No. 0 Sheet of
Except for the following identified comments, all other comments on the document have been resolved.
No. Section/ Page
Comment Response By Date Status O/C *
Remarks
1 Section 2/
Page 10 & 11
Include following in point 2.3, 2.4 – Consider wind speed and seismic zone according to location(may vary with respect to location)
Basic wind speed & Seismic Zone is tabulated as per station/terminal location
PAR 21st Jun
2017 Closed
2 Section 5.2 - For maintenance condition 50% of wind is considered as maintenance work is not envisage during heavy wind
PAR 21st Jun
2017 Closed
3 Section 9.2 - Finished Ground Level (FGL) & Highest Flood Level (HFL) for IPS1, IPS2 & IPS3 is tabulated as per latest site input
PAR 21st Jun
2017 Closed
4 Section 9.5.3
- Rainfall intensity is tabulated as per station/terminal location
PAR 21st Jun
2017 Closed
Additional Notes (if any)
DISTRIBUTION
* O - Open, C - Closed
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 1 of 36
VVSPL CAPACITY AUGMENTATION PROJECT
Civil / Structural Design Basis
Project No: 403102-14495
Document No: 14495-00-CI-BOD-0001
21 JUN 17
I-Think Lodha Techno Campus, 5th Floor, Tower B,
Pokhran Road No. 2 Thane (West) – 400607 Tel: +91 2266515700 Fax: +91 2267818000
© Copyright 2017 WorleyParsons
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 2 of 36
SYNOPSIS
Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited (hereinafter referred to as "HPCL") has appointed WorleyParsons
India Pvt. Ltd. as EPMC for the project.
HPCL is currently pursuing to expand Vizag refinery from the current name plate capacity of 8.3 MMPTA to
15 MMTPA with a yield of 11.85 MMTPA for MS, HSD and SKO. In-line with refinery expansion plan, HPCL
is also planning to take up capacity augmentation of existing VVSPL (Vizag Vijayawada Secunderabad
Pipeline) from 5.38 MMTPA to 7.9 MMTPA simultaneously.
Capacity augmentation is proposed by implementation of new pump stations at existing IPS-1 (Ch. 92.9 km),
IPS-2 (Ch. 264.5 km), SV-17 Station and also by upgrading the existing booster pump facilities in Vizag,
Rajahmundry, Vijayawada, Suryapet and in Secunderabad. It also covers formulating and integration of new
facilities with existing Electrical, Instrumentation, PLC, SCADA, APPS including LDS, OWS system, piping
arrangements.
This design basis specifies minimum engineering requirments for RCC structures ,Steel structures and
General Civil related activities.
Disclaimer
This report has been prepared on behalf of and for the exclusive use of HPCL, and is subject to and issued
in accordance with the agreement between HPCL and WorleyParsons India Pvt Ltd.
WorleyParsons India Pvt Ltd accepts no liability or responsibility whatsoever for it in respect of any use of or
reliance upon this document by any third party.
Copying this report without the permission of HPCL or WorleyParsons is not permitted.
VVSPL CAPACITY AUGMENTATION PROJECT
REV DESCRIPTION ORIG REVIEW WORLEY-
PARSONS APPROVAL
DATE CUSTOMER APPROVAL
DATE
B Issued for Customer Review
ASK
PAR
RAV
14 FEB 17
0 Issued for Design
ASK
PAR
RAV
14 FEB 17
1 Re-Issued for Design
RAD
PAR
RAV
21 JUN 17
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 3 of 36
CONTENTS
1. SCOPE ............................................................................................................................... 6
1.1 Applicable Codes and Standards for Design ..................................................................... 6
1.2 Applicable Codes and Standards for Materials. ................................................................. 8
1.3 Glossary ............................................................................................................................. 8
1.4 Unit and Language ............................................................................................................. 8
1.5 Geotechnical Parameters ................................................................................................... 8
2. DESIGN LOADS AND DESIGN PHILOSOPHY ............................................................... 9
2.1 Dead Loads (DL) ................................................................................................................ 9
2.2 Live Loads (LL)................................................................................................................... 9
2.3 Wind Loads (WL) ............................................................................................................. 10
2.4 Seismic Loads (SL) .......................................................................................................... 11
2.5 Equipment Loads (EEL) ................................................................................................... 12
2.6 Equipment Operating Loads (EOL) .................................................................................. 12
2.7 Thermal / Friction Load (TL/FL) ....................................................................................... 12
2.8 Impact and Vibratory Loads ............................................................................................. 12
2.9 Soil and Hydrostatic Pressure (SP).................................................................................. 12
2.10 Other Loads .................................................................................................................. 13
3. FOUNDATION DESIGN .................................................................................................. 14
3.1 Design Criteria for Foundation Design ............................................................................. 14
3.1.1 Depth of Foundation ............................................................................................ 14
3.1.2 Stability Criteria .................................................................................................... 14
3.2 Foundations for Rotating and Reciprocating Equipment ................................................. 15
4. DESIGN PHILOSOPHY FOR PIPE SUPPORTS ........................................................... 17
4.1 Type of Loads................................................................................................................... 17
4.1.1 Dead Loads : DL .................................................................................................. 17
4.1.2 Friction Force (Longitudinal and Transverse): FL ................................................ 17
4.1.3 Wind Loads: WL ................................................................................................... 17
4.1.4 Piping Load (Operating – PLo) ............................................................................ 17
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 4 of 36
4.1.5 Piping load (Testing – PLt) .................................................................................. 17
4.1.6 Piping Anchor Load (AL) ...................................................................................... 17
4.1.7 Loading on Longitudinal Piperack Beams ........................................................... 17
5. BASIC LOAD CASES AND LOAD COMBINATIONS ................................................... 19
5.1 For Equipment Foundations ............................................................................................. 20
5.2 For Building Design .......................................................................................................... 21
5.3 For Pipe Rack / Sleepers ................................................................................................. 22
6. BUILDINGS ................................................................................................................... 24
6.1 List of Buildings ................................................................................................................ 24
6.2 Plumbing/Sanitary ............................................................................................................ 24
7. STEEL STRUCTURE ...................................................................................................... 25
7.1 Material Standard and Grade ........................................................................................... 25
7.2 Minimum Thickness of Steel Elements ............................................................................ 25
7.3 Paint Specification ............................................................................................................ 26
7.4 Fire Proofing ..................................................................................................................... 26
7.5 Allowable Deflection ......................................................................................................... 26
8. CONCRETE ..................................................................................................................... 27
8.1 Materials ........................................................................................................................... 27
8.2 Minimum Thickness of Structural Concrete Elements ..................................................... 28
8.3 Minimum Height of Pedestals .......................................................................................... 28
8.4 Grouting and Minimum Grout Thickness ......................................................................... 28
9. GENERAL CIVIL .............................................................................................................. 30
9.1 Compound Wall and Fencing ........................................................................................... 30
9.2 Site Grading ..................................................................................................................... 30
9.3 Roads ............................................................................................................................... 30
9.4 Pavements ....................................................................................................................... 31
9.5 Drainage Systems ............................................................................................................ 31
9.5.1 Effluent Categories .............................................................................................. 32
9.5.2 Drainage Design Philosophy ............................................................................... 32
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 5 of 36
9.5.3 Drainage Design Criteria ..................................................................................... 33
9.5.4 Typical Material for Drainage Piping .................................................................... 34
10. MASONRY ....................................................................................................................... 35
11. SOFTWARE TO BE USED FOR THE PROJECT .......................................................... 36
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 6 of 36
1. SCOPE
This document presents the Civil/Structural Design Basis for the VVSPL Project for the design of civil,
structural and building works.
Design basis specifies the minimum requirements for the engineering of reinforced concrete structure, steel
structural and general civil related activities. All items shall be designed for satisfactory performance.
Civil structural Design/Technical specification for civil, structural and building works are summarized herein
below.
For Architectural finishes and items refer Architectural Design Basis (Doc. No: 14495-00-AR-BOD-0001).
1.1 Applicable Codes and Standards for Design
The following codes and standards are applicable to civil, structural and building design. Apart from the
Indian standard listed in following chapters, all other relevant codes related to this job requirement shall be
followed wherever applicable. The latest edition of codes and standards at the start of project shall be used
throughout the project duration.
Codes / Standards
(1) Design Loads
Dead Loads : IS: 875 part 1
Imposed Loads : IS: 875 part 2
Wind Loads : IS: 875 part 3
Special Loads : IS: 875 part 5
Seismic Loads : IS: 1893 part 1
IS: 1893 part 4
(2) Building
Layout and Planning : NBC
(3) Steel Construction : IS: 800
(4) Concrete Construction : IS: 456
General Civil
(5) Roads : IRC: 3,6 , 37
(6) Machine Foundations : IS: 2974 Part-1 to 5
(7) Liquid retaining structures : IS: 3370 Part-1 to 4
(8) Ductile detailing of RCC Structure : IS: 13920
(9) Code of practice for use of metal arc welding for general construction
: IS: 816
(10) Code of practice for construction of stone masonry
: IS: 1597
(11) High strength deformed steel bars and wires for concrete reinforcement
: IS: 1786
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 7 of 36
(12) Code of practice for design and construction of foundations in soils: General requirements
: IS: 1904
(13) Code of practice for structural use of unreinforced masonry
: IS: 1905
(14) Recommended practice for hot dipped galvanizing on iron and steel
: IS: 2629
(15) Code of practice for design and construction of raft foundations
: IS: 2950
(16) Code of practice for design and construction of machine foundations
: IS: 2974 Part 1 to 5
(17) Code of practice for earthquake resistant design and construction of buildings
: IS: 4326
(18) Determination of dynamic properties of soil - Method of test
: IS: 5249
(19) Recommendations for metal arc welding of carbon and carbon manganese steel
: IS: 9595
(20) Code of practice for determination of bearing capacity of shallow foundations
: IS: 6403
(21) Code of practice for calculation of settlements of foundations
: IS: 8009 Pt I, II
(22) Code of practice for design and construction of ring foundation
: IS: 11089
(23) Hollow Steel Section for Structural Use : IS: 4923
(24) Process Design and Operating Philosophies on Blow Down and sewer system
: OISD: 109
(25) Fire Protection Facilities for Petroleum depots, Terminals and Pipeline Installations
:
OISD: STD-117
(26) Layout for Oil and Gas Installations : OISD: STD-118
(27) Process Control Room Safety : OISD: 163
(28) Fire Proofing Of Steel Supporting Structures
In Oil and Gas Industry
: OISD: 164
(29) Storage and handling of Petroleum Products at depots and terminals including standalone crude oil storage facilities
: OISD: 244
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 8 of 36
1.2 Applicable Codes and Standards for Materials.
The following codes and standards shall be applied to the equipment and materials to be used for the
Facility.
(1) Building Materials
Coarse and Fine Aggregate for Concrete
: IS: 383
Concrete aggregates : IS: 6461 Part 1
Materials (other than Cement and Aggregate)
: IS: 6461 Part 2
(2) Structural Steel
Steel Material : IS: 2062
(3) Concrete
Re-bar : IS: 1786, IS: 432 PART 1 and 2
(4) Cement
Ordinary Portland Cement, 43 Grade
: IS: 8112
Ordinary Portland cement, 53 grade
: IS: 12269
Portland Slag Cement : IS: 455
Portland Pozzolana Cement (Fly Ash Based)
: IS: 1489 (Part 1)
(5) Ready Mix Concrete : IS: 4926
(6) Concrete Admixtures : IS: 9103
1.3 Glossary
(1) IPS : Intermediate Pumping Station
(2) SV : Sectionalizing Valve
1.4 Unit and Language
(1) Measurement Unit : SI
(2) Language : English
1.5 Geotechnical Parameters
For parameters related to Existing site condition, elevations and groundwater levels, the geotech
report furnished by HPCL shall be referred to.
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 9 of 36
2. DESIGN LOADS AND DESIGN PHILOSOPHY
These loading shall be applicable to all structures irrespective of the material employed for
construction.
2.1 Dead Loads (DL)
The weight of all permanent construction including self-weight of structural members, walls, fire
proofing, floors, roofs, stairways, fixed service and other equipment empty weight (excluding their
contents).
Following Unit weight shall be adopted:
Reinforced Concrete = 25 kN/m3
Plain Concrete = 24 kN/m3
Structural Steel = 78.5 kN/m3
Backfill Soil = 18 kN/m3
Brick Masonry wall = 18.85 kN/m3
Cement Plaster = 20.4 kN/m3
Concrete Hollow block = 15.0 kN/m3
2.2 Live Loads (LL)
Live load in general shall be as per IS: 875 Part 2, following minimum live loads shall be
considered in the design of structures:
Table 1 :
1. Control/Electrical Room and Service Platform
Panel Floor / Battery Room
AHU, UPS, Locker Room
Blower Room
Stairs, Corridors, Passages
Warehouse Floor / Grade Slab / Ground Floor
Access / Service Platform
-
-
-
-
-
-
10.0 kN/m2
5.0 kN/m2
7.5 kN/m2
5.0 kN/m2
10.0 kN/m2
2.5 kN/m2 or
3kN Concentrated Load
at Center
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 10 of 36
2. Roofs
Non Accessible RC Roof / Sheeted Roof
Accessible RC Roof
-
0.75 kN/m2
1.5 kN/m2
3. Staircase
Plant / Non-plant buildings
Store Room
-
-
5.0 kN/m2
7.5 kN/m2 or as per actual
4. Control & Electrical Building, Guest House
( Including partitions)
- 5.0 kN/m2
Live Load reduction shall be as per IS: 1893 part 1
2.3 Wind Loads (WL)
Basic wind speed is tabulated as per station/terminal location as below.
Table 1a :
Location Basic Wind
Speed (m/s) Location
Basic Wind
Speed (m/s)
Vizag 50 Vijayawada 50
IPS1 50 Suryapet 44
Rajahmundry 50 IPS3 44
IPS2 50 Secunderabad 44
Wind load in general shall be as per IS: 875 Part 3.
Please find below sample wind load calculation for Vizag terminal:
Basic wind Speed (Vb) = 50 m/s #
Risk Coefficient (k1) = 1.00 for all General Category Structures
0.7 for Compound Wall and temporary structures
Terrain Category for (k2) = 2 as per IS: 875 Part 3
Terrain, Height and Structure Size Factor (k2) = As given below in the Table 2 of IS: 875 Part 3
Topography Factor (k3) = 1.00
Importance Factor for cyclone (k4) = 1.15
Design Wind Speed (VZ) = Vb*k1*k2*k3*k4 m/s
Wind Pressure (pZ) = 0.6*VZ2 N/m
2
1
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 11 of 36
Typical Wind pressure on Buildings / Structures ( for terrain category 2) ##
Table 2 :
Height
(m)
K2
VZ
m/s
pz
N/m2
pz
KN/m2
Up to 10m 1.00 57.5 1983.75 1.98
10m - 15m 1.05 60.38 2187.08 2.19
15m - 20m 1.07 61.53 2271.56 2.27
20m - 30m 1.12 64.4 2488.42 2.49
30m - 50m 1.17 67.28 2715.959 2.72
## Wind Load – 10 % Extra Equipment area should be considered for connected piping to equipment as per
IS: 875 part 3
The Design wind pressure pd = Kd*Ka*Kc*pz
Where Kd = 1 (wind directionality factor)
Ka = Area Averaging Factor (Refer Table 4 of IS: 875 part 3)
Kc = 1 Unless satisfying cl 7.3.3.13 of IS: 875 part 3 where it can be taken as 0.9
Note:
1- # For any location, value having mis-match with that as per IS 875, the severe of the values
shall prevail.
2- for all metal roofs & claddings- Fasteners shall be designed for cyclonic wind velocity of most
sever type irrespective of wind zone.
2.4 Seismic Loads (SL)
a. Seismic Design shall be done in accordance with IS: 1893 part1- 2002
b. Seismic Zone is tabulated as per station/terminal location as below.
Table 2a :
Location Seismic Zone Location Seismic Zone
Vizag II Vijayawada III
IPS1 II Suryapet II
Rajahmundry III IPS3 II
IPS2 III Secunderabad II
1
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 12 of 36
c. Zone Factor : 0.10 for Zone II & 0.16 for Zone III
d. Importance Factor :1.25 (For Building Like Substation,Control Room etc.UNO),
1.5 (For Fire water Pump House)
1.0 ( Security Room, Guest House)
e. Soil Type : For Soil type refer Geotech report
2.5 Equipment Loads (EEL)
Equipment loads for various conditions such as EEL - Empty Condition, EOL - Operating Condition
and ETL - Test Condition are considered.
For calculating empty weight of the equipment all fixtures, platforms, ladders and attached piping
but excluding contents shall be considered. When piping weight is not indicated separately or
included in the weight of the equipment the same shall be taken as 10% of empty weight of the
equipment.
2.6 Equipment Operating Loads (EOL)
Operating loads shall comprise of the maximum design loads sustained by the equipment during
plant operation including inventory of product.
2.7 Thermal / Friction Load (TL/FL)
Horizontal forces due to thermal expansion of horizontal vessels/ Exchangers shall be relieved by
using slotted holes and slide plates and remaining force derived from product of the sliding saddle
gravity load and co-efficient of friction (0.3 steel to steel or 0.1 PTFE to PTFE), which shall be
applied to each support.
2.8 Impact and Vibratory Loads
Impact load shall be defined as an equivalent static force caused by a moving object. Structures
subjected to impact or vibratory loads shall be designed as per the provisions of IS: 875 and
IS: 2974. Requirements for monorail shall be as per IS: 800, IS: 875 or manufacturer’s data
whichever is more stringent.
2.9 Soil and Hydrostatic Pressure (SP)
Pressure on basement walls - In the design of basement walls or similar (approximately vertical)
structures below grade, provision shall be made for resisting lateral pressure of the adjacent soil. If
a portion or whole of the adjacent soil is below free water surface, pressure computations shall be
based on the diminished weight of the soil (due to buoyancy) plus full hydrostatic pressure.
If difference in plot level and surrounding area is more than 1m then complete RCC wall shall be
designed to withstand earth pressure as well as surcharge.
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 13 of 36
Uplift on Floors - In the design of basement floors and similar (approximately horizontal)
constructions below grade, the upward pressure of water shall be taken as full hydrostatic pressure
applied over the entire plan area. Factor of safety against uplift shall be 1.2.
2.10 Other Loads
Apart from the specified live loads, any other equipment load or possible overloading during
construction/ hydro-test/maintenance/erection shall also be considered in the design. Under hydro
test condition the wind force shall be taken as 50% of normal loading.
All Buildings/ Structures shall be designed to resist the worst combination of the above specified
loads.
All liquid retaining/ storage structures shall be designed assuming liquid up to the full height of wall
irrespective of provision of any over flow arrangement.
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 14 of 36
3. FOUNDATION DESIGN
Depth of foundation, Safe bearing pressure (Allowable net bearing capacity), other design
parameters for design shall be based on the following criteria and shall conform to Geotechnical
report for respective area.
Maximum settlement as per Geotech report
Table 3 :
Sr.No Foundation Settlement (mm)
1. Foundation for all types of Equipments, Pipe racks,
Buildings, sheds etc.
25
2 Footings for non-plant buildings and raft foundations. 40
3 Tank 100
3.1 Design Criteria for Foundation Design
3.1.1 Depth of Foundation
The type and depth of foundation shall be as per Geotechnical report.
Following are minimum depths of foundations:
Building foundations - 1500 mm
Equipment foundations - 300 mm
Pipe sleepers - 300 mm
3.1.2 Stability Criteria
Factor of safety against overturning (For Dead load) – 2
Factor of Safety against overturning (For Wind and seismic loading condition) – 1.5
Factor of safety for sliding – For plant operating with or without live load shall be 1.75 and with
wind/earthquake shall be 1.5.
Factor of safety for Buoyancy – The sum of vertically downward loads shall exceed 1.2 times of all
vertically upward loads.
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 15 of 36
Design philosophy for foundation design of Equipment –
Foundation design shall be as per Geotechnical report / data. Loads acting on Equipment
foundation are described in Clause 2.
Equipment foundation shall project minimum 150mm above HPP/ FFL for indoor and 300mm
above HPP for outdoor located equipments.
Isolated RCC footing for buildings without tie beam, or unreinforced strip foundation shall not
permitted in soft soil with N value less than 10.
3.2 Foundations for Rotating and Reciprocating Equipment
Unless otherwise specified foundation design shall follow general criteria indicated below:
Design of foundation shall conform to IS: 2974 Part-1 TO 5
Considerable rigidity of the machine foundation is essential to avoid failure of the machine
bearings. The foundation must have sufficient mass to absorb the vibration. The natural frequency
of the foundation should be less than 0.8 or greater than 1.2 times the operating frequency of the
machine to avoid resonance.
Where structural steel associated with walkways and platforms is to be erected around the
machine foundation, the attachment of the steelwork to the foundation for support should be
avoided. If the steel is attached to the foundation the effect of this additional mass on the
foundation response to vibration shall be included in the design.
• Reinforcement should be provided on all faces of the concrete to give a minimum reinforcement
value of 50 kg/m3 for up stands and 30 kg/m
3 for foundation rafts.
• The foundation thickness for vibrating machines should be at least 600 mm, unless a smaller
thickness is given by the machine manufacturer.
• Proportion the base to ensure that the eccentricity between the centroid of the static loads and
the centroid of the foundation base and the eccentricity between the centroid of the vertical
dynamic loads and the centroid of the foundation base are both within 5% of the relevant base
dimension.
• The machine foundation should be isolated from any adjacent foundations and structures.
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 16 of 36
Table 4 :
Minimum design criteria for equipment foundation (Rotating/Reciprocating Equipment)
P = Rated Power output of equipment (unit KW).
*If the supplier’s requirement is available, same shall be considered.
CRITERIA APPLICATION
Dynamic
analysis
*Allowable amplitude
Rotating : P ≥ 400 KW
Reciprocating : P ≥ 100 KW
Natural frequency of foundation Rotating : P ≥ 100 KW
Reciprocating : P ≥ 40 KW
Foundation
weight control
More than 3 x equip. weight Rotating : P < 100 KW
More than 5 x equip. weight Reciprocating : P < 40 KW
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 17 of 36
4. DESIGN PHILOSOPHY FOR PIPE SUPPORTS
4.1 Type of Loads
4.1.1 Dead Loads : DL
This shall mean, the weights of pipes, fittings, valves, insulation and the fluid contents of piping, including the
weight of Cable ducts wherever installed. Piping empty load (PLe) includes weight of piping and insulation.
Piping Loads shall be calculated considering the pipe diameters and piping arrangement subject to minimum
of 1.25kN/m2 over entire span.
4.1.2 Friction Force (Longitudinal and Transverse): FL
Longitudinal friction force shall be applied as below:
1 For more than 3 pipes = 10% of the total pipe weight tributary to that pipe support
2. For 2-3 Pipes = 20%
3. For single pipe = 30% of the total pipe weight.
4.1.3 Wind Loads: WL
For pipe supports, the tributary area of piping exposed to wind shall be taken as the nominal diameter of
pipe plus 10% of the width of the pipe rack .This should be multiplied by the length of the pipe to determine
the tributary area .
4.1.4 Piping Load (Operating – PLo)
Piping operating load includes piping self-weight, insulation and material weight carried by pipe.
4.1.5 Piping load (Testing – PLt)
Piping test load consists of self-weight, insulation and test material weight.
4.1.6 Piping Anchor Load (AL)
Piping Anchor load shall be supplied from Piping division from stress analysis.
4.1.7 Loading on Longitudinal Piperack Beams
Longitudinal beams connecting portal columns shall be sufficiently strong to sustain a minimum of 25% of
the load on the transverse beams or 10kN at center or the total load shall be assumed as 2 equal
concentrated loads acting at 1/3rd span, whichever is maximum.
This load shall be in addition to the piping loads transferred from the intermediate beams. Other longitudinal
axial forces coming on it from the design of the supporting system shall also be simultaneously taken into
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 18 of 36
account in the design of the longitudinal beam. Loads from monorails, when supported from these beams,
shall also be considered to be acting simultaneously along with all other loads mentioned above.
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 19 of 36
5. BASIC LOAD CASES AND LOAD COMBINATIONS
DL - Dead Load
LL - Live load
FPL - Fire-proofing load
WL - Wind load
SL - Seismic load
EEL - Equipment Empty Load
EOL - Equipment Operating Load
ETL - Equipment Test Load
HOL - Horizontal operating load
SP - Soil Pressure
ELL - Erection load (Temporary Loading)
BPL - Bundle Pull Load
FL - Friction Load
AL - Anchor Load
TL - Thermal Load
PLe - Piping Dead Load
PLo - Piping Operating Load
PLt - Piping Test Load
ML - Maintenance load / Monorail load
As per IS: 1893 Part-1 (clause no 6.3.4.3), minimum two horizontal motions shall be considered in
seismic combination.
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 20 of 36
5.1 For Equipment Foundations
Table 5:
* For Test Condition 50% of Wind Load is considered.
** Live Load shall be considered in Load combinations as per IS codal requirments if platforms
are supported on equipments.
Load
Combinations
DL LL
**
WL
SL EEL/
ELL
EOL
&
HOL
ETL FL BPL REMARKS
Equipment foundation design ( For Stability and Serviceability)
DL + EEL + WL 1.0 - 1.0 - 1.0 - - - Erection / Empty Condition
DL + EEL + WL 0.9 - 1.0 - 1.0 - - -
DL +EOL +WL 1.0 - 1.0 - - 1.0 -
Operating Condition
DL+EOL + SL 1.0 - - 1.0 - 1.0 - - -
DL+EOL+FL 1.0 - - - - 1.0 - 1.0 -
DL+ETL+WL 1.0 - 0.5* - - - 1.0 - - Test Condition
DL+WL+BPL 1.0 - 1.0 - - - - - 1.0 Maintenance Condition
Equipment foundation design ( For Concrete design)
DL + EEL + WL 0.9 - 1.5 - 0.9 - - - Erection / Empty Condition
DL +EOL +WL 1.2 - 1.2 - - 1.2 - - -
Operating Condition
DL+EOL + SL 1.2 - - 1.2 - 1.2 - - -
DL+EOL+FL 1.5 - - - - 1.5 - 1.5 -
DL+ETL+WL 1.5 - 0.75* - - - 1.5 - - Test Condition
DL+WL+BPL 1.5 - 1.5 - - - - - 1.5 Maintenance Condition
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 21 of 36
5.2 For Building Design
Table 6:
Load
Combinations
DL LL WL SL ML REMARKS
For Structure Design
DL + LL 1.5 1.5 - - - Normal
DL + WL 1.5 - 1.5 - -
Wind DL + WL 0.9 - 1.5 - -
DL+LL+WL 1.2 1.2 1.2 - -
DL + LL + SL 1.2 1.2 - 1.2 -
Seismic DL + SL 0.9 - - 1.5 -
DL + SL 1.5 - - 1.5 -
DL + LL + WL + ML 1.2 1.2 1.2 x 0.5 # - 1.2 Maintenance
For Foundation Analysis
DL + LL 1.0 1.0 - - - Normal
DL + WL 1.0 - 1.0 - -
Wind DL + WL 0.9 - 1.0 - -
DL+LL+WL 1.0 0.8 0.8 -
DL + LL + SL 1.0 0.8 - 0.8 -
Seismic DL + SL 1.0 - - 1.0 -
DL + SL 0.9 - - 1.0 -
DL + LL + WL + ML 1.0 0.8 0.8 x 0.5 # - 1.0 Maintenance
# For maintenance condition 50% of wind is considered as maintenance work is not envisage during heavy
wind.
1
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 22 of 36
5.3 For Pipe Rack / Sleepers
Table 7:
Load
Combinations
DL LL WL
SL EEL EOL
&
HOL
ETL FL/
TL
PLe PLo PLt AL REMARKS
For Stability and Serviceability
DL+LL+PLo+FL+
AL+EOL
1.0 1.0 - - - 1.0 - 1.0 1.0 - 1.0 Normal
DL+LL+PLo+
AL+SL+EOL
1.0 1.0 - 1.0 - 1.0 - - - 1.0 - 1.0 Seismic
DL+LL+PLo+EOL+
AL+WL
1.0 1.0 1.0 - - 1.0 - - - 1.0 - 1.0 Wind
DL+PLo+EOL+AL+
WL
1.0 - 1.0 - - 1.0 - - - 1.0 - 1.0 Wind
DL+PLt+ETL 1.0 - - - - - 1.0 - - - 1.0 -
Test DL+PLt+ETL+
0.5WL
1.0 - 0.5 - - - 1.0 - - - 1.0 -
DL+WL+PLe+EEL 1.0 - 1.0 - 1.0 - - - 1.0 - - -
Empty
DL+SL+PLe+EEL 1.0 - - 1.0 1.0 - - - 1.0
- - -
DL+WL+PLe+EEL 0.9 - 1.0 - 0.9 - - - 1.0 - - -
DL+SL+PLe+EEL 0.9 - - 1.0 0.9 - - - 1.0
- - -
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 23 of 36
Table 8 :
For Pipe Racks / sleepers
Load
Combinations
DL LL WL
SL EEL EOL
&
HOL
ET
L
FL/
TL
PLe PLo PLt AL REMARKS
For Strength Design
DL+
LL+PLo+FL+AL+
EOL
1.5 1.5 - - - 1.5 - 1.5 1.5 - 1.5
Normal
DL+LL+PLo+AL+
SL+EOL 1.2 1.2 - 1.2 - 1.2 - - - 1.2 -
1.2
Seismic
DL+PLo+AL+SL
+EOL 1.5 - - 1.5 - 1.5 - - - 1.5 - 1.5
DL+LL+PLo+
EOL+AL +WL
1.2 1.2 1.2 - - 1.2 - - - 1.2 - 1.2
Wind
DL+PLo+EOL+
AL +WL
1.5 - 1.5 - - 1.5 - - - 1.5 - 1.5
DL+PLt+ETL
1.5 - - - - - 1.5 - - - 1.5
-
Test
DL+PLt+ETL+
0.5WL
1.5 - 0.75 - - - 1.5 - - - 1.5 -
DL+WL+PLe+
EEL
1.5 - 1.5 - 1.5 - - - 1.5 - - -
Empty
DL+SL+PLe+
EEL
1.5 - - 1.5 1.5 - - - 1.5 - - -
DL+WL+PLe+
EEL
0.9 - 1.5 - 0.9 - - - 0.9 - - -
DL+SL+PLe+
EEL
0.9 - - 1.5 0.9 - - - 0.9 - - -
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 24 of 36
6. BUILDINGS
6.1 List of Buildings
Following are the buildings to be designed for the project at different locations:
1 Control & Electrical building
2 Substation Building
3 Pump House (Fuel and Fire water)
4 Security Room
5 Warehouse
6 VFD Room
7 Guest House
6.2 Plumbing/Sanitary
Material for plumbing and sanitary shall be best quality with ISI mark. Separate water tanks shall be provided
for each building (depending on requirement). List of make shall be provided in the tender to avoid dispute in
prices. This shall be gravity piped system for flows originating from toilet blocks, showers etc.
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 25 of 36
7. STEEL STRUCTURE
7.1 Material Standard and Grade
Unless otherwise noted, material code / standard and grade as below shall be applied:
Plate and Shape : IS: 2062 (Grade B)
Steel Pipe : Medium duty (IS: 1239 Part1 / IS: 1161)
Rectangular Hollow Tubes : IS: 4923
Ordinary Black Bolt : Class 4.6 (IS: 1367) (Only Temporary connection)
High Strength Bolt : Class 8.8 (IS: 1367, IS: 3757, IS: 4000)
Checkered Plate : IS: 3502
Steel Grating : IS: 2062(Grade A)
Anchor Bolt : ASTM: A193-B7
Hexagonal nuts ( for Anchor Bolts) : ASTM: A194.Gr.2H
Galvanized steel sheets : IS: 277
(Plain and corrugated)
Pre-coated Galvalume roof sheets : ASTM: A366, ASTM: A792
7.2 Minimum Thickness of Steel Elements
The minimum thickness of various structural components (Hot rolled sections) shall be as given:
General Construction:
Trusses, purlins, side girths and bracings 5mm
Main columns, main beams 6mm
Gussets in trusses and girders
i) Up to and including 12m span 8mm
ii) Above 12m span 10mm
Stiffeners 8mm
Base plates ( Excluding handrail, ladder and pipe supports) 16 mm
Chequered plate 6mm (on plain)
Grating 25mm thk Hot Dip galvanized MS grating
The minimum thickness of tubes shall be as specified in IS: 806.
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 26 of 36
7.3 Paint Specification
Painting shall be provided as per Project Specifications and Architectural drawing.
7.4 Fire Proofing
Where required by OISD-STD-164 norms, structural steel members shall be fireproofed by concrete
encasing or guniting (minimum thickness = 50mm).
a) For column elements steel sections wherever required up to and including 300mm depth shall be
coated by solid fill while section more than 300mm depth shall be coated in the shape of the profile.
b) For Beam elements steel sections up to and including 300mm depth shall be coated by solid fill
while section more than 300mm depth shall be coated in the shape of the profile.
7.5 Allowable Deflection
Allowable deflection for steel structure is specified as follows:
A) VERTICAL
For Pipe Supporting Beam : L/250, Max. 25 mm
For Eq’t Supporting Beam : L/500, Max. 25 mm
For Crane Girder (Manual) : L/500, Max. 25 mm or as per manufacturer’s requirement
For Crane Girder (EOT upto 50T) : L/750, Max. 25 mm or as per manufacturer’s requirement
For Other beams : L/325
Purlins / Cladding runner : L/150
Grating/ Chequered. Plate : L/200 or 6mm whichever is smaller.
Where L = Span length of the Supporting beam
B) HORIZONTAL
Column (under normal loads) : (1/325)*H H= Height of each story (Pipe rack,Process Buildings etc.)
Column (wind/ seismic loads) : (1/250)*H H= Height of each story for concrete buildings
Column (wind/seismic loads) : (1/150)*H H = Height of each story for steel building Elastic cladding
(Steel Shed,Ware house etc.)
(Reference Table 6: IS: 800)
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 27 of 36
8. CONCRETE
Concrete construction shall be conforming to IS: 456 -2000 shall be used.
8.1 Materials
a) Reinforced Cement Concrete (RCC)
M30 grade concrete or higher shall be used for all RCC structures, pits, foundations except
grade slab and paving based on exposure condition and serviceability.
Paving/Grade Slab: M25 (Minimum grade of concrete)
b) Lean Concrete
Lean concrete conforming to IS: 456 shall be used. The grade of concrete shall be as per Table
below. It shall conform to standard/detailed drawings.
Table 9 :
i Under All RCC foundations 100mm thick M15 with 100mm projection from
face of foundation
ii Under base of liquid retaining
structures
100mm thick M15 with 100mm projection from
face of foundation
iii. Encasement Concrete M20 grade concrete with 10mm down
aggregates
iv. Filling concrete
( To be used as filler material
wherever loose sub grade exists
by removing loose soil or where
levels are to be made up to
desired founding level)
M5 (Nominal Mix)
c) Plain Cement Concrete (PCC), plinth protection shall be as per job specification and job
detailed/standard drawings.
d) Cement
For Substructure: Ordinary Portland Cement conforming to IS: 8112 / IS: 12269, Portland
Pozzolana Cement with fly ash conforming to IS: 1489 Part 1, Slag cement conforming to IS 455
of approved brand and manufacture
For Superstructure: Ordinary Portland Cement conforming to IS: 12269, Portland Pozzolana
Cement with fly ash conforming to IS: 1489 Part-I, Slag cement conforming to IS 455 of approved
brand and manufacture
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 28 of 36
e) Rebar
For Substructure and Super structure : Fe500D conforming to IS: 1786
f) Binding Wire : 18 gauge black soft annealed SWG wire shall be used for binding of reinforcement
bars
8.2 Minimum Thickness of Structural Concrete Elements
The following minimum thickness shall be followed:
- Footings (All types including raft foundations without beams) 300mm
(Note: Tapered footings shall not have thickness less than 150mm at the edges. Minimum
average thickness shall not be less than 300mm)
- Basement Walls and Base Slab 150mm
- Slab thickness in Raft foundations with beam and slab
construction 225mm
- Floor/Roof Slab, Walkway, Canopy Slab resting on beams 125mm
- Cable/Pipe Trench/Launder Walls and Base Slab 150mm
- Parapet/Cantilevered Canopy Slab 100mm
- Louver/Fin. 100mm
- Pre-cast Trench Cover/Floor Slab 100mm
- Pre-cast Floor Slab/Louver (in contact with liquid) 100mm
- Liquid Retaining/Leak proof Structure Walls and Base Slab 200mm
- Underground Pit/Reservoir (Below ground water table)
Walls and Base slab 200mm
- Underground Pit (Above ground water table)
Walls and Base Slab 150mm
8.3 Minimum Height of Pedestals
The minimum projection of pedestals supporting any steel structure/stanchion bases shall be 150 above
HPP/ FFL for indoor and 300mm above HPP for outdoor located pedestals. The minimum projection of
pedestals for staircase/ladder shall be 150mm.
8.4 Grouting and Minimum Grout Thickness
The minimum thickness of grout shall be 25 mm and not more than 50mm.
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 29 of 36
Grout shall have a minimum compressive strength of 40 N/mm2 at 28 days
Cementitious non-shrink grout shall be used for filling gaps below base plates of steel columns and static
equipment also in sleeves around anchor bolts unless noted otherwise.
Epoxy-based proprietary non-shrink grout shall be used for filling the gaps below base plates and in sleeves
around anchor bolts to vibrating equipment including all pumps, compressors.
Grouting requirement for machines and equipment’s shall be governed by vendor’s requirement.
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 30 of 36
9. GENERAL CIVIL
9.1 Compound Wall and Fencing
Acquired land / plot shall be protected by providing Brick/Block/stone Masonry/RC Compound wall along the
boundary line of plot. Compound shall be at least 3.0m high with 0.6 m anti climber barbed wire on top.
9.2 Site Grading
All the plot area shall be cleaned and cleared off tree roots and vegetation.
The grading of the area shall be done by cutting and filling with the following:
a. Cutting area : Thoroughly rolled and compacted.
b. Filling area : Compacted in layers not exceeding 250mm - 300mm to
achieve 95% of maximum dry density conforming to IS: 2720, part-VII and Geotechnical Investigation
Report)
Refer following table for Finished Ground Level (FGL) & Highest Flood Level (HFL) for IPS1, IPS2 & IPS3.
Table 9a :
Station Proposed FGL (m) HFL (m) Remarks
IPS1 59.100 30.800 -
IPS2 92.450 16.000 Reference location -
Guntupalli
IPS3 312.000 313.700 Proposed FGL is above
existing road level
9.3 Roads
The main access to the plant shall be via a controlled access road to prevent unauthorised vehicles visiting
the plant. Roads in plant shall be sized and laid out giving due consideration to the amount of traffic and the
requirements of emergency vehicles.
• Road width shall be as per approved plot plan drawings.
Ramp Slope:
Desirable maximum ramp slope for all roads is 5% (1:20)
Road Cross Slope/Paving slope:
All hard surfaced roadways and access ways shall have a maximum cross slope of 0.5%. Access ways
around buildings shall have a minimum cross slope of 0.5% and a desirable cross slope of 2%.
1
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 31 of 36
9.4 Pavements
Within Plant Limits all Access ways/Roads/Truck Movement Areas including areas subject to drips and spills,
shall be RCC pavement Sidewalks and areas not subject to vehicular traffic (except area within dyke wall)
shall have a minimum pavement thickness of 150mm. Sidewalks may also be constructed with 100 mm thick
precast concrete Paver blocks.
Areas subject to vehicular/truck traffic shall have a minimum paving thickness of 200mm. All edges of
concrete pavement and pavements adjacent to manholes / catch basins shall be thickened.
Construction Joints:
Concrete area paving shall have contraction or construction joints. Isolation joints shall be used adjacent to
all poured in place foundations. Dowels, keyways or thickened edges shall be used at construction joints in
paving subject to vehicular traffic.
Expansion Joints:
Expansion joint shall be provided at maximum interval of 15 m. (UNO)
Paving Slope:
Pavement slopes preferred inside plant:
RCC Paved Area : Maximum 1:50 Minimum 1:300
Road Crossing Culverts:
Storm water drains shall cross the road by suitable pipe culverts or box culverts as the case may be.
Material of construction of culverts shall be as below:
Pipe culverts: Precast R.C.C. Hume pipe of Class NP3/NP4, shall conform to IS: 458.
Box culverts: R.C.C. construction (M30) minimum concrete grade.
9.5 Drainage Systems
The design of the drainage systems shall take into consideration the type of effluent in the system and safety
regulations relevant to personnel and equipment. Drainage system shall be designed after consideration
given to normal operating conditions and adequacy checked for fire or accident conditions.
Consequently, the aim of the drainage effluent disposal system shall be to segregate different types of
effluents in order to reduce the size, complexity as well as costs of wastewater treatment prior to discharge
and/or disposal.
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 32 of 36
Plant Drainage systems are primarily designed to ensure proper and effective drainage of Storm water and
spent firewater during Fire Event. Plant Drainage systems are segregated as follows:
9.5.1 Effluent Categories
Clean Stormwater (SW) System:
The runoff from the following areas shall be considered as clean surface water:
• Roads
• Guest house building
• Substation
• Control & Electrical Building
• Security Room
• Open Parking Lot
• VFD Room
Oily Water (OW) System:
The runoff from the following areas shall be considered as accidentally oil Contaminated
• Main Fuel Pump Station,
• Paved Area at pig receiving Location
The drainage from these areas shall be collected via separate gravity pipe drainage system.
Sanitary Sewer (SD) System:
Source for Sanitary Sewerage can be from following locations:
• Domestic Sewage from Control & Electrical Building
• Guest House
• Wash Basins
• Security Room
9.5.2 Drainage Design Philosophy
Clean Storm water (SW) System:
The Clean Surface Water Drainage System can either be a piped system, an open channel/ditch system or a
combination of both ultimately discharging into the public drain. Where the location of ditches/channels could
be considered to continue to contribute to the spread of fire or gas, adequate trapping facilities shall be used
to prevent the spread of fire.
Provision shall be made for tertiary containment if required. The objective of Tertiary containment is to
prevent escape of spills due to failure of secondary containment for any reasons and will not allow such spill
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 33 of 36
over to outside of the boundary of the installation that may lead to any damage to outside the plant limit. All
the drain openings shall be controlled through sluice gates. in order to prevent escape of accidental spill
entering the clean storm water drain as per OISD STANDARD-244
Pipe material shall be reinforced concrete pipe with rubber joint rings,
The open channel/ditch shall be covered with Heavy Duty grating / precast cover in Traffic area
Oily Water (OW) System:
The Accidentally Oil shall collect all contaminated flows, as indicated in Section 9.5.1 of this Document.
Accidentally contaminated oily Water system (OWS) shall collect the contaminated surface storm water from
process paved areas, which are prone to spillages during operation and maintenance.
The system shall be designed as gravity flowing drained pipe system. Particular attention shall paid to the
arrangement of the system with regard to sealing, venting and location of catch basins with respect to safe
operating of drainage system.
• Minimum pipe size shall be 8",
• Material: Underground OWS Pipe shall be CS (Carbon Steel) shall be provided with double
wrapping and Coating provided for all buried pipes as per OISD-STD-109
Sanitary Sewer (SD) System
The Sanitary Water System shall be designed as gravity flowing piped drain system This system shall not
discharge into another system prior to treatment and adequate self-cleansing velocities should be
maintained throughout the system.
• Minimum pipe size shall be 4"
• Material shall be HDPE
9.5.3 Drainage Design Criteria
General:
All piping sewers and channels shall be designed in accordance with accepted standard formulae for velocity
and discharge capacity of pipes and open channels.
Capacity:
Branch sewers shall be designed for greater of following two conditions:
• Rainfall based on Storm frequency of 5 years.
• Firewater Flowrate based on HSE Design.
Sizing of the system shall meet the requirements of governing flow rate, thus ensuring that no flooding can
occur.
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 34 of 36
Velocities:
• Minimum Velocity : 0.6m/sec
• Maximum Velocity : 2.4m/sec
Runoff Factors:
Impermeability factors for surface drainage design shall be taken as follows:
• For Paved areas and Building Roofs : 0.9
• For Unpaved area (including gravelled areas) : 0.5
• Soil & Green belt : 0.2
Design Rainfall Intensity:
Table 9b :
Station District Rainfall Intensity (mm/hr)
Vizag Vizag 79.6
IPS1 Vizag 79.6
Rajahmundry East Godavari 53.5
IPS2 West Godavari 35
Vijayawada Krishna 52
Suryapet Nalgonda 27
IPS3 Nalgonda 27
9.5.4 Typical Material for Drainage Piping
Table 10:
Material Standard Pipe Class Effluent Category
Carbon
Steel
API: 5L
ASTM: A53
A1A
Wrapping coating and Painting details refer
pipe class
Oily Water (OW)
system
RCC Pipes IS: 458 NP3/NP4 Pipe Culvert &
Clean Water Drains
HDPE IS: 14333 PE-80(PN12.5) Sanitary Sewer
System
1
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 35 of 36
10. MASONRY
Where needed, masonry structure design shall be in accordance with applicable Codes,Specification and
recommended practices listed in Section 1.1.
CIVIL / STRUCTURAL DESIGN BASIS
14495-00-CI-BOD-0001 Rev : 1 Page 36 of 36
11. SOFTWARE TO BE USED FOR THE PROJECT
For Analysis and Design: STAAD.Pro V8i Select Series 6, MS Excel 2010, Foundation-3D Version 6.2.0
and Mat-3D version 6.2.0
For Drafting: AutoCAD
For Detailing of RCC building: RCDC (Wherever applicable)
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 1 of 19
VVSPL CAPACITY AUGMENTATION PROJECT
Specification - Fence and Gate Work
Project No: 403102-14495
Document No: 14495-00-CI-SPC-0009
18 Aug 17
I-Think Lodha Techno Campus, 5th Floor, Tower B,
Pokhran Road No. 2 Thane (West) – 400607 Tel: +91 2266515700 Fax: +91 2267818000
© Copyright 2017 WorleyParsons
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 2 of 19
SYNOPSIS
This document presents the Project Specification - Fence and Gate Work for the VVSPL Capacity
Augmentation Project. & shall be used to detail the design and construction requirements for the project.
Disclaimer
This report has been prepared on behalf of and for the exclusive use of HPCL, and is subject to and issued
in accordance with the agreement between HPCL and WorleyParsons India Pvt Ltd.
WorleyParsons India Pvt Ltd accepts no liability or responsibility whatsoever for it in respect of any use of or
reliance upon this document by any third party.
Copying this report without the permission of HPCL or WorleyParsons is not permitted.
VVSPL CAPACITY AUGMENTATION PROJECT
REV DESCRIPTION ORIG REVIEW WORLEY-
PARSONS APPROVAL
DATE CUSTOMER APPROVAL
DATE
0 Issued for Use
RAD
PAR
KAK
18 Aug 17
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 3 of 19
CONTENTS
1. SCOPE ............................................................................................................................... 4
2. REFERENCE DOCUMENTS ............................................................................................. 5
2.1 Codes and Standards ........................................................................................................ 5
2.2 Other Standards / Specifications ...................................................................................... 6
3. EARTH WORK FOR CIVIL WORKS ................................................................................. 7
4. CONCRETE FOR FOUNDATION ..................................................................................... 8
5. STRUCTURAL STEEL FOR POSTS ................................................................................ 9
6. CHAIN LINK FENCING .................................................................................................... 10
6.1 Cleats for Eye Bolts ......................................................................................................... 10
6.2 Eye Bolt Strainers ............................................................................................................ 10
6.3 Stretcher Bar .................................................................................................................... 10
7. BARBED WIRE FENCING ............................................................................................... 11
8. ERECTION OF CHAIN LINK FENCING.......................................................................... 12
8.1 Erection of Posts and Struts............................................................................................ 12
8.2 Fixing Chain Link Fencing ............................................................................................... 12
9. MS GATES ....................................................................................................................... 13
10. BOOM BARRIERS (MOTORIZED) ................................................................................. 15
11. MANUAL/MOTORIZED ROLLING SHUTTER ................................................................ 17
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 4 of 19
1. SCOPE
This specification specifies the requirements of fence and associated gate work including foundation and
earthwork thereof. The height of the fence shall be in accordance with the drawing for fencing.
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 5 of 19
2. REFERENCE DOCUMENTS
Note: - Wherever reference is made to IS Codes, on any page of this Technical Specification (including
annexures), latest publication of the IS Code shall be referred to.
The Indian standard codes applicable to this section shall include but not limited to the following:
2.1 Codes and Standards
IS 278 Specification Galvanized Steel Barbed Wire For Fencing
IS 432 (Part 1) Mild Steel Specification For Medium Tensile Steel Bars And Hard Drawn Steel
Wire For Concrete Reinforcement: Part 1 Mild Steel And Medium Tensile Steel
Bars
IS 432 (Part 2) Mild Steel Specification For Medium Tensile Steel Bars And Hard Drawn Steel
Wire For Concrete Reinforcement: Part 2 Hard-Drawn Steel Wire
IS 456 Code Of Practice For Plain And Reinforced Concrete
IS 800 Code Of Practice For General Construction In Steel
IS 806 Code Of Practice For Use Of Steel Tubes In General Building Construction.
IS 814 Covered Electrodes For Manual Metal Arc Welding Of Carbon And Carbon
Manganese Steel
IS 816 Code Of Practice For Use Of Metal Arc Welding For General Construction In
Mild Steel
IS 817 Code Of Practice For Training And Testing Of Metal Arc Welders
IS 817 (Part I) Training Of Welders - Code Of Practice: Part 1 Manual Metal Arc Welding
IS 819 Code Of Practice For Resistance Spot Welding For Light Assemblies In Mild
Steel
IS 822 Code Of Procedure For Inspection Of Welds
IS 919 (Part I) ISO Systems Of Limits And Fits: Bases Of Tolerance, Deviations And Fits
IS 1161 Steel Tubes For Structural Purposes – Specification
IS 1182 Recommended Practice For Radiographic Examination Of Fusion Welded Butt
Joints In Steel Plates
IS 1200 (Part 8) Method Of Measurement Of Building And Civil Engineering Works: Steel Work
And Iron Work
IS 1239 Steel Tubes, Tubulars And Other Wrought Steel Fittings
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 6 of 19
IS 1786 Specification For High Strength Deformed Steel Bars And Wires For Concrete
Reinforcement
IS 2721 Galvanized Steel Chain Link Fence Fabric.
IS 6248 Metal Rolling Shutters And Rolling Grills.
BS EN 13241 Industrial,Commercial And Garage Doors And Gates. Product Standards
ASTM A36 Standard Specification For Carbon Structural Steel.
ASTM A312 Standard Specification For Seamless, Welded, And Heavily Cold Worked
Austenitic Stainless Steel Pipes.
ASTM A500 Standard Specification For Cold-Formed Welded And Seamless Carbon Steel
Structural Tubing In Rounds And Shapes.
ASTM A536 Standard Specification For Ductile Iron Castings.
ASTM B26 Standard Specification For Aluminum-Alloy Sand Castings.
2.2 Other Standards / Specifications
Specification for Earth Work 14495-00-CI-SPC-0001
Specification for Concrete Work 14495-00-CI-SPC-0002
Specification for Steel Work 14495-00-ST-SPC-0001
Specification for Structural Steel Painting 14495-00-ST-SPC-0002
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 7 of 19
3. EARTH WORK FOR CIVIL WORKS
Refer Project Specification No. 14495-00-CI-SPC-0001.
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 8 of 19
4. CONCRETE FOR FOUNDATION
The concrete shall be placed on a clean bed having the designed level.
Stone aggregates for concrete shall be of approved quality and size. All concrete work shall strictly be
carried out as per IS 456.
For concrete work refer to project specification 14495-00-CI-SPC-0002
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 9 of 19
5. STRUCTURAL STEEL FOR POSTS
For structural steel works refer to project specification 14495-00-ST-SPC-0001.
Steel sections as mentioned in the drawing shall be used for the vertical posts, top rails, the struts & ties.
The work shall be carried out as per IS 800.
All necessary fitments like tie road, Turn buckle, gussets, stiffeners and all others as mentioned in the
drawing and as directed by the Engineer-in-charge shall be provided. All the posts/struts shall be free from
rust, scale, cracks, twists and other defects and shall be fabricated to the required shape and size. All the
posts and struts shall be of sizes and lengths as specified in the drawing. The posts and struts shall have
split ends for proper fixing and shall be embedded in the plain cement concrete block as mentioned in the
drawing.
All structural members like posts, bracings etc. shall be painted with 2 coats of Zinc Chromate primer and
finishing coat of Polyurethene paint before fixing of Chain Link Fence or Barbed wire.
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 10 of 19
6. CHAIN LINK FENCING
The material requirement shall confirm to IS 2721. The chain link fencing shall be woven from 3.15mm
diameter wire with mesh size of 50mm. The mesh wire shall not vary from the specified diameter by more
than +0.05mm.
The line wire shall be 4mm diameter mild steel.
The stirrup wire for securing the line wires to the concrete intermediate posts shall be 2.5mm diameter
mild steel.
The tying wire for securing the chain link fencing to the line wire shall be 1.6mm diameter mild steel.
Hair pin staple for fastening down the bottom of galvanized chain line fencing to the concrete sill shall be
of 3.15mm wire. The ends shall be bent outwards to secure anchorage.
6.1 Cleats for Eye Bolts
Cleats for eye bolts shall be of uniform size and shall consist of mild steel angle of
65 x 65 x 6mm.
6.2 Eye Bolt Strainers
The eye bolt strainer shall consist of bolts with welded eye sufficiently threaded and fitted with a nut and
washer.
Two-way eye bolt strainers shall have a suitable ring nut fitted after the wires have been strained on one
side.
6.3 Stretcher Bar
Stretcher bar shall consist of mild steel flat 25mm x 4.75mm. They shall be secured to the cleats by steel
bolts.
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 11 of 19
7. BARBED WIRE FENCING
The galvanized steel barbed wire shall be, A-1 conforming to IS 278.
Galvanized steel barbed wire shall be tied to the structural post with welded MS Nibs or with GI wire through
holes in the tie post.
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 12 of 19
8. ERECTION OF CHAIN LINK FENCING
8.1 Erection of Posts and Struts
Straining posts L65x65x6, shall be provided at all ends and corner of fences, at changes in direction or
acute variations in level and at intervals not exceeding 18m on straight lengths of fence. Intermediate
posts shall be spaced at regular intervals not exceeding 2.5 m.
Struts shall be fitted to all straining posts behind the chain link fabric in the direction of the line of fence.
8.2 Fixing Chain Link Fencing
There shall be four evenly spaced rows of line wire. The top wire shall be doubled making five line wires in
all. The bottom wire shall be close to the ground unless otherwise noted in the drawings.
Each line wire shall be strained lightly by means of eyebolt strainers or winders at each straining point.
Each line wire shall be secured to each intermediate post by a wire stirrup passed through a hole in the
posts and secured to the line wire by three complete turns on each side of the post.
The chain link fencing shall be strained between each pair of straining posts and secured to each straining
post by means of a stretcher bar. On the top line wires shall be threaded through the appropriate adjacent
rows of mesh, care being taken that no meshes in the rows are bypassed by the line wire except where
deviation is necessary at the straining posts. The second top line wire shall be strained in front of the
fencing. The fencing shall be attached to the top and bottom line wires by wire ties spaced 150mm and to
the other line wires by wire ties spaced 450mm apart.
The bottom of the fencing shall be treated as follows:
Continuous concrete sill 125mm wide x 225mm high for full length between posts shall be cast with top
25mm above FGL and 25mm below the chain link fencing. Hairpin staples shall be threaded through the
bottom row of mesh at 750mm centers and set in the sill to a depth of 150mm.
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 13 of 19
9. MS GATES
Open able/sliding gate contractor to refer the master layout detail drawings for location. Motorized gates
shall have Motor capacity ranging from 350 KG to 4000 KG, depending on the weight of the gate. The
Motor shall have Heavy Intensive Duty Cycle and can be used in any environmental Conditions.in addition
to the vehicular entry gates, pedestrian gates shall also be provided as per requirement in the master
layout plan.
The gate shall be manufactured from rolled hollow section mild steel tube. The gate leaf is to be a torsion
free, fully welded unit with the vertical bars fully welded to the top and bottom gate beams. The leaf shall
be fully supported by the hanging post obviating any need for a jockey wheel. For single leaf gates the
closing post will provide a slam plate to locate the gate when in the closed position. Manual gates are
provided with mortise locks, drop bolts and holding back catches.
The gate may be provided with the following alternative infills; welded mesh, pales to match palisade
fencing, flat, profiled or louvered sheet steel or aluminum, wood (close boarded or hit and miss), round
bar, diagonal bar, or the gate frame can be prepared to accept the customers own material.
For power operated gates the hanging post(s) shall incorporate an open/close key switch and an
emergency stop button and house fully programmable control panel that will interface with all types of
access control systems; e.g. Card readers or radio transmitters, and for larger gates can also be equipped
with inverters to give ‘soft start’ and ‘soft stop’ functions, together with speed control. The control panel
should have a built in auto close delay function, and plug in cards for inductive ground loops, traffic
light/status indication, and electro-magnetic lock control. Access to the control panel shall be through a
lockable steel access door.
The drive system is to be mounted at high level on the gate hanging post(s), with the drive transmitted to
the gate leaf by an articulated arm. This arm is to incorporate a lockable pin to allow the drive to be
disengaged for manual operation in the event of power failure. The drive system shall be powered by a
three phase 230/400V, 50Hz motor driving through a maintenance free worm drive gearbox equipped with
adjustable limit switches to stop the gate in the open and closed positions. The drive units shall be
shrouded in stainless steel covers.
Gate leaves up to 4.00 meters are to be held closed by the drive mechanism, and larger leaves
incorporating an additional heavy duty magnetic lock rated at 4.60kN. The lock is to be released and
degaussed by the control panel prior to gate movement. The standard safety buffer system shall be ‘fail
safe’, and conform to the latest European Regulations – BS EN 13241-1:2003 (Category 3). It shall
consist of two rubber buffers per leaf located either side of the gates vertical leading edge and bottom
beam.
To ensure long term corrosion protection after fabrication, components should be shot blasted, hot zinc
sprayed and polyurethane coated. Colours should be as specified by the Engineer in charge.
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 14 of 19
Foundation and general arrangements drawings should be supplied immediately after order has been
placed, for dimensional approval, and to ensure that the foundations can be completed in good time
before the gate is delivered. Wiring diagrams should also be delivered well in advance.
The Technical Specification for the mild steel gates and fixtures shall be as specified in drawing. For
general specification for fabrication & erection in Steel refer to specification no. 14495-00-ST-SPC-0001.
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 15 of 19
10. BOOM BARRIERS (MOTORIZED)
Boom barriers shall be installed at all the vehicular Entry/Exit Points to restrict unauthorized access.
A Boom Barrier shall mean a rising barrier that shall open in case of an impulse with the use of a long
Range Card Reader. The barrier shall close only after the vehicle has passed. Appropriate sensors shall
be used for this purpose. A torque motor with 100% duty cycle shall operate the barrier. The motor shall
remain with voltage applied but at reduced power. The power dissipated in the form of heat shall prevent
the occurrence of condensation and corrosion. The drive shall not have friction clutches or limit switches
to stall the boom at the end positions. The drive motor shall have intelligent control mechanism and the
intelligent sensors shall accelerate and decelerate the movement of the booms. The barrier booms shall
not bounce at the end positions.
The barrier booms shall be lockable at both the end positions in the event of power failure. The Boom
barrier shall be changeable on site from right axial to left axial or vice-versa. The Boom Barrier shall be
capable of being installed and operated without any problems, in the open, exposed to all the
environmental conditions. The Boom Barrier housing shall have Nirosta steel or equivalent base frame
and shall use Phosphatized powder coated Zinc or-sheet. The housing shall not require the use of any
tools except for a single key. The equipment shall be CE certified. A short circuit -proof 24 Volts controller
shall operate the barrier (no damage to the fuses in case of misconnection).
• Boom Length : As mentioned in the drawings & BOQ at various locations.
• Open/Close Time : 5 Seconds
• Boom Material :Extruded Aluminum Alloy
• Duty Cycle : 100 %
• Intelligence & Motor :Micro Controller Based Motor
• Drive :Torque Controlled DC Servo Motor with PWM Technology
• Safety : Magnetic Loop Detector Embedded
• Housing : MS Powder Coated with IP 67 Protections.
A traffic signal light with a red and green light shall be provided. The diameter of the lights shall be 150mm
or more. As the boom lowers to its full height and the traffic signal light shall be red. When the boom is
lifted the traffic signal light shall be green. The boom arm shall lower or raise time shall be less than
5seconds. The boom arm shall be equipped with an aluminum pedestrian curtain. Road ordinance
compliant STOP and NO ENTRY signs shall be installed.
The plinth for the boom shall be cast with M20 concrete. Sleeves shall be cast into the concrete to allow
all cables to terminate from the bottom.
Accessibility
The equipment shall be easily accessible for maintenance and repair purposes as well as for manual
operation. The access panel shall be lockable.
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 16 of 19
Excavations and draining
The design shall allow for the minimum excavations and simplify the installation. If necessary drainage
have to be provided to allow water seepage and prevent water to accumulate in and around the barrier.
Installation
The installation shall be done in such a way that it will prevent vehicles from driving in or out of the
premises unauthorized. The traffic light will also face towards the correct side to caution vehicles. Correct
directions must be determined on site with the user before commencing with the installation.
Manufacturers Details
The manufacturer’s details and contact numbers as well as serial number, model and make of the
equipment shall be displayed on the equipment cabinet and all parts. No equipment without identification
shall be accepted.
Standards
All equipment shall be of the latest technology and conform to the latest national and international
standards applicable to this type of security equipment.
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 17 of 19
11. MANUAL/MOTORIZED ROLLING SHUTTER
Motorized MS Rolling Shutter with fire rated for Two hours. Motor sizing (150kg to 5000 kg) shall be
provided as per appropriate capacity required for the required opening size. Hand cranking and gear
operation shall be provided from inside and outside at the operable heights.
INSTALLATION
Components
i. Slats for rolling shutters shall be made from tested bright hot rolled double dipped galvanised steel
lath section of 18 swg tested mild steel strips at 75mm rolling centers, interlocking with each other.
The profile will be such as to prevent excessive deflection under specified wind load.
ii. Rolling grills shall be constructed out of 6mm rods at 35 mm on centers running horizontally
flexible connected with vertical links spaced not more than 200 mm centers. Alternatively, rolling
grills shall be made from perforated slats of approved design reinforced with 6mm dia rods.
iii. End locks shall be heavy type M.C.I / CI and shall be provided at each end of alternate slats
unless specified otherwise.
iv. Bottom bars shall be finished with two angles not less than 6 mm thick for external shutters. When
shown on drawings, a flexible weather strip shall be applied to make tight contact with the floor.
Bottom lath shall be coupled to a lock plate fabricated from 3mm thick galvanized steel plate and
securely riveted with stiffening angles.
v. Guides shall be of such depth as to retain the shutter under a wind pressure of 100 Kg/Sq. m.
vi. Shafts shall be of steel pipe of sufficient size to carry the tensional load with a maximum deflection
of 1/360th of span. Grease packed ball bearings or bushings shall be provided for smooth trouble
free operation.
vii. Hoods shall be formed of not less than 20 gauge steel, suitable reinforced to prevent sag.
viii. Locks shall be slide bolt and hasp, or cylinder lock operable from both sides. Provision securing
hand chain with pad-lock, provision for removable handle for hand cranks etc. shall be made as
prescribed by the Engineer in Charge.
ix. Power unit shall be suitable for kW = VTA, Local Isolation switch (SFU/MCCB) rating = VTA (VTA
= Vendor to Advice) power supply and be either floor or wall mounted unit. The motor shall be of
sufficient capacity, to move the shutter in either direction at a speed of 0.3 meters per second. In
addition to the gear motor each standard power unit shall include a magnetic brake, a reversing
starter with built-in overload protection, a geared limit switch and one push button station located
inside the building unless otherwise stated in drawing. It is desirable that the bottom bar of motor
operated doors shall be provided with a sensitive edge, electrically connected to stop the travel of
the door on meeting an obstruction.
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 18 of 19
x. Operating chains shall be of tested quality, heavily galvanized and with all ends rounded to assure
smooth operation and hand protection.
xi. Reduction gears shall be high strength grey cast iron, machine moulded from machine out
patterns.
Manually Operated Shutters/Grills (self-coiling type or push pull down)
Self-coiling type rolling shutters shall be raised or lowered manually by means of a puffing hook applied to
the pulling handles fixed on the bottom lock plate. The length of the pulling hook shall be adequate to
push the bottom lock plate to the topmost position with ease. Manually operated shutters shall be easily
operable by one person. The speed of operation shall be about 1.3 meters per second. In general,
manually operated shutters shall be push pull type for opening up to 8 Sq. meters in area. It shall be used
up to a maximum of about 8 m2 clear area without ball bearings and up to a clear area of about 12 m2
with ball bearings, as per IS 6248. Larger shutters shall, be either chain or gear operated or crank and
gear operated. The crank handle shall be removable. All shutters shall be lockable from one or both sides
as desired by the Engineer in Charge
Mechanically or Gear Operated Shutters/Grills
It shall be fitted with ball bearings. It shall be used up to a maximum of about 25 m2 clear area, if the
rolling shutter is operated by a bevel gear-box and crank handle and up to a maximum of about 35 m2
clear area ,as per IS 6248. All shutters shall be lockable from one or both sides as desired by the engineer
in charge. Gear-operated type rolling shutters ordinarily employ a worm drive arrangement, the worm
driving the worm wheel attached to one end of the roller. Worm drive is preferred in view of its irreversible
nature, which provides a safeguard against any accidental downward descent of the curtain due to failure
of the springs.
Power operated Shutters/Grills
Electrically operated rolling shutters shall be operated by an electric motor operating on kW = VTA, Local
Isolation switch (SFU/MCCB) rating = VTA (VTA = Vendor to Advice). The electric motor shall drive the
worm shaft by chain or Vee-belt drive or through a reduction gear box. The reduction gear box shall have
a control lever within easy reach from the floor so that the motor may be disengaged and the auxiliary
chain gear operating mechanism may be engaged instantly in the event of power failure. The motor unit
shall be so mounted that the motor may be completely removed without interfering with the operation of
the rolling shutter or the auxiliary drive. The electric drive shall be so designed as to limit the speed of
movement of the curtain in either direction to not more than about 10 cm/s The controls provided for the
electric motor shall include push The controls provided for the electric motor shall include push button
control through the medium of a 3-phase reversing starter with Interlocking contractors and overload
protection. The reversing starter shall be wall mounted and fitted adjacent to the shutter in a convenient
position. A minimum of 3 phase buttons marked ‘Forward‘, ‘Reverse & ‘Stop’ or ’Up, ‘Down‘, ‘Stop’ shall be
provided with a mechanical locking arrangement to prevent unauthorized or irregular operation of the push
SPECIFICATION - FENCE AND GATE WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0009 Rev : 0 Page 19 of 19
buttons. Limit switches shall be provided to cut off current to the motor when the rolling shutter reaches
the limit of its travel in the ‘Up’ and ‘Down’ directions. Arrangement shall also be provided for emergency
mechanical Operation of the rolling shutter in the event of failure of electricity or electrical equipment. The
emergency mechanical operation shall be by an auxiliary chain wheel and hand chain drive on the worm
shaft.
Shop Coat Shutters shall be painted with one coat of red lead or zinc chromate primer. Where specified, shutters
shall be galvanized and subsequently painted one coat of zinc chromate for adhesion of field coat and
shop paint as per specification.
Erection
Shutters shall be installed by the manufacturer or his authorized representative and all work shall be as
per manufacturer’s instructions. Any drilling or cutting to concrete, masonry etc. shall be made good after
erection of shutters and all abrasion to shop coat shall be touched up. All electrical work shall be in strict
accordance with the latest Indian Electricity Rules.
Acceptance Criteria and Guarantee
Shop Inspection
After completing the manufacture of the different components of the rolling shutter, an arrangement for
shop inspection by the Engineer in charge shall be made to check the conformity with approved shop
drawings.
Field Inspection
After installing the shutters, the Contractor shall test the performance of the shutter in the presence of the
Engineer in charge. The shutters shall be smoothly operable under all ambient conditions. All control and
locking devices shall give fault free performance.
Guarantee
The Contractor shall give guarantee for the successful operation of the shutters. This shall be supported
by a separate and unilateral guarantee from the manufacturer of the shutters.
Rates and Measurement
Rates for rolling shutters and grill shall include the cost of the locks, guide channels, cost of drive as
specified. In case of electrically operated rolling shutters, the rate shall also include the mounting of
controls, wire and wiring from the nearest junction box, conduit and other electrical connections and cost
of electric motor.
Measurement
Supply and installation of rolling shutter and grill shall be measured in Sq. m. in net outer to outer
(including frame) area of each type used as described in “Schedule of Items”.
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 1 of 23
VVSPL CAPACITY AUGMENTATION PROJECT
Specification - Miscellaneous Work
Project No: 403102-14495
Document No: 14495-00-CI-SPC-0010
18 Aug 17
I-Think Lodha Techno Campus, 5th Floor, Tower B,
Pokhran Road No. 2 Thane (West) – 400607 Tel: +91 2266515700 Fax: +91 2267818000
© Copyright 2017 WorleyParsons
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 2 of 23
SYNOPSIS
This document presents the Project Specification - Miscellaneous Work for the VVSPL Capacity
Augmentation Project. & shall be used to detail the design and construction requirements for the project.
Disclaimer
This report has been prepared on behalf of and for the exclusive use of HPCL, and is subject to and issued
in accordance with the agreement between HPCL and WorleyParsons India Pvt Ltd.
WorleyParsons India Pvt Ltd accepts no liability or responsibility whatsoever for it in respect of any use of or
reliance upon this document by any third party.
Copying this report without the permission of HPCL or WorleyParsons is not permitted.
VVSPL CAPACITY AUGMENTATION PROJECT
REV DESCRIPTION ORIG REVIEW WORLEY-
PARSONS APPROVAL
DATE CUSTOMER APPROVAL
DATE
0 Issued for Use
AVJ
PAR
KAK
18 Aug 17
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 3 of 23
CONTENTS
1. SCOPE ............................................................................................................................... 5
2. REFERENCE DOCUMENTS ............................................................................................. 6
2.1 Codes and Standards ........................................................................................................ 6
2.2 Other Standards / Specifications........................................................................................ 7
3. ANTITERMITE TREATMENT ............................................................................................ 8
3.1 Scope ................................................................................................................................. 8
3.2 Materials And Application ................................................................................................... 8
3.3 Procedure for Treatment .................................................................................................... 8
3.4 Treatment of Plinth/Basement and Apron .......................................................................... 9
3.5 Treatment of Soil along External Perimeter of Building ..................................................... 9
4. HERITAGE PLASTER ..................................................................................................... 10
4.1 Material ............................................................................................................................. 10
4.2 Workmanship ................................................................................................................... 10
4.3 Work Elements to be Included ......................................................................................... 11
5. PAVER BLOCK ................................................................................................................ 12
5.1 Technical Requirements .................................................................................................. 12
5.1.1 Interlocking Paver Block ............................................................................................... 12
5.1.2 Sub-Base Preparation .................................................................................................. 13
5.1.3 Installation of Paver Blocks .......................................................................................... 14
6. STAINLESS STEEL RAILING ......................................................................................... 15
6.1 Structural Requirements .................................................................................................. 15
6.1.1 Loads ............................................................................................................................ 15
6.1.2 Materials ....................................................................................................................... 15
6.1.3 Fasteners ...................................................................................................................... 15
6.1.4 Fabrication .................................................................................................................... 15
6.1.5 Preparation ................................................................................................................... 15
6.1.6 Installation ..................................................................................................................... 16
6.2 Submittals ......................................................................................................................... 16
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 4 of 23
6.3 Quality Assurance ............................................................................................................ 16
6.4 Delivery Storage and Handling ........................................................................................ 16
6.5 Project Conditions ............................................................................................................ 16
7. TENSIONED FABRIC STRUCTURE .............................................................................. 18
7.1 Section ............................................................................................................................. 18
7.2 Subcontractor’s Work ....................................................................................................... 18
7.3 Related Requirements ..................................................................................................... 19
7.4 Leed Submittals ............................................................................................................... 19
7.5 Close Out Submittals ....................................................................................................... 19
7.6 Quality Assurance ............................................................................................................ 19
7.7 System Requirements ...................................................................................................... 19
7.8 Field Conditions ............................................................................................................... 20
7.9 Warranty ........................................................................................................................... 20
7.10 Performance Requirements ............................................................................................. 21
7.11 Canopy Fabric .................................................................................................................. 21
7.12 Canopy Frame, Cables, Fittings and Accessories ........................................................... 22
7.13 Execution .......................................................................................................................... 22
7.13.1 Examination .................................................................................................................. 22
7.13.2 Field Quality Control ..................................................................................................... 22
7.13.3 Erection ......................................................................................................................... 22
7.13.4 Adjusting ....................................................................................................................... 23
7.13.5 Demonstration .............................................................................................................. 23
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 5 of 23
1. SCOPE
This specification covers the material and workmanship requirements for the following miscellaneous works.
Following Miscellaneous works have been covered in this specification:
i. Anti-Termite Treatment
ii. Heritage Plaster
iii. Paver Blocks
iv. SS Handrails
v. Tensioned Fabric Structure
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 6 of 23
2. REFERENCE DOCUMENTS
2.1 Codes and Standards
The Indian Standards and other referred standards (including all amendments and revisions) shall
be considered as part of this Specification. In case any particular aspect of work is not covered specifically
by these or any other relevant Indian Standard Specification, any other good engineering practice as may
be specified by the company shall be followed.
Following Indian standards including all amendments and revisions shall be considered as part of
this specification.
IS 6313 Code Of Practice For Anti-Termite Measures In Buildings
Part 1 - Constructional Measures
Part 2 - Pre Constructional Chemical Treatment Measures
Part 3 - Treatment For Existing Buildings
IS 8944 Chlorpyrifos Emulsifiable Concentrates
IS 383 Coarse And Fine Aggregates From Natural Sources For Concrete
IS 456 Plain And Reinforced Concrete- Code Of Practice
IS 2185 Specification For Concrete Masonry Unit
IS 2386 Methods Of Test For Aggregates For Concrete
IS 8112 Ordinary Portland Cement Grade, 43
IS 1542 Sand For Plaster
IS 1661 Code Of Practice For Application Of Cement And Cement-Lime Plaster Finishes
IS 1237 Cement Concrete Flooring Tiles – Specification
IS 12269 Ordinary Portland Cement, 53 Grade
IS 15658 Precast Concrete Blocks For Paving — Specification A 555 Standard Specification For General Requirements For Stainless Steel Wire And Wire Rods E 894 Standard Test Method For Anchorage Of Permanent Metal Railing Systems And Rails For
Buildings. E 935 Standard Test Methods For Performance Of Permanent Metal Railing Systems And Rails For
Buildings. E 985 Standard Specification For Permanent Metal Railing Systems And Rails For Buildings
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 7 of 23
2.2 Other Standards / Specifications
Specification for Earth Work 14495-00-CI-SPC-0001
Specification for Concrete Work 14495-00-CI-SPC-0002
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 8 of 23
3. ANTITERMITE TREATMENT
3.1 Scope
This specification establishes the materials and method of accomplishing pre-constructional anti-termite
treatment of soil for protection of buildings against attack by subterranean termites with the
usage of chemical emulsions in accordance with the procedure laid down.
3.2 Materials and Application
• Materials shall be chloropyrifos emulsifiable concentrates (1%) conforming to IS 8944 in water
emulsions. Alternatively Imidacloprid 30.50 SC, Permathrin, Cypermethrine, Fenvalerate,
Isofenphose or equivalent Government approved material shall be used for Anti-termite treatment.
• The treatment shall be carried out by a licensed and approved agency specialized in the field.
• Dosage of the application of emulsion given in this specification shall be treated as minimum
requirements. However in case of variation in dosage based on manufacturer’s recommendations,
the more stringent requirements shall govern.
• Apart from this specification, the work shall be carried out in compliance with IS 6313.
3.3 Procedure for Treatment
The treatment shall be carried out by an approved agency specialized in the field. Apart from this
specification, the work shall be carried out in compliance with IS 6313. In case of any contradiction, this
specification shall govern.
Site Preparation
Prior to start of chemical treatment, area(s), shall be made free from logs, stumps, timber off
cuts, leveling pegs, roots of plants/trees etc. Soil treatment shall start when foundation trenches/pits are
ready to take concrete masonry in foundations and plinth area ready for laying the subgrade. Treatment
shall not be carried out when it is raining or the subsoil water level is at the same or higher than the level
of treatment. In the event of water-logging of foundations, the water shall be pumped out and the chemical
emulsion applied when the soil is absorbent. Treatment of the excavated pits/trenches and backfill for
Foundations
• The bottom surface and the lower 300 mm side surfaces of the excavated pits/trenches
for foundations of masonry works and RCC plinth beams supporting such masonry works,
shall be treated with specified chemical emulsion @ 5 litres/m of the surface area.
However, no such treatment shall be required in case of pits/trenches made for RCC foundations
supporting RCC walls and/or columns.
• On completion of construction of masonry foundations, the backfill in immediate contact
with the substructure shall be treated in layers of 300 mm with emulsion @ 7.5 litres/m2 of the
vertical surface of the substructure (i.e. 7.5 x 0.300 = 2.25 litres/meter of perimeter) for each side.
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 9 of 23
The treatment shall be given after ramming of each layer of soil, by rodding the earth at 150 mm
centres close to the wall surface and working the rod backward and forward (parallel to the wall
surface) and then spraying the specified dosage of emulsion. The emulsion shall be directed
towards the masonry surfaces so that the soil in contact with these surfaces is well treated with
the chemical. After the treatment, the soil shall be tamped back into place. This shall be done for
full depth of the fill.
• For RCC walls and columns, the treatment as specified in (b) shall start from a depth 500 mm
below the finished ground level and shall be done upto the FGL.
3.4 Treatment of Plinth/Basement and Apron
• The top surface of the consolidated earth below the non-suspended floor slabs and the
peripheral aprons of widths upto 750 mm, the bottom surface and side surfaces of the excavated
pits for the basements shall be treated with chemical emulsion @ 5 litres/m2 of the surface area.
Holes 50 to 75 mm deep at 150 mm centres, both ways, shall be made on the surface with 12 mm
diameter mild steel rod and then emulsion shall be sprayed uniformly over the area. At expansion
joint locations, anti-termite treatment shall be supplemented by treating through the expansion
joint @ 2.0 litres per linear metre of joint after the subgrade has been laid.
• Treatment of Junctions of plinth filling and wall/column faces shall be done after making a
small channel 30 mm x 30 mm, by making rod holes 150 mm apart (upto the ground level) in the
channel and then by moving the rod backward and forward @7.5 litres/m2 of the vertical
wall/column surface, so as to soak the soil right to the bottom. The soil shall be tamped back into
place after the treatment.
3.5 Treatment of Soil along External Perimeter of Building
After the building is complete, the earth along the external perimeter shall be rodded at intervals of 150
mm and to depth of 300 mm. The rod shall be moved backward and forward parallel to the wall to break
up the earth and chemical emulsion poured along the wall @ 7.5 litres/m2 of vertical surface (i.e. 7.5 x
0.300 = 2.25 litres/metre of perimeter). After the treatment, the earth shall be tamped back into place.
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 10 of 23
4. HERITAGE PLASTER
This work item shall be applied for Heritage textured finish on external surface of Brick masonry, external
concrete surfaces of buildings and structures.
4.1 Material
i. Cement to be used as per IS 8112.
ii. Sand to be used as per IS 1542 & fineness modules as per IS 1661 Table 2
Mix Proportion: As indicated below
1 cement: 6 sand by volume for First Coat and Second Coat of Heritage Textured Plaster.
4.2 Workmanship
• Maximum thickness of first coat: 13 mm and second coat as per manufacturer’s specification.
• Number of coats: 2.
• Minimum Curing Period: 7 days for first coat.
• Type - Heritage Textured Plater.
• Permissible variations in final level of plaster + 2 mm per meter in vertical plane.
• All undulations in final level of plaster shall be checked with straight edge, spirit level and line
strings (stretched).
• Any undulations exceeding permissible limits shall be rectified by CONTRACTOR at his own cost.
• Any hollowed plaster detected by tapping shall be rectified by CONTRACTOR at his own cost.
• Construction joints in wall plaster shall be horizontal as far as possible. No vertical or diagonal
joints shall be permitted unless approved by Engineer-In-Charge.
• In case of sweating of plaster due to excessively wet wall surface or wet mortar mix or high atmos-
pheric humidity, corrective measures shall be taken to eliminate sweating of plaster such as use
of heaters or dehumidifying agents like silica gel etc. during working period.
• Any minor cracks in mortar shall be rectified by CONTRACTOR at his own cost. If the cracking of
mortar is excessive, CONTRACTOR shall remove the plaster and re-do the work at his own cost.
Engineer-In-Charge’s judgment shall be final.
• The edges around duct openings, cable conduits, door and window openings, pipe sleeves, insert
plate and other embedded items shall be finished sharp or rounded as per drawings or as
instructed by Engineer-In-Charge. All openings and embedded items shall be properly covered
while mortaring and shall be cleaned after the final finished coat is completed.
• All corners of walls, junctions between floors and ceilings shall be finished perfectly vertical, and
rounded.
• RCC. Column edges shall be finished vertical and all sharp edges shall be rendered smooth.
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 11 of 23
4.3 Work Elements to be Included
• Cleaning the surface of all laitance and loose particles and roughening the concrete surface ade-
quately to receive the mortar.
• Wetting the surface with water including adhesive before commencing plastering work.
• Preparing mortar level pads confirming to final thickness of mortar required as per Drawing, on the
wall surface regular intervals and at the same time checking the verticality of this final level of
mortar pads with plumb bob.
• Mixing of cement and sand with water either in a machine or manually to obtain uniform plasters
mix.
• Applying mortar mix with trowel, using steel trowel on the wall surface starting from top level and
gradually working down.
• Taking care to check that the mortar coat thickness does not exceed 13 mm for first coat.
• Smoothening the mortar with trowel to obtain a uniform surface without any waves.
• (8) After initial setting of the first coat, to roughen/comb the first coat to form the grooves with
wire brush taking care to see that the plaster does not fall off during combing operation.
• Curing of first coat with clean water continuously for specified days.
• Application of Heritage Textured Plaster coat shall be as per manufacturer’s specification
(BAKELITE HYLAM or equivalent) and by approved applicator.
• To check the surface undulations and verticality of final plastered surface by rules.
• Erecting all necessary scaffolding, walkways and platforms before starting the plastering work and
dismounting of the same after completion of the work.
• All edges around openings in walls to be finished as per drawings or as per instructions of
Engineer-In-Charge.
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 12 of 23
5. PAVER BLOCK
This specification covers the workmanship, supply, transportation, stacking, installation, requirements of
materials, necessary equipment, testing, etc., for interlocking paver block paving.
5.1 Technical Requirements
5.1.1 Interlocking Paver Block
Material for Paver Block
Concrete interlocking block shall be in a variety of shapes like unpaved, diamond, octagonal, rectangular
and square, to design paving in herring bone pattern or other approved patterns as per owner’s
requirement. It shall be available in various colors. The paver block thickness shall be 100 mm as per
client’s requirement with a minimum compressive strength of 500 kg / cm2. Wearing & Water
absorption property shall be as per IS 1237.
Interlocking paver block should conform to IS 15658 and IS 456. The interlocking paver block shall have
anti-skid surface. If granite chips or other aggregate if used, the percentage used in the making of paver
block mix shall be specified & tested as per Owner/consultant requirement. If water repellant coating is
used for top coat the details shall be specified to Owner/consultant. The coating to be of approved
make & laid as per manufacturer’s specification. The colour, shade guarantee shall be furnished to
Owner/ consultant.
Concrete mixing shall be done in computerized batching plants. Proper steam curing shall be done in
stock yards. Moulds of high grade steel/special rubber moulds shall be used to achieve better edges.
• Cementations Materials – Ordinary Portland cement Grade 43 material conforming to IS 8112 or
Grade 53 material conforming to IS 12269. The cement content shall not be less than 300 Kg /
Cu. M in concrete.
• Coarse Aggregates shall be 12mm down grade size as per IS 383
• Fine Aggregate: Fine aggregates shall be as per IS 383; grading as per IS 2386 Part 1. Fine
aggregates shall consist of natural sand obtained due to natural disintegration of rock, which is
deposited by rivers, streams, crushed stone sand or crushed gravel sand, the use of sea sand
shall not be allowed. The sand shall be river sand, clean and free from impurities.
• Colored paving blocks shall have minimum content of inorganic pigment of 5% by weight of
cement content as per manufacturer’s instruction.
Physical Requirements for Paver Block
Paver block should conform to IS 15658
Absorption
The average absorption of the test samples shall not be greater than 5% with no individual unit greater
than 7% as required
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 13 of 23
Resistance to freezing and thawing
The manufacturer shall satisfy the purchaser either by proven field performance or a laboratory freezing
and thawing test that the paving units have adequate resistance to freezing and thawing. If a laboratory
test is used, when tested in accordance with Section 8 of Method C 67 of ISO-DIS-4108, specimens shall
have no breakage and not greater than 1.0% loss in dry weight of any individual unit when subjected to 50
cycles of freezing and thawing. This test shall be conducted not more than 12 months prior to delivery of
units.
Abrasion Resistance
When tested, specimens shall not have a greater volume loss than 15 cm3 per 50 cm2. The
average thickness loss shall not exceed 3 mm.
Visual Inspection
All units shall be sound and free of defects that may interfere with the proper placing of the unit or impair
the strength or performance of the block. Minor cracks incidental to the usual methods of manufacture or
minor chipping resulting from customary methods of handling in shipment and delivery. Cracks shall be
identified & tested as per Owner /consultant requirement.
Sampling and Testing
The purchaser or his authorized representative shall be accorded proper facilities to inspect and sample
the units at the place of manufacture from the lots ready for delivery.
Rejection
In case the shipment fails to conform to the specified requirements, the supplier may sort it and
new specimens shall be selected by the purchaser from the retained lot and tested at the
expense of the supplier. In case the second set of specimen fail to conform to the test requirements, the
entire lot shall be rejected.
5.1.2 Sub-Base Preparation
Sub base preparation shall be as per drawing and shall depend on soil conditions. But generally cement
concrete paver blocks shall be laid on top for the driveway and parking over an evenly spread
sand cushion of 50 mm thick and 150 mm thick Wet Mix macadam in two layers. Each layer of 75 mm
thickness duly watered and rolled. The bottom layer shall have metal size ranging from 63 to 45 mm and
the top layer shall have metal size ranging from 53 to 22.4 mm. The sub base shall have thickness of 100
mm duly compacted with soil of CBR value above 20% or meeting 95% proctor compaction density test,
whichever is more stringent. The remaining layer shall be filled with soil to suit site conditions with CBR
value more than the CBR value of soil at the site. The requirement of the depth of construction as per the
requirement of CBR curves for flexible pavement design given in IRC 37. All layers shall be rolled with 80
to 100 KN smooth wheel power roller. If specified in drawing, geotextile application under soil sub-grade
would be required at location where soil conditions are poor. PCC bed course of concreting as per IS 456
shall be provided if shown in the drawing as per specific requirement of site condition.
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 14 of 23
5.1.3 Installation of Paver Blocks
Precast Kerb stone shall be fixed on both sides to act as edge restrain then blocks are laid in between this
area. Pavers shall be laid in the patterns as shown on the drawings. Straight pattern lines shall be
maintained. Joints between the pavers shall be between 2 mm and 4 mm wide.
Gaps at the edges of the paved area shall be filled with cut pavers or edge units.
Cut pavers shall be placed along the edge with a double bladed splitter or masonry saw.
Low amplitude, high frequency plate vibrator capable of 1360kg to 2270 kg centrifugal compaction force
shall be used to vibrate the pavers into the sand.
The pavers shall be vibrated, sweeping dry sand into the joints and vibrating until they are full. This shall
require at least two or three passes with the vibrator. Vibration within three feet of the unrestrained edges
of the paving units shall not be permitted.
All work to within three feet of the laying face must be left fully compacted with sand-filled joints at the
completion of each day. Remaining un-compacted edge of the laying face and sand with
waterproof covering shall be covered.
Excess sand when the job is completed shall be swept off.
The final surface elevations shall not deviate more than 10 mm under a 3 m long straight edge.
The surface elevation of pavers shall be 4 to 6 mm above adjacent drainage inlets, concrete collars or
channels. Paver block shall be laid to slope as per drawing
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 15 of 23
6. STAINLESS STEEL RAILING
6.1 Structural Requirements
6.1.1 Loads
Handrail, wall rail and Guardrail assemblies and attachments shall withstand a minimum concentrated load
of 200 pounds applied horizontally or vertically down at any point on the top rail. Infill area of guardrail
system capable of withstanding a horizontal concentrated load of 200 pounds applied to one square foot at
any point in the system. Load not to act concurrently with loads on top rail of system in determining stress on
guardrail. Handrail assemblies and guards shall be designed to resist a load of 50 pounds per linear foot
(pound per foot) (0.73 kN/m) applied in any direction at the top and to transfer this load through the supports
to the structure.
6.1.2 Materials
All Stainless Steel tubing to be 304 welded stainless steel tubing- 37.5 mm with smooth buffing and polish.
All lateral bars to be 12mm solid stainless steel with a smooth buffing and polish. All fittings to be 304
stainless steel. Top rail as 62mm stainless steel or 62mm wood using hard maple, oak, and cherry as per
sections detailed. All wood finishes being by others to facilitate matching of finishes. Grip rail to be 37.5 mm
O.D. stainless steel.
6.1.3 Fasteners
All mechanical fasteners used shall be manufactured from stainless steel.
6.1.4 Fabrication
All mitered and welded corners shall be ground smooth to match finish. Make exposed joints butt tight and
flush. Interior sleeves shall be used for typical splices. Fasteners are allowed at splice connection. Verify
dimensions on site prior to shop fabrication.
6.1.5 Preparation
Coordinate post setting drawings, diagrams, templates, instructions, and directions for installation of
anchorages. These include items such as sleeves, concrete inserts, anchor bolts, and miscellaneous items
having integral anchors that are to be embedded in concrete and masonry construction.
Coordinate delivery of anchorages to project site.
Coordinate that blocking is in place for all mounting fasteners.
Clean debris and dust from surfaces and embed holes thoroughly prior to installation.
Prepare surfaces using the methods recommended by the manufacturer for achieving proper results given
the substrate and project conditions.
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 16 of 23
6.1.6 Installation
Install in accordance with manufacturer's drawings and direction.
Fit exposed connections accurately together to form tight joints except as necessary for expansion. Perform
cutting, drilling, and fitting required for installation of handrails. Accurately set handrails in location,
alignment, and elevation, measured from established lines and levels. Set posts plumb within a tolerance of
3 mm.
When fastening to in-place construction, provide anchorage devices and fittings to properly secure rail to in-
place construction. Examples of such devices include threaded fittings (for concrete inserts), toggle bolts
and through-bolts. Separate dissimilar materials with bushings, grommets or washers to prevent electrolytic
corrosion.
6.2 Submittals
Contractor to submit approval drawings to include the following:
• Section-thru details.
• Mounting methods.
• Typical Elevations
• Key plan layouts
Samples of manufacturer’s standard color chart. For custom colors 2 chips will be submitted for color match and approval by engineer-in-charge.
Shop Drawings: Drawings showing fabrication and installation of handrails including plans, elevations, sections, details of components, anchor details and attachment to adjoining units of work.
6.3 Quality Assurance
Source Limitations: Obtain each type of railing through one source from a single manufacturer.
6.4 Delivery Storage and Handling
Materials to be delivered to the job site in good condition and adequately protected against damage as
handrails are a finished product. Store on site in a safe location to avoid damage to finished materials.
Stacking should be done in a manner that will prevent bending. Store material in a clean, dry location away
from uncured concrete and masonry. Any protection on the railings during transportation should remain until
installed. Keep handling on site to a minimum. Exercise caution to avoid damage to finishes of material.
6.5 Project Conditions
Field Measurements: Where handrails and railings are indicated to fit to other construction, check actual
dimensions of other construction by accurate site measurements before fabrication; show recorded
measurements on final shop drawings.
Where site measurements cannot be made without delaying the railing fabrication and delivery, obtain
guaranteed dimensions from site drawings and proceed with fabrication of products to avoid delay in
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 17 of 23
fabrication, delivery and installation.
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 18 of 23
7. TENSIONED FABRIC STRUCTURE
Tensioned Fabric Structure is cable and/or frame supported tensioned membrane-covered fabric structure;
incorporating a fabric with low elongation characteristics under tension and capable of an anticlastic (having
principal curvatures of opposite sign at a given point) configuration. Fabric structures in which fabric is
applied as flat or mono-axially curved configurations are not acceptable.
7.1 Section
• Section includes a tensioned fabric canopy system as shown on Drawings and specified in this
Section.
• Architect’s drawings indicate design intent with respect to sizes, shapes, and configurations of the
tensioned fabric canopy. Provide all components and accessories required for complete tensioned
fabric canopy system, whether or not specifically shown or specified.
• The tensioned fabric structure will assume bolted/pinned connections for field assembly.
No field welding will be permitted.
7.2 Tensioned Fabric
Tensile membrane (fabric) sheet of total weight 650 g/m2width 250 cms,yarn 1100 dtex,100% Polyster, Plain
Weave with minimum Breaking strength (warp/weft) 2500/2200 N/5cm,min Tearing strength (warp/weft)
250/300 N,min adhesion 100 N/5cm-120 N/5cm,temperature resistance -30°C to + 70°C Flame Retardancy
M2 Light Fastness 7-8, Low Wicking, anti microbial, UV protection of approved make) with provision for
conduiting & lighting fixtures. rate includes transportation, machineries, handling, manpower, painting,
complete.
Warranty for Fabric shall be 15 years
7.3 Subcontractor’s Work
The tensioned fabric structure Subcontractor shall be responsible for the structural design,
detailing, fabrication, supply, and installation of the Work specified herein. The intent of this
specification is to establish in the first instance an undivided, single-source responsibility of
the Subcontractor for all of the foregoing functions.
Subcontractor’s Work shall include the structural design, supply, fabrication, shipment, and
erection of the following items:
• The architectural membrane as indicated on the drawings and in these specifications.
• Cables and fittings.
• Perimeter, catenary, and sectionalized aluminum clamping system.
• Structural steel, including masts, trusses, struts, and beams as indicated on the drawings.
• Fasteners and gaskets.
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 19 of 23
7.4 Related Requirements
• “Cast-in-Place Concrete” for concrete footings for posts of tensioned fabric structure.
• “Structural Steel Framing” and “Architecturally Exposed Structural Steel” for steel structure
supporting tensioned fabric structure.
7.5 Leed Submittals
• Product Data for BMR Credit 1: For products having recycled content, documentation
indicating percentages by weight of postconsumer and pre-consumer recycled content.
Include statement indicating cost for each product having recycled content.
• Product Certificates for BMR Credit 1 local materials: For products and materials
required to comply with requirements for regionally manufactured materials. Include
statement indicating cost for each regionally manufactured material. To include statement indicating
location of manufacturer and distance to Project for each
regionally manufactured material. Select locally or regionally fabricated products wherever possible.
7.6 Close Out Submittals
Maintenance Data: For tensioned fabric structures to include in operation and maintenance
manuals include the following:
• Methods for maintaining tensioned fabric structure fabrics and finishes.
• Precautions about cleaning materials and methods that could be detrimental to fabrics,
finishes, and performance.
7.7 Quality Assurance
Fabricator Qualifications: Shop that employs skilled workers who custom-fabricate tensioned
fabric structures similar to those required for this Project and whose products have a record of successful in-
service performance.
Fabricator’s engineering services must utilize Finite Element Analysis software that
performs fabric form finding and takes into account fabric material properties and pre-
stress characteristics.
Fabricator must have proven record of at least (5) successful projects of similar size and
similar specified fabric material.
Fabricator must have been in continuous operation as a professional tensioned fabric
structure manufacturer for minimum of (10) years prior to contract.
7.8 System Requirements
General: Provide a tensioned fabric structure system that complies with requirements
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 20 of 23
specified herein by testing the Subcontractor’s corresponding membrane system in
accordance with the indicated test methods.
Building Code Criteria: The tensioned fabric structure shall comply with the International
Building Code, 2009 edition.
Comply with local building codes and respective loading criteria for Live Loads,
Dead Loads, Wind Speed, and Seismic Loads.
Life Safety: Tensioned fabric structure shall be detailed so that no life safety issue is
created in the event of a loss of a part of the membrane. The tensioned fabric structure
shall not rely on the membrane for structural stability.
7.9 Field Conditions
Weather Limitations:
Proceed with installation only when existing and forecasted weather
conditions permit installation of tensioned fabric structure in exterior locations to be
performed according to manufacturers’ written instructions and warranty requirements.
Field Measurements:
Where tensioned fabric structure installation is indicated to fit to other
work, verify dimensions of other work by field measurements before fabrication and indicate
measurements on Shop Drawings. Allow clearances for fenestration operation throughout the
entire operating range. Notify Architect of discrepancies. Coordinate fabrication schedule
with construction progress to avoid delaying the Work.
7.10 Warranty
Manufacturer and fabricator agree to repair or replace components of tensioned fabric structures that fail in
materials or workmanship within specified warranty period of one year from the date of Substantial
Completion.
Failures include, but are not limited to, the following:
• Structural failures including framework.
• Deterioration of fabric including seam failure.
• Deterioration of metals, metal finishes, and other materials beyond normal weathering.
Warranty Period, Fabric: Reference the manufacturer’s limited warranty for the specified
fabric manufacturer and product.
Warranty Period, Cables, Securement Devices and Accessories: One year from date of
Substantial Completion.
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 21 of 23
7.11 Performance Requirements
Regulatory Requirements:
Provide tensioned fabric canopy system complying with requirements and limitations of authorities having
jurisdiction that are within Contractor’s control.
Delegated Design:
Engage a qualified professional engineer to design tensioned fabric canopy system. Delegated design
engineering requirements include, but are not limited to, the following:
• Prepare structural design drawings defining the precise interface geometry determination,
reaction loads imposed on structural steel framing, anchoring loads, connection details,
interfaces and seam layouts.
• Structural calculations for the tensioned fabric canopy system shall include:
• Large deflection numerical shape generation that will insure a stable, uniformly
stressed, three dimensionally curved shape that is in static equilibrium with the internal
pre-stress forces and is suitable to resist all applied loads.
• Large deflection finite element method structural analysis of the membrane system
under all applicable wind and seismic loads.
• Connection design including bolt, weld and ancillary member sizing.
• Biaxial fabric test specification, interpretation and fabric compensation determination.
• Accurate generation of the two dimensional compensated fabric templates required to
generate the three dimensional equilibrium shape.
• Structural Performance: Tensioned fabric canopy system shall withstand the effects of
gravity loads and the following loads and stresses within limits.
Wind Loads: To be determined by Subcontractor’s Engineer of Record.
Live Loads: To be determined by Subcontractor’s Engineer of Record.
Seismic Loads: To be determined by Subcontractor’s Engineer of Record.
• Thermal Movements: Allow for thermal movements from ambient and surface temperature
changes.
• Control of Corrosion: Prevent galvanic action and other forms of corrosion by insulating
metals and other materials from direct contact with incompatible materials.
7.12 Canopy Fabric
• Product: Subject to compliance with requirements, provide fabric as called out and specified by the
Engineer in charge in the bid drawings.
• Fire-Test-Response Characteristics: Provide canopy fabric with the fire-test-response
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 22 of 23
characteristics indicated, as determined by testing identical products according to test
method indicated below by UL or another testing and inspecting agency acceptable to
authorities having jurisdiction:
• Flame-Resistance Ratings: Passes NFPA 701.
• Fabric properties:
Fabric thickness and tensile strength: Must meet engineering requirements with a safety
factor of five.
Color: White
7.13 Canopy Frame, Cables, Fittings and Accessories
• General: Provide accessories as standard with tensioned fabric canopy system fabricator and as
specified. Fabricate and finish accessories at the factory to greatest extent possible, by
manufacturer’s standard procedures and processes. Comply with indicated profiles and with
dimensional and structural requirements.
• Metal Surfaces, General: Provide materials with smooth surfaces, without seam marks, roller
marks, rolled trade names, stains, discolorations, or blemishes.
• Paint Finish for marine or other corrosive environments: Color: As selected from manufacturer’s
available stock colors.
7.14 Execution
7.14.1 Examination
• Examine structural steel framing and other substrates, with Installer present, for compliance
with requirements for installation tolerances and other conditions affecting performance of
the Work.
• Prepare written report, endorsed by Installer, listing conditions detrimental to performance.
• Proceed with installation only after unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected.
7.14.2 Field Quality Control
Manufacturer’s Field Service: Engage a factory-authorized service representative to test and
inspect components, assemblies, and equipment installations, including connections.
• Prepare test and inspection reports.
7.14.3 Erection
Proceed with installation of tensioned fabric structure only when existing and forecasted
weather conditions will permit work to be performed in accordance with manufacturer’s
SPECIFICATION - MISCELLANEOUS WORK
14495-00-CI-SPC-0010 Rev : 0 Page 23 of 23
recommendations.
• Erect frame and fabric in accordance with the procedures of the approved manufacturer.
• Adequate pre-stress shall be applied to eliminate fabric wrinkles and excess cable sag.
7.14.4 Adjusting
When requested from date of Substantial Completion, provide on-site assistance in adjusting system to suit
actual occupied conditions.
7.14.5 Demonstration
Engage a factory-authorized service representative to train Owner’s maintenance personnel
to adjust cable and fabric tension and to clean and maintain canopy fabric.
14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Rev : A Page 1 of 17
VVSPL CAPACITY AUGMENTATION PROJECT
Specification for Bulk Material
Project No: 403102-14495
Document No: 14495-00-EL-SPC-0013
14 Feb 2017
I-Think Lodha Techno Campus, 5
th Floor, Tower B,
Pokhran Road No. 2 Thane (West) – 400607 Tel: +91 2266515700 Fax: +91 2267818000
© Copyright 2017 WorleyParsons
SPECIFICATION FOR BULK MATERIAL
14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Rev : A Page 3 of 17
CONTENTS
1 SCOPE ............................................................................................................................................... 4
2 CODES AND STANDARDS ............................................................................................................... 4
3 SITE CONDITIONS .............................................................................................................................. 6
4 DESIGN AND CONSTRUCTION REQUIREMENTS ................................................................... 6
5 INSPECTION AND TESTING .......................................................................................................... 17
6 PACKING AND DESPATCH ............................................................................................................ 17
SPECIFICATION FOR BULK MATERIAL
14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Rev : A Page 4 of 17
1 SCOPE
This specification covers the minimum requirements for the design, material, manufacturing,
inspection, testing, supply, shipment and delivery to site of electrical bulk items for VVSPL
Capacity Augmentation Project.
The Vendor shall be fully responsible for the design, material, manufacturing, inspection, testing
and delivery of electrical bulk items at site.
Definitions
Purchaser : Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited
Engineer / Consultant : WorleyParsons India Pvt. Ltd.
Vendor / Manufacturer : Supplier of electrical bulk items
2 CODES AND STANDARDS
2 .1 The equipment shall comply with the requirements of latest revision of following standards issued
by BIS (Bureau of Indian Standards), unless otherwise specified:
IS 5 Colours for ready mixed paints and enamels
SP 30 (BIS) National Electrical Code 2011
IS 816 Code of practice for use of metal arc welding for general construction
in mild steel
IS 875 - 3 Design Loads (Other Than Earthquake) For Buildings And Structures -
Code Of Practice - Part 3: Wind Loads
IS 1248 Direct acting indicating analogue electrical measuring instruments and
their accessories
IS 1293 Plugs And Socket-outlets Of Rated Voltage Up To And Including 250
Volts And Rated Current Up To 16 Amperes
IS 1364 Hexagon head bolts, screws and nuts of product grades A and B
IS 1573 Electroplated Coatings of Zinc on Iron and Steel
IS 2157 Handloom shoddy woollen blankets
IS 2309 Code of practice for the protection of buildings and allied structures
against lightning
IS 2418 - 1 Specification For Tubular Fluorescent Lamps For General Lighting
SPECIFICATION FOR BULK MATERIAL
14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Rev : A Page 5 of 17
Service - Part 1: Requirements And Tests
IS 2629 Recommended practice for hot dip galvanizing of iron and steel
IS 2633 Methods for testing uniformity of coating of zinc coated articles
IS 3043 Code of practice for earthing
IS 3323 Bi-pin Lamp Holders For Tubular Fluorescent Lamps
IS 3618 Phosphate treatment of iron and steel for protection against corrosion
IS 3854 Switches For Domestic And Similar Purposes
IS 4759 Hot-dip zinc coatings on structural steel and other allied products
IS 5081 Glass Tubes for Tubular Fluorescent Lamps for General Lighting
Service - Specification
IS 6005 Code of practice for phosphating of iron and steel
IS 8224 Electric Lighting Fittings For Division 2 Areas
IS 9794 Boards/blanks for sley bottom, race, cap and box back of cotton looms
IS 9974 : Part 1 High pressure sodium vapour lamps :Part 1 General requirements and
tests
IS 13021 AC supplied electronic ballasts for tubular florescent lamps
IS 13032 AC Miniature Circuit-breaker Boards For Voltages Not Exceeding 1000
V
IS 16101 General Lighting : LED and LED Modules
IS 16102 Self Ballasted LED lamps for General Lighting Services
IS 16103 LED modules for General Lighting
IS 16104 DC or AC Supply Electronic Control gear for LED Modules
IS 16107 Luminaries Performance
IS/IEC 60079-1 Explosive atmospheres - Part 1: Equipment protection by flameproof
enclosures "d"
IS/IEC 60529 Degrees of protection provided by enclosures (IP CODE)
IS/IEC 60947 Low voltage switchgear and controlgear
2. .2 In case of imported equipment, standards of the country of origin shall be applicable, if these
standards are equivalent or stringent than the applicable Indian standards.
SPECIFICATION FOR BULK MATERIAL
14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Rev : A Page 6 of 17
2 .3 The equipment shall also conform to the provisions of Indian Electricity rules and other statutory
regulations currently in force in the country.
2 .4 In case Indian standards are not available for any equipment, standards issued by
IEC/BS/VDE/IEEE/NEMA or equivalent agency shall be applicable.
2 .5 In case of any contradiction between various referred standards/specifications/data sheet and
statutory regulations the following order of priority shall govern:
- Statutory regulations
- Data sheets
- This specification
- Codes and standards
However the vendor shall bring any such contradiction to the notice of Purchaser for prior
approval.
3 SITE CONDITIONS
3.1 The electrical bulk items shall be suitable for installation and satisfactory operation in indoor or
outdoor installation as specified with humid and corrosive atmosphere.
3.2 The electrical bulk items shall be designed to operate under site conditions as specified in the site
conditions. If not specifically mentioned therein, a design ambient temperature of 40oC for indoor,
50oC for outdoor and an altitude not exceeding 1000 metres above mean sea level shall be
considered.
3.3 The electrical bulk items described in this specification is intended for continuous duty at the
specified ratings under the specified site conditions.
4 DESIGN AND CONSTRUCTION REQUIREMENTS
4.1 General
4.1.1 The offered equipment shall be brand new with state of art technology and proven field track
record. No prototype equipment shall be offered.
4.1.2 The electrical bulk items shall be rated for supply voltage and frequency as specified and shall be
suitable for +10% supply voltage variations and +5% supply frequency variations where applicable.
4.1.3 All electrical bulk items shall be supplied with fixing hardware such as nuts, bolts & washers of
stainless steel necessary for installation.
4.1.4 All electrical bulk items paint shade shall be as per Manufacturers standard unless otherwise
specified.
SPECIFICATION FOR BULK MATERIAL
14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Rev : A Page 7 of 17
4.1.5 All electrical bulk items specified for installation in hazardous areas, shall be tested by CMRI and
duly approved by PESO Nagpur or DGMS Dhanbad or any other applicable statutory authority. All
indigenous FLP equipment shall also have valid BIS license as required by statutory authorities.
4.1.6 All Indoor electrical equipments enclosures shall be cleaned free of rust, given a coat of red-oxide
primer and finished with two coats of epoxy based paint of shade RAL 7032. Outdoor equipments
enclosure paint shade shall be 631 as per IS-5
4.2 Local Control Station
4.2.1 Each local control station shall be surface mounted consisting of but not limited to following
Enclosure : Die cast aluminium alloy LM6 for hazardous area
Fibreglass Reinforced Polyster (FRP) for safe area
Enclosure IP rating : IP 55 for Outdoor Area / IP 42 for Indoor Area.
Type of Protection : Minimum Ex ‘d’ type for hazardous area
Control devices : Shrouded start push button (Green),
Mushroom head, stayput type padlocking, stop push button (Red),
Local/Remote selector switch (if specified)
Ammeter (If specified).
Gasket : Neoprene
Terminals : Copper suitable for termination of specified cable size,
: numbers as specified
Cable entries : As specified at bottom
Hardware : Stainless steel
Fully wired from circuit elements to pre-numbered terminals
Accessories
Internal and external Grounding Terminal
Canopy : If specified for outdoor installation
4.2.2 “Start” pushbutton shall be non-maintaining with “Double Break” type contacts, one pair normally
open and one pair normally closed.
4.2.3 Mushroom head Stayput type “Stop” pushbutton shall be maintaining type contacts, one pair
normally open and one pair normally closed.
SPECIFICATION FOR BULK MATERIAL
14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Rev : A Page 8 of 17
4.2.4 Ammeter shall be 62mm dia., taut band, moving iron type with suppressed scale to suit the
motor starting current.
4.2.5 Local/Remote selector switch shall be maintaining type contacts on selected position, one pair
normally open and one pair normally closed.
4.3 Welding Receptacles with Plugs
Each welding receptacle with plug shall consist of but not limited to following items
Type : 4 Wire (3PH+N) with switch
Enclosure : Die cast aluminium alloy LM6 for hazardous area
Fibreglass Reinforced Polyster (FRP) for safe area
Enclosure IP rating : IP 55 for Outdoor Area / IP 42 for Indoor Area.
Type of Protection : Minimum Ex ‘d’ type for hazardous area
Gasket : Neoprene
Terminals : Copper suitable for termination of specified cable size,
: numbers as specified
Cable entries : As specified at bottom
Hardware : Stainless steel
Fully wired from circuit elements to pre-numbered terminals
Accessories
Internal and external Grounding Terminal
Canopy : If specified for outdoor installation
4.4 Cable Glands
4.4.1 Cable glands shall be of nickel plated brass unless otherwise specified and shall be manufactured
in accordance with IS/IEC 60529 and IS/IEC 60079-1.
4.4.2 The single compression type cable glands shall be used for indoor panels/equipment (e.g.
substation, control room etc). The cable glands for outdoor terminations shall be whether
protected, double compression type and shall have PVC shroud for additional whether protection.
4.4.3 Cable glands forming a part of relevant FLP enclosure, shall be FLP type, tested by CMRI or any
other recognized independent testing laboratory and approved by PESO/DGMS or any other
statutory authority as applicable. Indigenous FLP glands shall have valid BIS license as per the
requirements of statutory authorities. The size of cable glands supplied shall be appropriate to the
size of cable so that flameproofness of glands is retained.
SPECIFICATION FOR BULK MATERIAL
14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Rev : A Page 9 of 17
4.4.4 Cable glands shall meet the requirements of IP-55 (minimum) for suitable weather protection.
4.4.5 Entry thread of cable gland shall be compatible to the entry thread provided in the equipment (BS,
ET, NPT, PG as applicable). If required, suitable reducers/adopters shall be used.
4.4.6 Cable glands shall be manufactured to provide cable sealing of inner and outer sheaths and
clamping of armour by special ring.
4.4.7 Cable glands shall be constructed in such a way that same gland can be used for all types of
armouring.
4.4.8 Cable glands shall be provided with earth tag, lock nut and IP sealing washer.
4.4.9 Each cable gland shall be provided with PVC shrouds.
4.5 Cable lugs
4.5.1 The cable lugs shall be tinned copper or aluminium as specified, tubular, seamless compression
type unless specified otherwise.
4.5.2 The type of cable lug shall be as follows.
a) Single hole, ring type for power cable and earthing cable terminations.
b) Pin type insulated or fork type insulated for small power and control cable terminations
4.6 HV Termination and jointing Kits
4.6.1 HV termination kits shall be heat shrinkable, stress control type, indoor or outdoor as specified.
4.6..2 HV termination kits shall be designed to provide a complete moisture seal including the crotch area
of 3C cables and complete re-jacketing of individual cores.
4.6.3 HV termination kits shall be provided with insulated right angle boots (if specified), cable
preparation kits, sealing compounds and other accessories required for complete termination of
specified HV cables.
4.6.4 HV termination kits shall provide creepage distances for indoor termination and outdoor termination
in accordance with IS.
4.6.5 HV termination kits shall have provision for earthing of copper screen (solderless).
4.6.6 HV termination kits which shall be suitable for the cable size mentioned in cable schedule to
outdoor equipment, transformer, switchgear, as specified
4.7 Cable Trays
4.7.1 These shall be ladder type trays either prefabricated hot dip galvanized (610 gm per sq. meter)
sheet steel trays or site fabricated angle iron painted trays as specified or prefabricated perforated
cable trays.
SPECIFICATION FOR BULK MATERIAL
14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Rev : A Page 10 of 17
a) Pre-fabricated hot dipped galvanized ladder type trays - The cable trays shall comply with the
requirements specified in installation details.
b) Site fabricated angle iron trays - Angle iron cable trays shall be fabricated from standard rolled
angle iron sections of size 75x75x8 for runners for supporting spans limited to 3000mm. Cross
support shall be 25 x 6 mm MS flat for tray width upto 500 mm and 32 x 6 mm flat for tray of
more than 500 mm wide and spacing between two cross supports shall not exceed 250 mm.
c) Pre-fabricated hot dipped galvanized perforated type trays - The cable trays shall comply with
the requirements specified in installation details
4.7.2 Vertical supports for both the prefabricated and side fabricated type trays shall be fabricated out of
ISMC 100 and horizontal supports shall be with 65 x 65 x 6 mm angle iron sections. Outer most tier
of all vertical cable trays shall be covered with GI sheet for protection against physical damage to
cables.
4.7.3 Cable racks and trays shall be covered by removable top covers on upper most tier allowing
adequate ventilation in following cases where:
a) Mechanical damage of cables is likely to occur during maintenance in the plant.
b) Oil or spillage of chemicals can be expected.
c) Protection from exposure to sun is required.
GI cover sheet shall allow adequate ventilation to the cables and shall be in standard length of
3000 mm, flanged on both sides for fixing on cable tray. Covers shall be complete with required GI
hardware.
4.7.4 If specified, pre-fabricated ladder type cable trays shall be suitable for concentrated load of one
person (75 kg) standing on cable trays.
4.8 Lighting and Small Power Distribution Boards
4.8.1 Distribution boards shall be made of 1.6mm thick sheet steel and shall be industrial type, dust and
vermin proof. In case Distribution boards are located in Hazardous area, they shall be made of Die
cast aluminium alloy LM6 and minimum Protection type shall be Ex ‘d’ suitable for Zone 1 & 2, Gas
group IIA/IIB & temperature class T3 unless mentioned elsewhere. Distribution boards shall be
indoor/outdoor type as specified. Indoor type distribution boards shall have IP42 degree of
protection and shall be suitable for surface or flush mounting on wall surface as specified.
Distribution boards located outdoor shall be IP55 weather protected and shall also preferably have
integral canopy for additional weather protection. The canopy shall be made of 2mm thick
galvanized sheet steel or FRP where these are separate from the equipment.
4.8.2 Distribution boards shall have TPN incoming feeder and single phase or three phase outgoing
feeders as specified. Distribution boards shall be equipped with phase and neutral busbars of
required current carrying capacity. The outgoing feeders shall be provided with single pole
SPECIFICATION FOR BULK MATERIAL
14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Rev : A Page 11 of 17
miniature circuit breakers (MCBs) for safe areas and double pole MCBs for hazardous areas for
single phase distribution and switch fuse unit for 3-phase distribution. The incomer shall be with
MCB and ELCB unit for lighting and small power distribution and switch fuse unit for other auxiliary
distribution unless otherwise specified.
4.8.3 Switch fuse units and Miniature circuit breakers shall be mounted in such a way that the operating
levers projects outside the front bakelite cover plates for ease of operation. A hinged door to cover
the operating knobs shall be provided. In addition, a circuit diagram indicating incomer details and
outgoing details viz. circuit number, circuit rating, load connected and details of the load shall be
pasted inside the distribution boards. Also a laminated copy of the diagram shall be provided inside
the distribution boards in a suitably designed pocket.
4.8.4 Two external earthing studs for connection to the plant earthing grid shall be provided on the panel.
Further, the distribution boards shall be provided with an earth bus bar with terminal studs for
connection to the third core of each outgoing circuit. Each circuit phase and neutral shall be given
ferrule numbers. Complete wiring inside the panel, shall be neatly bunched with PVC tape and
button. Sufficient terminals shall be provided in the terminal block so as to ensure that not more
than one wire (core) is connected to a terminal.
4.8.5 The distribution board shall have knock out holes or removable gland plate for the entry of incoming
and outgoing conduits or cables.
4.8.6 All MCBs shall be of M9 category as per IS 8828 and sensitivity of ELCBs shall be 100 mA unless
otherwise specified.
4.8.7 All switches or fuse switches shall be air break type provided with quick make/break manual
operating mechanism.
4.8.8 Fuses shall be non-deteriorating HRC cartridge link type. Power fuses shall be pressure fitted type
and shall preferably have ribs on the contact blades to ensure good line contact.
4.8.9 AC voltmeters and ammeters shall be provided in incoming feeder of distribution boards if
specified. All AC ammeters and voltmeters shall be of digital type with accuracy class of 1.5 as per
IS.
4.8.10 Wherever the size of incoming cable to distribution boards is more than 35 sqmm a suitable cable
adapter box shall be provided and attached to the distribution boards. The incoming cable leads
shall be connected to terminal block (bolted type terminals) of required size. This terminal block
shall be connected to TPN incomer unit through separate PVC insulated copper conductor wires/bus
bars. Sufficient space shall be provided (200 to 250mm) between gland plate and the bottom of
terminal block for easy termination
4.9 Lighting Fixtures
4.9.1 Lighting fixtures shall be manufactured in accordance with IS 2418-1, IS 3323, IS 5081, IS 13021,
IS 16101, IS 16102, IS 16103, IS 16104, IS 16107, IS/IEC 60529 and IS/IEC 60079.
SPECIFICATION FOR BULK MATERIAL
14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Rev : A Page 12 of 17
4.9.2 Outdoor lighting fixtures shall have minimum IP55 degree of protection. Indoor lighting fixtures
shall have minimum IP20 degree of protection.
4.9.3 Lighting Fixtures shall be suitable for termination of required cable sizes as indicated in lighting and
small power layouts and installation details.
4.9.4 Lighting fixtures paint shade shall be as per Supplier’s standard.
4.9.5 Each Fluorescent lighting fixture shall consist of but not limited to following items
Body : Non metallic one piece fiberglass reinforced Polyester (FRP) with SS
toggles
Lamp : Fluorescent, Numbers as specified
Ballast : Electronic with fuse to protect ballast
Gasket : Neoprene
Cover : High transparency clear acrylic
Reflector : Stove enamelled
Hardware : Stainless steel
Lamp socket
Accessories
Internal earthing Terminal
Provisions to field drill for pendant mounting
4.9.6 High intensity discharge lighting fixtures shall be integral type and each lighting fixture shall consist
of but not limited to following items
Body : Cast copper-free aluminium for hazardous area
: Fibreglass Reinforced Polyster (FRP) for safe area
Lamp : High pressure sodium (HPS)/ Metal Halide (MH)
Hinged Ballast : Electronic with multi tap
Ballast guard starter cut-out switch
Instant re-strike feature wherever specified
Globe : Heat and impact resistant
Guard : Copper-free aluminium
Reflector (STD. DOME) : Krydon fiberglass-reinforced polyester
SPECIFICATION FOR BULK MATERIAL
14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Rev : A Page 13 of 17
Reflector (Floodlight) : Anodized aluminium Gasketing seal between mounting module,
housing & optical assembly
Lamp socket : Mogul base porcelain
Hardware : Stainless steel
Accessories
Internal Grounding Terminal
4.9.7 Each LED lighting fixture shall consist of but not limited to following items
Body : Non metallic one piece fiberglass reinforced polyester (FRP) with SS
toggles
Lamp : High brightness white LED arranged in arrays
Ballast : Electronic with fuse to protect ballast
Gasket : Neoprene
Cover : High transparency clear acrylic
Reflector : Stove enamelled
Hardware : Stainless steel
Accessories
Internal earthing Terminal
Provisions to field drill for pendant mounting
4.9.8 Hazardous area lighting fixtures enclosures shall be made of Die cast aluminium alloy LM6 and
minimum Protection type shall be Ex ‘d’ suitable for Zone 1 & 2, Gas group IIA/IIB & temperature
class T3 unless mentioned elsewhere.
4.9.9 Battery Room lighting fixtures shall be suitable for Zone 1 & 2, Gas group IIC & temperature
class T3 unless mentioned elsewhere.
4.9.10 All lighting fixtures shall be of high power factor type i.e. at least 0.9 or more. Lighting fixtures
have shall be energy efficient type with BEE level higher than 3 Star.
4.9.11 All critical area lighting fixtures shall have inbuilt battery back-up of 30 minutes.
4.10 Small Power Receptacles
Small Power recpetacles shall be manufactured in accordance with IS 1293, IS/IEC 60309, IS/IEC
60079.
Each recpetacles shall consist of but not limited to following items
SPECIFICATION FOR BULK MATERIAL
14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Rev : A Page 14 of 17
Type : 3 Wire (1PH+N+G) with switch
Enclosure : Die cast aluminium alloy LM6 for hazardous area
Fibreglass Reinforced Polyster (FRP) for safe industrial area
ABS plastic for Safe non-industrial area.
Enclosure IP rating : IP 55 for Outdoor Area / IP 42 for Indoor Area.
Type of Protection : Minimum Ex ‘d’ type for hazardous area
Gasket : Neoprene
Terminals : Copper suitable for termination of specified cable/wire size,
: numbers as specified
Cable entries : As specified at bottom
Hardware : Stainless steel
Fully wired from circuit elements to pre-numbered terminals for Hazardous and Safe Industial area.
Accessories
Internal Grounding Terminal
Canopy : If specified for outdoor installation
4.11 Switches
Switches shall be manufactured in accordance with IS 3854, IS/IEC 60079.
Each switch shall consist of but not limited to following items
Type : 1 pole to 4 pole as specified
Enclosure : Die cast aluminium alloy LM6 for hazardous area
Fibreglass Reinforced Polyster (FRP) for safe area
ABS plastic for Safe non-industrial area.
Enclosure IP rating : IP 55 for Outdoor Area / IP 42 for Indoor Area.
Type of Protection : Minimum Ex ‘d’ type for hazardous area
Gasket : Neoprene
Terminals : Copper suitable for termination of specified cable size,
: numbers as specified
Cable entries : As specified at bottom
SPECIFICATION FOR BULK MATERIAL
14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Rev : A Page 15 of 17
Hardware : Stainless steel
Fully wired from circuit elements to pre-numbered terminals
Accessories
Internal Grounding Terminal
Canopy : If specified for outdoor installation
4.12 Junction boxes
Junction Box shall be manufactured in accordance with IS 8224, IS/IEC 60079.
Each junction box shall consist of but not limited to following items
Type : 2 way to 6 way as specified
Enclosure : Die cast aluminium alloy LM6 for hazardous area
Fibreglass Reinforced Polyster (FRP) for safe area
Enclosure IP rating : IP 55 for Outdoor Area / IP 42 for Indoor Area.
Type of Protection : Minimum Ex ‘d’ type for hazardous area
Gasket : Neoprene
Terminals : Copper suitable for termination of specified cable size,
: numbers as specified
Cable entries : As specified at sides / bottom / top depending on number of ways
Hardware : Stainless steel
Fully wired from circuit elements to pre-numbered terminals
Accessories
Internal Grounding Terminal
Canopy : If specified for outdoor installation
4.13 Lighting poles
4.13.1 All Lighting poles shall be made of galvanized steel, designed for wind parameters as per IS 875 (part
3) and loading of specified lighting fixtures and shall comply with relevant standards.
4.13.2 The flood lighting poles wherever specified shall be provided with suitable mounting brackets with
hardware for specified number of flood lighting fixtures, one hand hole at approx. 1m height
having removable bolted cover, internal and external earthing studs.
SPECIFICATION FOR BULK MATERIAL
14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Rev : A Page 16 of 17
4.13.3 The street lighting poles wherever specified shall be provided with suitable mounting brackets with
hardware for specified number of street lighting fixtures, one hand hole at approx. 1m height
having removable bolted cover, internal and external earthing studs.
4.13.4 The flood lighting, street lighting and ground poles shall be provided with suitable base plate and
fixing material for fixing on concrete foundation. The fixing details and foundation loading details
shall be provided.
4.14 Earthing
4.14.1 The main earth grid conductor and earth bars shall be hot dip galvanized MS flat with the sizes as
specified.
4.14.2 The branch conductor shall be either hot dip galvanized MS flat with sizes as specified or hot dip
galvanised MS wire rope with size as specified.
4.14.3 Earth electrode shall be heavy duty, hot dip galvanized MS/copper pipe with size and length as
specified.
4.14.4 Amount of galvanizing shall be 610 gm per sq. meter
4.15 Lightning Protection
The horizontal and vertical conductors shall be hot dip galvanized MS flat with the sizes as
specified. Amount of galvanizing shall be 610 gm per sq. meter.
4.16 Conduits
4.16.1 Conduits shall be of hot dip galvanized steel for protection. Stub-up conduits with diameter and
length as specified.
4.16.2 Conduits shall be provided with bushing for protection of cables for stub-up.
4.16.3 Fixation accessories shall be stainless steel or hot dip galvanized after fabrication.
4.16.4 PVC conduits with appropriate accessories shall be provided as specified.
4.17 Miscellaneous and Safety Equipments
Following equipments shall be supplied in substation, as per Indian Electricity Rules:
4.17.1 Fire buckets filled with clean dry sand and ready for immediate use for extinguishing fires suitably
mounted on G.I. stand and fire extinguisher (carbon dioxide, dry chemical extinguisher etc.) suitable
for dealing with electric fires shall be conspicuously marked and kept.
4.17.2 First aid boxes containing ointments and medicines for immediate treatment of injuries (As
prescribed by Indian Red Cross Society or equivalent).
4.17.3 Instructions of restoration of persons suffering from electric shock in English, Hindi and local
language of the district shall be affixed in a conspicuous place.
SPECIFICATION FOR BULK MATERIAL
14495-00-EL-SPC-0013 Rev : A Page 17 of 17
4.17.4 Danger boards (H.V., M.V.) shall be provided on transformer gate, switchboards, entrance to
switchgear room and at other places as required by Purchaser.
4.17.5 Safety insulation mats for operation and maintenance of electrical equipments.
4.17.6 Ladders for maintenance of electrical equipments.
5 INSPECTION AND TESTING
5.2.1 Inspection and testing requirements shall be in accordance with the respective equipment
specification, applicable codes and standards indicated and also Vendor standard inspection and
testing requirements. Purchaser reserves the right to witness all tests with sufficient advance
notice from Vendor. The test reports shall be approved by Purchaser before dispatch.
5.2.2 Purchaser also reserves the right of inspection of any electrical works equipment / material during
fabrication. Vendor shall furnish all necessary information concerning the supply to Purchaser.
5.2.3 All routine and acceptance tests shall be carried out at Vendor’s / Manufacturer's work under his
care and expense.
5.2.4 Type and special tests shall be carried out at Vendor's work or independent approved testing
laboratory under his care and expense. Type and special test certificate of identical rating of
equipment may be acceptable in lieu of actual type and special tests if approved by Purchaser.
5.2.5 All testing instruments shall be calibrated with proper validity and have traceability to National
Standards.
6 PACKING AND DESPATCH
All the equipment shall be divided into several shipping sections for protection and ease of
handling during transportation. The equipment shall be properly packed for selected mode of
transportation i.e. by ship/rail or trailer. The panels shall be wrapped in polyethylene sheets before
being placed in wooden crates /cases to prevent damage to the finish. Crates /cases shall have
skid bottoms for handling. Special precaution notations such as Fragile, This side up, center of
gravity, weight, Purchaser's particulars, Purchase number etc. shall be clearly marked on the
package together with other details as per purchase order.
The equipment may be stored outdoors for long periods before installation. The packing should be
suitable for outdoor storage in areas with heavy rains and high ambient temperature unless
otherwise agreed.
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 1 of 30
VVSPL CAPACITY AUGMENTATION PROJECT
Specification for Electrical Equipment Installation
Project No: 403102-14495
Document No: 14495-00-EL-SPC-0014
14 Feb 2017
I-Think Lodha Techno Campus, 5
th Floor, Tower B,
Pokhran Road No. 2 Thane (West) – 400607 Tel: +91 2266515700 Fax: +91 2267818000
© Copyright 2017 WorleyParsons
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 3 of 30
CONTENTS
1.0 SCOPE ............................................................................................................................... 4
2.0 CODES AND STANDARDS ......................................................................................... 4
3.0 EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION ........................................................................................... 6
4.0 CABLE INSTALLATION .................................................................................................. 16
5.0 LIGHTING INSTALLATION ............................................................................................. 22
6.0 EARTHING INSTALLATION............................................................................................ 26
7.0 LIGHTNING PROTECTION INSTALLATION .................................................................. 28
8.0 LIST OF CONSTRUCTION EQUIPMENT ....................................................................... 29
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 4 of 30
1.0 SCOPE
This specification covers minimum requirements for the installation of electrical equipment, forming
part of electrical power distribution and utilization system for VVSPL Capacity Augmentation
Project.
The Contractor shall be fully responsible for the installation of electrical equipment.
Definitions
Purchaser : Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited
Engineer / Consultant : WorleyParsons India Pvt. Ltd.
Contractor : Installation contractor of electrical equipment
Vendor / Manufacturer : Supplier of electrical bulk items
2.0 CODES AND STANDARDS
2.1 The work shall be carried out in the best workmanlike manner in conformity with this specification,
installation standards, layout drawings, codes of practice of Bureau of Indian Standards and OISD
standards
IS 5 Colours for ready mixed paints and enamels
SP 30 (BIS) National Electrical Code 2011
IS 816 Code of practice for use of metal arc welding for general construction
in mild steel
IS 1239 Steel tubes, tubulars and other wrought steel fittings
IS 1255 Code of practice for installation and maintenance of power cables up
to and including 33kV rating
IS 1364 Hexagon head bolts, screws and nuts of product grades A and B
IS 1573 Electroplated coatings of zinc on iron and steel
IS 2309 Code of practice for the protection of buildings and allied structures
against lightning
IS 2629 Recommended practice for hot dip galvanizing of iron and steel
IS 2633 Methods for testing uniformity of coating of zinc coated articles
IS 3043 Code of practice for earthing
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 5 of 30
.
2.2 In addition to the above it shall be ensured that the installation conforms to the requirements of the
following as applicable:
a) Indian Electricity Act and Rules.
b) Regulations laid down by CEA/Electrical Inspectorate.
c) Regulations laid down by PESO/ DGMS (as applicable).
d) The petroleum rules (ministry of Industry Government of India).
e) Any other regulations laid down by central/state/local authorities and Insurance agencies.
2.3 In case of any contradiction between various referred standards, specifications and statutory
regulations the following order of priority shall govern:
- Statutory regulations
- This specification
- Codes and standards
However the Contractor shall bring any such contradiction to the notice of Purchaser for prior
approval.
IS 3618 Phosphate treatment of iron and steel for protection against corrosion
IS 4759 Hot-dip zinc coatings on structural steel and other allied products
IS 6005 Code of practice for phosphating of iron and steel
IS 7689 Guide for the control of undesirable static electricity
IS 7816 Guide for testing Insulation resistance of rotating machines
IS 10028 : Part 2 Code of practice for selection, installation and maintenance of
Transformers : Part 2 - Installation
IS 10118 : Part 3 Code of practice for selection, installation and maintenance of
switchgear and control gear : Part 3 - Installation
OISD-RP-110 Recommended practices on static electricity
OISD-STD-137 Inspection of Electrical Equipment
OISD-RP-147 Inspection and safe practices during electrical installations
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 6 of 30
3.0 EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
Prior to start of installation of the electrical equipment contractor shall verify that equipment and
complete materials have been received. Handling, shifting to required site location, installation,
testing and commissioning of all electrical equipment shall be done by contractor with utmost care.
Manufacturer’s instructions and the requirements given in their technical manuals shall be strictly
adhered. The substation/switchgear room wherein the equipment shall be installed shall be kept
clean, dry and free from all debris. Panel floor cutouts not in immediate use shall be suitably
covered to avoid any mishap. When handling the switchboard panels, care shall be taken to
observe the correct lifting arrangements and to make sure that slings are attached to the
manufacturer’s designated lifting arrangements and to make sure that slings are attached to the
manufacturer’s designated lifting points. No parts shall be subjected to undue strains or sudden
stresses which could cause damage to the equipment.
The lifting position mark indicated on packing casing shall be adhered to strictly, for keeping it in
required vertical position.
Contractor shall check and report to the Purchaser about any damaged item and / or missing
component for getting the same replaced as per specifications. During installation, all accessories
and loose items shall also be inspected by the contractor before their assembly/mounting.
In case of any modifications/replacement of existing equipments or Tie-ins with existing Electrical
systems, approvals shall be obtained from Purchaser before any work to be implemented. The tie-in
and shoutdown philosophy shall be developed by Contractor in coordination with production,
operation and maintenance department. Detailed Task Risk Assesment (TRA) shall be developed by
the Contractor for all modifications/replacement or tie-ins activities and shall be approved by all
concerened authoirities.
The following philosophies provide the frame work for modifications/replacement or tie-in approach:
a) The existing facilities shall continue to operate normally. Contractor shall verify the
requirements for modifications, replacement and interface or tie-in with existing / new electrical
systems.
b) In general, a planned construction campaign shall be scheduled to facilitate the
modifications/replacement or tie-in work. However, prepration for modifications/replacement or
tie-in work can be proceed on an opportunistic or scheduled shutdown prior to the planned
construction campaign in consulatation with Purchaser. Associated shoutdown co-ordination
shall be carried out by the Contractor as per Purchaser procedure to complete the
modifications/replacement of existing electrical equipments or tie-in hook up for all electrical
systems.
3.1 Switchboards and Bus Ducts
3.1.1 The term switchboard here includes all HV / MV/ LV switchboard panels, motor control centers,
power and lighting distribution boards, UPS panels, ACDB, charger panels, DCDB etc. The
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 7 of 30
switchboard panels shall be handled with care, avoiding any impact to the equipment. Dragging of the
panels directly on floor shall be avoided. Roller bars may be used for shifting of panels: Use of a
crane and trailer shall be made for handling of equipment. The switchboard panels shall be properly
supported on the truck or trailer by means of ropes to avoid any chance of tilting. The switchboards
shall be lifted after ensuring that panel supports, nuts and bolts are all intact and tightened. While
lifting the panels in packed conditions utmost care shall be taken to avoid any damage to
insulators, bushings, metering and protective equipment. The panels shall be preferably kept
inside the packing cases till foundations are ready.
3.1.2 The switchboard panels shall be installed on prepared foundations or floor cutouts. Steel base
channels shall be welded to inserts provided in floor slab. Cross members shall be provided at the
junctions of each shipping section and other places as required. Alternatively when the floor is
being-laid, base channel frame of panels supplied by the vendor shall be grouted and leveled in
cement concrete. It shall be ensured that the base plate level of HV switchboard shall match with
the finished floor level. The foundation pockets and the grouted bolts shall be cured for a minimum
period of 48 hours.
3.1.3 The switchboard panels shall be taken out from the packed cases and shifted one by one to its
proper place. All the panels shall be assembled, aligned and leveled: Alignment of panels shall be
checked in both longitudinal and lateral directions. It shall be ensured that panel to panel coupling
bolts, bus bar links etc. fit properly without any strain on any part. No new holes for jointing of the
panels other than those recommended by the vendor shall be drilled. No gaps shall be left between
the panels. The lifting, racking in and out operation of the breaker and all other motions shall be
free from any obstruction.
The panels shall be checked for correct vertical position using pendulum weight and spirit levels.
The switchboard panels shall be tack welded at suitable intervals at base channel.
After erection of switchboard panels, all uncovered portions of floor cutouts shall be covered with 6
mm thick removable chequerred plates finished with floor level. The design of the chequerred
plates shall be such that the maximum allowable deflection is L/200 (where L is the span of the
chequerred plates in metres) for a live load of 500 kg./sq. meters. Suitable lifting arrangements
shall be provided for chequered plates: The chequerred plates shall be painted with a coat of red
oxide zinc chromate primer after proper surface preparation as per specifications. Where specified,
panels cutouts provided for future use shall be filled with lean concrete.
3.1.4 After completion of erection of switchboards, all the cubicles, switchboard components such as
switches, starters, C.T. and P.T. chambers, busbar chamber shall be cleaned and checked for
tightness of all the components. Vacuum circuit breakers shall be checked for integrity of bottle seals.
All loosely supplied items shall be fitted up. Bus bar sections or links shall be inserted and where
specified, of high voltage equipment shall be insulated. Interconnection wiring between shipping
sections shall be made by contractor. All the wiring connections shall also be checked.
Phase sequence and polarity of PTs and CTs shall be checked. Contact resistance of all busbar
joints and contactors shall be checked. Insulator shall be checked for any damage. All the starters,
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 8 of 30
switches, contacts shall be cleaned with C.T.C. where required. All the moving parts shall be
checked for easy and free movement. Hinges of panel doors shall be lubricated to give free
and noise free movement. All openings shall be kept completely closed to avoid ingress of any
foreign particles inside the panel.
Functional scheme verification of individual feeder shall be carried out and minor wiring
modifications in the panel wiring, if required shall be done as per the directions of Purchaser.
Special attention shall be paid to CT circuits polarity, wiring continuity and correctness in the
protection as well as measurement circuits. Auto transfer scheme shall be simulated and verified.
During the course of scheme verification tests, defective components if any shall be taken out,
after bringing to the notice of Purchaser. The same shall be replaced by component supplied by
Purchaser.
3.1.5 Where switchboard is damp or having a low IR value due to damaged insulators/
bushings/any other insulated parts, or any other reason, the entire switchboard shall be dried . up
according to the instruction of the Purchaser for the I.R value to improve to a sate level for
commissioning. Care shall be taken to protect the surrounding insulation from direct local heating
during the drying up process.
3.1.6 All the metering instruments, protective relays and other relays and contactors shall be tested
as per manufacturer's recommendations and according to the instructions of the Purchaser. Protection
relays shall be inserted and connected and settings adjusted as required by the Purchaser.
3.1.7 All moving parts, of closing/tripping mechanism, racking in and racking out mechanism, spouts and
shutter closing mechanism shall be checked for proper operation. All the auxiliary contacts of breaker
shall be checked-up, cleaned and contact pressure measured.
3.1.8 All the control wiring, PTs, bushings, bus bars, other live parts of switchgear, incoming and
outgoing cables shall be meggered.
3.1.9 Electrical simulation tests shall be carried out for all the protective, alarm and annunciation relays
and external interfaces to ascertain proper functioning.
3.1.10 Safety insulation mats of approved make and of required voltage grade shall be provided in the sub-
Station.
3.1.11 Pre-Commissioning Check List:
Before commissioning any switchboard, following points shall be checked and ensured for safe
energizing of the switchboard:
a) That the installation of equipment to be commissioned is complete in all respects with its
auxiliaries and all other mounting including earthing. Openings in floor within and outside panels
have been sealed off. All cover and door gaskets are intact to make the enclosure vermin proof.
b) All the metering instruments have been checked and found in working order. Indicating lamps are
healthy and are in correct position. All power and control fuses are of proper rating.
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 9 of 30
c) That the polarity test and ratio test of all the P.T.s and C.T.s is complete and phase sequence of
C.T.s conforms to the correct vector group connections. Wiring continuity and correctness are
ensured in the protection and measurement circuits. Polarity of D.C. supply for all the circuits is
correct.
d) That the high voltage tests of incoming and outgoing cables have been conducted and results
are satisfactory.
e) That all the protective relays including both conventional and microprocessor based numerical
relays and thermal overload relays have been tested for secondary injection tests. (Primary
injection tests shall be carried out for differential protection, Restricted Earth fault protection
at full / reduced current to ensure correctness of complete wiring). Relay settings, status indications,
fault annunciations, data logging, display of switchboard SLDs shall be verified from MMI in case
the same is provided.
f) That I.R. Value has been recorded for bus bars, circuit breaker, incoming and outgoing cables,
control wiring and potential transformers. Where required joint resistance of bus bars have been
recorded and found to be satisfactory. All the surroundings and panels have been cleaned and
temporary earth leads have been removed.
3.1.12 Bus Ducts:
The bus ducts as per issued drawings will be supplied in parts and all the parts shall be assembled
and the bus bar connections shall be made at site. The insulators in bus ducts shall be inspected
for any possible damage during transit and the defective ones shall be replaced. The insulators
shall be cleaned. Contact surface of bus bars, bus bar bolts and nuts shall be thoroughly cleaned.
Petroleum jelly shall then be applied and bolted connection made. The bus duct enclosure shall be
checked for earth continuity and then earthed at two places. The bus duct shall be properly
supported between switchgear and transformer. The opening in the wall where the bus duct enters
the switchgear room shall be completely sealed to avoid rain water entry. Expansion joints, flexible
connections etc. supplied by the manufacturer of the bus duct shall be properly connected. The
bus duct levelling shall be checked with spirit level and pendulum weight.
3.2 Transformers
Transformers on receipt at site shall be unloaded by means of crane or lifting devices of adequate
capacity. All lifting lugs shall be used to avoid unbalanced lifting and undue stresses on lugs. Lifting
lugs if any provided for partial lifting (e.g. for active part, conservator) etc. shall not be used for
lifting complete transformer. Parts other than those identified for lifting of the transformer shall not
be used for lifting. While slinging, care shall be taken to avoid slings touching other parts.
3.2.1 Before lifting transformer, it shall be ensured that all cover bolts are tightened fully. In case when it
is necessary to use jacks for lifting, projections provided for the purposes of jacking shall be used.
Lifting jacks shall not be used under the valves or radiator tubes. For transporting transformers
from stores to site, the transformers shall be loaded on a suitable capacity truck or trailor. The
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 10 of 30
transformers shall be properly supported by steel ropes and stoppers on the trailor to avoid tilting
of the transformers in transit due to jerks and vibrations. At no instance the transformer shall be
kept on bare ground. Where it is not possible to unload the transformer directly on a foundation, it
shall be unloaded on a properly built wooden sleeper platform. A transformer shall never be left
without putting stoppers to the wheels.
3.2.2 Transformer shall be examined, for any sign of damage in transit. Particular attention shall be
given to the following in this regard:
a) Dents on tank wall or cooling tubes.
b) Damage to protruding parts like valves, sight glass etc.
c) Loosening of bolts due to vibration in transit.
d) Cracked or broken bushings.
e) Oil leakage particularly along welds.
If any thing adverse is noted the same shall be brought to the notice of Purchaser.
3.2.3 Contractor shall examine the transformer base, oil pit, tire walls and foundations laid by the civil
contractor. It shall be ensured that oil spills can not propagate along cable trenches. Any
discrepancy noted will be brought to the notice of Purchaser. Transformers shall be placed on
channels or rails over concrete foundations. The transformers shall be leveled, aligned and
checked for free movement on the channels or rails. Stoppers shall be provided to the transformers
immediately to prevent any movement. Normally transformers upto 1000 kVA rating shall be
received duly fitted with radiator tubes, conservator tanks, valves, wheels and other accessories.
While the transformers of above 1000 kVA rating may be supplied with loose accessories. All the
accessories like radiators, cooling fans, valves, conservator tanks, explosion vent pipe, bushings
and other devices which are supplied in different packages shall be checked for any transit
damage and cleaned thoroughly before fixing on the transformer. All loosely supplied parts shall be
assembled as per manufacturer's instruction manuals/ drawings and documents. All the
connections for C.T.s bushings and other wiring shall be checked for tightness and correctness
before replacing the lid or tightening all the bolts.
3.2.4 Topping of transformer with oil:
Before topping up with oil, transformer shall be fitted with all accessories such as valves, gauges,
thermometers etc. Oil samples shall be taken from each drum and tested for determination of
dielectric strength. Any sign of leakage of the barrel or of its having been opened shall be recorded
and reported. It is necessary to filter the oil before the transformers are filled. It shall be ensured in
oil filling operation that no air pockets are left in the tank and that no dust or moisture enters the oil.
All air vents shall be opened. Oil shall be filled through a streamline oil filter using metal hose. To
prevent aeration or the oil, the transformer tank shall be filled through the bottom drain valve. In a
transformer with conservator tank, the rate of oil flow shall be reduced when the level is almost
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 11 of 30
upto the bottom of the main cover to prevent internal pressure from rupturing the pressure relief-
pipe diaphragm. Sufficient time shall be allowed for the oil to permeate the transformers and also
for the locked -up air bubbles to escape. Any air accumulation in the buchholz relay shall be
released.
3.2.5 Transformer Oil
a) Sample of oil from the transformer shall be taken from the bottom of the tank.
b) Testing of Oil:
For dielectric test, the oil shall be tested as described in IS 335. The oil shall also be tested for
acidity in accordance with the methods prescribed.
3.2.6 Drying out of the transformers, if required, shall be carried out and record maintained in
accordance with IS 10028. Normally a streamline filter shall be used for drying-up. I.R. value
versus time of both windings shall be recorded during the drying-up process.
Precautions when drying
a) The maximum sustained temperature to which transformer oil may be subjected shall be limited
to 800C.
b) The transformer shall be carefully monitored throughout the drying out process and all observations
shall be carefully recorded.
c) Drying out shall be continued so that the insulation resistance as prescribed in the standard
code of practice is attained and the value remains constant for more than 12 hours. However, a
minimum number of cycles shall be done for each transformer as found necessary by the
Purchaser. Generally a megger reading of 2 megohms / kV at 600 C temp with a 5 kV Megger
may be a rough indication for stopping the dehydration.
3.2.7 The following work on transformers shall be performed by the contractor if specifically called for:
a) Before finally commissioning the transformer it may sometimes be desired to run it for a few hours
on short-circuit, applying a low voltage, approximately equal to the impedance voltage of the
transformer. During this process, regular readings of the insulation resistance of the winding to
earth and winding to winding and temperature against time shall be recorded.
b) Testing of radiator tubes for any leakage and rectifying these by welding / brazing.
3.2.8 Pre-commissioning Check List:
Before commissioning of any transformer, the following points shall be checked for safe
energisation of the transformer:
a) That all the accessories have been fixed properly and transformer body and neutral are
properly earthed. The transformer dehydration is over and results are satisfactory and
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 12 of 30
approved by the Purchaser. In case transformers are idle for more than one month after
dehydration, transformer oil has been given at least two circulations.
b) That the oil level, in the transformer conservator tank and all the bushings is upto the marked
point and the oil has been tested for dielectric strength and acidity.
c) That the silicagel is in reactivated condition. The breather pipe is clear from any blocking and
contains oil upto the proper level.
d) The explosion vent diaphragm does not have any dents. Accumulation of any oil and air had
been released.
e) That the operation of off-load and on-load tap changers on all the tap positions is satisfactory. The
mechanical parts of the on-load tap changer are lubricated. Motor IR value has taken and found
satisfactory. Tap position mechanical indicator on the transformer and tap position indication
meter on the control panel are reading the same tap positions. Tap changer limit switches are
operating satisfactorily on the maximum and minimum tap positions. On-load tap changer contact
pressure and resistance is as per manufacturers recommendations. Oil level of tap changer tank is
upto the required level and oil has been tested for dielectric strength. The tap setting on which
the off load tap switch is locked shall be recorded. Generally the off-load tap switch shall be kept
on nominal tap.
f) That the buchholz relay has been tested and checked up for any friction in the movement, and
floats are free, all the other protective relays, alarm and annunciation relays have been tested.
g) That all the metering equipment have been tested and polarity test of P.T's and transformer
winding is satisfactory. Phase sequence and connections have been checked for proper vector
group.
h) That the ratio test and winding resistance on all the tap positions is satisfactory.
i) That gaps of arcing horns for the bushings where provided are in order and earth connections for
the surge diverters have been checked
j) That the winding and oil temperature thermometer pockets contain oil and the winding and oil
temperature settings on dial gauges are in order.
k) That the transformers fitted with fans for forced air cooling have been checked up for automatic
starting and stopping of the fans and air-displacement has been verified.
l) That the simulation tests for all external interface connection alarm, annunciation and trip circuits
have been checked and are in order.
m) That the insulation resistance of all the control circuits and IR value of the transformer windings
and all the incoming and outgoing cables have been checked.
n) That all the valves in the cooling system and valve between the buchholz relay and the
conservator tanks are in open position.
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 13 of 30
o) That the setting of all the protective relays is at the desired value and D.C. Trip supply is
healthy.
3.2.9 Observations after Commissioning
After switching on the transformer the following points shall be observed and recorded.
a) The inrush magnetizing current and no-load current.
b) Alarm, if any, or if any relay flag has operated.
c) Voltage and current on all the three phases.
d) Transformer hum or abnormal noise.
e) Circulation of oil and leakages.
f) Record current, voltage, cooling air temperature, winding temperature and oil temperature
readings, hourly for 24 hours.
g) Cable end boxes, for any over -heating.
3.3 H.V. and M.V. Motors
3.3.1 All the motors generally would be erected by the mechanical contractor.
3.3.2 Contractor shall keep the motor space heater energized as per the directions of Purchaser.
Contractor shall measure the insulation resistance of motor windings. Insulation resistance of the
motors shall be measured between the winding of the machine and its frame by means of a 500 /
1000 V Meggar in case of 415 V motors A minimum value of 1 megohm for 415 V motors shall be
considered a safe value. In case of lower I.R. Value, the insulation value shall be improved by any of
the following methods as directed by the Purchaser.
a) Blowing hot air from external source.
b) Putting the motor in oven:
c) Placing heaters or lamps around and inside after making suitable guarding and covering
arrangements so as to conserve the heat.
In case the insulation is low, the following method of drying has to be adopted, after consultation
with Purchaser. During drying the temperature rise of winding shall not exceed the permissible value for
the class of insulation used:
a) By locking the motor so that it can not rotate and then applying such a low voltage to the stator
terminals so as to pass full load current in the stator keeping the stator winding temperature
below 90° C . In this case a close watch shall be kept for any possible overheating and I.R.
Values vs. temperature shall be plotted and heating continued till I.R. value becomes steady.
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 14 of 30
b) By blasting hot air from external source, Maximum temperature of winding while drying shall be
70° C to 80°C (thermometer) or 90° C to 95° C by resistance method. Heating shall be done
slowly first till steady temperature of winding is reached after 4 to 5 hours, and for large
machines after 10 hours. A record has to be kept for drying process, with half an hour readings
and, till steady temperature is reached. In case it is essential, the drying process can be
supplemented by blower.
3.3.3 It shall be ensured that the motor leads are correctly connected in the terminal box, as indicated in
the 'Name Plate'. The covers of all terminal boxes shall be properly fixed, the gaskets intact. The
control circuit shall be tested for proper functioning as per circuit diagram.
3.3.4 In case of synchronous machines, slip rings and brush gear shall be polished and brushes shall be
fixed in their holders with clearance and pressure as recommended by the manufacturers.
3.3.5 Before commissioning, the ventilation and cooling system of the motor must be inspected. In case
of motor with forced ventilation the air inlet shall be examined to ensure that it is free from moisture
and any foreign material. It shall also be ensured that recommended flow and pressure of air is
available to produce the required cooling effect.
3.3.6 The motor control gear shall also be carefully examined, the over-load settings may be reduced or
time lags bypassed from protective gear to ensure rapid tripping of switchgear in event of faults.
The direction of rotation of a new motor specially of large capacity, and phase sequence of supply
shall be kept in view while joining and connecting to the motor terminals.
3.3.7 Finally the motor shall be started on no-load after decoupling, and shall be allowed to run for a
minimum period of 4 hours, or for a time as instructed by Purchaser. Attention shall be given to the
proper running of the bearings, vibration or unusual noises if any. Voltage, starting current, no load
current, stator winding and bearing temperature shall be recorded after every 1 hour during this
test. Direction of rotation shall be checked and recorded. Normally the motors run in clockwise
direction as viewed from the driving end with reference to the phase sequence R, Y, B.
3.3.8 After switching off the motor, the insulation resistance of the motor shall be recorded under hot and
cold conditions.
3.3.9 If the no load test run is found satisfactory, the motor shall be allowed to run for 8 hours and all
readings shall be recorded.
3.3.10 The following work on motors, may be performed by the contractor if specifically called for.
a) The proper level of bearing oil has to be checked. The condition of grease in bearings shall be
checked and in case it is necessary, complete replacement of bearing with specified grade of
grease after proper cleaning of the bearing shall have to be done. Wherever external greasing facility
exists, the condition of grease may be checked by pumping some new grease of specified grade
at start. If the grease coming out is deteriorated grease shall be replaced.
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 15 of 30
b) All the motors, motor exciter set and induction generators directly coupled or coupled through
reduction gears shall be checked for abnormal vibration, if any Large rated HV motors with
journal type bearings are liable to get damaged from shock, rough handling during transit. Any
minor defect in a race or roller may give rise to considerable amount of vibration and noise.
Contractor shall check and bring to the attention of Purchaser any defect noticed in this regard.
c) Due care shall be taken to avoid any damage to bearing insulation wherever provided.
3.4. Batteries
Battery (Lead acid, Nickel Cadmium or VRLA type as specified) shall be erected on stands and
insulators supplied by the manufacturer of the batteries. The installation shall be done as per the
layout drawings and manufacturer's instructions. Electrolyte if required / as applicable shall be filled as
per manufacturer's instructions. Interrow connections shall be made with the leads supplied by the
manufacturer. .
3.5 Neutral Earthing Resistor
The neutral earthing resistor shall be inspected for any damage to the resistor grid and other
components. The resistor shall be levelled and installed. All covers etc. shall be checked for
tightness to ensure that the enclosure of the resistor is dust, vermin and weatherproof. Earthing
conductors shall be taken from the out end terminal of the resistor, for connection to earth electrodes
and to the main grid.
3.6 Welding Receptacles
The welding receptacles shall be erected on steel/concrete structures as per the drawings. In isolated
places a separate support shall be fabricated and installed.
3.7 Push Button/Control Stations
The push buttons / control stations shall be installed near to the motors to be controlled. Individual
channel supports shall be installed as per standard. If control stations for hazardous areas are to be
supplied by contractor, these shall be of Ex (d) type, tested by CMRI and approved by CCE or other
applicable certifying authorities. All outdoor push buttons / control stations shall preferably have
integral canopies for additional weather protection. The canopy shall be made of 2 mm thick
galvanized sheet steel or FRP where these are not integral with the equipment.
3.8 Gang operated Isolators/outdoor Disconnectors
The isolators shall be transported to site in the dismantled condition. All the insulators may be also
supplied loose. The contractor shall inspect, clean, assemble and install the isolator on the base
structure previously fabricated, erected and leveled by him. The operating mechanism shall be
installed on the structure and connected to the isolator poles. The operating mechanism shall be
tested by slowly bringing the isolator to the closed position and carrying out the necessary adjustment
as per the manufacturer's instructions. The earthing switches, frames and operating handle etc. shall
be earthed.
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 16 of 30
3.9 Miscellaneous Items
Contractor shall provide the following items in substation, as per Indian Electricity Rules
3.9.1 Fire buckets filled with clean dry sand and ready for immediate use for extinguishing fires and fire
extinguisher (carbon dioxide, dry chemical extinguisher etc.) suitable for dealing with electric fires
shall be conspicuously marked and kept.
3.9.2 First aid boxes containing ointments and medicines for immediate treatment of injuries (As
prescribed by Indian Red Cross Society or equivalent).
3.9.3 Instructions of restoration of persons suffering from electric shock in English, Hindi and local
language of the district shall be affixed in a conspicuous place.
3.9.4 Danger boards (H.V., M.V.) shall be provided on transformer gate, switchboards, entrance to
switchgear room and at other places as required by Purchaser.
3.10 Generators
Contractor shall install main, emergency or standby generators with their gas turbine or diesel engine
drivers, and equipment associated with these ‘packages’, in locations as shown on the AFC contract
drawings and in accordance with manufacturer’s instructions. Contractor shall install and terminate
interconnecting cables in accordance with equipment vendor’s drawings and contract drawings.
Contractor shall check the installation and correctness of the various protection devices fitted to
medium voltage machines. Anti-condensation heaters where fitted shall be connected up to a
temporary supply and left energized as soon as equipment is delivered.
4.0 CABLE INSTALLATION
4.1 General
4.1.1 Cable installation shall include power, control and lighting cables. These shall be laid in
trenches/cable trays as detailed in the power layout drawings. Cable routing given on the power
layout drawings shall be checked in the field so as to avoid interference with other services such
piping, instrumentation, civil, structural, mechanical etc. Any change in routing shall be done to suit
the field conditions suitably interfacing with other services wherever deemed necessary, after
obtaining approval of Purchaser.
High voltage, medium voltage power and control cables shall be separated from each other by
adequate spacing or by running through independent pipes, trenches or cables trays, as shown on
power layout drawings/installation details. Details of cable routes and cable spacings not shown in
detail drawing shall be determined by the Contractor and approved by the Purchaser.
4.1.2 High voltage, medium voltage power and control cables shall be separated from each other by
adequate spacing or by running through independent pipes, trenches or cable trays, as shown on
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 17 of 30
layout drawings/installation standards. Details of cable routes and cable spacings not shown in
detail on these drawing shall be determined by the Contractor and approved by the Purchaser.
When single core cables are laid in flat formation, the individual cable fixing clamps and spacers
shall be of non-magnetic material. As a general practice, the sheath of single core cables shall be
earthed at one point to keep sheath at earth potential unless otherwise stated. Single core cables,
when laid in trefoil formation shall be braced by suitable clamps at a distance, not exceeding 3
meters along the cable routing.
If straight through joints are required to be provided on single core cables, amour shall be broken
at joints as per Supplier’s recommendations. For single core cables, armour shall be earthed at
one end for the cable run length as per Supplier’s recommendation.
Minimum spacing of 300 mm between power, control cables and Telephone, Communication, Fire
alarm cables shall be maintained.
4.1.3 The lengths indicated in the cables schedule are only approximate. The Contractor shall ascertain
the exact length of cable for a particular feeder by measuring at site. All cable routes shall be
carefully measured. Before the start of cable laying, the Contractor shall prepare cable drum
schedule and get that approved by Purchaser to minimize/avoid straight though joints and then the
cables cut to the required lengths, leaving sufficient lengths for the terminations of the cable at both
ends. The various cable lengths cut from the cable reels shall be carefully selected to prevent
undue wastage of cables. Extra loop length shall be given for feeder cables where required as per
the directions of Purchaser to meet contingencies.
Cables shall be laid in directly buried trench or in RCC trench (underground trench) or in cable tray
along pipe sleepers or in over head trays as shown on power layout drawings.
Overhead trays shall be installed 2700 mm (minimum) above grade level. At road crossings
overhead trays shall be installed at 7000 mm (minimum) above level or cables shall be routed
cable tray culvert/Electrical road crossing s as per power layout drawings.
Sufficient care shall be taken while laying cables to avoid formation of twist, sharp bend etc. in
order to avoid mechanical injuries to cables. Rollers shall be used for pulling of cables.
Cable installation shall provide minimum cable bending radii as recommended by cable Supplier.
4.1.4 Cables shall be neatly arranged in the trenches/trays in such a manner that criss-crossing is
avoided and final take off to the motor/switchgear is facilitated. Arrangement of cables within the
trenches/trays shall be in line with power layout drawings. Cable routing between cable trench and
equipment/motors shall be taken through GI pipe sleeves of adequate size. Pipe sleeves shall be
laid at an angle of maximum 45 to the trench wall. Bending radii of pipes shall not be less than 8D.
It is to be ensured that both the ends of GI pipe sleeves shall be sealed with approved whether
proof sealing plastic compound after cabling. In places where it is not possible, cables shall be laid
in smaller branch trenches.
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 18 of 30
4.1.5 All cables shall be identified close to their termination point by cable tag numbers as per cable
schedule. Cable tag numbers shall be punched on aluminum straps (2mm thick, 20 mm wide and
of enough length) securely fastened to the cable and wrapped around it.
Each underground cable shall be provided with cable tags of lead securely fastened every 30 m of
its underground length with at least one tag at each end before the cable enters/leaves the ground.
In unpaved areas, cable trenches shall be identified by means of cable markers as per installation
drawing. These cable markers shall be placed at location of changes in the direction of cables and
at intervals of not more than 20 m and also at cable straight through joint locations.
4.1.6 All temporary ends of cables must be protected against dirt and moisture to prevent damage to the
insulation. For this purpose, ends of cables shall be taped with an approved PVC end cap or
rubber insulating tape.
4.1.7 Each row of cables shall be laid in place and before covering with sand. All wall opening/pipe
sleeves shall be effectively sealed after installation of cables to avoid seepage of water inside
building /lined trench. Every cable shall be given an insulation test in presence of Purchaser before
filling the cable trench with sand. Any cable which is found defective shall be replaced.
4.1.8 Where cables pass through foundation walls, the necessary openings shall be provided in advance
for the same by another agency. However, should it become necessary to cut holes in existing
structures for example floor slab etc., the Contractor shall determine their location and obtain
approval of the Purchaser before carrying out the same.
4.1.9 Cables for road crossings shall be taken through ERC (Electrical Road Crossing) as shown in the
power layout drawings.
At road crossing and other places where cables enter pipe sleeves adequate bed of sand shall be
given so that the cables do not slack and get damaged by pipe ends.
4.1.10 Wherever cable trench crosses storm water, waste water channel/drain, cables shall be taken
through PVC/RCC pipes. Where cables are required to cross drains of depth more than 1200 mm,
cables shall be taken over the drain on cable trays supported suitably using ISMC 150/200
sections.
4.1.11 Ends of cables leaving trench shall be coiled & capped and provided with protective cover till such
time the final termination to the equipment is completed.
4.1.12 Cables laid direct in ground
Cables shall be laid underground in excavated cable trenches where specified in cable layout
drawings. Trenches shall be of sufficient depth and width for accommodation of all cables. Cables
shall be properly spaced and arranged with a view of heat dissipation and economy of design.
Maximum number of cable layers in trench shall be preferably limited to 5 layers.
Minimum depth of cable trench shall be 750 mm for medium voltage and 900 mm for H.V. Cables.
The depth and the width of the trench shall vary depending upon the number of layers of cables
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 19 of 30
Cables shall be laid in buried trenches at depth as shown in the power layout drawings. It is to be
insured by the Contractor that the bottom of buried trenches shall be cleared of all rocks, stones
and sharp objects before cables are placed. The trench bottom shall be filled with a layer of sand.
This sand shall be leveled and cables laid over it. These cables shall be covered with 150 mm of
sand on top of the largest diameter cable and sand shall be lightly compacted. A flat protective
covering of 75 mm thick second class red bricks shall than be laid and the reminder of the trench
shall then be back – filled with soil, rammed and leveled.
4.1.13 Cables laid in concrete trench
Cables shall be laid in 3 or 4 tiers in concrete trench as shown on power layout drawings. Concrete
cables trenches shall be filled with sand in hazardous area to avoid accumulation of hazardous
gases and oil. RCC covers of trenches shall be effectively sealed to avoid ingress of chemical and
oil in process area. Removal of concrete covers where required for the purpose of cable laying
and reinstating them in their proper position after cables are laid shall be done by Contractor.
All wall opening /pipe sleeves shall be effectively sealed after installation of cables to avoid
seepage of water.
4.1.14 Above ground cables
a) Cables installed above grade shall be run in cable trays, clamped on walls, ceiling or structures
and shall be run parallel or at right angles to beams, walls or columns. Cable routing shall be
planned to be away from heat sources such as hot piping, gas, water, oil drainage piping, air-
conditioning duct etc. Each cable tray shall contain only one layer of cables as far as possible
for power cables. However control cables may be laid in double layer in the cable trays.
b) Individual cable or small group of cables (upto 3 to 4 cables) which run along structures/walls
etc. shall be clamped by means of 16 SWG GI saddles on 25 x 6 mm saddle bars. Alternatively
small group of cables can be taken through 100/150 mm slotted channel tray/ISMC 100. Cables
shall be supported so as to prevent sagging. In general, distance between supports shall be
approximately 300 mm for cables upto 25 diameters and maximum 450 mm for cables larger
than 25 mm dia. To prevent the sagging of cables.
c) Cable laid on supporting angle in cable trenches, structures, columns and vertical run of cable
trays shall be suitably clamped by means of G.I. saddles/clams, whereas cables in horizontal
run of cable trays shall be tied by means of nylon cords. Distance between supporting angles
shall not exceed 600mm.
d) All cable trays (other than galvanized trays) and supporting steel structures shall be painted
before laying of cables. The under surfaces shall be properly degreased, derusted, descaled
and cleaned. The painting shall be done with one coat of redoxide zinc chromate primer. Final
painting shall be done with two coats of approved bituminous aluminum paint unless otherwise
specified.
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 20 of 30
e) Where cables rise from trench to motor, lighting panel, control station, junction box etc., they
shall be taken in GI pipe for mechanical protection upto a minimum of 300 mm above grade.
Cable ends shall be carefully pulled through conduit to prevent damage to cable.
f) All G.I. Pipes shall be laid as per layout drawings and site conditions. Before fabrication of
various profiles of pipes by hydraulically operated bending machine (which is to be arranged by
the Contractor) all the burrs from the pipes shall be removed. GI Pipes having bends shall be
buried in soil/concrete in such a way that the bend shall be totally concealed. For G.I. pipes
buried in soil, bitumen coating shall be applied on the buried lengths. Installation of G.I. pipes
shall be undertaken well before paving is completed and necessary co ordination with paving
agency shall be the responsibility of Contractor.
Following guide shall be used for sizing of G.I. pipe.
i) 1 cable in a pipe - 53 % of pipe cross-sectional area occupied by cables.
ii) 2 cables in a pipe - 31 % of pipe cross-sectional area occupied by cables.
iii) 3 cables in a pipe - 43 % of pipe cross-sectional area occupied by cables.
iv) 4 and above cables in a pipe - 40 % of pipe cross-sectional area occupied by cables.
After the cables are installed and all testing is complete, conduit ends above grade shall be
plugged with a suitable weatherproof plastic compound / bitumen / suitable sealing compound.
Alternatively rubber bushes shall be employed for the purpose of sealing
4.1.15 Terminations
a) All HV and MV cables shall be terminated at the equipment by means of single/double
compression type cables glands as specified suitable for the cable size. They shall have a
screwed nipple with conduit electrical threads and check nut. The cables shall be identified
close to their termination points at both the ends of cable (cable numbers shall be punched on
aluminium strips 2mm thick and securely fastened to the cables wrapped around it) and also
along the route at recommended intervals, by cable tag numbers.
All cable entries for outdoor termination shall be preferably through bottom. Outdoor cable
termination through top of equipment shall not be permitted.
b) Power cables cores wherever colour coding is not available shall be identified with red, yellow
and blue PVC tapes. Where copper to aluminum connections are made, necessary bimetallic
washers shall be used.
c) In case of control cables, all cores shall be identified at both ends by their terminal numbers by
means of PVC ferrules suitable for core size. Wire numbers shall be as per
schematic/wiring/inter-connection diagram. All unused spare cores of control, cables shall be
neatly bunched and ferruled with cable tag at both ends, for future use.
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 21 of 30
For trip circuit identification additional red ferules shall be used only in the particular cores of
control cables at the termination points in the Switchgear/Control panels and Control Switches.
d) Contractor shall drill holes for fixing glands wherever necessary. Gland plate shall be of non-
magnetic material/aluminum sheet in case of single core cables. All unused cable entries on
equipment/panels shall be plugged/sealed.
e) The cable shall be terminated at electrical equipment /switchboards through glands of proper
size. The individual cores shall then be dressed and taken along the cables ways or shall be
fixed to the panels with polyethylene straps. The cable glanding shall be done as per Supplier’s
instructions. Cable armour shall not be exposed after termination is complete. In case of
termination of cables at the bottom of a panel over a cable trench having no access from the
bottom close fit holes shall be drilled in the gland plate for all the cables in one line, and then
gland plate shall be split in two parts along the centre line of holes. After fixing bottom plate,
uncovered cable holes/gaps shall be sealed with cold setting compound.
f) Crimping of lugs to cable leads shall be done by hand crimping/hydraulically operated tool as
per requirement. Insulation of the leads shall be removed before crimping. Conductor surface
shall be cleaned and shall not be left open. Suitable conducting jelly shall be applied on the
conductor lead. Lugs shall enclose all strands of cable core. Cutting of stands shall not be
allowed.
g) HV cables shall be terminated with heat shrinkable termination kits, indoor or outdoor type as
specified by approved HV cable jointers. Supplier’s instructions shall be followed for applying
heat shrinkable termination kits.
h) The Contractor shall bring to the notice of Purchaser any mismatch in cable glands, lugs
provided with the equipment vis-à-vis to the cable size indicated in cable schedule for taking
corrective action.
i) The cable joints in power and control cables shall be avoided as far as possible. In case a joint
is unavoidable, the following shall be insured:
i) The number of joints shall be restricted to minimum as far as possible.
ii) The location of joints shall be identified with permanents markers.
iii) No joints shall be allowed in hazardous areas without the approval of Purchaser.
iv) No joints will be allowed in the Cable seller.
The jointing and termination of medium voltage power cables shall be carried out by trained
personnel only. Jointing and termination of high voltage cables shall be done by skilled and
experienced jointer duly approved by Purchaser. Only type tested termination kits of approved
make shall be used.
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 22 of 30
j) No unauthorized repairs, modifications shall be carried out on the hazardous area equipment
terminal boxes and junction boxes. Damaged enclosures of hazardous area equipment shall be
brought to the notice of Purchaser by Contractor. After termination is complete, all the bolts,
nuts, hard wares of terminal box shall be properly placed in its position and tightened.
k) Where required, cable sealing boxes intended to be used with the apparatus shall be filled with
solid setting type bituminous compound unless otherwise specified.
5.0 LIGHTING INSTALLATION
5.1 General
5.1.1 The lighting fixtures in the plant shall be fed from lighting and small power distribution board. All
outdoor lighting shall be group controlled manually or through photoelectric synchronous timer.
Lighting wiring between distribution boards and lighting fixtures shall be done with 3-core (phase,
neutral and earth) Cu/XLPE/SWA/PVC cable for plant areas and substation building. Wiring in the
other building shall be done by means of 3-core Cu/PVC cables, or PVC insulated copper
conductor wires in conduit/Metsec channel as specified. All joints of conductors in Switch
boards/JBs Fittings shall be made only by means of approved mechanical connectors (nylon/PVC
connectors). Bare twisted joints shall not be permitted any where in the wiring system.
5.1.2 The lighting and small power layouts furnished by Purchaser will indicate approximate locations of
lighting fixtures. The Contractor shall determine, with approval of Purchaser, the exact locations of
each fixture in order to avoid interference with other services such as piping, instrumentation, civil,
structural, mechanical etc and also with a view to obtain as much uniform illumination as
practicable, and to avoid objectionable shadows. Conduits shall be laid out by the Contractor to
suit field conditions suitably interfacing with other services and as per directions of the Purchaser.
5.1.3 On walkways, platforms and other outdoor area, lighting fixtures shall be located nearer to landing
of stairs or ladders, gauges, flowmeters, panel boards and other equipment to provide proper
illumination.
5.1.4 The minimum height of any lighting fixture shall be preferably not less than 2.5 meters above the
floor level.
5.1.5 All outdoor cable terminations to outdoor junction boxes, panels, socket outlets etc. shall be
through bottom or from side. Top entries for cables shall be avoided to avoid water entry. All cable
glands for outdoor terminations shall be double compression type and the gland shall be covered
with PVC or rubber boot shroud. All unused cable entries shall be plugged with suitable blanking
plugs.
5.1.6 Mounting height of equipment shall be as under :-
Top of Switch Box : 1200 mm from FFL (Finished floor level)
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 23 of 30
Bottom of Lighting/Power Panel : 1500mm from FFL
5/15 Amp. Receptacle : 300mm from FFL unless otherwise specified
(1200 mm for process areas and industrial sheds)
Lighting fixture : As indicated in layout drawing
Exhaust fan : In the cutout provided / as indicated in Layout
drawings.
5.1.7 Fixtures shall be firmly supported from the structures. Support clamps etc. may be bolted or
welded to the existing steel work or metal inserts. In case of concrete structures, where metal
inserts are not available, fixtures shall be suspended from concrete surfaces with the help of
anchor fasteners. In such cases special care shall be taken to see that anchoring is firm. In places
where ceiling fans are provided, lighting fixtures shall be suspended below the level of fan to avoid
shadow effect.
5.1.8 Circuit cables in a group shall be cleated to structure by using galvanised strip clamps or cable run
in cable trays wherever trays are available. Spacers and cleats shall be of required size to
accommodate the cables. All hardware shall be galvanised. Underground lighting cables (in
paved areas) shall be taken in suitable G.I. sleeves buried at a minimum depth of 300mm from
FFL. GI pipe sleeves shall be extended to 300mm above FFL. Exact termination/layout of G.I. pipes
(for protection of cables) shall be decided at site as per site convenience in consultation with
Purchaser.
5.1.9 Wiring for all outlet sockets shall be done with 3 cores of equal sizes for phase, neutral and
earth. The terminals of switch sockets shall be suitable to receive the size of wire specified.
5.1.10 All lighting fixtures shall be provided with terminal block with required terminals suitable for connection
of wire up to 2.5 sq. mm copper conductor.
5.1.11 The cable shall be straightened after unwinding it from the drum. All cables be clamped/laid in
straight run without any sag and kink.
5.1.12 For location where fan points are shown, fan hooks with junction box shall be provided during
concreting. Where fan hooks and J.Bs. are provided separately JB shall be located within a
distance of 300mm from hook for mounting of ceiling rose.
5.1.13 Industrial type plug sockets with 20A switch or rating as specified shall be provided at a height of
500mm from FFL for window AC units. Socket outlets and plugs for installation in MCC room, DG
room, etc. shall be of industrial metal clad type.
5.1.14 Wiring for exhaust fans shall be terminated in receptacles as specified in layout drawing and the
connection from receptacle to the exhaust fan shall be by means of a flexible cord equivalent in
size to the main run of wires. Switch for exhaust fan shall be located in a separate switch board
along with other switches
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 24 of 30
5.2 Conduit System
5.2.1 Surface or concealed conduit system of wiring shall be adopted, as specified in the drawings.
Required number of pull boxes shall be used at intervals to facilitate easy drawing of wires.
Separate conduit shall be run for lighting and power circuits. Further, conduits for Normal
lighting/Emergency lighting/DC critical lighting shall be separate. Conduit layout shall be decided at
site as per site conditions. Drop conduits for switch boards shall be decided by Contractor as per
wall locations shown in Architectural drawings. All exposed run of conduits on surface, shall be
vertical or horizontal.
5.2.2 Only threaded type conduit fittings shall be used for metallic conduit system. Pin grip type or clamp
type fittings are not acceptable. Conduit ends shall be free from sharp edges or burrs. The ends of
all conduits shall be reamed and neatly bushed.
Conduit shall be of minimum 25mm dia. Maximum number of wires permissible in a conduit shall
be seven for wire size of 2.5 sq mm.
5.2.3 The exposed outer surface of the conduit pipes, including all accessories forming part of the
conduit system, shall be adequately protected against rusting. In all cases, bare threaded portion
of conduit pipe shall not be exposed unless such bare threaded portion is treated with anti
corrosive preservative or covered with approved plastic compound.
5.2.4 Conduit connection to outlet boxes shall be by means of screwed hubs or check nuts on either
side. Where concealed wiring is done, junction boxes (65mm deep) shall be used so as to rest on
shuttering properly. All conduit connections shall be properly screwed and Junction box covers
shall be properly fitted so as to avoid entry of concrete slurry.
5.2.5 Where concealed wiring is to be adopted, conduits shall be laid in time before concreting of the
slab. Pull wire (GI or steel) shall be provided inside conduit for the ease of wire pulling. The
Contractor shall coordinate his work with other agencies involved in the civil works in such a way,
that the work of the other agencies is not hampered or delayed. Vertical conduit runs shall be
made in wall before plastering is done so as to avoid chasing. Where chases are made for conduit
run Contractor shall fill these chases or any other openings made by them after completing the
work and patch the surface. During installation, care shall be taken to see that proper covers are
provided to prevent rusting of conduits. Locations of all point outlets, junction boxes shall be
marked with brick powder or sand so that these are easily identified after shuttering removal. As
built conduit layout drawing shall be submitted by Contractor after completion of the work.
5.2.6 All junction boxes, bends and other accessories shall be of the same material as that of conduit
and shall have the same protective coatings.
5.2.7 After erection, the entire conduit system shall be tested, for mechanical and electrical continuity
and shall be permanently connected to earth by means of approved type of earthing clamps.
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 25 of 30
5.3 Hazardous Area Installation
5.3.1 Wiring in hazardous area shall be done by using minimum 2.5mm2 copper conductor armoured
cable. Circuit wiring feeding hazardous areas shall be controlled by two pole switches/MCBs (for
phase as well as neutral isolation).
5.3.2 Correct type of lighting equipment (fixtures and JBs) with regard to hazardous protection as
specified in the drawing shall be installed for the areas classified as Zone 1, Zone 2 etc.
5.3.3 The terminations in the junction boxes and the lighting fittings shall be done avoiding possibility of
loose connections due to vibrations. After the terminations are made the cover of the junction
boxes and the lighting fittings shall be closed properly with all bolts and hard wares in correct
position, retaining its explosion and weather protections. In fixtures having double cable entries,
both the entries shall be used for looping in and looping out connection, thus minimising the use of
a separate junction box. Wherever separate control gear boxes (C.G. box) are provided looping in
and looping out connections shall be through CG box, thus avoiding the use of a additional junction
box. All unused cable entries shall be sealed with suitable plugs.
5.3.4 Circuit cables shall be firmly cleated in a group along columns/ beam/ladders/side
channels/platform using 1.6mm thick GI saddles on 25x3 mm GI saddle bar at intervals of 400mm
to 500mm for straight run and on either side close to bending and at both termination ends as per
the directions of Purchaser. Where required, 3 or more of cables may be taken in slotted channel
tray after obtaining approval of the Purchaser. Cables shall not be routed along hand rails.
Where fire proofing column/structures are encountered, all cabling shall be taken in GI pipes of
required size and both ends shall be sealed, well before fire proofing is done. Similarly equipment
such as lighting fixture, control gear box, lighting/ power panels, field call stations, junction boxes
etc. shall be installed on suitable steel mounting frame/distance bracket, thereby avoiding direct
contact with the concrete used for fire proofing.
5.3.5 Cable glands for terminating cable on flameproof equipment shall be of double compression FLP
type. Any material/equipment specified to be supplied by Contractor for installation in hazardous
areas, shall be tested by CMRI and duly approved by PESO Nagpur or DGMS Dhanbad or any
other applicable statutory authority. All indigenous FLP equipment shall also have valid BIS license
as required by statutory authorities.
5.4 High Mast Lighting
5.4.1 The high masts shall be installed on concrete foundations with the base plate bolted on to the
anchor bolts. The high mast shall be painted with a coat of primer and two coats of aluminium
paint, the second coat to be given just before handing over to the Purchaser. The high masts shall
be numbered as per drawings. The high masts shall be connected to the plant earth grid at two
points.
5.4.2 Exact orientation of flood lighting fixtures shall be decided at site to achieve optimum utility of
these fixtures.
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 26 of 30
6.0 EARTHING INSTALLATION
6.1 This consist of main earth conductor (grid conductor) forming a closed ring network with required
number of earth electrodes connected to it to provide a common earth for electrical device and
metallic structures. From each earth electrode two distinct connections shall be made of the main
earth conductor. The earth plates shall be used for taking multiple earth connections to two or
more equipment.
6.2 The earth conductors shall be laid in ground, along cable trays / cable trench / pipe rack etc as
indicated on the earthing layout drawings. The location shown on the earthing layout drawings are
indicative. The exact location of earth conductors in the filed shall be determined by Contractor in
consultation with the Purchaser. Earth conductors shall be located avoiding interferences with
other services such as piping, instrumentation, civil, structural, mechanical etc.
6.3 Where lined cable trenches are available, the earth conductor shall be laid in the trenches and
shall be firmly cleated to the sidewall of concrete trenches using GI clamps at interval of 400 mm to
500 mm and near to the termination end. The earthing conductor shall run along one of the cable
trays along a cable route. The earthing conductor shall be suitably cleated and electrically bonded
to all the other cable trays on the same cable route at regular interval of 25 to 30 metre. The
earthing for equipment shall be tapped from the main earth conductor and not from cable tray
support structure. Earth conductor when laid underground shall be at a depth of 600mm below
finished grade level.
6.4 Joints and tapping in the main earth loop shall be made in such a way that reliable and good
electrical connections are permanently ensured. All joints below grade shall be welded and shall be
suitably protected by giving two coats of bitumen and covering with Hessian tape. Earth strip laid
above ground shall be welded across straight through joints and joints shall be suitably protected
by giving two coats of bitumen to avoid oxidation and insulation film formation of the strip surface.
When two earth strips are to be jointed by means of welding, lap welding with an overlapping of
strip equivalent to double the width of the strip and all four sides shall be continuously welded. All
joints at tappings above ground shall be means of connector/ lugs. A minimum of two bolts of
adequate size shall be used for this purpose. Earthing strip joints at earth plate and equipment
shall be through GI bolts, nut etc.
6.5 Installation of Earth Electrodes
6.5.1 Earth electrodes shall be installed as shown on earthing layout drawings and installation details.
The location shown on the earthing layout drawings are indicative. The exact location of earth
electrodes in the filed shall be determined by Contractor in consultation with the Purchaser,
depending on the soil strata and resistivity. Earth electrodes shall be located avoiding interferences
with other services such as road, building foundation, column, pipelines etc. The civil area
drawings shall be referred for this. The distance between two earth electrodes shall not be less
than twice the depth of electrode.
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 27 of 30
6.5.2 Earth electrodes shall preferably be located in a moist soil which has a fine texture, grain size and
distribution. Wherever practicable the soil be dug up, all lumps broken and stones removed from
the immediate vicinity of the electrodes and soil packed by watering and ramming as tight as
possible.
6.5.3 The electrodes shall have a clean surface, not covered by paint, enamel, grease or other materials
of poor conductivity.
6.5.4 All earth electrodes shall be tested for earth resistance by means of standard earth test meter. The
tests shall take place in dry months, preferably after a protracted dry spell.
6.5.5 The disconnect facility shall be provided for the individual earth electrode to check its earth
resistance periodically.
6.5.6 Location of earth electrodes shall be marked by permanent markers for easy identification. All
earth Electrodes shall be serial numbered and also marked on ‘As Built’ drawing for future
reference.
6.5.7 Individual earth electrodes shall be provided for each lighting arrestor and flood light mast.
6.5.8 Earthing system provided for concrete paved area by other agency where applicable; shall be
connected to the plant earthing system below ground by minimum two earth connections.
6.6 Connection
The earth system connections shall generally cover the following:
Equipment earthing for personnel safety
System neutral earthing
Static and lighting protection
6.6.1 The following shall be earthed.
System neutral
Current and potential transformer secondary neutral
Metallic non-current carrying parts of all electrical apparatus such as transformers,
switchboards, bus duct, motors, neutral earthing resistors, capacitors, UPS , battery charger
panels, welding receptacles, power sockets, lighting / power panels, control stations, lighting
fixtures etc.
Steel structures/ columns, rail loadings platforms etc.
Cable trays and racks, lighting mast and poles.
Storage tanks, spheres, vessels, columns and all other process equipment.
Fance and gate for electrical equipment (e.g. transformer, yard etc.)
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 28 of 30
Cable shields and armour
Flexible earth provision for Wagon, Truck
Shield wire
Conductor size for branch connection to various equipment shall be as per Installation details
unless otherwise stated on earthing layout drawings.
6.6.2 All process pipelines shall be bonded and earthed at the entry and exist points of battery limit of
hazardous area. Earth continuity conductors across pipe flanges shall not be provided as per OISD
110.
6.6.3 Steel pipe racks in the process units and offsite area shall be earthed at every 24 metres.
6.6.4 Equipment / street light pole etc. located remote from main network may be earthed by means of
individual earth electrode and earth conductor unless otherwise stated in specifications.
6.6.5 The main earthing network shall be used for earthing of equipment to protect against static
electricity.
6.6.6 All medium and high voltage equipment (above 250V) shall be earthed by two separate and
distinct connections with earth.
6.6.7 Plant instrument system clean earthing, UPS system clean / safety earth shall be separate from
the electrical earthing system.
6.6.8 All paint, scale and enamel shall be removed from the contact surface before the earthing
connections are made.
6.6.9 All earthing connections for equipment earthing shall be preferably from the earth plate mounted
above ground wherever provided. Equipment foundation bolts shall not be used for earthing
connection.
6.6.10 Earth connections shall be made through compression type cable welded lugs.
6.6.11 All hardware used for earthing installation shall be hot dip galvanized or zinc passivated. Spring
washers shall be used for all earthing connections and all connections adequately locked against
loosening.
6.6.12 Lighting fixtures and receptacles shall be earthed through the extra core provided in the lighting
circuit/ cable for this purpose.
6.6.13 The reinforcement of sub-station building and the sub-station floor shall be connected to main
earth grid.
7.0 LIGHTNING PROTECTION INSTALLATION
Lightning protection shall be provided for the equipment, structure and buildings as shown on
lightning protection layout drawings. Self conducting structures shall not require separate aerial rod
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 29 of 30
and down conductors. These shall however be connected to the earthing system at two or more
points as shown on earthing layout drawing. An independent earthing network shall be provided for
lightning protection and this shall be bonded at least at two points with the main earthing network
below ground. Lightning down conductor shall be brought to earth electrode in shortest straight
path as feasible to minimize surge impedance. Aerial and down conductors shall be located
avoiding interferences with other services such as ducts, pipes, equipment, supports etc.
8.0 LIST OF CONSTRUCTION EQUIPMENT
The contractor shall have all necessary construction equipment, tools and tackles and testing
instruments to carry out the erection works and to commission the system as specified. These shall
include but not be limited to the following, and these shall be brought to site by contractor before the
start of work.
8.1 Equipment
1. Portable grinder.
2. Portable welding machine.
3. Portable gas cutting / welding set.
4. Pipe threading machine.
5. Pipe bending machine (hydraulic).
6. Portable drill machine suitable to take up drilling for different sizes as per requirement.
7. Dewatering pump sets (diesel driven).
8. Power Hacksaw.
9. Conduit dyeset.
10. Hydraulic crimping machine.
11. Hand crimping tool.
12. Portable electric blowers, vacuum cleaners.
13. Miscellaneous items such as slings, pulleys, tarpaulins, wooden sleepers, ladders, etc. as
required.
14. Safety belts, safety goggles, and gloves.
15. Separate tool kit for each Electrician.
8.2 Test Instruments
1. Insulation tester 1000 V hand driven.
SPECIFICATION FOR ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
14495-00-EL-SPC-0014 Rev : A Page 30 of 30
2. Insulation tester 2500 V motor/hand driven.
3. Insulation tester 5000 V motor/hand driven
4. Phase sequence indicator.
5. Earth Resistance tester.
6. Single phase variac
7. 3 phases variac of adequate capacity.
8. Secondary injection testing kit.
9. Multimeter both analogue and digital
10. Portable Ammeters, Wattmeters, P.F. meters.
11. Portable Voltmeters.
12. Clip on meters of different ranges.
13. Tacho-meter.
14. Kelvins double bridge for measurement of very low resistance.
15. D.C. high -pot test kit.
16. Oil filtration machine of adequate capacity.
17. LUX METER to measure illumination levels.
14495-00-EL-SPC-0015 Rev : A Page 1 of 11
VVSPL CAPACITY AUGMENTATION PROJECT
Specification for Field Inspection, Testing and Commissioning
Project No: 403102-14495
Document No: 14495-00-EL-SPC-0015
14 Feb 2017
I-Think Lodha Techno Campus, 5
th Floor, Tower B,
Pokhran Road No. 2 Thane (West) – 400607 Tel: +91 2266515700 Fax: +91 2267818000
© Copyright 2017 WorleyParsons
SPECIFICATION FOR FIELD INSPECTION, TESTING AND COMMISSIONING
14495-00-EL-SPC-0015 Rev : A Page 3 of 11
CONTENTS
1.0 SCOPE ............................................................................................................................... 4
2.0 CODES AND STANDARDS ......................................................................................... 4
3.0 FILED INSPECTION, TESTING AND COMMISSIONING ................................................. 5
SPECIFICATION FOR FIELD INSPECTION, TESTING AND COMMISSIONING
14495-00-EL-SPC-0015 Rev : A Page 4 of 11
1.0 SCOPE
This specification covers minimum requirements for the field inspection, testing and commissioning
of electrical equipment and installation, forming part of electrical power distribution and utilization
system for VVSPL Capacity Augmentation Project.
The Contractor shall be fully responsible for the installation of electrical equipment.
Definitions
Purchaser : Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited
Engineer / Consultant : WorleyParsons India Pvt. Ltd.
Contractor : Contractor of field inspection, testing and commissioning of electrical
equipment and installation
Vendor / Manufacturer : Supplier of electrical bulk items
2.0 CODES AND STANDARDS
2.1 The filed inspection, testing and commissioning of electrical equipment and installation shall be
carried out in line with this specification and the latest edition of following Indian Standards and
OISD standards.
2.2 In addition to the above it shall be ensured that the field inspection, testing and commissioning
conforms to the requirements of the following as applicable:
a) Indian Electricity Act and Rules.
b) Regulations laid down by CEA/Electrical Inspectorate.
c) Regulations laid down by PESO / DGMS (as applicable).
SP 30 (BIS) National Electrical Code 2011
IS 1255 Code of practice for installation and maintenance of power cables
up to and including 33kV rating
IS 7816 Guide for testing Insulation resistance of rotating machines
IS 10810 : Part 43 Method of test for cables : Part 43 - Insulation resistances
IS 10810 : Part 45 Method of test for cables : Part 45 - High Voltage test
OISD-STD-137 Inspection of Electrical Equipment
OISD-RP-147 Inspection and safe practices during electrical installations
SPECIFICATION FOR FIELD INSPECTION, TESTING AND COMMISSIONING
14495-00-EL-SPC-0015 Rev : A Page 5 of 11
d) The petroleum rules (ministry of Industry Government of India).
e) Any other regulations laid down by central/state/local authorities and Insurance agencies.
2 .3 In case of any contradiction between various referred standards, specifications and statutory
regulations the following order of priority shall govern:
- Statutory regulations
- This specification
- Codes and standards
However the Contractor shall bring any such contradiction to the notice of Purchaser for prior
approval.
3.0 FILED INSPECTION, TESTING AND COMMISSIONING
3.1 Contractor shall carry out complete filed inspection, testing and commissioning of electrical
equipment as per Inspection Test Plans.
3.2 Before the complete installation or an addition to the existing installation is put into service,
inspection/ pre-commissioning checks and tests shall carried out by contractor, In the event of
defects being found out , the same shall be rectified and the installation retested as applicable.
3.3 The pre-commissioning inspection among the requirements shall include visual inspection,
checking the workmanship of the installation, the rating of equipment, safety clearances sizes of
cables installed, conformance to the AFC document, soundness of switchgear bus connections,
wiring properly dressed and labeled, sealing of unused cable entries, checking of all safety
interlocks, control/ interface functions as per requirements etc.
3.4 Visual inspection for soundness of bus bar connections of bus ducts, terminal connections of
equipments / motor shall be carried out. It shall be ensure that no foreign materials are present
inside bus duct and equipment terminal boxes. After the visual inspection, all the covers of
equipment manufacturers instructions.
3.5 Pre- commissioning tests shall include but not be limited to the following
Continuity test for each winding and power and control circuits.
Insulation test for each winding and power and control circuit.
High Voltage test for cables
Dielectric strength test on transformer oil.
Checking the correctness of wiring schemes, control circuit interlocks for intended functioning
Verification of phase sequence.
SPECIFICATION FOR FIELD INSPECTION, TESTING AND COMMISSIONING
14495-00-EL-SPC-0015 Rev : A Page 6 of 11
Testing of all types of relays/ releases for required operation.
Testing of measuring instruments for proper functioning
Earth continuity test for all circuits.
Checking of safety features of correctness of operation etc.
Checking of all wired interface contacts (analog, digital input/ output contacts) for DCS and ESD
interface, at panel and equipment terminal chambers as applicable. (Contractor shall co-
ordinate with the other agencies involved for the above and provide support service for
checking interfaces of electrical equipments and the intended functioning)
Earth resistance measurement for each earth electrode and the earthing system as a whole.
Lighting installation shall be tested for correct illumination levels, with the fittings installed.
Fittings shall be operated only With specified type of a lamp or tube.
Checking of battery float and boost charge voltage at correct levels.
Load trials as agreed between Contractor and Purchaser.
3.6 After the above test and inspection are completed, control circuits shall be tested for correct
operation under all operating combinations and proved correct applying power to main circuits.
3.7 A close visual inspection of electrical equipment in hazardous area shall be made to ensure that
equipment is suitable for the classified zone and gas group and correctly installed , with all covers,
bolts, nuts and hardware’s intact and there is no physical damage mark seen on the enclosure.
3.8 Site Acceptance test procedure for specific equipment shall be furnished by the respective
equipment vendor. The contractor shall provide necessary assistance to the equipment vendor to
perform site acceptance testing to enable the equipment vendor to perform the same.
3.9 All pre-commissioning checks and tests shall be carried out as per the directions of Purchaser. In
addition to the equipment manufacturers instructions, pre-commissioning check requirements shall
also be complied. All tests shall be carried out by contractor in the presence of Purchaser.
3.10 The contractor shall bring to site required tools, tackles and testing instruments for carrying out
filed testing, Contractor shall use only calibrated measuring and test instrument and shall maintain
calibrated records.
3.11 The Insulation Resistance test values for various electrical equipment shall be below:
3.11.1 Cables
The insulation resistance test values for cables shall be as per following table:
SPECIFICATION FOR FIELD INSPECTION, TESTING AND COMMISSIONING
14495-00-EL-SPC-0015 Rev : A Page 7 of 11
Rated Voltage of the Cable DC Test Voltage in Volts
Minimum Insulation
resistance in Mega
ohms
Lighting and power circuit wiring 250 1
650 /1100V grade cables 1,000 10
1,900/3,600V grade cables 1,000 200
3,800/6,600V grade cables 1,000 200
6,350/11,000V grade cables 5,000 200
8,700/15,000V grade cables 5,000 200
12,700/22000V grade cables 5,000 200
19,000/33000V grade cables 5,000 200
3.11.2 HV, MV and Miscellaneous Switchboards
The insulation resistance test values for switchboards shall be as per following table:
Rated Voltage of the
Switchboard DC Test Voltage in Volts
Minimum Insulation
resistance in Mega ohms
33,000V 5,000 200
11,000V 5,000 200
6,600V 1,000 200
3,300V 1,000 200
415V 1,000 100
240V 500 10
110V 500 10
3.11.3 Generators and Motors
The insulation resistance test values for Generators and Motors shall be as per following table:
SPECIFICATION FOR FIELD INSPECTION, TESTING AND COMMISSIONING
14495-00-EL-SPC-0015 Rev : A Page 8 of 11
Rated Voltage of the
Generators and Motors DC Test Voltage in Volts
Minimum Insulation
resistance in Mega ohms
11,000V 5,000 120
6,600V 1,000 80
3,300V 1,000 50
415V 1,000 15
240V 500 12
3.11.4 Transformers
The insulation resistance test values for Transformers shall be as per following table:
Rated Voltage of the
Transformers DC Test Voltage in Volts
Minimum Insulation
resistance in Mega ohms
Up to 600V 1,000 100
601 to 500V 2,500 1,000
5001 to 15,000V 5,000 5,000
15001 to 35,000V 5,000 10,000
3.11.5 It shall be ensured that during insulation tests, electronic devices and components that are liable to
get damaged on applied test voltage shall be disconnected from circuit. The instructions of
equipment / panel manufacturer shall be followed strictly in this regard.
3.11.6 For medium voltage (up to 1000V), 1000V Megger and for high voltage 5 kV Megger shall be used
3.12 High Voltage testing
3.12.1 D.C. high voltage test shall be conducted as per following table on all H. V. feeder cables and also
on 1100 V grade cables where straight through joints have been made.
Rated Voltage
of cable (kV) TEST VOLTAGE (kV) BETWEEN
Duration
(Minutes)
Uo / U *
Any Conductor and
Metallic Sheath /
Screen / Armour
Conductor to Conductor
(For Unscreened Cables)
SPECIFICATION FOR FIELD INSPECTION, TESTING AND COMMISSIONING
14495-00-EL-SPC-0015 Rev : A Page 9 of 11
0.65/1.1 3 3 5
1.9/3.3 5 9 5
3.3/3.3 9 9 5
3.8/6.6 10.5 18 5
6.6/6.6 18 18 5
6.35/11 18 30 5
11/11 30 30 5
12.7/22 37.5 - 5
19/33 60 - 5
* UO : Phase Voltage
U : Line Voltage
3.12.2 The cable cores must be discharged on completion of DC high voltage test and cable shall be kept
earthed until it is put into service.
3.12.3 DC test voltage for old cables shall be 1.5 times rated voltage or less depending on the age of
cables, repair work or nature of joining work carried out, etc. In any case, the test voltage shall not
be less than the rated voltage.
3.13 All protective relays including thermal overload relays shall be tested by secondary injection
current. Primary injection tests shall be carried out for differential protection, restricted earth fault
protection at full/ reduced current to ensure correctness of complete wiring.
3.14 Before energizing any equipment, ‘COMMISSIONING CLEARANCE FORM’ as per standard
format shall be duly filled in by contractor and submitted to WP/ Owner.
3.15 It shall be ensured that the electrical inspectorate approval is available before energizing the
equipment.
3.16 Cables
3.16.1 Before energizing, the insulation resistance of every circuit shall be measured from phase to
neutral and from phase/neutral to earth.
3.16.2 Where splices or terminations are required in circuits rated above 650 volts, insulation resistance
of each length of cable shall be measured before splicing and or /terminating. After completion of
splices and /or terminations measurements shall be repeated.
3.16.3 The insulation resistance of directly buried cable shall be measured before cable trenches are back
filled. Measurements shall be repeated after back filing.
SPECIFICATION FOR FIELD INSPECTION, TESTING AND COMMISSIONING
14495-00-EL-SPC-0015 Rev : A Page 10 of 11
3.16.4 D.C. High Voltage test shall be conducted on cables given below after installation.
a) All 1100 volts grade cables in which straight through joints have been made.
b) All cables above 1100 V grade.
Cables shall be installed in final positions with all the straight through joints complete. During the
high voltage test, all other electrical equipment related to the cable installation, such as switches,
instrument transformers, bus bars, etc., must be earthed and adequate clearance shall be
maintained from the other equipment and framework to prevent flash overs. In each test, the
metallic sheath/screen/armour shall be connected to earth.
3.17 Lighting and Small Power System
3.17.1 Pre-commissioning checks and tests shall include but not be limited to the following:
a) The insulation resistance of each circuit without the lamps (load) being in place shall be
measured and it should not be less than 1000,000 ohms. (Between phases, phases to neutral,
phase/neutral to Earth).
b) Current and voltage of all the phases shall be measured at the lighting panel busbars with
all the circuits switched on with lamps. If required load shall be balanced on the three phases.
c) The earth continuity for all socket outlets shall be checked. A fixed relative position of the
phase and neutral connections inside the socket shall be established for all sockets.
d) After inserting all the lamps and switching on all the circuits, minimum and maximum illumination
level shall be measured in the area and recorded.
e) It shall be ensured that switch provided for ON/OFF control of point (light/fan/socket) is only
on LIVE side.
f) Operation of ELCB's shall be checked
g) focusing angle of fixtures shall be changed/ adjusted where required
3.18 Earthing System
3.18.1 Earthing systems/ connections shall be tested as follows:
a) Resistance of individual earth electrodes shall be measured after disconnecting it from the grid
by using standard earth test megger.
b) Earthing resistance of the grid shall be measured after connecting all the earth electrodes to the
grid. The resistance value of an earth grid to the general mass of earth shall be as follows:
For the electrical system and equipment a value that ensures the operation of the protection
device in the electrical circuit but not in excess of 1 ohm.
SPECIFICATION FOR FIELD INSPECTION, TESTING AND COMMISSIONING
14495-00-EL-SPC-0015 Rev : A Page 11 of 11
For lighting protection, the value of 5 ohms as earth resistance shall be desirable, but in no
case it shall be more than 10 ohms.
c) The resistance to earth shall be measured typically at the following points:
At each electrical system earth or system neutral earth.
At each earth provided for structure lighting protections.
At one point on earthing system used to earth electrical equipment enclosures.
At one point on earthing system used to earth wiring system, enclosures, such as metal
conduits and cable sheaths or armour.
At one point on fence enclosing electrical equipment.
–
HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM
CORPORATION LTD.
HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM
CORPORATION LTD.
HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM
CORPORATION LTD.
HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM
CORPORATION LTD.
HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM
CORPORATION LTD.
HINDUSTAN PETROLEUM
CORPORATION LTD.